changeset: 5507:64be8a494bdc
parent: 5496:a7da359711ce
user: Aidan Kehoe <kehoea(a)parhasard.net>
date: Mon May 09 19:38:01 2011 +0100
files: man/ChangeLog man/Makefile man/doclicense.texi man/info.texi man/texinfo.tex
man/texinfo.texi man/texinfo/fdl.texi man/texinfo/texinfo.texi man/texinfo/version.texi
man/widget.texi
description:
Backed out changeset a7da359711ce, restoring Ben's GPLv3 manual changes.
diff -r a7da359711ce -r 64be8a494bdc man/ChangeLog
--- a/man/ChangeLog Mon May 02 10:35:36 2011 +0100
+++ b/man/ChangeLog Mon May 09 19:38:01 2011 +0100
@@ -1,3 +1,440 @@
+2010-02-19 Ben Wing <ben(a)xemacs.org>
+
+ * widget.texi:
+ * widget.texi (Top):
+ * widget.texi (Introduction):
+ * widget.texi (User Interface):
+ * widget.texi (Programming Example):
+ * widget.texi (Setting Up the Buffer):
+ * widget.texi (Basic Types):
+ * widget.texi (link):
+ * widget.texi (url-link):
+ * widget.texi (info-link):
+ * widget.texi (push-button):
+ * widget.texi (editable-field):
+ * widget.texi (text):
+ * widget.texi (menu-choice):
+ * widget.texi (radio-button-choice):
+ * widget.texi (item):
+ * widget.texi (choice-item):
+ * widget.texi (toggle):
+ * widget.texi (checkbox):
+ * widget.texi (checklist):
+ * widget.texi (editable-list):
+ * widget.texi (group):
+ * widget.texi (Sexp Types):
+ * widget.texi (constants):
+ * widget.texi (generic):
+ * widget.texi (atoms):
+ * widget.texi (composite):
+ * widget.texi (Widget Properties):
+ * widget.texi (Defining New Widgets):
+ * widget.texi (Widget Browser):
+ * widget.texi (Widget Minor Mode):
+ * widget.texi (Utilities):
+ * widget.texi (Widget Wishlist):
+ * widget.texi (Widget Internals):
+ * widget.texi (GNU Free Documentation License):
+ * widget.texi (Index):
+ Sync with FSF 23.1.92.
+
+2010-02-19 Ben Wing <ben(a)xemacs.org>
+
+ * texinfo/fdl.texi: New file.
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi:
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Top):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Copying Conditions):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Overview):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Reporting Bugs):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Using Texinfo):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Output Formats):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Info Files):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Printed Books):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Formatting Commands):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Conventions):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Comments):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Minimum):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Six Parts):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Short Sample):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (History):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Texinfo Mode):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Texinfo Mode Overview):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (XEmacs Editing):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Inserting):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Showing the Structure):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Updating Nodes and Menus):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Updating Commands):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Updating Requirements):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Other Updating Commands):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Info Formatting):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Printing):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Texinfo Mode Summary):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Beginning a File):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Sample Beginning):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Texinfo File Header):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (First Line):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Start of Header):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (setfilename):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (settitle):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (End of Header):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Document Permissions):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (copying):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (insertcopying):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Titlepage & Copyright Page):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (titlepage):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (titlefont center sp):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (title subtitle author):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Copyright):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (end titlepage):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (headings on off):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Contents):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (The Top Node):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Top Node Example):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Master Menu Parts):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Global Document Commands):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (documentdescription):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (setchapternewpage):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (paragraphindent):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (firstparagraphindent):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (exampleindent):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Software Copying Permissions):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Ending a File):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Printing Indices & Menus):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (File End):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Structuring):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Tree Structuring):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Structuring Command Types):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (makeinfo top):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (chapter):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (unnumbered & appendix):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (majorheading & chapheading):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (section):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (unnumberedsec appendixsec heading):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (subsection):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (subsubsection):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Raise/lower sections):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Nodes):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Two Paths):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Node Menu Illustration):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (node):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Node Names):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Writing a Node):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Node Line Tips):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Node Line Requirements):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (First Node):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (makeinfo top command):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (makeinfo Pointer Creation):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (anchor):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Menus):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Menu Location):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Writing a Menu):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Menu Parts):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Less Cluttered Menu Entry):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Menu Example):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Other Info Files):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Cross References):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (References):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Cross Reference Commands):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Cross Reference Parts):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (xref):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Reference Syntax):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (One Argument):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Two Arguments):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Three Arguments):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Four and Five Arguments):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Top Node Naming):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (ref):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (pxref):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (inforef):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (uref):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (cite):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Marking Text):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Indicating):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Useful Highlighting):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (code):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (kbd):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (key):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (samp):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (verb):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (var):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (env):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (file):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (command):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (option):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (dfn):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (abbr):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (acronym):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (indicateurl):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (email):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Emphasis):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (emph & strong):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Smallcaps):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Fonts):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Quotations and Examples):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Block Enclosing Commands):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (quotation):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (example):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (verbatim):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (verbatiminclude):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (lisp):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (small):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (display):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (format):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (exdent):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (flushleft & flushright):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (noindent):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (indent):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (cartouche):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Lists and Tables):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Introducing Lists):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (itemize):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (enumerate):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Two-column Tables):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (table):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (ftable vtable):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (itemx):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Multi-column Tables):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Multitable Column Widths):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Multitable Rows):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Special Displays):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Floats):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (float):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (caption shortcaption):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (listoffloats):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Images):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Image Syntax):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Image Scaling):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Footnotes):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Footnote Commands):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Footnote Styles):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Indices):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Index Entries):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Predefined Indices):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Indexing Commands):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Combining Indices):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (syncodeindex):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (synindex):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (New Indices):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Insertions):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Atsign Braces Comma):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Inserting an Atsign):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Inserting Braces):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Inserting a Comma):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Inserting Quote Characters):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Inserting Space):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Not Ending a Sentence):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Ending a Sentence):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Multiple Spaces):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (frenchspacing):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (dmn):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Inserting Accents):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Inserting Quotation Marks):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Dots Bullets):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (dots):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (bullet):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (TeX and copyright):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (tex):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (copyright symbol):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (registered symbol):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (euro):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (pounds):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (textdegree):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (minus):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (geq leq):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (math):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Click Sequences):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Glyphs):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Glyphs Summary):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (result):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (expansion):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Print Glyph):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Error Glyph):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Equivalence):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Point Glyph):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Breaks):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Break Commands):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Line Breaks):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (- and hyphenation):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (allowcodebreaks):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (w):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (tie):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (sp):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (page):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (group):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (need):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Definition Commands):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Def Cmd Template):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Def Cmd Continuation Lines):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Optional Arguments):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (deffnx):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Def Cmds in Detail):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Functions Commands):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Variables Commands):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Typed Functions):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Typed Variables):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Data Types):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Abstract Objects):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Object-Oriented Variables):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Object-Oriented Methods):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Defining Macros):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Invoking Macros):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Macro Details):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (alias):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (definfoenclose):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Hardcopy):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Use TeX):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Format with tex/texindex):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Format with texi2dvi):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Print with lpr):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Within XEmacs):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Texinfo Mode Printing):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Compile-Command):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Requirements Summary):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Preparing for TeX):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Overfull hboxes):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (smallbook):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (A4 Paper):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (pagesizes):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Cropmarks and Magnification):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (PDF Output):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Obtaining TeX):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Creating and Installing Info Files):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Creating an Info File):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (makeinfo advantages):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Invoking makeinfo):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (makeinfo options):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Pointer Validation):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (makeinfo in XEmacs):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (texinfo-format commands):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Batch Formatting):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Tag and Split Files):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Installing an Info File):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Directory File):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (New Info File):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Other Info Directories):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Installing Dir Entries):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Invoking install-info):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Generating HTML):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (HTML Translation):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (HTML Splitting):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (HTML CSS):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (HTML Xref):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (HTML Xref Link Basics):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (HTML Xref Node Name Expansion):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (HTML Xref Command Expansion):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (HTML Xref 8-bit Character Expansion):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (HTML Xref Mismatch):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Command List):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Command Syntax):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Tips):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Sample Texinfo Files):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Short Sample Texinfo File):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (GNU Sample Texts):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Invoking sample):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (GNU Free Documentation License):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Index):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Verbatim Copying License):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (All-permissive Copying License):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Include Files):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Using Include Files):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (texinfo-multiple-files-update):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Include Files Requirements):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Sample Include File):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Include Files Evolution):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Headings):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Headings Introduced):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Heading Format):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Heading Choice):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Custom Headings):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Catching Mistakes):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (makeinfo Preferred):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Debugging with Info):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Debugging with TeX):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Using texinfo-show-structure):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Using occur):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Running Info-Validate):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Using Info-validate):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Unsplit):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Tagifying):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Splitting):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Refilling Paragraphs):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (Command and Variable Index):
+ * texinfo/texinfo.texi (General Index):
+ * texinfo/version.texi: New file.
+ Sync with FSF 23.1.92. Make new directory to hold the files needed
+ to generate texinfo.info, since there are three such files now.
+
+2010-02-19 Ben Wing <ben(a)xemacs.org>
+
+ * Makefile:
+ * Makefile (src_files1):
+ * Makefile (DIR):
+ * Makefile (texinfo-srcs):
+ * Makefile ($(INFODIR)/widget.info):
+ * Makefile ($(INFODIR)/texinfo.info):
+ * Makefile (.PHONY):
+ * Makefile (texinfo.dvi):
+ * Makefile (texinfo.pdf):
+ * Makefile ($(HTMLDIR)/widget.html):
+ * Makefile ($(HTMLDIR)/texinfo.html):
+ Incorporate texinfo.texi moving to a subdirectory texinfo/.
+ Do some tricks to reduce the amount of duplication while still
+ maintaining compatible with non-GNU make (at least, with
+ Solaris make).
+
+ * doclicense.texi: New file.
+ * info.texi:
+ * info.texi (Top):
+ * info.texi (Getting Started):
+ * info.texi (Help-Small-Screen):
+ * info.texi (Help):
+ * info.texi (Help-P):
+ * info.texi (Help-^L):
+ * info.texi (Help-Inv):
+ * info.texi (Help-]):
+ * info.texi (Help-M):
+ * info.texi (Help-FOO):
+ * info.texi (Help-Xref):
+ * info.texi (Help-Int):
+ * info.texi (Help-Q):
+ * info.texi (Advanced):
+ * info.texi (Search Text):
+ * info.texi (Search Index):
+ * info.texi (Go to node):
+ * info.texi (Choose menu subtopic):
+ * info.texi (Create Info buffer):
+ * info.texi (XEmacs Info Variables):
+ * info.texi (Expert Info):
+ * info.texi (Add):
+ * info.texi (Menus):
+ * info.texi (Cross-refs):
+ * info.texi (Help-Cross):
+ * info.texi (Tags):
+ * info.texi (Checking):
+ * info.texi (Index):
+ * texinfo.tex:
+ * texinfo.tex (paragraphindent{%):
+ * texinfo.tex (sectionheading will have):
+ * texinfo.tex (chapterzzz{#3}%):
+ * texinfo.tex (subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec):
+ * texinfo.tex (subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec):
+ * texinfo.tex (subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec):
+ * texinfo.tex (sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%):
+ * texinfo.tex (sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%):
+ * texinfo.tex (sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%):
+ * texinfo.tex
(sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%):
+ * texinfo.tex (sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%):
+ * texinfo.tex (sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%):
+ * texinfo.tex (sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%):
+ * texinfo.tex (sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%):
+ * texinfo.tex (sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%):
+ * texinfo.tex (sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}):
+ * texinfo.tex (sectionheading to do the printing.):
+ * texinfo.tex (sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%):
+ * texinfo.tex (sectionheading, q.v.):
+ Sync with FSF 23.1.92.
+
2010-02-10 Stephen J. Turnbull <stephen(a)xemacs.org>
* xemacs-faq.texi (Top): Update menu.
diff -r a7da359711ce -r 64be8a494bdc man/Makefile
--- a/man/Makefile Mon May 02 10:35:36 2011 +0100
+++ b/man/Makefile Mon May 09 19:38:01 2011 +0100
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
# Makefile for man subdirectory in XEmacs
# Copyright (C) 1995 Board of Trustees, University of Illinois
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995 Sun Microsystems.
-# Copyright (C) 2005 Ben Wing.
+# Copyright (C) 2005, 2010 Ben Wing.
# This file is part of XEmacs.
@@ -43,77 +43,37 @@
HTMLDIR = ../html
PHOTODIR = ../etc/photos
-info_files = \
- $(INFODIR)/beta.info \
- $(INFODIR)/cl.info \
- $(INFODIR)/custom.info \
- $(INFODIR)/emodules.info \
- $(INFODIR)/external-widget.info \
- $(INFODIR)/info.info \
- $(INFODIR)/internals.info \
- $(INFODIR)/lispref.info \
- $(INFODIR)/new-users-guide.info \
- $(INFODIR)/standards.info \
- $(INFODIR)/term.info \
- $(INFODIR)/termcap.info \
- $(INFODIR)/texinfo.info \
- $(INFODIR)/widget.info \
- $(INFODIR)/xemacs-faq.info \
- $(INFODIR)/xemacs.info
+src_files1 = \
+ $(DIR)beta.texi \
+ $(DIR)cl.texi \
+ $(DIR)custom.texi \
+ $(DIR)emodules.texi \
+ $(DIR)external-widget.texi \
+ $(DIR)info.texi \
+ $(DIR)internals.texi \
+ $(DIR)lispref.texi \
+ $(DIR)new-users-guide.texi \
+ $(DIR)standards.texi \
+ $(DIR)term.texi \
+ $(DIR)termcap.texi \
+ $(DIR)texinfo.texi \
+ $(DIR)widget.texi \
+ $(DIR)xemacs.texi \
+ $(DIR)xemacs-faq.texi
-html_files = \
- $(HTMLDIR)/beta.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/cl.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/custom.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/emodules.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/external-widget.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/info.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/lispref.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/internals.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/new-users-guide.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/standards.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/term.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/termcap.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/texinfo.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/widget.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/xemacs.html \
- $(HTMLDIR)/xemacs-faq.html
+DIR:=
+src_files:= $(src_files1)
-dvi_files = \
- beta.dvi \
- cl.dvi \
- custom.dvi \
- emodules.dvi \
- external-widget.dvi \
- info.dvi \
- lispref.dvi \
- internals.dvi \
- new-users-guide.dvi \
- standards.dvi \
- term.dvi \
- termcap.dvi \
- texinfo.dvi \
- widget.dvi \
- xemacs.dvi \
- xemacs-faq.dvi
+DIR:= $(INFODIR)/
+info_files:= $(src_files1:.texi=.info)
-pdf_files = \
- beta.pdf \
- cl.pdf \
- custom.pdf \
- emodules.pdf \
- external-widget.pdf \
- info.pdf \
- lispref.pdf \
- internals.pdf \
- new-users-guide.pdf \
- standards.pdf \
- term.pdf \
- termcap.pdf \
- texinfo.pdf \
- widget.pdf \
- xemacs.pdf \
- xemacs-faq.pdf
+DIR:= $(HTMLDIR)/
+html_files:= $(src_files1:.texi=.html)
+
+dvi_files:= $(src_files:.texi=.dvi)
+
+pdf_files:= $(src_files:.texi=.pdf)
+
xemacs-srcs = \
xemacs/abbrevs.texi \
@@ -243,6 +203,11 @@
new-users-guide/search.texi \
new-users-guide/xmenu.texi
+texinfo-srcs = \
+ texinfo/fdl.texi \
+ texinfo/texinfo.texi \
+ texinfo/version.texi
+
$(INFODIR)/beta.info : beta.texi
$(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/beta.info beta.texi
@@ -270,10 +235,7 @@
$(INFODIR)/termcap.info : termcap.texi
$(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/termcap.info termcap.texi
-$(INFODIR)/texinfo.info: texinfo.texi
- $(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/texinfo.info texinfo.texi
-
-$(INFODIR)/widget.info: widget.texi
+$(INFODIR)/widget.info: widget.texi doclicense.texi
$(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/widget.info widget.texi
$(INFODIR)/xemacs-faq.info : xemacs-faq.texi
@@ -292,12 +254,16 @@
$(INFODIR)/new-users-guide.info : $(new-users-guide-srcs)
$(MAKEINFO) -P new-users-guide -o $(INFODIR)/new-users-guide.info
new-users-guide/new-users-guide.texi
+$(INFODIR)/texinfo.info: $(texinfo-srcs)
+ $(MAKEINFO) -P texinfo -o $(INFODIR)/texinfo.info texinfo/texinfo.texi
+
xemacs : $(INFODIR)/xemacs.info
lispref : $(INFODIR)/lispref.info
internals : $(INFODIR)/internals.info
new-users-guide.info : $(INFODIR)/new-users-guide.info
+texinfo: $(INFODIR)/texinfo.info
-.PHONY: xemacs lispref internals new-users-guide info dvi pdf
+.PHONY: xemacs lispref internals new-users-guide texinfo info dvi pdf
info : $(info_files)
html : $(html_files)
@@ -320,6 +286,9 @@
new-users-guide.dvi : $(new-users-guide-srcs)
$(TEXI2DVI) -I new-users-guide new-users-guide/new-users-guide.texi
+texinfo.dvi: $(texinfo-srcs)
+ $(TEXI2DVI) -I texinfo texinfo/texinfo.texi
+
dvi : $(dvi_files)
xemacs.pdf: $(xemacs-srcs)
@@ -333,6 +302,9 @@
new-users-guide.pdf: $(new-users-guide-srcs)
$(TEXI2DVI) --pdf -I new-users-guide new-users-guide/new-users-guide.texi
+
+texinfo.pdf: $(texinfo-srcs)
+ $(TEXI2DVI) --pdf -I texinfo texinfo/texinfo.texi
pdf: $(pdf_files)
@@ -381,9 +353,6 @@
$(HTMLDIR)/termcap.html : termcap.texi
$(TEXI2HTML_SPLIT) termcap.texi
-$(HTMLDIR)/texinfo.html: texinfo.texi
- $(TEXI2HTML_SPLIT) texinfo.texi
-
$(HTMLDIR)/widget.html : widget.texi
$(TEXI2HTML_SPLIT) widget.texi
@@ -412,9 +381,13 @@
$(HTMLDIR)/new-users-guide.html : $(new-users-guide-srcs)
$(TEXI2HTML_SPLIT) new-users-guide/new-users-guide.texi
+$(HTMLDIR)/texinfo.html: $(texinfo-srcs)
+ $(TEXI2HTML_SPLIT) texinfo/texinfo.texi
+
xemacs : $(HTMLDIR)/xemacs.html
lispref : $(HTMLDIR)/lispref.html
internals : $(HTMLDIR)/internals.html
new-users-guide.html : $(HTMLDIR)/new-users-guide.html
+texinfo: $(HTMLDIR)/texinfo.html
html : $(html_files)
diff -r a7da359711ce -r 64be8a494bdc man/doclicense.texi
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/man/doclicense.texi Mon May 09 19:38:01 2011 +0100
@@ -0,0 +1,513 @@
+@c -*-texinfo-*-
+@c The GNU Free Documentation License.
+@center Version 1.3, 3 November 2008
+@c Synced up with: FSF 23.1.92.
+@c Synced by: Ben Wing, 2-17-10.
+
+@c This file is intended to be included within another document,
+@c hence no sectioning command or @node.
+
+@display
+Copyright @copyright{} 2000, 2001, 2002, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+@uref{http://fsf.org/}
+
+Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
+of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
+@end display
+
+@enumerate 0
+@item
+PREAMBLE
+
+The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other
+functional and useful document @dfn{free} in the sense of freedom: to
+assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it,
+with or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially.
+Secondarily, this License preserves for the author and publisher a way
+to get credit for their work, while not being considered responsible
+for modifications made by others.
+
+This License is a kind of ``copyleft'', which means that derivative
+works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. It
+complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft
+license designed for free software.
+
+We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free
+software, because free software needs free documentation: a free
+program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms that the
+software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals;
+it can be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or
+whether it is published as a printed book. We recommend this License
+principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference.
+
+@item
+APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS
+
+This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that
+contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be
+distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice grants a
+world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, to use that
+work under the conditions stated herein. The ``Document'', below,
+refers to any such manual or work. Any member of the public is a
+licensee, and is addressed as ``you''. You accept the license if you
+copy, modify or distribute the work in a way requiring permission
+under copyright law.
+
+A ``Modified Version'' of the Document means any work containing the
+Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with
+modifications and/or translated into another language.
+
+A ``Secondary Section'' is a named appendix or a front-matter section
+of the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the
+publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall
+subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall
+directly within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document is in
+part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain
+any mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical
+connection with the subject or with related matters, or of legal,
+commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding
+them.
+
+The ``Invariant Sections'' are certain Secondary Sections whose titles
+are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the notice
+that says that the Document is released under this License. If a
+section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not
+allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may contain zero
+Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant
+Sections then there are none.
+
+The ``Cover Texts'' are certain short passages of text that are listed,
+as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that
+the Document is released under this License. A Front-Cover Text may
+be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words.
+
+A ``Transparent'' copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy,
+represented in a format whose specification is available to the
+general public, that is suitable for revising the document
+straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of
+pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available
+drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or
+for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input
+to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file
+format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to thwart
+or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent.
+An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount
+of text. A copy that is not ``Transparent'' is called ``Opaque''.
+
+Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain
+@sc{ascii} without markup, Texinfo input format, La@TeX{} input
+format, @acronym{SGML} or @acronym{XML} using a publicly available
+@acronym{DTD}, and standard-conforming simple @acronym{HTML},
+PostScript or @acronym{PDF} designed for human modification. Examples
+of transparent image formats include @acronym{PNG}, @acronym{XCF} and
+@acronym{JPG}. Opaque formats include proprietary formats that can be
+read and edited only by proprietary word processors, @acronym{SGML} or
+@acronym{XML} for which the @acronym{DTD} and/or processing tools are
+not generally available, and the machine-generated @acronym{HTML},
+PostScript or @acronym{PDF} produced by some word processors for
+output purposes only.
+
+The ``Title Page'' means, for a printed book, the title page itself,
+plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material
+this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in
+formats which do not have any title page as such, ``Title Page'' means
+the text near the most prominent appearance of the work's title,
+preceding the beginning of the body of the text.
+
+The ``publisher'' means any person or entity that distributes copies
+of the Document to the public.
+
+A section ``Entitled XYZ'' means a named subunit of the Document whose
+title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following
+text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ stands for a
+specific section name mentioned below, such as ``Acknowledgements'',
+``Dedications'', ``Endorsements'', or ``History''.) To
``Preserve the Title''
+of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a
+section ``Entitled XYZ'' according to this definition.
+
+The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which
+states that this License applies to the Document. These Warranty
+Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in this
+License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other
+implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has
+no effect on the meaning of this License.
+
+@item
+VERBATIM COPYING
+
+You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either
+commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the
+copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies
+to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other
+conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use
+technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further
+copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept
+compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough
+number of copies you must also follow the conditions in section 3.
+
+You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and
+you may publicly display copies.
+
+@item
+COPYING IN QUANTITY
+
+If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have
+printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and the
+Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the
+copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover
+Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on
+the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify
+you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present
+the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and
+visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition.
+Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve
+the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated
+as verbatim copying in other respects.
+
+If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit
+legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit
+reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent
+pages.
+
+If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering
+more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent
+copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy
+a computer-network location from which the general network-using
+public has access to download using public-standard network protocols
+a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material.
+If you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps,
+when you begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure
+that this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated
+location until at least one year after the last time you distribute an
+Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that
+edition to the public.
+
+It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the
+Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give
+them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document.
+
+@item
+MODIFICATIONS
+
+You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under
+the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you release
+the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the Modified
+Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution
+and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy
+of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version:
+
+@enumerate A
+@item
+Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct
+from that of the Document, and from those of previous versions
+(which should, if there were any, be listed in the History section
+of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version
+if the original publisher of that version gives permission.
+
+@item
+List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities
+responsible for authorship of the modifications in the Modified
+Version, together with at least five of the principal authors of the
+Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five),
+unless they release you from this requirement.
+
+@item
+State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the
+Modified Version, as the publisher.
+
+@item
+Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
+
+@item
+Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications
+adjacent to the other copyright notices.
+
+@item
+Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice
+giving the public permission to use the Modified Version under the
+terms of this License, in the form shown in the Addendum below.
+
+@item
+Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections
+and required Cover Texts given in the Document's license notice.
+
+@item
+Include an unaltered copy of this License.
+
+@item
+Preserve the section Entitled ``History'', Preserve its Title, and add
+to it an item stating at least the title, year, new authors, and
+publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If
+there is no section Entitled ``History'' in the Document, create one
+stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as
+given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified
+Version as stated in the previous sentence.
+
+@item
+Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for
+public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise
+the network locations given in the Document for previous versions
+it was based on. These may be placed in the ``History'' section.
+You may omit a network location for a work that was published at
+least four years before the Document itself, or if the original
+publisher of the version it refers to gives permission.
+
+@item
+For any section Entitled ``Acknowledgements'' or ``Dedications'',
Preserve
+the Title of the section, and preserve in the section all the
+substance and tone of each of the contributor acknowledgements and/or
+dedications given therein.
+
+@item
+Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document,
+unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers
+or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles.
+
+@item
+Delete any section Entitled ``Endorsements''. Such a section
+may not be included in the Modified Version.
+
+@item
+Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled ``Endorsements'' or
+to conflict in title with any Invariant Section.
+
+@item
+Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.
+@end enumerate
+
+If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or
+appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material
+copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all
+of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the
+list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's license notice.
+These titles must be distinct from any other section titles.
+
+You may add a section Entitled ``Endorsements'', provided it contains
+nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various
+parties---for example, statements of peer review or that the text has
+been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a
+standard.
+
+You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a
+passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list
+of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of
+Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or
+through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already
+includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or
+by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of,
+you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit
+permission from the previous publisher that added the old one.
+
+The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License
+give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or
+imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
+
+@item
+COMBINING DOCUMENTS
+
+You may combine the Document with other documents released under this
+License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for modified
+versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the
+Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and
+list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its
+license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty Disclaimers.
+
+The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and
+multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single
+copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but
+different contents, make the title of each such section unique by
+adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original
+author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number.
+Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of
+Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined work.
+
+In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled ``History''
+in the various original documents, forming one section Entitled
+``History''; likewise combine any sections Entitled
``Acknowledgements'',
+and any sections Entitled ``Dedications''. You must delete all
+sections Entitled ``Endorsements.''
+
+@item
+COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS
+
+You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents
+released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this
+License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in
+the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for
+verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects.
+
+You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute
+it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this
+License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all
+other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document.
+
+@item
+AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS
+
+A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate
+and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or
+distribution medium, is called an ``aggregate'' if the copyright
+resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights
+of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit.
+When the Document is included in an aggregate, this License does not
+apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves
+derivative works of the Document.
+
+If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these
+copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half of
+the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed on
+covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the
+electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic form.
+Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole
+aggregate.
+
+@item
+TRANSLATION
+
+Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may
+distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section 4.
+Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special
+permission from their copyright holders, but you may include
+translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the
+original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a
+translation of this License, and all the license notices in the
+Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also include
+the original English version of this License and the original versions
+of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between
+the translation and the original version of this License or a notice
+or disclaimer, the original version will prevail.
+
+If a section in the Document is Entitled ``Acknowledgements'',
+``Dedications'', or ``History'', the requirement (section 4) to Preserve
+its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the actual
+title.
+
+@item
+TERMINATION
+
+You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document
+except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt
+otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute it is void, and
+will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
+
+However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your license
+from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) provisionally,
+unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and finally
+terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright holder
+fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means prior to
+60 days after the cessation.
+
+Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is
+reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the
+violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have
+received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that
+copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after
+your receipt of the notice.
+
+Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the
+licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under
+this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently
+reinstated, receipt of a copy of some or all of the same material does
+not give you any rights to use it.
+
+@item
+FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE
+
+The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions
+of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new
+versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
+differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See
+@uref{http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/}.
+
+Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number.
+If the Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this
+License ``or any later version'' applies to it, you have the option of
+following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or
+of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the
+Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version
+number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not
+as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the Document
+specifies that a proxy can decide which future versions of this
+License can be used, that proxy's public statement of acceptance of a
+version permanently authorizes you to choose that version for the
+Document.
+
+@item
+RELICENSING
+
+``Massive Multiauthor Collaboration Site'' (or ``MMC Site'') means any
+World Wide Web server that publishes copyrightable works and also
+provides prominent facilities for anybody to edit those works. A
+public wiki that anybody can edit is an example of such a server. A
+``Massive Multiauthor Collaboration'' (or ``MMC'') contained in the
+site means any set of copyrightable works thus published on the MMC
+site.
+
+``CC-BY-SA'' means the Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0
+license published by Creative Commons Corporation, a not-for-profit
+corporation with a principal place of business in San Francisco,
+California, as well as future copyleft versions of that license
+published by that same organization.
+
+``Incorporate'' means to publish or republish a Document, in whole or
+in part, as part of another Document.
+
+An MMC is ``eligible for relicensing'' if it is licensed under this
+License, and if all works that were first published under this License
+somewhere other than this MMC, and subsequently incorporated in whole
+or in part into the MMC, (1) had no cover texts or invariant sections,
+and (2) were thus incorporated prior to November 1, 2008.
+
+The operator of an MMC Site may republish an MMC contained in the site
+under CC-BY-SA on the same site at any time before August 1, 2009,
+provided the MMC is eligible for relicensing.
+
+@end enumerate
+
+@page
+@heading ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents
+
+To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of
+the License in the document and put the following copyright and
+license notices just after the title page:
+
+@smallexample
+@group
+ Copyright (C) @var{year} @var{your name}.
+ Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
+ under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
+ or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
+ with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover
+ Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
+ Free Documentation License''.
+@end group
+@end smallexample
+
+If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts,
+replace the ``with(a)dots{}Texts.'' line with this:
+
+@smallexample
+@group
+ with the Invariant Sections being @var{list their titles}, with
+ the Front-Cover Texts being @var{list}, and with the Back-Cover Texts
+ being @var{list}.
+@end group
+@end smallexample
+
+If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other
+combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the
+situation.
+
+If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we
+recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of
+free software license, such as the GNU General Public License,
+to permit their use in free software.
+
+
+@c Local Variables:
+@c ispell-local-pdict: "ispell-dict"
+@c End:
+
+@ignore
+ arch-tag: c1679162-1d8a-4f02-bc52-2e71765f0165
+@end ignore
diff -r a7da359711ce -r 64be8a494bdc man/info.texi
--- a/man/info.texi Mon May 02 10:35:36 2011 +0100
+++ b/man/info.texi Mon May 09 19:38:01 2011 +0100
@@ -1,115 +1,126 @@
-\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
+\input texinfo.tex @c -*-texinfo-*-
+@c We must \input texinfo.tex instead of texinfo, otherwise make
+@c distcheck in the Texinfo distribution fails, because the texinfo Info
+@c file is made first, and texi2dvi must include . first in the path.
@comment %**start of header
-@setfilename ../info/info.info
+@setfilename info.info
@settitle Info
+@syncodeindex fn cp
+@syncodeindex vr cp
+@syncodeindex ky cp
@comment %**end of header
-@comment $Id: info.texi,v 1.9 2001/04/13 09:11:28 michaels Exp $
+@c Synced up with: Texinfo 4.13.
+@c Synced by: Ben Wing, 2-19-10.
+
+@copying
+This file describes how to use Info, the on-line, menu-driven GNU
+documentation system.
+
+Copyright @copyright{} 1989, 1992, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
+2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+@quotation
+Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
+under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
+any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
+Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
+Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
+license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
+License'' in the XEmacs manual.
+
+(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and
+modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Buying copies from GNU
+Press supports the FSF in developing GNU and promoting software
+freedom.''
+
+This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
+Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
+separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
+license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
+@end quotation
+@end copying
@dircategory Texinfo documentation system
@direntry
-* Info: (info). Documentation browsing system.
+* Info: (info). How to use the documentation browsing system.
@end direntry
-
-@ifinfo
-This file describes how to use Info, the on-line, menu-driven GNU
-documentation system.
-
-Copyright (C) 1989, 92, 96, 97, 98, 99 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
-this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
-are preserved on all copies.
-
-@ignore
-Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
-results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
-notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
-(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
-
-@end ignore
-Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
-manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that the entire
-resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a permission
-notice identical to this one.
-
-Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
-into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions,
-except that this permission notice may be stated in a translation approved
-by the Free Software Foundation.
-@end ifinfo
@titlepage
@title Info
-@subtitle The online, menu-driven GNU documentation system
+@subtitle The online, hyper-text GNU documentation system
@author Brian Fox
+@author and the GNU Texinfo community
@page
@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
-Copyright @copyright{} 1989, 92, 93, 96, 97, 98, 99 Free Software
-Foundation, Inc.
-@sp 2
-Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330 @*
-Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
-this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
-are preserved on all copies.
-
-Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
-manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that the entire
-resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a permission
-notice identical to this one.
-
-Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
-into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions,
-except that this permission notice may be stated in a translation approved
-by the Free Software Foundation.
+@insertcopying
@end titlepage
+@contents
+
+@ifnottex
@node Top
@top Info: An Introduction
-Info is a program for reading documentation, which you might be using
-now to read this.
+The GNU Project distributes most of its on-line manuals in the
+@dfn{Info format}, which you read using an @dfn{Info reader}. You are
+probably using an Info reader to read this now.
-To learn how to use Info, type the command @kbd{h} while using the Info
-program. It brings you to a programmed instruction sequence.
+There are two primary Info readers: @code{info}, a stand-alone program
+designed just to read Info files (@pxref{Top,,Stand-alone Info,
+info-stnd, GNU Info}), and the @code{info} package in XEmacs, a
+general-purpose editor. At present, only the XEmacs reader supports
+using a mouse.
+
+@ifinfo
+If you are new to the Info reader and want to learn how to use it,
+type the command @kbd{h} now. It brings you to a programmed
+instruction sequence.
+
+To read about advanced Info commands, type @kbd{n} twice. This
+brings you to @cite{Advanced Info Commands}, skipping over the `Getting
+Started' chapter.
+@end ifinfo
+@end ifnottex
@menu
* Getting Started:: Getting started using an Info reader.
-* Advanced Info:: Advanced commands within Info.
-* Creating an Info File:: How to make your own Info file.
+* Advanced:: Advanced Info commands.
+* Expert Info:: Info commands for experts.
+* Index:: An index of topics, commands, and variables.
@end menu
-@node Getting Started, Advanced Info, Top, Top
+@node Getting Started, Advanced, Top, Top
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
@chapter Getting Started
-This first part of the Info manual describes how to get around inside
+This first part of this Info manual describes how to get around inside
of Info. The second part of the manual describes various advanced
-Info commands, and how to write an Info as distinct from a Texinfo
-file. The third part is about how to generate Info files from
-Texinfo files.
+Info commands. The third part briefly explains how to generate Info
+files from Texinfo files, and describes how to write an Info file
+by hand.
-@iftex
-This manual is primarily designed for use on a computer, so that you can
-try Info commands while reading about them. Reading it on paper is less
+@ifnotinfo
+This manual is primarily designed for browsing with an Info reader
+program on a computer, so that you can try Info commands while reading
+about them. Reading it on paper or with an HTML browser is less
effective, since you must take it on faith that the commands described
-really do what the manual says. By all means go through this manual now
-that you have it; but please try going through the on-line version as
-well.
+really do what the manual says. By all means go through this manual
+now that you have it; but please try going through the on-line version
+as well.
+@cindex Info reader, how to invoke
+@cindex entering Info
There are two ways of looking at the online version of this manual:
@enumerate
@item
Type @code{info} at your shell's command line. This approach uses a
-small stand-alone program designed just to read Info files.
+stand-alone program designed just to read Info files.
@item
-Type @code{emacs} at the command line; then type @kbd{C-h i} (Control
-@kbd{h}, followed by @kbd{i}). This approach uses the Info mode of the
-Emacs program, an editor with many other capabilities.
+Type @code{xemacs} at the command line; then type @kbd{C-h i}
+(@kbd{Control-h}, followed by @kbd{i}). This approach uses the Info
+mode of the XEmacs editor.
@end enumerate
In either case, then type @kbd{mInfo} (just the letters), followed by
@@ -118,90 +129,98 @@
the screen.
@c FIXME! (pesch(a)cygnus.com, 14 dec 1992)
@c Is it worth worrying about what-if the beginner goes to somebody
-@c else's Emacs session, which already has an Info running in the middle
+@c else's XEmacs session, which already has an Info running in the middle
@c of something---in which case these simple instructions won't work?
-@end iftex
+@end ifnotinfo
@menu
-* Help-Small-Screen:: Starting Info on a Small Screen
-* Help:: How to use Info
-* Help-P:: Returning to the Previous node
-* Help-^L:: The Space, Rubout, B and ^L commands.
-* Help-M:: Menus
-* Help-Adv:: Some advanced Info commands
-* Help-Q:: Quitting Info
+* Help-Small-Screen:: Starting Info on a Small Screen.
+* Help:: How to use Info.
+* Help-P:: Returning to the Previous node.
+* Help-^L:: The Space, DEL, B and ^L commands.
+* Help-Inv:: Invisible text in XEmacs Info.
+* Help-M:: Menus.
+* Help-Xref:: Following cross-references.
+* Help-Int:: Some intermediate Info commands.
+* Help-Q:: Quitting Info.
@end menu
-@node Help-Small-Screen, Help, , Getting Started
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@node Help-Small-Screen
@section Starting Info on a Small Screen
-@iftex
+@ifnotinfo
(In Info, you only see this section if your terminal has a small
number of lines; most readers pass by it without seeing it.)
-@end iftex
+@end ifnotinfo
-Since your terminal has an unusually small number of lines on its
+@cindex small screen, moving around
+Since your terminal has a relatively small number of lines on its
screen, it is necessary to give you special advice at the beginning.
-If you see the text @samp{--All----} at near the bottom right corner
-of the screen, it means the entire text you are looking at fits on the
-screen. If you see @samp{--Top----} instead, it means that there is
-more text below that does not fit. To move forward through the text
-and see another screen full, press the Space bar, @key{SPC}. To move
-back up, press the key labeled @samp{Backspace} or @key{Delete}.
+If the entire text you are looking at fits on the screen, the text
+@samp{All} will be displayed at the bottom of the screen. In the
+stand-alone Info reader, it is displayed at the bottom right corner of
+the screen; in XEmacs, it is displayed on the modeline. If you see the
+text @samp{Top} instead, it means that there is more text below that
+does not fit. To move forward through the text and see another screen
+full, press @key{SPC}, the Space bar. To move back up, press the key
+labeled @samp{Backspace} or @samp{DEL} (on some keyboards, this key
+might be labeled @samp{Delete}).
@ifinfo
-Here are 40 lines of junk, so you can try Spaces and Deletes and
+Here are 40 lines of junk, so you can try @key{SPC} and @key{DEL} and
see what they do. At the end are instructions of what you should do
next.
-This is line 17 @*
-This is line 18 @*
-This is line 19 @*
-This is line 20 @*
-This is line 21 @*
-This is line 22 @*
-This is line 23 @*
-This is line 24 @*
-This is line 25 @*
-This is line 26 @*
-This is line 27 @*
-This is line 28 @*
-This is line 29 @*
-This is line 30 @*
-This is line 31 @*
-This is line 32 @*
-This is line 33 @*
-This is line 34 @*
-This is line 35 @*
-This is line 36 @*
-This is line 37 @*
-This is line 38 @*
-This is line 39 @*
-This is line 40 @*
-This is line 41 @*
-This is line 42 @*
-This is line 43 @*
-This is line 44 @*
-This is line 45 @*
-This is line 46 @*
-This is line 47 @*
-This is line 48 @*
-This is line 49 @*
-This is line 50 @*
-This is line 51 @*
-This is line 52 @*
-This is line 53 @*
-This is line 54 @*
-This is line 55 @*
-This is line 56 @*
+@format
+This is line 20
+This is line 21
+This is line 22
+This is line 23
+This is line 24
+This is line 25
+This is line 26
+This is line 27
+This is line 28
+This is line 29
+This is line 30
+This is line 31
+This is line 32
+This is line 33
+This is line 34
+This is line 35
+This is line 36
+This is line 37
+This is line 38
+This is line 39
+This is line 40
+This is line 41
+This is line 42
+This is line 43
+This is line 44
+This is line 45
+This is line 46
+This is line 47
+This is line 48
+This is line 49
+This is line 50
+This is line 51
+This is line 52
+This is line 53
+This is line 54
+This is line 55
+This is line 56
+This is line 57
+This is line 58
+This is line 59
+@end format
If you have managed to get here, go back to the beginning with
-Delete, and come back here again, then you understand Space and
-Delete. So now type an @kbd{n} ---just one character; don't type
-the quotes and don't type the Return key afterward--- to
-get to the normal start of the course.
+@kbd{DEL} (or @key{BACKSPACE}), and come back here again, then you
+understand the about the @samp{Space} and @samp{Backspace} keys. So
+now type an @kbd{n}---just one character; don't type the quotes and
+don't type the Return key afterward---to get to the normal start of
+the course.
@end ifinfo
@node Help, Help-P, Help-Small-Screen, Getting Started
@@ -210,141 +229,315 @@
You are talking to the program Info, for reading documentation.
+ There are two ways to use Info: from within XEmacs or as a
+stand-alone reader that you can invoke from a shell using the command
+@command{info}.
+
+@cindex node, in Info documents
Right now you are looking at one @dfn{Node} of Information.
A node contains text describing a specific topic at a specific
-level of detail. This node's topic is ``how to use Info''.
+level of detail. This node's topic is ``how to use Info''. The mode
+line says that this is node @samp{Help} in the file @file{info}.
- The top line of a node is its @dfn{header}. This node's header (look at
-it now) says that it is the node named @samp{Help} in the file
-@file{info}. It says that the @samp{Next} node after this one is the node
-called @samp{Help-P}. An advanced Info command lets you go to any node
-whose name you know.
+@cindex header of Info node
+ The top line of a node is its @dfn{header}. This node's header
+(look at it now) says that the @samp{Next} node after this one is the
+node called @samp{Help-P}. An advanced Info command lets you go to
+any node whose name you know. In the stand-alone Info reader program,
+the header line shows the names of this node and the Info file as
+well. In XEmacs, the header line is displayed with a special typeface,
+and remains at the top of the window all the time even if you scroll
+through the node.
- Besides a @samp{Next}, a node can have a @samp{Previous} or an @samp{Up}.
-This node has a @samp{Previous} but no @samp{Up}, as you can see.
+ Besides a @samp{Next}, a node can have a @samp{Previous} link, or an
+@samp{Up} link, or both. As you can see, this node has all of these
+links.
+@kindex n @r{(Info mode)}
Now it is time to move on to the @samp{Next} node, named @samp{Help-P}.
->> Type @samp{n} to move there. Type just one character;
+@format
+>> Type @kbd{n} to move there. Type just one character;
do not type the quotes and do not type a @key{RET} afterward.
+@end format
+@noindent
@samp{>>} in the margin means it is really time to try a command.
+
+@format
+>> If you are in XEmacs and have a mouse, and if you already practiced
+ typing @kbd{n} to get to the next node, click now with the left
+ mouse button on the @samp{Next} link to do the same ``the mouse way''.
+@end format
@node Help-P, Help-^L, Help, Getting Started
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
@section Returning to the Previous node
+@kindex p @r{(Info mode)}
This node is called @samp{Help-P}. The @samp{Previous} node, as you see,
is @samp{Help}, which is the one you just came from using the @kbd{n}
command. Another @kbd{n} command now would take you to the next
node, @samp{Help-^L}.
->> But do not do that yet. First, try the @kbd{p} command, which takes
- you to the @samp{Previous} node. When you get there, you can do an
- @kbd{n} again to return here.
+@format
+>> But do not type @kbd{n} yet. First, try the @kbd{p} command, or
+ (in XEmacs) click on the @samp{Prev} link. That takes you to
+ the @samp{Previous} node. Then use @kbd{n} to return here.
+@end format
- This all probably seems insultingly simple so far, but @emph{do not} be
-led into skimming. Things will get more complicated soon. Also,
-do not try a new command until you are told it is time to. Otherwise,
-you may make Info skip past an important warning that was coming up.
+ If you read this in XEmacs, you will see an @samp{Info} item in the
+menu bar, close to its right edge. Clicking the mouse on the
+@samp{Info} menu-bar item opens a menu of commands which include
+@samp{Next} and @samp{Previous} (and also some others which you didn't yet
+learn about).
->> Now do an @kbd{n} to get to the node @samp{Help-^L} and learn more.
+ This all probably seems insultingly simple so far, but @emph{please
+don't} start skimming. Things will get complicated soon enough!
+Also, please do not try a new command until you are told it is time
+to. You could make Info skip past an important warning that was
+coming up.
-@node Help-^L, Help-M, Help-P, Getting Started
+@format
+>> Now do an @kbd{n}, or (in XEmacs) click the middle mouse button on
+ the @samp{Next} link, to get to the node @samp{Help-^L} and learn more.
+@end format
+
+@node Help-^L, Help-Inv, Help-P, Getting Started
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section The Space, Delete, B and ^L commands.
+@section The Space, DEL, B and ^L commands
- This node's header tells you that you are now at node @samp{Help-^L}, and
-that @kbd{p} would get you back to @samp{Help-P}. The node's title is
-underlined; it says what the node is about (most nodes have titles).
+ This node's mode line tells you that you are now at node
+@samp{Help-^L}, and the header line tells you that @kbd{p} would get
+you back to @samp{Help-P}. The node's title is highlighted and may be
+underlined as well; it says what the node is about.
This is a big node and it does not all fit on your display screen.
You can tell that there is more that is not visible because you
-can see the string @samp{--Top-----} rather than @samp{--All----} near
-the bottom right corner of the screen.
+can see the text @samp{Top} rather than @samp{All} near the bottom of
+the screen.
- The Space, Delete and @kbd{B} commands exist to allow you to ``move
-around'' in a node that does not all fit on the screen at once.
-Space moves forward, to show what was below the bottom of the screen.
-Delete moves backward, to show what was above the top of the screen
-(there is not anything above the top until you have typed some spaces).
+@kindex SPC @r{(Info mode)}
+@kindex DEL @r{(Info mode)}
+@kindex BACKSPACE @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-scroll-up
+@findex Info-scroll-down
+ The @key{SPC}, @key{BACKSPACE} (or @key{DEL})@footnote{The key which
+we call ``Backspace or DEL'' in this manual is labeled differently on
+different keyboards. Look for a key which is a little ways above the
+@key{ENTER} or @key{RET} key and which you normally use outside XEmacs
+to erase the character before the cursor, i.e.@: the character you
+typed last. It might be labeled @samp{Backspace} or @samp{<-} or
+@samp{DEL}, or sometimes @samp{Delete}.} and @kbd{b} commands exist to
+allow you to ``move around'' in a node that does not all fit on the
+screen at once. @key{SPC} moves forward, to show what was below the
+bottom of the screen. @key{DEL} or @key{BACKSPACE} moves backward, to
+show what was above the top of the screen (there is not anything above
+the top until you have typed some spaces).
->> Now try typing a Space (afterward, type a Delete to return here).
+@format
+>> Now try typing a @key{SPC} (afterward, type a @key{BACKSPACE} to
+ return here).
+@end format
- When you type the space, the two lines that were at the bottom of
-the screen appear at the top, followed by more lines. Delete takes
-the two lines from the top and moves them to the bottom,
-@emph{usually}, but if there are not a full screen's worth of lines
-above them they may not make it all the way to the bottom.
+ When you type the @key{SPC}, the two lines that were at the bottom of
+the screen appear at the top, followed by more lines. @key{DEL} or
+@key{BACKSPACE} takes the two lines from the top and moves them to the
+bottom, @emph{usually}, but if there are not a full screen's worth of
+lines above them they may not make it all the way to the bottom.
- If you type Space when there is no more to see, it rings the
-bell and otherwise does nothing. The same goes for Delete when
-the header of the node is visible.
+ If you are reading this in XEmacs, note that the header line is
+always visible, never scrolling off the display. That way, you can
+always see the @samp{Next}, @samp{Prev}, and @samp{Up} links, and you
+can conveniently go to one of these links at any time by
+clicking the middle mouse button on the link.
- If your screen is ever garbaged, you can tell Info to print it out
-again by typing @kbd{C-l} (@kbd{Control-L}, that is---hold down ``Control'' and
-type an @key{L} or @kbd{l}).
+@cindex reading Info documents top to bottom
+@cindex Info documents as tutorials
+ @key{SPC} and @key{DEL} not only move forward and backward through
+the current node. They also move between nodes. @key{SPC} at the end
+of a node moves to the next node; @key{DEL} (or @key{BACKSPACE}) at
+the beginning of a node moves to the previous node. In effect, these
+commands scroll through all the nodes in an Info file as a single
+logical sequence. You can read an entire manual top to bottom by just
+typing @key{SPC}, and move backward through the entire manual from
+bottom to top by typing @key{DEL} (or @key{BACKSPACE}).
+ In this sequence, a node's subnodes appear following their parent.
+If a node has a menu, @key{SPC} takes you into the subnodes listed in
+the menu, one by one. Once you reach the end of a node, and have seen
+all of its subnodes, @key{SPC} takes you to the next node or to the
+parent's next node.
+
+@kindex PAGEUP @r{(Info mode)}
+@kindex PAGEDOWN @r{(Info mode)}
+ Many keyboards nowadays have two scroll keys labeled @samp{PageUp}
+and @samp{PageDown} (or maybe @samp{Prior} and @samp{Next}). If your
+keyboard has these keys, you can use them to move forward and backward
+through the text of one node, like @key{SPC} and @key{BACKSPACE} (or
+@key{DEL}). However, @key{PAGEUP} and @key{PAGEDOWN} keys never
+scroll beyond the beginning or the end of the current node.
+
+@kindex C-l @r{(Info mode)}
+ If your screen is ever garbaged, you can tell Info to display it
+again by typing @kbd{C-l} (@kbd{Control-L}---that is, hold down
+@key{CTRL} and type @kbd{L} or @kbd{l}).
+
+@format
> Type @kbd{C-l} now.
+@end format
+@kindex b @r{(Info mode)}
To move back to the beginning of the node you are on, you can type
-a lot of Deletes. You can also type simply @kbd{b} for beginning.
+the @key{BACKSPACE} key (or @key{DEL}) many times. You can also type
+@kbd{b} just once. @kbd{b} stands for ``beginning.''
+
+@format
> Try that now. (We have put in enough verbiage to push this past
-the first screenful, but screens are so big nowadays that perhaps it
-isn't enough. You may need to shrink your Emacs or Info window.)
-Then come back, with Spaces.
+ the first screenful, but screens are so big nowadays that perhaps it
+ isn't enough. You may need to shrink your XEmacs or Info window.)
+ Then come back, by typing @key{SPC} one or more times.
+@end format
- If your screen is very tall, all of this node might fit at once.
-In that case, "b" won't do anything. Sorry; what can we do?
-
+@kindex ? @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-summary
You have just learned a considerable number of commands. If you
want to use one but have trouble remembering which, you should type
-a @key{?} which prints out a brief list of commands. When you are
-finished looking at the list, make it go away by pressing @key{SPC}
+@kbd{?}, which displays a brief list of commands. When you are
+finished looking at the list, make it go away by typing @key{SPC}
repeatedly.
+@format
> Type a @key{?} now. Press @key{SPC} to see consecutive
screenfuls of
->> the list until finished.
+ the list until finished. Then type @key{SPC} several times. If
+ you are using XEmacs, the help will then go away automatically.
+@end format
+
+ (If you are using the stand-alone Info reader, type @kbd{C-x 0} to
+return here, that is---press and hold @key{CTRL}, type an @kbd{x},
+then release @key{CTRL} and @kbd{x}, and press @kbd{0}; that's a zero,
+not the letter ``o''.)
From now on, you will encounter large nodes without warning, and
-will be expected to know how to use Space and Delete to move
-around in them without being told. Since not all terminals have
+will be expected to know how to use @key{SPC} and @key{BACKSPACE} to
+move around in them without being told. Since not all terminals have
the same size screen, it would be impossible to warn you anyway.
->> Now type @kbd{n} to see the description of the @kbd{m} command.
+@format
+>> Now type @kbd{n}, or click the middle mouse button on the @samp{Next} link,
+ to visit the next node.
+@end format
-@node Help-M, Help-Adv, Help-^L, Getting Started
+@node Help-Inv, Help-M, Help-^L, Getting Started
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Menus
+@section Invisible text in XEmacs Info
-Menus and the @kbd{m} command
+ Before discussing menus, we need to make some remarks that are only
+relevant to users reading Info using XEmacs. Users of the stand-alone
+version can skip this node by typing @kbd{]} now.
- With only the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} commands for moving between nodes, nodes
-are restricted to a linear sequence. Menus allow a branching
-structure. A menu is a list of other nodes you can move to. It is
-actually just part of the text of the node formatted specially so that
-Info can interpret it. The beginning of a menu is always identified
-by a line which starts with @samp{* Menu:}. A node contains a menu if and
-only if it has a line in it which starts that way. The only menu you
-can use at any moment is the one in the node you are in. To use a
-menu in any other node, you must move to that node first.
+@cindex invisible text in XEmacs
+ In XEmacs, certain text that appears in the stand-alone version is
+normally hidden, technically because it has the @samp{invisibility}
+property. Invisible text is really a part of the text. It becomes
+visible (by default) after killing and yanking, it appears in printed
+output, it gets saved to file just like any other text, and so on.
+Thus it is useful to know it is there.
+
+@findex visible-mode
+You can make invisible text visible by using the command @kbd{M-x
+visible-mode}. Visible mode is a minor mode, so using the command a
+second time will make the text invisible again. Watch the effects of
+the command on the ``menu'' below and the top line of this node.
+
+If you prefer to @emph{always} see the invisible text, you can set
+@code{Info-hide-note-references} to @code{nil}. Enabling Visible mode
+permanently is not a real alternative, because XEmacs Info also uses
+(although less extensively) another text property that can change the
+text being displayed, the @samp{display} property. Only the
+invisibility property is affected by Visible mode. When, in this
+tutorial, we refer to the @samp{XEmacs} behavior, we mean the
+@emph{default} XEmacs behavior.
+
+Now type @kbd{]}, to learn about the @kbd{]} and @kbd{[} commands.
+
+@menu
+* ]: Help-]. Node telling about ].
+* stuff: Help-]. Same node.
+* Help-]:: Yet again, same node.
+@end menu
+
+@node Help-], , , Help-Inv
+@subsection The @kbd{]} and @kbd{[} commands
+
+If you type @kbd{n} now, you get an error message saying that this
+node has no next node. Similarly, if you type @kbd{p}, the error
+message tells you that there is no previous node. (The exact message
+depends on the Info reader you use.) This is because @kbd{n} and
+@kbd{p} carry you to the next and previous node @emph{at the same
+level}. The present node is contained in a menu (see next) of the
+node you came from, and hence is considered to be at a lower level.
+It is the only node in the previous node's menu (even though it was
+listed three times). Hence it has no next or previous node that
+@kbd{n} or @kbd{p} could move to.
+
+If you systematically move through a manual by typing @kbd{n}, you run
+the risk of skipping many nodes. You do not run this risk if you
+systematically use @kbd{@key{SPC}}, because, when you scroll to the
+bottom of a node and type another @kbd{@key{SPC}}, then this carries
+you to the following node in the manual @emph{regardless of level}.
+If you immediately want to go to that node, without having to scroll
+to the bottom of the screen first, you can type @kbd{]}.
+
+Similarly, @kbd{@key{BACKSPACE}} carries you to the preceding node
+regardless of level, after you scrolled to the beginning of the
+present node. If you want to go to the preceding node immediately,
+you can type @kbd{[}.
+
+For instance, typing this sequence will come back here in three steps:
+@kbd{[ n [}. To do the same backward, type @kbd{] p ]}.
+
+Now type @kbd{]} to go to the next node and learn about menus.
+
+@node Help-M, Help-Xref, Help-Inv, Getting Started
+@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@section Menus and the @kbd{m} command
+
+@cindex menus in an Info document
+@cindex Info menus
+ With only the @kbd{n} (next), @kbd{p} (previous), @kbd{@key{SPC}},
+@kbd{@key{BACKSPACE}}, @kbd{]} and @kbd{[} commands for moving between
+nodes, nodes are restricted to a linear sequence. Menus allow a
+branching structure. A menu is a list of other nodes you can move to.
+It is actually just part of the text of the node formatted specially
+so that Info can interpret it. The beginning of a menu is always
+identified by a line which starts with @w{@samp{* Menu:}}. A node
+contains a menu if and only if it has a line in it which starts that
+way. The only menu you can use at any moment is the one in the node
+you are in. To use a menu in any other node, you must move to that
+node first.
After the start of the menu, each line that starts with a @samp{*}
-identifies one subtopic. The line usually contains a brief name
-for the subtopic (followed by a @samp{:}), the name of the node that talks
-about that subtopic, and optionally some further description of the
+identifies one subtopic. The line usually contains a brief name for
+the subtopic (followed by a @samp{:}, normally hidden in XEmacs), the
+name of the node that talks about that subtopic (again, normally
+hidden in XEmacs), and optionally some further description of the
subtopic. Lines in the menu that do not start with a @samp{*} have no
special meaning---they are only for the human reader's benefit and do
not define additional subtopics. Here is an example:
@example
-* Foo: FOO's Node This tells about FOO
+* Foo: Node about FOO. This tells about FOO.
@end example
-The subtopic name is Foo, and the node describing it is @samp{FOO's Node}.
-The rest of the line is just for the reader's Information.
-[[ But this line is not a real menu item, simply because there is
-no line above it which starts with @samp{* Menu:}.]]
+The subtopic name is Foo, and the node describing it is @samp{Node
+about FOO}. The rest of the line is just for the reader's
+Information. [[ But this line is not a real menu item, simply because
+there is no line above it which starts with @w{@samp{* Menu:}}. Also,
+in a real menu item, the @samp{*} would appear at the very start of
+the line. This is why the ``normally hidden'' text in XEmacs, namely
+@samp{: Node about FOO.}, is actually visible in this example, even
+when Visible mode is off.]]
When you use a menu to go to another node (in a way that will be
described soon), what you specify is the subtopic name, the first
@@ -358,44 +551,56 @@
abbreviation for this:
@example
-* Foo:: This tells about FOO
+* Foo:: This tells about FOO.
@end example
@noindent
This means that the subtopic name and node name are the same; they are
-both @samp{Foo}.
+both @samp{Foo}. (The @samp{::} is normally hidden in XEmacs.)
->> Now use Spaces to find the menu in this node, then come back to
- the front with a @kbd{b} and some Spaces. As you see, a menu is
+@format
+>> Now use @key{SPC} to find the menu in this node, then come back to
+ the front with a @kbd{b} and some @key{SPC}s. As you see, a menu is
actually visible in its node. If you cannot find a menu in a node
by looking at it, then the node does not have a menu and the
@kbd{m} command is not available.
+@end format
- The command to go to one of the subnodes is @kbd{m}---but @emph{do
-not do it yet!} Before you use @kbd{m}, you must understand the
-difference between commands and arguments. So far, you have learned
-several commands that do not need arguments. When you type one, Info
-processes it and is instantly ready for another command. The @kbd{m}
-command is different: it is incomplete without the @dfn{name of the
-subtopic}. Once you have typed @kbd{m}, Info tries to read the
-subtopic name.
+If you keep typing @key{SPC} once the menu appears on the screen, it
+will move to another node (the first one in the menu). If that
+happens, type @key{BACKSPACE} to come back.
- Now look for the line containing many dashes near the bottom of the
-screen. There is one more line beneath that one, but usually it is
-blank. If it is empty, Info is ready for a command, such as @kbd{n}
-or @kbd{b} or Space or @kbd{m}. If that line contains text ending
-in a colon, it means Info is trying to read the @dfn{argument} to a
-command. At such times, commands do not work, because Info tries to
-use them as the argument. You must either type the argument and
-finish the command you started, or type @kbd{Control-g} to cancel the
-command. When you have done one of those things, the line becomes
-blank again.
+@kindex m @r{(Info mode)}
+ The command to go to one of the subnodes is @kbd{m}. This is very
+different from the commands you have used: it is a command that
+prompts you for more input.
+ The Info commands you know do not need additional input; when you
+type one of them, Info processes it instantly and then is ready for
+another command. The @kbd{m} command is different: it needs to know
+the @dfn{name of the subtopic}. Once you have typed @kbd{m}, Info
+tries to read the subtopic name.
+
+ Now, in the stand-alone Info, look for the line containing many
+dashes near the bottom of the screen. (This is the stand-alone
+equivalent for the mode line in XEmacs.) There is one more line
+beneath that one, but usually it is blank. (In XEmacs, this is the
+echo area.) When it is blank, Info is ready for a command, such as
+@kbd{n} or @kbd{b} or @key{SPC} or @kbd{m}. If that line contains
+text ending in a colon, it means Info is reading more input for the
+last command. You can't type an Info command then, because Info is
+trying to read input, not commands. You must either give the input
+and finish the command you started, or type @kbd{Control-g} to cancel
+the command. When you have done one of those things, the input entry
+line becomes blank again. Then you can type Info commands again.
+
+@findex Info-menu
The command to go to a subnode via a menu is @kbd{m}. After you type
the @kbd{m}, the line at the bottom of the screen says @samp{Menu item: }.
You must then type the name of the subtopic you want, and end it with
a @key{RET}.
+@cindex abbreviating Info subnodes
You can abbreviate the subtopic name. If the abbreviation is not
unique, the first matching subtopic is chosen. Some menus put
the shortest possible abbreviation for each subtopic name in capital
@@ -405,84 +610,244 @@
item name, except for one space where a space appears in the item in
the menu.
- You can also use the @dfn{completion} feature to help enter the subtopic
-name. If you type the Tab key after entering part of a name, it will
-magically fill in more of the name---as much as follows uniquely from
-what you have entered.
+@cindex completion of Info node names
+ You can also use the @dfn{completion} feature to help enter the
+subtopic name. If you type the @key{TAB} key after entering part of a
+name, it will fill in more of the name---as much as Info can deduce
+from the part you have entered.
If you move the cursor to one of the menu subtopic lines, then you do
-not need to type the argument: you just type a Return, and it stands for
-the subtopic of the line you are on.
+not need to type the argument: you just type a @key{RET}, and it
+stands for the subtopic of the line you are on. You can also click
+the middle mouse button directly on the subtopic line to go there.
Here is a menu to give you a chance to practice. This menu gives you
three ways of going to one place, Help-FOO:
@menu
* Foo: Help-FOO. A node you can visit for fun.
-* Bar: Help-FOO. Strange! two ways to get to the same place.
+* Bar: Help-FOO. We have made two ways to get to the same place.
* Help-FOO:: And yet another!
@end menu
+(Turn Visible mode on if you are using XEmacs.)
+
+@format
> Now type just an @kbd{m} and see what happens:
+@end
format
Now you are ``inside'' an @kbd{m} command. Commands cannot be used
now; the next thing you will type must be the name of a subtopic.
- You can change your mind about doing the @kbd{m} by typing Control-g.
+ You can change your mind about doing the @kbd{m} by typing
+@kbd{Control-g}.
+@format
> Try that now; notice the bottom line clear.
+@end format
+@format
> Then type another @kbd{m}.
+@end format
->> Now type @samp{BAR} item name. Do not type Return yet.
+@format
+>> Now type @kbd{BAR}, the item name. Do not type @key{RET} yet.
+@end format
- While you are typing the item name, you can use the Delete key to
-cancel one character at a time if you make a mistake.
+ While you are typing the item name, you can use the @key{DEL} (or
+@key{BACKSPACE}) key to cancel one character at a time if you make a
+mistake.
->> Type one to cancel the @samp{R}. You could type another @samp{R} to
- replace it. You do not have to, since @samp{BA} is a valid abbreviation.
+@format
+>> Press @key{DEL} to cancel the @samp{R}. You could type another @kbd{R}
+ to replace it. But you do not have to, since @samp{BA} is a valid
+ abbreviation.
+@end format
+@format
> Now you are ready to go. Type a @key{RET}.
+@end format
- After visiting Help-FOO, you should return here.
+ After visiting @samp{Help-FOO}, you should return here.
+ Another way to move to the menu subtopic lines and between them is
+to type @key{TAB}. Each time you type a @key{TAB}, you move to the
+next subtopic line. To move to a previous subtopic line in the
+stand-alone reader, type @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}---that is, press and hold
+the @key{META} key and then press @key{TAB}. (On some keyboards, the
+@key{META} key might be labeled @samp{Alt}.) In XEmacs Info, type
+@kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to move to a previous subtopic line (press and hold
+the @key{Shift} key and then press @key{TAB}).
+
+ Once you move cursor to a subtopic line, press @key{RET} to go to
+that subtopic's node.
+
+@cindex mouse support in Info mode
+@kindex Mouse-2 @r{(Info mode)}
+ If your terminal supports a mouse, you have yet another way of going
+to a subtopic. Move your mouse pointer to the subtopic line,
+somewhere between the beginning @samp{*} and the colon @samp{:} which
+ends the subtopic's brief name. You will see the subtopic's name
+change its appearance (usually, its background color will change), and
+the shape of the mouse pointer will change if your platform supports
+that. After a while, if you leave the mouse on that spot, a small
+window will pop up, saying ``Mouse-2: go to that node,'' or the same
+message may appear at the bottom of the screen.
+
+ @kbd{Mouse-2} is the second button of your mouse counting from the
+left---the middle button on a 3-button mouse. (On a 2-button mouse,
+you may have to press both buttons together to ``press the middle
+button''.) The message tells you pressing @kbd{Mouse-2} with the
+current position of the mouse pointer (on subtopic in the menu) will
+go to that subtopic.
+
+@findex Info-mouse-follow-nearest-node
+ More generally, @kbd{Mouse-2} in an Info buffer finds the nearest
+link to another node and goes there. For example, near a cross
+reference it acts like @kbd{f}, in a menu it acts like @kbd{m}, on the
+node's header line it acts like @kbd{n}, @kbd{p}, or @kbd{u}, etc. At
+end of the node's text @kbd{Mouse-2} moves to the next node, or up if
+there's no next node.
+
+@format
> Type @kbd{n} to see more commands.
-
-@c If a menu appears at the end of this node, remove it.
-@c It is an accident of the menu updating command.
-
-Here is another way to get to Help-FOO, a menu. You can ignore this
-if you want, or else try it (but then please come back to here).
-
-@menu
-* Help-FOO::
-@end menu
+@end format
@node Help-FOO, , , Help-M
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
@subsection The @kbd{u} command
- Congratulations! This is the node @samp{Help-FOO}. Unlike the other
-nodes you have seen, this one has an @samp{Up}: @samp{Help-M}, the node you
-just came from via the @kbd{m} command. This is the usual
-convention---the nodes you reach from a menu have @samp{Up} nodes that lead
-back to the menu. Menus move Down in the tree, and @samp{Up} moves Up.
-@samp{Previous}, on the other hand, is usually used to ``stay on the same
-level but go backwards''
+ Congratulations! This is the node @samp{Help-FOO}. It has an @samp{Up}
+pointer @samp{Help-M}, the node you just came from via the @kbd{m}
+command. This is the usual convention---the nodes you reach from a menu
+have @samp{Up} nodes that lead back to the menu. Menus move Down in the
+tree, and @samp{Up} moves Up. @samp{Previous}, on the other hand, is
+usually used to ``stay on the same level but go backwards''.
+@kindex u @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-up
You can go back to the node @samp{Help-M} by typing the command
-@kbd{u} for ``Up''. That puts you at the @emph{front} of the
-node---to get back to where you were reading you have to type
-some @key{SPC}s.
+@kbd{u} for ``Up''. This puts you at the menu subtopic line pointing
+to the subnode that the @kbd{u} command brought you from. (Some Info
+readers may put you at the @emph{front} of the node instead---to get
+back to where you were reading, you have to type some @key{SPC}s.)
+ Another way to go Up is to click @kbd{Mouse-2} on the @samp{Up}
+pointer shown in the header line (provided that you have a mouse).
+
+@format
> Now type @kbd{u} to move back up to @samp{Help-M}.
+@end
format
-@node Help-Adv, Help-Q, Help-M, Getting Started
+@node Help-Xref, Help-Int, Help-M, Getting Started
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Some advanced Info commands
+@section Following Cross-References
- The course is almost over, so please stick with it to the end.
+@cindex cross references in Info documents
+ In Info documentation, you will see many @dfn{cross references}.
+Cross references look like this: @xref{Help-Cross, Cross}. That text
+is a real, live cross reference, whose name is @samp{Cross} and which
+points to the node named @samp{Help-Cross}. (The node name is hidden
+in XEmacs. Do @kbd{M-x visible-mode} to show or hide it.)
+@kindex f @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-follow-reference
+ You can follow a cross reference by moving the cursor to it and
+press @key{RET}, just as in a menu. In XEmacs, you can also click
+@kbd{Mouse-1} on a cross reference to follow it; you can see that the
+cross reference is mouse-sensitive by moving the mouse pointer to the
+reference and watching how the underlying text and the mouse pointer
+change in response.
+
+ Another way to follow a cross reference is to type @kbd{f} and then
+specify the name of the cross reference (in this case, @samp{Cross})
+as an argument. For this command, it does not matter where the cursor
+was. If the cursor is on or near a cross reference, @kbd{f} suggests
+that reference name in parentheses as the default; typing @key{RET}
+will follow that reference. However, if you type a different
+reference name, @kbd{f} will follow the other reference which has that
+name.
+
+@format
+>> Type @kbd{f}, followed by @kbd{Cross}, and then @key{RET}.
+@end format
+
+ As you enter the reference name, you can use the @key{DEL} (or
+@key{BACKSPACE}) key to edit your input. If you change your mind
+about following any reference, you can use @kbd{Control-g} to cancel
+the command. Completion is available in the @kbd{f} command; you can
+complete among all the cross reference names in the current node by
+typing a @key{TAB}.
+
+ To get a list of all the cross references in the current node, you
+can type @kbd{?} after an @kbd{f}. The @kbd{f} continues to await a
+cross reference name even after displaying the list, so if you don't
+actually want to follow a reference, you should type a @kbd{Control-g}
+to cancel the @kbd{f}.
+
+@format
+>> Type @kbd{f?} to get a list of the cross references in this node. Then
+ type a @kbd{Control-g} and see how the @samp{f} gives up.
+@end format
+
+ The @key{TAB}, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} and @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} keys,
+which move between menu items in a menu, also move between cross
+references outside of menus.
+
+ Sometimes a cross reference (or a node) can lead to another file (in
+other words another ``manual''), or, on occasion, even a file on a
+remote machine (although Info files distributed with XEmacs or the
+stand-alone Info avoid using remote links). Such a cross reference
+looks like this: @xref{Top,, Overview of Texinfo, texinfo, Texinfo:
+The GNU Documentation Format}. (After following this link, type
+@kbd{l} to get back to this node.) Here the name @samp{texinfo}
+between parentheses refers to the file name. This file name appears
+in cross references and node names if it differs from the current
+file, so you can always know that you are going to be switching to
+another manual and which one.
+
+However, XEmacs normally hides some other text in cross-references.
+If you put your mouse over the cross reference, then the information
+appearing in a separate box (tool tip) or in the echo area will show
+the full cross-reference including the file name and the node name of
+the cross reference. If you have a mouse, just leave it over the
+cross reference @xref{Top,, Overview of Texinfo, texinfo, Texinfo:
+The GNU Documentation Format}, and watch what happens. If you
+always like to have that information visible without having to move
+your mouse over the cross reference, use @kbd{M-x visible-mode}, or
+set @code{Info-hide-note-references} to a value other than @code{t}
+(@pxref{XEmacs Info Variables}).
+
+@format
+>> Now type @kbd{n} to learn more commands.
+@end format
+
+@node Help-Int, Help-Q, Help-Xref, Getting Started
+@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@section Some intermediate Info commands
+
+ The introductory course is almost over; please continue
+a little longer to learn some intermediate-level commands.
+
+ Most Info files have an index, which is actually a large node
+containing little but a menu. The menu has one menu item for each
+topic listed in the index. (As a special feature, menus for indices
+may also include the line number within the node of the index entry.
+This allows Info readers to go to the exact line of an entry, not just
+the start of the containing node.)
+
+ You can get to the index from the main menu of the file with the
+@kbd{m} command and the name of the index node; then you can use the
+@kbd{m} command again in the index node to go to the node that
+describes the topic you want.
+
+ There is also a short-cut Info command, @kbd{i}, which does all of
+that for you. It searches the index for a given topic (a string) and
+goes to the node which is listed in the index for that topic.
+@xref{Search Index}, for a full explanation.
+
+@kindex l @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-history-back
+@cindex going back in Info history
If you have been moving around to different nodes and wish to
retrace your steps, the @kbd{l} command (@kbd{l} for @dfn{last}) will
do that, one node-step at a time. As you move from node to node, Info
@@ -490,171 +855,419 @@
@kbd{l} command revisits nodes in the history list; each successive
@kbd{l} command moves one step back through the history.
- If you have been following directions, ad @kbd{l} command now will get
-you back to @samp{Help-M}. Another @kbd{l} command would undo the
-@kbd{u} and get you back to @samp{Help-FOO}. Another @kbd{l} would undo
-the @kbd{m} and get you back to @samp{Help-M}.
-
->> Try typing three @kbd{l}'s, pausing in between to see what each
- @kbd{l} does.
-
-Then follow directions again and you will end up back here.
+@format
+>> Try typing @kbd{p p n} and then three @kbd{l}'s, pausing in between
+to see what each @kbd{l} does. You should wind up right back here.
+@end format
Note the difference between @kbd{l} and @kbd{p}: @kbd{l} moves to
where @emph{you} last were, whereas @kbd{p} always moves to the node
-which the header says is the @samp{Previous} node (from this node, to
-@samp{Help-M}).
+which the header says is the @samp{Previous} node (from this node, the
+@samp{Prev} link leads to @samp{Help-Xref}).
- The @samp{d} command gets you instantly to the Directory node.
-This node, which is the first one you saw when you entered Info,
-has a menu which leads (directly, or indirectly through other menus),
-to all the nodes that exist.
+@kindex r @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-history-forward
+@cindex going forward in Info history
+ You can use the @kbd{r} command (@code{Info-history-forward} in XEmacs)
+to revisit nodes in the history list in the forward direction, so that
+@kbd{r} will return you to the node you came from by typing @kbd{l}.
->> Try doing a @samp{d}, then do an @kbd{l} to return here (yes,
+@kindex L @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-history
+@cindex history list of visited nodes
+ The @kbd{L} command (@code{Info-history} in XEmacs) creates a virtual
+node that contains a list of all nodes you visited. You can select
+a previously visited node from this menu to revisit it.
+
+@kindex d @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-directory
+@cindex go to Directory node
+ The @kbd{d} command (@code{Info-directory} in XEmacs) gets you
+instantly to the Directory node. This node, which is the first one
+you saw when you entered Info, has a menu which leads (directly or
+indirectly, through other menus), to all the nodes that exist. The
+Directory node lists all the manuals and other Info documents that
+are, or could be, installed on your system.
+
+@format
+>> Try doing a @kbd{d}, then do an @kbd{l} to return here (yes,
@emph{do} return).
+@end format
- Sometimes, in Info documentation, you will see a cross reference.
-Cross references look like this: @xref{Help-Cross, Cross}. That is a
-real, live cross reference which is named @samp{Cross} and points at
-the node named @samp{Help-Cross}.
+@kindex t @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-top-node
+@cindex go to Top node
+ The @kbd{t} command moves to the @samp{Top} node of the manual.
+This is useful if you want to browse the manual's main menu, or select
+some specific top-level menu item. The XEmacs command run by @kbd{t}
+is @code{Info-top-node}.
- If you wish to follow a cross reference, you must use the @samp{f}
-command. The @samp{f} must be followed by the cross reference name
-(in this case, @samp{Cross}). While you enter the name, you can use the
-Delete key to edit your input. If you change your mind about following
-any reference, you can use @kbd{Control-g} to cancel the command.
+@format
+>> Now type @kbd{n} to see the last node of the course.
+@end format
- Completion is available in the @samp{f} command; you can complete among
-all the cross reference names in the current node by typing a Tab.
-
->> Type @samp{f}, followed by @samp{Cross}, and a @key{RET}.
-
- To get a list of all the cross references in the current node, you can
-type @kbd{?} after an @samp{f}. The @samp{f} continues to await a
-cross reference name even after printing the list, so if you don't
-actually want to follow a reference, you should type a @kbd{Control-g}
-to cancel the @samp{f}.
-
->> Type "f?" to get a list of the cross references in this node. Then
- type a @kbd{Control-g} and see how the @samp{f} gives up.
-
->> Now type @kbd{n} to see the last node of the course.
+ @xref{Advanced}, for more advanced Info features.
@c If a menu appears at the end of this node, remove it.
@c It is an accident of the menu updating command.
-@node Help-Cross, , , Help-Adv
-@subsection The node reached by the cross reference in Info
-
- This is the node reached by the cross reference named @samp{Cross}.
-
- While this node is specifically intended to be reached by a cross
-reference, most cross references lead to nodes that ``belong'' someplace
-else far away in the structure of Info. So you cannot expect the
-footnote to have a @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous} or @samp{Up} pointing
-back to where you came from. In general, the @kbd{l} (el) command is
-the only way to get back there.
-
->> Type @kbd{l} to return to the node where the cross reference was.
-
-@node Help-Q, , Help-Adv, Getting Started
+@node Help-Q, , Help-Int, Getting Started
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
@section Quitting Info
+@kindex q @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-exit
+@cindex quitting Info mode
To get out of Info, back to what you were doing before, type @kbd{q}
-for @dfn{Quit}.
+for @dfn{Quit}. This runs @code{Info-exit} in XEmacs.
- This is the end of the course on using Info. There are some other
-commands that are meant for experienced users; they are useful, and you
-can find them by looking in the directory node for documentation on
-Info. Finding them will be a good exercise in using Info in the usual
+ This is the end of the basic course on using Info. You have learned
+how to move in an Info document, and how to follow menus and cross
+references. This makes you ready for reading manuals top to bottom,
+as new users should do when they learn a new package.
+
+ Another set of Info commands is useful when you need to find
+something quickly in a manual---that is, when you need to use a manual
+as a reference rather than as a tutorial. We urge you to learn
+these search commands as well. If you want to do that now, follow this
+cross reference to @ref{Advanced}.
+
+Yet another set of commands are meant for experienced users; you can
+find them by looking in the Directory node for documentation on Info.
+Finding them will be a good exercise in using Info in the usual
manner.
->> Type @samp{d} to go to the Info directory node; then type
- @samp{mInfo} and Return, to get to the node about Info and
+@format
+>> Type @kbd{d} to go to the Info directory node; then type
+ @kbd{mInfo} and Return, to get to the node about Info and
see what other help is available.
+@end format
-@node Advanced Info
-@chapter Info for Experts
+@node Advanced
+@chapter Advanced Info Commands
-This chapter describes various advanced Info commands, and how to write
-an Info as distinct from a Texinfo file. (However, in most cases, writing a
-Texinfo file is better, since you can use it @emph{both} to generate an
-Info file and to make a printed manual. @xref{Top,, Overview of
-Texinfo, texinfo, Texinfo}.)
+ This chapter describes various advanced Info commands. (If you
+are using a stand-alone Info reader, there are additional commands
+specific to it, which are documented in several chapters of @ref{Top,,
+GNU Info, info-stnd, GNU Info}.)
+
+@kindex C-q @r{(Info mode)}
+ One advanced command useful with most of the others described here
+is @kbd{C-q}, which ``quotes'' the next character so that it is
+entered literally (@pxref{Inserting Text,,,xemacs,XEmacs User's
+Manual}). For example, pressing @kbd{?} ordinarily brings up a list
+of completion possibilities. If you want to (for example) search for
+an actual @samp{?} character, the simplest way is to insert it using
+@kbd{C-q ?}. This works the same in XEmacs and stand-alone Info.
@menu
-* Expert:: Advanced Info commands: g, s, e, and 1 - 5.
-* Add:: Describes how to add new nodes to the hierarchy.
- Also tells what nodes look like.
-* Menus:: How to add to or create menus in Info nodes.
-* Cross-refs:: How to add cross-references to Info nodes.
-* Tags:: How to make tag tables for Info files.
-* Checking:: Checking an Info File
-* Emacs Info Variables:: Variables modifying the behavior of Emacs Info.
+* Search Text:: How to search Info documents.
+* Search Index:: How to search the indices for specific subjects.
+* Go to node:: How to go to a node by name.
+* Choose menu subtopic:: How to choose a menu subtopic by its number.
+* Create Info buffer:: How to create a new Info buffer in XEmacs.
+* XEmacs Info Variables:: Variables modifying the behavior of XEmacs Info.
@end menu
-@node Expert, Add, , Advanced Info
+
+@node Search Text, Search Index, , Advanced
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Advanced Info Commands
+@section @kbd{s} searches Info documents
-@kbd{g}, @kbd{s}, @kbd{1}, -- @kbd{9}, and @kbd{e}
+@cindex searching Info documents
+@cindex Info document as a reference
+ The commands which move between and inside nodes allow you to read
+the entire manual or its large portions. But what if you need to find
+some information in the manual as fast as you can, and you don't know
+or don't remember in what node to look for it? This need arises when
+you use a manual as a @dfn{reference}, or when it is impractical to
+read the entire manual before you start using the programs it
+describes.
-If you know a node's name, you can go there by typing @kbd{g}, the
-name, and @key{RET}. Thus, @kbd{gTop@key{RET}} would go to the node
-called @samp{Top} in this file (its directory node).
-@kbd{gExpert@key{RET}} would come back here.
+ Info has powerful searching facilities that let you find things
+quickly. You can search either the manual text or its indices.
-Unlike @kbd{m}, @kbd{g} does not allow the use of abbreviations.
-
-To go to a node in another file, you can include the filename in the
-node name by putting it at the front, in parentheses. Thus,
-@kbd{g(dir)Top@key{RET}} would go to the Info Directory node, which is
-node @samp{Top} in the file @file{dir}.
-
-The node name @samp{*} specifies the whole file. So you can look at
-all of the current file by typing @kbd{g*@key{RET}} or all of any
-other file with @kbd{g(FILENAME)@key{RET}}.
-
-The @kbd{s} command allows you to search a whole file for a string.
+@kindex s @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-search
+ The @kbd{s} command allows you to search a whole Info file for a string.
It switches to the next node if and when that is necessary. You
type @kbd{s} followed by the string to search for, terminated by
@key{RET}. To search for the same string again, just @kbd{s} followed
by @key{RET} will do. The file's nodes are scanned in the order
-they are in in the file, which has no necessary relationship to the
-order that they may be in in the tree structure of menus and @samp{next}
+they are in the file, which has no necessary relationship to the
+order that they may be in the tree structure of menus and @samp{next}
pointers. But normally the two orders are not very different. In any
-case, you can always do a @kbd{b} to find out what node you have
+case, you can always look at the mode line to find out what node you have
reached, if the header is not visible (this can happen, because @kbd{s}
puts your cursor at the occurrence of the string, not at the beginning
of the node).
-If you grudge the system each character of type-in it requires, you
-might like to use the commands @kbd{1}, @kbd{2}, @kbd{3}, @kbd{4}, ...
-@kbd{9}. They are short for the @kbd{m} command together with an
-argument. @kbd{1} goes through the first item in the current node's
-menu; @kbd{2} goes through the second item, etc.
+@kindex M-s @r{(Info mode)}
+ In XEmacs, @kbd{Meta-s} is equivalent to @kbd{s}. That is for
+compatibility with other GNU packages that use @kbd{M-s} for a similar
+kind of search command. Both @kbd{s} and @kbd{M-s} run in XEmacs the
+command @code{Info-search}.
-If your display supports multiple fonts, and you are using Emacs' Info
-mode to read Info files, the @samp{*} for the fifth menu item is
-underlined, and so is the @samp{*} for the ninth item; these underlines
-make it easy to see at a glance which number to use for an item.
+@kindex C-s @r{(Info mode)}
+@kindex C-r @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex isearch
+ Instead of using @kbd{s} in XEmacs Info and in the stand-alone Info,
+you can use an incremental search started with @kbd{C-s} or @kbd{C-r}.
+It can search through multiple Info nodes. @xref{Incremental Search,,,
+xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}. In XEmacs, you can disable this behavior
+by setting the variable @code{Info-isearch-search} to @code{nil}
+(@pxref{XEmacs Info Variables}).
-On ordinary terminals, you won't have underlining. If you need to
-actually count items, it is better to use @kbd{m} instead, and specify
-the name.
+@node Search Index, Go to node, Search Text, Advanced
+@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@section @kbd{i} searches the indices for specific subjects
-The Info command @kbd{e} changes from Info mode to an ordinary
-Emacs editing mode, so that you can edit the text of the current node.
-Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to switch back to Info. The @kbd{e} command is allowed
-only if the variable @code{Info-enable-edit} is non-@code{nil}.
+@cindex searching Info indices
+@kindex i @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-index
+ Since most topics in the manual should be indexed, you should try
+the index search first before the text search. The @kbd{i} command
+prompts you for a subject and then looks up that subject in the
+indices. If it finds an index entry with the subject you typed, it
+goes to the node to which that index entry points. You should browse
+through that node to see whether the issue you are looking for is
+described there. If it isn't, type @kbd{,} one or more times to go
+through additional index entries which match your subject.
-@node Add, Menus, Expert, Advanced Info
+ The @kbd{i} command and subsequent @kbd{,} commands find all index
+entries which include the string you typed @emph{as a substring}.
+For each match, Info shows in the echo area the full index entry it
+found. Often, the text of the full index entry already gives you
+enough information to decide whether it is relevant to what you are
+looking for, so we recommend that you read what Info shows in the echo
+area before looking at the node it displays.
+
+ Since @kbd{i} looks for a substring, you can search for subjects even
+if you are not sure how they are spelled in the index. For example,
+suppose you want to find something that is pertinent to commands which
+complete partial input (e.g., when you type @key{TAB}). If you want
+to catch index entries that refer to ``complete,'' ``completion,'' and
+``completing,'' you could type @kbd{icomplet@key{RET}}.
+
+ Info documents which describe programs should index the commands,
+options, and key sequences that the program provides. If you are
+looking for a description of a command, an option, or a key, just type
+their names when @kbd{i} prompts you for a topic. For example, if you
+want to read the description of what the @kbd{C-l} key does, type
+@kbd{iC-l@key{RET}} literally.
+
+@findex info-apropos
+@findex index-apropos
+If you aren't sure which manual documents the topic you are looking
+for, try the @kbd{M-x info-apropos} command in XEmacs, or the @kbd{M-x
+index-apropos} command in the stand-alone reader. It prompts for
+a string and then looks up that string in all the indices of all the
+Info documents installed on your system.
+
+@node Go to node, Choose menu subtopic, Search Index, Advanced
+@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@section @kbd{g} goes to a node by name
+
+@kindex g @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-goto-node
+@cindex go to a node by name
+ If you know a node's name, you can go there by typing @kbd{g}, the
+name, and @key{RET}. Thus, @kbd{gTop@key{RET}} would go to the node
+called @samp{Top} in this file. (This is equivalent to @kbd{t}, see
+@ref{Help-Int}.) @kbd{gGo to node@key{RET}} would come back here.
+
+ Unlike @kbd{m}, @kbd{g} does not allow the use of abbreviations.
+But it does allow completion, so you can type @key{TAB} to complete a
+partial node name.
+
+@cindex go to another Info file
+ To go to a node in another file, you can include the file name in the
+node name by putting it at the front, in parentheses. Thus,
+@kbd{g(dir)Top@key{RET}} would go to the Info Directory node, which is
+the node @samp{Top} in the Info file @file{dir}. Likewise,
+@kbd{g(xemacs)Top@key{RET}} goes to the top node of the XEmacs manual.
+
+ The node name @samp{*} specifies the whole file. So you can look at
+all of the current file by typing @kbd{g*@key{RET}} or all of any
+other file with @kbd{g(@var{filename})*@key{RET}}.
+
+@node Choose menu subtopic, Create Info buffer, Go to node, Advanced
+@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@section @kbd{1}--@kbd{9} choose a menu subtopic by its number
+
+@kindex 1 @r{through} 9 @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex Info-nth-menu-item
+@cindex select @var{n}'th menu item
+ If you begrudge each character of type-in which your system requires,
+you might like to use the commands @kbd{1}, @kbd{2}, @kbd{3}, @kbd{4},
+@dots{}, @kbd{9}. They are short for the @kbd{m} command together
+with a name of a menu subtopic. @kbd{1} goes through the first item
+in the current node's menu; @kbd{2} goes through the second item, etc.
+In the stand-alone reader, @kbd{0} goes through the last menu item;
+this is so you need not count how many entries are there.
+
+ If your display supports multiple fonts, colors or underlining, and
+you are using XEmacs' Info mode to read Info files, the third, sixth
+and ninth menu items have a @samp{*} that stands out, either in color
+or in some other attribute, such as underline; this makes it easy to
+see at a glance which number to use for an item.
+
+ Some terminals don't support either multiple fonts, colors or
+underlining. If you need to actually count items, it is better to use
+@kbd{m} instead, and specify the name, or use @key{TAB} to quickly
+move between menu items.
+
+@node Create Info buffer, XEmacs Info Variables, Choose menu subtopic, Advanced
+@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@section @kbd{M-n} creates a new independent Info buffer in XEmacs
+
+@kindex M-n @r{(Info mode)}
+@findex clone-buffer
+@cindex multiple Info buffers
+ If you are reading Info in XEmacs, you can select a new independent
+Info buffer in a new XEmacs window by typing @kbd{M-n}. The new buffer
+starts out as an exact copy of the old one, but you will be able to
+move independently between nodes in the two buffers. (In Info mode,
+@kbd{M-n} runs the XEmacs command @code{clone-buffer}.)
+
+ In XEmacs Info, you can also produce new Info buffers by giving a
+numeric prefix argument to the @kbd{m} and @kbd{g} commands. @kbd{C-u
+m} and @kbd{C-u g} go to a new node in exactly the same way that
+@kbd{m} and @kbd{g} do, but they do so in a new Info buffer which they
+select in another window.
+
+ Another way to produce new Info buffers in XEmacs is to use a numeric
+prefix argument for the @kbd{C-h i} command (@code{info}) which
+switches to the Info buffer with that number. Thus, @kbd{C-u 2 C-h i}
+switches to the buffer @samp{*info*<2>}, creating it if necessary.
+
+@node XEmacs Info Variables, , Create Info buffer, Advanced
+@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@section XEmacs Info-mode Variables
+
+The following variables may modify the behavior of Info-mode in XEmacs;
+you may wish to set one or several of these variables interactively,
+or in your init file. @xref{Examining, Examining and Setting
+Variables, Examining and Setting Variables, xemacs, XEmacs User's
+Manual}. The stand-alone Info reader program has its own set of
+variables, described in @ref{Variables,, Manipulating Variables,
+info-stnd, GNU Info}.
+
+@vtable @code
+@item Info-directory-list
+The list of directories to search for Info files. Each element is a
+string (directory name) or @code{nil} (try default directory). If not
+initialized Info uses the environment variable @env{INFOPATH} to
+initialize it, or @code{Info-default-directory-list} if there is no
+@env{INFOPATH} variable in the environment.
+
+If you wish to customize the Info directory search list for both XEmacs
+Info and stand-alone Info, it is best to set the @env{INFOPATH}
+environment variable, since that applies to both programs.
+
+@item Info-additional-directory-list
+A list of additional directories to search for Info documentation files.
+These directories are not searched for merging the @file{dir} file.
+
+@item Info-mode-hook
+Hooks run when @code{Info-mode} is called. By default, it contains
+the hook @code{turn-on-font-lock} which enables highlighting of Info
+files. You can change how the highlighting looks by customizing the
+faces @code{info-node}, @code{info-xref}, @code{info-xref-visited},
+@code{info-header-xref}, @code{info-header-node}, @code{info-menu-header},
+@code{info-menu-star}, and @code{info-title-@var{n}} (where @var{n}
+is the level of the section, a number between 1 and 4). To customize
+a face, type @kbd{M-x customize-face @key{RET} @var{face} @key{RET}},
+where @var{face} is one of the face names listed here.
+
+@item Info-fontify-maximum-menu-size
+Maximum size of menu to fontify if @code{font-lock-mode} is non-@code{nil}.
+
+@item Info-fontify-visited-nodes
+If non-@code{nil}, menu items and cross-references pointing to visited
+nodes are displayed in the @code{info-xref-visited} face.
+
+@item Info-use-header-line
+If non-@code{nil}, XEmacs puts in the Info buffer a header line showing
+the @samp{Next}, @samp{Prev}, and @samp{Up} links. A header line does
+not scroll with the rest of the buffer, making these links always
+visible.
+
+@item Info-hide-note-references
+As explained in earlier nodes, the XEmacs version of Info normally
+hides some text in menus and cross-references. You can completely
+disable this feature, by setting this option to @code{nil}. Setting
+it to a value that is neither @code{nil} nor @code{t} produces an
+intermediate behavior, hiding a limited amount of text, but showing
+all text that could potentially be useful.
+
+@item Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes
+If set to a non-@code{nil} value, @key{SPC} and @key{BACKSPACE} (or
+@key{DEL}) keys in a menu visit subnodes of the current node before
+scrolling to its end or beginning, respectively. For example, if the
+node's menu appears on the screen, the next @key{SPC} moves to a
+subnode indicated by the following menu item. Setting this option to
+@code{nil} results in behavior similar to the stand-alone Info reader
+program, which visits the first subnode from the menu only when you
+hit the end of the current node. The default is @code{nil}.
+
+@item Info-isearch-search
+If non-@code{nil}, isearch in Info searches through multiple nodes.
+
+@item Info-enable-active-nodes
+When set to a non-@code{nil} value, allows Info to execute Lisp code
+associated with nodes. The Lisp code is executed when the node is
+selected. The Lisp code to be executed should follow the node
+delimiter (the @samp{DEL} character) and an @samp{execute: } tag, like
+this:
+
+@example
+^_execute: (message "This is an active node!")
+@end example
+@end vtable
+
+
+@node Expert Info
+@chapter Info for Experts
+
+ This chapter explains how to write an Info file by hand. However,
+in most cases, writing a Texinfo file is better, since you can use it
+to make a printed manual or produce other formats, such as HTML and
+DocBook, as well as for generating Info files.
+
+The @code{makeinfo} command converts a Texinfo file into an Info file;
+@code{texinfo-format-region} and @code{texinfo-format-buffer} are
+XEmacs functions that do the same.
+
+@xref{Top,, Overview of Texinfo, texinfo, Texinfo: The GNU
+Documentation Format}, for how to write a Texinfo file.
+
+@xref{Creating an Info File,,, texinfo, Texinfo: The GNU Documentation
+Format}, for how to create an Info file from a Texinfo file.
+
+@xref{Installing an Info File,,, texinfo, Texinfo: The GNU
+Documentation Format}, for how to install an Info file after you
+have created one.
+
+However, if you want to edit an Info file manually and install it manually,
+here is how.
+
+@menu
+* Add:: Describes how to add new nodes to the hierarchy.
+ Also tells what nodes look like.
+* Menus:: How to add to or create menus in Info nodes.
+* Cross-refs:: How to add cross-references to Info nodes.
+* Tags:: How to make tags tables for Info files.
+* Checking:: Checking an Info File.
+@end menu
+
+@node Add, Menus, , Expert Info
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
@section Adding a new node to Info
To add a new topic to the list in the Info directory, you must:
+
@enumerate
@item
Create some nodes, in some file, to document that topic.
@@ -662,29 +1275,27 @@
Put that topic in the menu in the directory. @xref{Menus, Menu}.
@end enumerate
-Usually, the way to create the nodes is with Texinfo (@pxref{Top,,
-Overview of Texinfo, texinfo, Texinfo}); this has the advantage that you
-can also make a printed manual from them. However, if you want to edit
-an Info file, here is how.
+@cindex node delimiters
+ The new node can live in an existing documentation file, or in a new
+one. It must have a @samp{^_} character before it (invisible to the
+user; this node has one but you cannot see it), and it ends with either
+a @samp{^_}, a @samp{^L} (``formfeed''), or the end of file.@footnote{If
+you put in a @samp{^L} to end a new node, be sure that there is a
+@samp{^_} after it to start the next one, since @samp{^L} cannot
+@emph{start} a node. Also, a nicer way to make a node boundary be a
+page boundary as well is to put a @samp{^L} @emph{right after} the
+(a)samp{^_}.}
-The new node can live in an existing documentation file, or in a new
-one. It must have a @key{^_} character before it (invisible to the
-user; this node has one but you cannot see it), and it ends with either
-a @key{^_}, a @key{^L}, or the end of file. Note: If you put in a
-@key{^L} to end a new node, be sure that there is a @key{^_} after it
-to start the next one, since @key{^L} cannot @emph{start} a node.
-Also, a nicer way to make a node boundary be a page boundary as well
-is to put a @key{^L} @emph{right after} the @key{^_}.
+ The @samp{^_} starting a node must be followed by a newline or a
+@samp{^L} newline, after which comes the node's header line. The
+header line must give the node's name (by which Info finds it), and
+state the names of the @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous}, and @samp{Up}
+nodes (if there are any). As you can see, this node's @samp{Up} node
+is the node @samp{Expert Info}. The @samp{Next} node is @samp{Menus}.
- The @key{^_} starting a node must be followed by a newline or a
-@key{^L} newline, after which comes the node's header line. The header
-line must give the node's name (by which Info finds it), and state the
-names of the @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous}, and @samp{Up} nodes (if there
-are any). As you can see, this node's @samp{Up} node is the node
-@samp{Top}, which points at all the documentation for Info. The
-@samp{Next} node is @samp{Menus}.
-
- The keywords @dfn{Node}, @dfn{Previous}, @dfn{Up}, and @dfn{Next},
+@cindex node header line format
+@cindex format of node headers
+ The keywords @dfn{Node}, @dfn{Next}, @dfn{Previous}, and @dfn{Up}
may appear in any order, anywhere in the header line, but the
recommended order is the one in this sentence. Each keyword must be
followed by a colon, spaces and tabs, and then the appropriate name.
@@ -692,36 +1303,41 @@
does not end it; node names may contain spaces. The case of letters
in the names is insignificant.
+@cindex node name format
+@cindex Directory node
A node name has two forms. A node in the current file is named by
what appears after the @samp{Node: } in that node's first line. For
example, this node's name is @samp{Add}. A node in another file is
named by @samp{(@var{filename})@var{node-within-file}}, as in
-@samp{(info)Add} for this node. If the file name starts with ``./'',
-then it is relative to the current directory; otherwise, it is relative
-starting from the standard Info file directory of your site.
-The name @samp{(@var{filename})Top} can be abbreviated to just
-@samp{(@var{filename})}. By convention, the name @samp{Top} is used for
-the ``highest'' node in any single file---the node whose @samp{Up} points
-out of the file. The Directory node is @file{(dir)}. The @samp{Top} node
-of a document file listed in the Directory should have an @samp{Up:
+@samp{(info)Add} for this node. If the file name starts with @samp{./},
+then it is relative to the current directory; otherwise, it is
+relative starting from the standard directory for Info files of your
+site. The name @samp{(@var{filename})Top} can be abbreviated to just
+@samp{(@var{filename})}. By convention, the name @samp{Top} is used
+for the ``highest'' node in any single file---the node whose @samp{Up}
+points out of the file. The @samp{Directory} node is @file{(dir)}, it
+points to a file @file{dir} which holds a large menu listing all the
+Info documents installed on your site. The @samp{Top} node of a
+document file listed in the @samp{Directory} should have an @samp{Up:
(dir)} in it.
+@cindex unstructured documents
The node name @kbd{*} is special: it refers to the entire file.
Thus, @kbd{g*} shows you the whole current file. The use of the
node @kbd{*} is to make it possible to make old-fashioned,
unstructured files into nodes of the tree.
The @samp{Node:} name, in which a node states its own name, must not
-contain a filename, since Info when searching for a node does not expect
-one to be there. The @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous} and @samp{Up} names
-may contain them. In this node, since the @samp{Up} node is in the same
-file, it was not necessary to use one.
+contain a file name, since when Info searches for a node, it does not
+expect a file name to be there. The @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous} and
+@samp{Up} names may contain them. In this node, since the @samp{Up}
+node is in the same file, it was not necessary to use one.
Note that the nodes in this file have a file name in the header
line. The file names are ignored by Info, but they serve as comments
to help identify the node for the user.
-@node Menus, Cross-refs, Add, Advanced Info
+@node Menus, Cross-refs, Add, Expert Info
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
@section How to Create Menus
@@ -729,19 +1345,20 @@
The @kbd{m} command searches the current node's menu for the topic which it
reads from the terminal.
- A menu begins with a line starting with @samp{* Menu:}. The rest of the
-line is a comment. After the starting line, every line that begins
-with a @samp{* } lists a single topic. The name of the topic--the
-argument that the user must give to the @kbd{m} command to select this
-topic---comes right after the star and space, and is followed by a
-colon, spaces and tabs, and the name of the node which discusses that
-topic. The node name, like node names following @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous}
-and @samp{Up}, may be terminated with a tab, comma, or newline; it may also
-be terminated with a period.
+@cindex menu and menu entry format
+ A menu begins with a line starting with @w{@samp{* Menu:}}. The
+rest of the line is a comment. After the starting line, every line
+that begins with a @samp{* } lists a single topic. The name of the
+topic---what the user must type at the @kbd{m}'s command prompt to
+select this topic---comes right after the star and space, and is
+followed by a colon, spaces and tabs, and the name of the node which
+discusses that topic. The node name, like node names following
+@samp{Next}, @samp{Previous} and @samp{Up}, may be terminated with a
+tab, comma, or newline; it may also be terminated with a period.
If the node name and topic name are the same, then rather than
-giving the name twice, the abbreviation @samp{* NAME::} may be used
-(and should be used, whenever possible, as it reduces the visual
+giving the name twice, the abbreviation @samp{* @var{name}::} may be
+used (and should be used, whenever possible, as it reduces the visual
clutter in the menu).
It is considerate to choose the topic names so that they differ
@@ -750,7 +1367,7 @@
the beginning of each item name which is the minimum acceptable
abbreviation for it (a long menu is more than 5 or so entries).
- The nodes listed in a node's menu are called its ``subnodes'', and it
+ The nodes listed in a node's menu are called its ``subnodes,'' and it
is their ``superior''. They should each have an @samp{Up:} pointing at
the superior. It is often useful to arrange all or most of the subnodes
in a sequence of @samp{Next} and @samp{Previous} pointers so that
@@ -760,11 +1377,11 @@
is, node @samp{Top} in file @file{.../info/dir}. You can put new entries
in that menu just like any other menu. The Info Directory is @emph{not} the
same as the file directory called @file{info}. It happens that many of
-Info's files live on that file directory, but they do not have to; and
-files on that directory are not automatically listed in the Info
+Info's files live in that file directory, but they do not have to; and
+files in that directory are not automatically listed in the Info
Directory node.
- Also, although the Info node graph is claimed to be a ``hierarchy'',
+ Also, although the Info node graph is claimed to be a ``hierarchy,''
in fact it can be @emph{any} directed graph. Shared structures and
pointer cycles are perfectly possible, and can be used if they are
appropriate to the meaning to be expressed. There is no need for all
@@ -772,17 +1389,18 @@
has two connected components. You are in one of them, which is under
the node @samp{Top}; the other contains the node @samp{Help} which the
@kbd{h} command goes to. In fact, since there is no garbage
-collector, nothing terrible happens if a substructure is not pointed
-to, but such a substructure is rather useless since nobody can
-ever find out that it exists.
+collector on the node graph, nothing terrible happens if a substructure
+is not pointed to, but such a substructure is rather useless since nobody
+can ever find out that it exists.
-@node Cross-refs, Tags, Menus, Advanced Info
+@node Cross-refs, Tags, Menus, Expert Info
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
@section Creating Cross References
+@cindex cross reference format
A cross reference can be placed anywhere in the text, unlike a menu
item which must go at the front of a line. A cross reference looks
-like a menu item except that it has @samp{*note} instead of @kbd{*}.
+like a menu item except that it has @samp{*note} instead of @samp{*}.
It @emph{cannot} be terminated by a @samp{)}, because @samp{)}'s are
so often part of node names. If you wish to enclose a cross reference
in parentheses, terminate it with a period first. Here are two
@@ -792,32 +1410,62 @@
*Note details: commands. (See *note 3: Full Proof.)
@end example
-They are just examples. The places they ``lead to'' do not really exist!
+@noindent
+@emph{These are just examples.} The places they ``lead to'' do not
+really exist!
-@node Tags, Checking, Cross-refs, Advanced Info
+@menu
+* Help-Cross:: Target of a cross-reference.
+@end menu
+
+
+@node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
+@subsection The node reached by the cross reference in Info
+
+ This is the node reached by the cross reference named @samp{Cross}.
+
+ While this node is specifically intended to be reached by a cross
+reference, most cross references lead to nodes that ``belong''
+someplace else far away in the structure of an Info document. So you
+cannot expect this node to have a @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous} or
+@samp{Up} links pointing back to where you came from. In general, the
+@kbd{l} (el) command is the only way to get back there.
+
+@format
+>> Type @kbd{l} to return to the node where the cross reference was.
+@end format
+
+@node Tags, Checking, Cross-refs, Expert Info
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Tag Tables for Info Files
+@section Tags Tables for Info Files
+@cindex tags tables in Info files
You can speed up the access to nodes of a large Info file by giving
-it a tag table. Unlike the tag table for a program, the tag table for
+it a tags table. Unlike the tags table for a program, the tags table for
an Info file lives inside the file itself and is used
automatically whenever Info reads in the file.
- To make a tag table, go to a node in the file using Emacs Info mode and type
+@findex Info-tagify
+ To make a tags table, go to a node in the file using XEmacs Info mode and type
@kbd{M-x Info-tagify}. Then you must use @kbd{C-x C-s} to save the
-file.
+file. Info files produced by the @code{makeinfo} command that is part
+of the Texinfo package always have tags tables to begin with.
- Once the Info file has a tag table, you must make certain it is up
-to date. If, as a result of deletion of text, any node moves back
+@cindex stale tags tables
+@cindex update Info tags table
+ Once the Info file has a tags table, you must make certain it is up
+to date. If you edit an Info file directly (as opposed to editing its
+Texinfo source), and, as a result of deletion of text, any node moves back
more than a thousand characters in the file from the position
-recorded in the tag table, Info will no longer be able to find that
-node. To update the tag table, use the @code{Info-tagify} command again.
+recorded in the tags table, Info will no longer be able to find that
+node. To update the tags table, use the @code{Info-tagify} command
+again.
- An Info file tag table appears at the end of the file and looks like
+ An Info file tags table appears at the end of the file and looks like
this:
@example
-^_
+^_^L
Tag Table:
File: info, Node: Cross-refs^?21419
File: info, Node: Tags^?22145
@@ -828,11 +1476,10 @@
@noindent
Note that it contains one line per node, and this line contains
the beginning of the node's header (ending just after the node name),
-a Delete character, and the character position in the file of the
+a @samp{DEL} character, and the character position in the file of the
beginning of the node.
-
-@node Checking, Emacs Info Variables, Tags, Advanced Info
+@node Checking, , Tags, Expert Info
@section Checking an Info File
When creating an Info file, it is easy to forget the name of a node when
@@ -847,49 +1494,20 @@
checking pointers to other files would be terribly slow. But those are
usually few.
+@findex Info-validate
To check an Info file, do @kbd{M-x Info-validate} while looking at any
-node of the file with Emacs Info mode.
+node of the file with XEmacs Info mode.
-@node Emacs Info Variables, , Checking, Advanced Info
-@section Emacs Info-mode Variables
+@node Index
+@unnumbered Index
-The following variables may modify the behavior of Info-mode in Emacs;
-you may wish to set one or several of these variables interactively, or
-in your @file{~/.emacs} init file. @xref{Examining, Examining and
-Setting Variables, Examining and Setting Variables, xemacs, XEmacs
-User's Manual}.
+This is an alphabetical listing of all the commands, variables, and
+topics discussed in this document.
-
-@vtable @code
-@item Info-enable-edit
-Set to @code{nil}, disables the @samp{e} (@code{Info-edit}) command. A
-non-@code{nil} value enables it. @xref{Add, Edit}.
-
-@item Info-enable-active-nodes
-When set to a non-@code{nil} value, allows Info to execute Lisp code
-associated with nodes. The Lisp code is executed when the node is
-selected.
-
-@item Info-directory-list
-The list of directories to search for Info files. Each element is a
-string (directory name) or @code{nil} (try default directory).
-
-@item Info-directory
-The standard directory for Info documentation files. Only used when the
-function @code{Info-directory} is called.
-@end vtable
-
-
-@node Creating an Info File
-@chapter Creating an Info File
-
-@xref{Top,, Overview of Texinfo, texinfo, Texinfo}, to learn how to
-write a Texinfo file.
-
-@xref{Create an Info File, , Creating an Info File, texinfo, Texinfo},
-to learn how to create an Info file from a Texinfo file.
-
-@xref{Install an Info File, , Installing an Info File, texinfo, Texinfo},
-to learn how to install an Info file after you have created one.
+@printindex cp
@bye
+
+@ignore
+ arch-tag: 965c1638-01d6-4156-9227-b10418b9d8e8
+@end ignore
diff -r a7da359711ce -r 64be8a494bdc man/texinfo.tex
--- a/man/texinfo.tex Mon May 02 10:35:36 2011 +0100
+++ b/man/texinfo.tex Mon May 09 19:38:01 2011 +0100
@@ -3,15 +3,16 @@
% Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
\expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
%
-\def\texinfoversion{1999-09-25.10}
-%
-% Copyright (C) 1985, 86, 88, 90, 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99
-% Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-%
-% This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+\def\texinfoversion{2008-04-18.10}
+%
+% Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
+% 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
+% 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+%
+% This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
% modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
-% published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at
-% your option) any later version.
+% published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
+% License, or (at your option) any later version.
%
% This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
% useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
@@ -19,25 +20,19 @@
% General Public License for more details.
%
% You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-% along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write
-% to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
-% Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-%
-% In other words, you are welcome to use, share and improve this program.
-% You are forbidden to forbid anyone else to use, share and improve
-% what you give them. Help stamp out software-hoarding!
+% along with this program. If not, see <
http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+%
+% As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
+% a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
+% restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.)
%
% Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
% reports; you can get the latest version from:
-%
ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo.tex
-% (and all GNU mirrors, see
http://www.gnu.org/order/ftp.html)
-%
ftp://texinfo.org/tex/texinfo.tex
-%
ftp://us.ctan.org/macros/texinfo/texinfo.tex
-% (and all CTAN mirrors, finger ctan(a)us.ctan.org for a list).
-% /home/gd/gnu/doc/texinfo.tex on the GNU machines.
-% The texinfo.tex in any given Texinfo distribution could well be out
+%
http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or
+%
ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex
+% (and all CTAN mirrors, see
http://www.ctan.org).
+% The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
% of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
-% Texinfo has a small home page at
http://texinfo.org/.
%
% Send bug reports to bug-texinfo(a)gnu.org. Please include including a
% complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
@@ -50,13 +45,17 @@
% texindex foo.??
% tex foo.texi
% tex foo.texi
-% dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever, to process the dvi file; this makes foo.ps.
-% The extra runs of TeX get the cross-reference information correct.
+% dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
+% The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
% Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
% than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
%
-% It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages. You can get
-% the existing language-specific files from
ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/.
+% It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
+% extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
+% full Texinfo distribution.
+%
+% The GNU Texinfo home page is
http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
+
\message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
@@ -66,7 +65,14 @@
\everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
\catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
-% Save some parts of plain tex whose names we will redefine.
+
+\chardef\other=12
+
+% We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
+% For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
+\let\+ = \relax
+
+% Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
\let\ptexb=\b
\let\ptexbullet=\bullet
\let\ptexc=\c
@@ -76,22 +82,35 @@
\let\ptexend=\end
\let\ptexequiv=\equiv
\let\ptexexclam=\!
+\let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
+\let\ptexgtr=>
+\let\ptexhat=^
\let\ptexi=\i
+\let\ptexindent=\indent
+\let\ptexinsert=\insert
\let\ptexlbrace=\{
+\let\ptexless=<
+\let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
+\let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
+\let\ptexplus=+
\let\ptexrbrace=\}
+\let\ptexslash=\/
\let\ptexstar=\*
\let\ptext=\t
-
-% We never want plain's outer \+ definition in Texinfo.
-% For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
-\let\+ = \relax
-
-\message{Basics,}
-\chardef\other=12
+\let\ptextop=\top
% If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
% starts a new line in the output.
\newlinechar = `^^J
+
+% Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
+% messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
+%
+\ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
+ \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
+\else
+ \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
+\fi
% Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
\ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
@@ -131,44 +150,119 @@
\ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
\ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
\ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
-\ifx\putwordDeftypevar\undefined\gdef\putwordDeftypevar{Variable}\fi
\ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
-\ifx\putwordDeftypefun\undefined\gdef\putwordDeftypefun{Function}\fi
+
+% Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
+\chardef\spacecat = 10
+\def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat}
+
+% sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences.
+\chardef\colonChar = `\:
+\chardef\commaChar = `\,
+\chardef\dashChar = `\-
+\chardef\dotChar = `\.
+\chardef\exclamChar= `\!
+\chardef\lquoteChar= `\`
+\chardef\questChar = `\?
+\chardef\rquoteChar= `\'
+\chardef\semiChar = `\;
+\chardef\underChar = `\_
% Ignore a token.
%
\def\gobble#1{}
-\hyphenation{ap-pen-dix}
-\hyphenation{mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers}
-\hyphenation{eshell}
-\hyphenation{white-space}
+% The following is used inside several \edef's.
+\def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
+
+% Hyphenation fixes.
+\hyphenation{
+ Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
+ ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
+ data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
+ man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
+ par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
+ spell-ing spell-ings
+ stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
+ wide-spread wrap-around
+}
% Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
-\newdimen \bindingoffset
-\newdimen \normaloffset
+\newdimen\bindingoffset
+\newdimen\normaloffset
\newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
+
+% For a final copy, take out the rectangles
+% that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
+% that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
+%
+\def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt}
+
+% @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
+% surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
+% change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
+% have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
+% vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
+%
+\def\|{%
+ % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
+ \leavevmode
+ %
+ % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
+ \vadjust{%
+ % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
+ % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
+ \vskip-\baselineskip
+ %
+ % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
+ % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
+ \llap{%
+ %
+ % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
+ \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
+ %
+ % This is the space between the bar and the text.
+ \hskip 12pt
+ }%
+ }%
+}
% Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
% and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
-% since that produces some useless output on the terminal.
+% since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
+% some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
+% file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
%
\def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
-\ifx\eTeXversion\undefined
-\def\loggingall{\tracingcommands2 \tracingstats2
- \tracingpages1 \tracingoutput1 \tracinglostchars1
- \tracingmacros2 \tracingparagraphs1 \tracingrestores1
- \showboxbreadth\maxdimen\showboxdepth\maxdimen
+\def\loggingall{%
+ \tracingstats2
+ \tracingpages1
+ \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
+ \tracingparagraphs1
+ \tracingoutput1
+ \tracingmacros2
+ \tracingrestores1
+ \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
+ \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging
+ \tracingscantokens1
+ \tracingifs1
+ \tracinggroups1
+ \tracingnesting2
+ \tracingassigns1
+ \fi
+ \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
+ \errorcontextlines16
}%
-\else
-\def\loggingall{\tracingcommands3 \tracingstats2
- \tracingpages1 \tracingoutput1 \tracinglostchars1
- \tracingmacros2 \tracingparagraphs1 \tracingrestores1
- \tracingscantokens1 \tracingassigns1 \tracingifs1
- \tracinggroups1 \tracingnesting2
- \showboxbreadth\maxdimen\showboxdepth\maxdimen
-}%
-\fi
+
+% add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
+% we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
+%
+\def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
+ \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
+\def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
+ \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
+\def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
+ \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
% For @cropmarks command.
% Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
@@ -184,6 +278,50 @@
\newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
\newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
+% Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
+% We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
+% This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
+%
+% A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
+% \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
+%
+% Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
+% (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
+% of a page, or that at the bottom of a page. The solution is
+% described on page 260 of The TeXbook. It involves outputting two
+% marks for the sectioning macros, one before the section break, and
+% one after. I won't pretend I can describe this better than DEK...
+\def\domark{%
+ \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
+ \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
+ \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
+ \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
+ \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
+ \mark{%
+ \the\toks0 \the\toks2
+ \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6
+ \noexpand\else \the\toks8
+ }%
+}
+% \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
+% page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
+% the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
+% @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
+% first @chapter.
+\def\gettopheadingmarks{%
+ \ifcase0\topmark\fi
+ \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
+}
+\def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
+\def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
+
+% Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
+\def\lastchapterdefs{}
+\def\lastsectiondefs{}
+\def\prevchapterdefs{}
+\def\prevsectiondefs{}
+\def\lastcolordefs{}
+
% Main output routine.
\chardef\PAGE = 255
\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
@@ -201,7 +339,9 @@
%
% Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
% the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
+ \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
\setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}%
+ \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
\setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}%
%
{%
@@ -209,11 +349,18 @@
% take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
% before the \shipout runs.
%
- \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
\indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
\normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
- % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
+ % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
+ % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
+ % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
+ % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
+ % it needs to be
+ % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym}
\shipout\vbox{%
+ % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
+ \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
+ %
\ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup
\hsize = \outerhsize
\vskip-\topandbottommargin
@@ -237,13 +384,11 @@
\pagebody{#1}%
\ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
% Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
- % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingxxx.)
+ % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
% The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
- \vskip 2\baselineskip
+ \vskip 24pt
\unvbox\footlinebox
\fi
- %
- \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfmkdest{\the\pageno} \fi
%
\ifcropmarks
\egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
@@ -262,7 +407,7 @@
\egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
\fi
}% end of \shipout\vbox
- }% end of group with \turnoffactive
+ }% end of group with \indexdummies
\advancepageno
\ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
}
@@ -275,7 +420,7 @@
% marginal hacks, juha(a)viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
\ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
\rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
-\dimen@=\dp#1 \unvbox#1
+\dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
\ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
\ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
}
@@ -295,143 +440,161 @@
% the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
% macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
%
-\def\parsearg#1{%
- \let\next = #1%
+\def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
+\def\parseargusing#1#2{%
+ \def\argtorun{#2}%
\begingroup
\obeylines
- \futurelet\temp\parseargx
-}
-
-% If the next token is an obeyed space (from an @example environment or
-% the like), remove it and recurse. Otherwise, we're done.
-\def\parseargx{%
- % \obeyedspace is defined far below, after the definition of \sepspaces.
- \ifx\obeyedspace\temp
- \expandafter\parseargdiscardspace
- \else
- \expandafter\parseargline
- \fi
-}
-
-% Remove a single space (as the delimiter token to the macro call).
-{\obeyspaces %
- \gdef\parseargdiscardspace {\futurelet\temp\parseargx}}
+ \spaceisspace
+ #1%
+ \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
+}
{\obeylines %
\gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
\endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
- %
- % First remove any @c comment, then any @comment.
- % Result of each macro is put in \toks0.
- \argremovec #1\c\relax %
- \expandafter\argremovecomment \the\toks0 \comment\relax %
- %
- % Call the caller's macro, saved as \next in \parsearg.
- \expandafter\next\expandafter{\the\toks0}%
- }%
-}
-
-% Since all \c{,omment} does is throw away the argument, we can let TeX
-% do that for us. The \relax here is matched by the \relax in the call
-% in \parseargline; it could be more or less anything, its purpose is
-% just to delimit the argument to the \c.
-\def\argremovec#1\c#2\relax{\toks0 = {#1}}
-\def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\relax{\toks0 = {#1}}
-
-% \argremovec{,omment} might leave us with trailing spaces, though; e.g.,
+ \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
+ }%
+}
+
+% First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
+\def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
+\def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
+
+% Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single
space.
+%
+% \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
% @end itemize @c foo
-% will have two active spaces as part of the argument with the
-% `itemize'. Here we remove all active spaces from #1, and assign the
-% result to \toks0.
-%
-% This loses if there are any *other* active characters besides spaces
-% in the argument -- _ ^ +, for example -- since they get expanded.
-% Fortunately, Texinfo does not define any such commands. (If it ever
-% does, the catcode of the characters in questionwill have to be changed
-% here.) But this means we cannot call \removeactivespaces as part of
-% \argremovec{,omment}, since @c uses \parsearg, and thus the argument
-% that \parsearg gets might well have any character at all in it.
-%
-\def\removeactivespaces#1{%
- \begingroup
- \ignoreactivespaces
- \edef\temp{#1}%
- \global\toks0 = \expandafter{\temp}%
- \endgroup
-}
-
-% Change the active space to expand to nothing.
-%
-\begingroup
+% This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
+% by \finishparsearg.
+%
+\def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
+\def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
+\def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
+ \def\temp{#3}%
+ \ifx\temp\empty
+ % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
+ \let\temp\finishparsearg
+ \else
+ \let\temp\argcheckspaces
+ \fi
+ % Put the space token in:
+ \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
+}
+
+% If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
+% to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
+% We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
+% just before passing the control to \argtorun.
+% (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
+% either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
+% that a pair of braces would be stripped.
+%
+% But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
+%
+\def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
+
+% \parseargdef\foo{...}
+% is roughly equivalent to
+% \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
+% \def\Xfoo#1{...}
+%
+% Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
+% favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
+
+\def\parseargdef#1{%
+ \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
+}
+\def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
+ \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
+ \def#1##1%
+}
+
+% Several utility definitions with active space:
+{
\obeyspaces
- \gdef\ignoreactivespaces{\obeyspaces\let =\empty}
-\endgroup
+ \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
+
+ % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
+ % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
+ % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
+ % should produce a line of output anyway.
+ %
+ \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
+
+ % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
+ % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
+ % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
+ \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
+}
\def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
-%% These are used to keep @begin/@end levels from running away
-%% Call \inENV within environments (after a \begingroup)
-\newif\ifENV \ENVfalse \def\inENV{\ifENV\relax\else\ENVtrue\fi}
-\def\ENVcheck{%
-\ifENV\errmessage{Still within an environment; press RETURN to continue}
-\endgroup\fi} % This is not perfect, but it should reduce lossage
-
-% @begin foo is the same as @foo, for now.
+% Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
+%
+% \envdef\foo{...}
+% \def\Efoo{...}
+%
+% It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
+% actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
+% defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
+% whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
+% used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
+%
+% Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
+% are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The
+% implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
+% special case.)
+
+
+% At run-time, environments start with this:
+\def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
+% initialize
+\let\thisenv\empty
+
+% ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
+\long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
+\def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
+
+% Check whether we're in the right environment:
+\def\checkenv#1{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\thisenv\temp
+ \else
+ \badenverr
+ \fi
+}
+
+% Environment mismatch, #1 expected:
+\def\badenverr{%
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
+ not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
+}
+\def\inenvironment#1{%
+ \ifx#1\empty
+ out of any environment%
+ \else
+ in environment \expandafter\string#1%
+ \fi
+}
+
+% @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
+% But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
+%
+\parseargdef\end{%
+ \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
+ \else
+ % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03
+ \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
+ \csname E#1\endcsname
+ \endgroup
+ \fi
+}
+
\newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
-\outer\def\begin{\parsearg\beginxxx}
-
-\def\beginxxx #1{%
-\expandafter\ifx\csname #1\endcsname\relax
-{\errhelp=\EMsimple \errmessage{Undefined command @begin #1}}\else
-\csname #1\endcsname\fi}
-
-% @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
-%
-\def\end{\parsearg\endxxx}
-\def\endxxx #1{%
- \removeactivespaces{#1}%
- \edef\endthing{\the\toks0}%
- %
- \expandafter\ifx\csname E\endthing\endcsname\relax
- \expandafter\ifx\csname \endthing\endcsname\relax
- % There's no \foo, i.e., no ``environment'' foo.
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Undefined command `@end \endthing'}%
- \else
- \unmatchedenderror\endthing
- \fi
- \else
- % Everything's ok; the right environment has been started.
- \csname E\endthing\endcsname
- \fi
-}
-
-% There is an environment #1, but it hasn't been started. Give an error.
-%
-\def\unmatchedenderror#1{%
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{This `@end #1' doesn't have a matching `@#1'}%
-}
-
-% Define the control sequence \E#1 to give an unmatched @end error.
-%
-\def\defineunmatchedend#1{%
- \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\unmatchedenderror{#1}}%
-}
-
-
-% Single-spacing is done by various environments (specifically, in
-% \nonfillstart and \quotations).
-\newskip\singlespaceskip \singlespaceskip = 12.5pt
-\def\singlespace{%
- % Why was this kern here? It messes up equalizing space above and below
- % environments. --karl, 6may93
- %{\advance \baselineskip by -\singlespaceskip
- %\kern \baselineskip}%
- \setleading \singlespaceskip
-}
%% Simple single-character @ commands
@@ -452,16 +615,22 @@
\let\{=\mylbrace
\let\}=\myrbrace
\begingroup
- % Definitions to produce actual \{ & \} command in an index.
- \catcode`\{ = 12 \catcode`\} = 12
+ % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
+ % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
+ \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other
\catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2
- \catcode`\@ = 0 \catcode`\\ = 12
- @gdef@lbracecmd[\{]%
- @gdef@rbracecmd[\}]%
-@endgroup
+ \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other
+ !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]%
+ !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]%
+ !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]%
+ !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]%
+!endgroup
+
+% @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
+\let\comma = ,
% Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
-% Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @v @H.
+% Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
\let\, = \c
\let\dotaccent = \.
\def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
@@ -469,20 +638,41 @@
\let\ubaraccent = \b
\let\udotaccent = \d
-% Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown
-% Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (and lowercase versions) @ss.
+% Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
+% Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
\def\questiondown{?`}
\def\exclamdown{!`}
+\def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}}
+\def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}}
% Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
\def\imacro{i}
\def\jmacro{j}
\def\dotless#1{%
\def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi
- \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j
+ \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi
+ \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi
\else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
\fi\fi
+}
+
+% The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
+% period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
+%
+\edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
+
+% @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
+% latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
+% convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
+% the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
+% \scriptscriptstyle).
+%
+\def\LaTeX{%
+ L\kern-.36em
+ {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
+ \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A}\vss}}%
+ \kern-.15em
+ \TeX
}
% Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
@@ -503,14 +693,32 @@
% @* forces a line break.
\def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
+% @/ allows a line break.
+\let\/=\allowbreak
+
% @. is an end-of-sentence period.
-\def\.{.\spacefactor=3000 }
+\def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
% @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
-\def\!{!\spacefactor=3000 }
+\def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
% @? is an end-of-sentence query.
-\def\?{?\spacefactor=3000 }
+\def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
+
+% @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
+%
+\def\onword{on}
+\def\offword{off}
+%
+\parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
+ \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on/off}%
+ \fi\fi
+}
% @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
% beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
@@ -525,47 +733,24 @@
% therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
% the text is small, which looks bad.
%
-\def\group{\begingroup
- \ifnum\catcode13=\active \else
+% Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
+% cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
+% does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
+% explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
+% threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
+% percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
+%
+\newbox\groupbox
+\def\vfilllimit{0.7}
+%
+\envdef\group{%
+ \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
\errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
\errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
\fi
- %
- % The \vtop we start below produces a box with normal height and large
- % depth; thus, TeX puts \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the
- % next line of text is done) \lineskip glue after it. (See p.82 of
- % the TeXbook.) Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
- % above. But it's pretty close.
- \def\Egroup{%
- \egroup % End the \vtop.
- \endgroup % End the \group.
- }%
- %
- \vtop\bgroup
- % We have to put a strut on the last line in case the @group is in
- % the midst of an example, rather than completely enclosing it.
- % Otherwise, the interline space between the last line of the group
- % and the first line afterwards is too small. But we can't put the
- % strut in \Egroup, since there it would be on a line by itself.
- % Hence this just inserts a strut at the beginning of each line.
- \everypar = {\strut}%
- %
- % Since we have a strut on every line, we don't need any of TeX's
- % normal interline spacing.
- \offinterlineskip
- %
- % OK, but now we have to do something about blank
- % lines in the input in @example-like environments, which normally
- % just turn into \lisppar, which will insert no space now that we've
- % turned off the interline space. Simplest is to make them be an
- % empty paragraph.
- \ifx\par\lisppar
- \edef\par{\leavevmode \par}%
- %
- % Reset ^^M's definition to new definition of \par.
- \obeylines
- \fi
- %
+ \startsavinginserts
+ %
+ \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
% Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
% @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
% end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
@@ -575,6 +760,32 @@
\comment
}
%
+% The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
+% \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
+% \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
+% above. But it's pretty close.
+\def\Egroup{%
+ % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
+ % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
+ \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
+ \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
+ \egroup % End the \vtop.
+ % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
+ \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
+ % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
+ \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
+ % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
+ % group, force a page break.
+ \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
+ \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight
+ \page
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \box\groupbox
+ \prevdepth = \dimen1
+ \checkinserts
+}
+%
% TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
% message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
%
@@ -587,10 +798,8 @@
\newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
-\def\need{\parsearg\needx}
-
% Old definition--didn't work.
-%\def\needx #1{\par %
+%\parseargdef\need{\par %
%% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally
%% if the depth of the box does not fit.
%{\baselineskip=0pt%
@@ -598,7 +807,7 @@
%\prevdepth=-1000pt
%}}
-\def\needx#1{%
+\parseargdef\need{%
% Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
% paragraph.
\par
@@ -637,37 +846,11 @@
\fi
}
-% @br forces paragraph break
+% @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
\let\br = \par
-% @dots{} output an ellipsis using the current font.
-% We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in a typewriter
-% font as three actual period characters.
-%
-\def\dots{%
- \leavevmode
- \hbox to 1.5em{%
- \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil minus 0.25fil
- .\hss.\hss.%
- \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil minus 0.5fil
- }%
-}
-
-% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
-%
-\def\enddots{%
- \leavevmode
- \hbox to 2em{%
- \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil minus 0.25fil
- .\hss.\hss.\hss.%
- \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil minus 0.5fil
- }%
- \spacefactor=3000
-}
-
-
-% @page forces the start of a new page
+% @page forces the start of a new page.
%
\def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
@@ -679,57 +862,131 @@
\newskip\exdentamount
% This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
-\def\exdent{\parsearg\exdentyyy}
-\def\exdentyyy #1{{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}}
+\parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
% This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
-\def\nofillexdent{\parsearg\nofillexdentyyy}
-\def\nofillexdentyyy #1{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
-\leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
-
-% @inmargin{TEXT} puts TEXT in the margin next to the current paragraph.
-
-\def\inmargin#1{%
-\strut\vadjust{\nobreak\kern-\strutdepth
- \vtop to \strutdepth{\baselineskip\strutdepth\vss
- \llap{\rightskip=\inmarginspacing \vbox{\noindent #1}}\null}}}
+\parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
+ \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
+
+% @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
+% paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
+% class. WHICH is `l' or `r'.
+%
\newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
\def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
-
-%\hbox{{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}}
-
-% @include file insert text of that file as input.
-% Allow normal characters that we make active in the argument (a file name).
-\def\include{\begingroup
- \catcode`\\=12
- \catcode`~=12
- \catcode`^=12
- \catcode`_=12
- \catcode`|=12
- \catcode`<=12
- \catcode`>=12
- \catcode`+=12
- \parsearg\includezzz}
-% Restore active chars for included file.
-\def\includezzz#1{\endgroup\begingroup
- % Read the included file in a group so nested @include's work.
+%
+\def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
+ \nobreak
+ \kern-\strutdepth
+ \vtop to \strutdepth{%
+ \baselineskip=\strutdepth
+ \vss
+ % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
+ % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
+ \ifx#1l%
+ \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
+ \else
+ \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
+ \fi
+ \null
+ }%
+}}
+\def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
+\def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
+%
+% @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
+% (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
+% else use TEXT for both).
+%
+\def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
+\def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
+ \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
+ \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
+ \def\righttext{#2}%
+ \else
+ \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
+ \def\righttext{#1}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ \ifodd\pageno
+ \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
+ \else
+ \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
+ \fi
+ \temp
+}
+
+% @include FILE -- \input text of FILE.
+%
+\def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
+\def\includezzz#1{%
+ \pushthisfilestack
\def\thisfile{#1}%
- \input\thisfile
-\endgroup}
+ {%
+ \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE.
+ \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion
+ \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }%
+ %
+ % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes
+ % definitions, etc.
+ \expandafter
+ }\temp
+ \popthisfilestack
+}
+\def\filenamecatcodes{%
+ \catcode`\\=\other
+ \catcode`~=\other
+ \catcode`^=\other
+ \catcode`_=\other
+ \catcode`|=\other
+ \catcode`<=\other
+ \catcode`>=\other
+ \catcode`+=\other
+ \catcode`-=\other
+}
+
+\def\pushthisfilestack{%
+ \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
+}
+\def\pushthisfilestackX{%
+ \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
+}
+\def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
+ \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
+}
+
+\def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
+\def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
+ the stack of filenames is empty.}}
\def\thisfile{}
-% @center line outputs that line, centered
-
-\def\center{\parsearg\centerzzz}
-\def\centerzzz #1{{\advance\hsize by -\leftskip
-\advance\hsize by -\rightskip
-\centerline{#1}}}
+% @center line
+% outputs that line, centered.
+%
+\parseargdef\center{%
+ \ifhmode
+ \let\next\centerH
+ \else
+ \let\next\centerV
+ \fi
+ \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
+}
+\def\centerH#1{%
+ {%
+ \hfil\break
+ \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
+ \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
+ \line{#1}%
+ \break
+ }%
+}
+\def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}}
% @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
-\def\sp{\parsearg\spxxx}
-\def\spxxx #1{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
+\parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
% @comment ...line which is ignored...
% @c is the same as @comment
@@ -744,13 +1001,13 @@
% @paragraphindent NCHARS
% We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
-% We cannot implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
-%
+% NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
+% We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
+%
\def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
\def\noneword{none}
%
-\def\paragraphindent{\parsearg\doparagraphindent}
-\def\doparagraphindent#1{%
+\parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
\def\temp{#1}%
\ifx\temp\asisword
\else
@@ -767,8 +1024,7 @@
% We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
% It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
% I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
-\def\exampleindent{\parsearg\doexampleindent}
-\def\doexampleindent#1{%
+\parseargdef\exampleindent{%
\def\temp{#1}%
\ifx\temp\asisword
\else
@@ -780,26 +1036,159 @@
\fi
}
+% @firstparagraphindent WORD
+% If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
+% after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
+% paragraphs.
+%
+% The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
+% \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
+% We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
+% By default, we suppress indentation.
+%
+\def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
+\def\insertword{insert}
+%
+\parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\noneword
+ \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
+ \else\ifx\temp\insertword
+ \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
+ \fi\fi
+}
+
+% Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
+% \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
+%
+% We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
+% paragraph.
+%
+\gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
+ \gdef\indent{%
+ \restorefirstparagraphindent
+ \indent
+ }%
+ \gdef\noindent{%
+ \restorefirstparagraphindent
+ \noindent
+ }%
+ \global\everypar = {%
+ \kern -\parindent
+ \restorefirstparagraphindent
+ }%
+}
+
+\gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
+ \global \let \indent = \ptexindent
+ \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent
+ \global \everypar = {}%
+}
+
+
% @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
%
\def\asis#1{#1}
-% @math means output in math mode.
-% We don't use $'s directly in the definition of \math because control
-% sequences like \math are expanded when the toc file is written. Then,
-% we read the toc file back, the $'s will be normal characters (as they
-% should be, according to the definition of Texinfo). So we must use a
-% control sequence to switch into and out of math mode.
-%
-% This isn't quite enough for @math to work properly in indices, but it
-% seems unlikely it will ever be needed there.
-%
-\let\implicitmath = $
-\def\math#1{\implicitmath #1\implicitmath}
-
-% @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above.
-\def\bullet{\implicitmath\ptexbullet\implicitmath}
-\def\minus{\implicitmath-\implicitmath}
+% @math outputs its argument in math mode.
+%
+% One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
+% an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
+% _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
+% which is what @var uses.
+{
+ \catcode`\_ = \active
+ \gdef\mathunderscore{%
+ \catcode`\_=\active
+ \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
+ }
+}
+% Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character.
+% FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but
+% this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not
+% otherwise define @\.
+%
+% The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
+\def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
+%
+\def\math{%
+ \tex
+ \mathunderscore
+ \let\\ = \mathbackslash
+ \mathactive
+ % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode
+ \let\"=\ddot
+ \let\'=\acute
+ \let\==\bar
+ \let\^=\hat
+ \let\`=\grave
+ \let\u=\breve
+ \let\v=\check
+ \let\~=\tilde
+ \let\dotaccent=\dot
+ $\finishmath
+}
+\def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
+
+% Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
+% We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
+% to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
+%
+{
+ \catcode`^ = \active
+ \catcode`< = \active
+ \catcode`> = \active
+ \catcode`+ = \active
+ \gdef\mathactive{%
+ \let^ = \ptexhat
+ \let< = \ptexless
+ \let> = \ptexgtr
+ \let+ = \ptexplus
+ }
+}
+
+% Some math mode symbols.
+\def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$}
+\def\geq{\ifmmode \ge\else $\ge$\fi}
+\def\leq{\ifmmode \le\else $\le$\fi}
+\def\minus{\ifmmode -\else $-$\fi}
+
+% @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
+% We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
+% typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
+% in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
+% whichever is larger.
+%
+\def\dots{%
+ \leavevmode
+ \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
+ \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
+ \dimen0 = \wd0
+ \else
+ \dimen0 = 1.5em
+ \fi
+ \hbox to \dimen0{%
+ \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
+ .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
+ .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
+ .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
+ }%
+}
+
+% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
+%
+\def\enddots{%
+ \dots
+ \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
+}
+
+% @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up
+% Texinfo's parsing.
+%
+\let\comma = ,
% @refill is a no-op.
\let\refill=\relax
@@ -815,20 +1204,20 @@
% So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
% This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
\def\setfilename{%
+ \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
\iflinks
- \readauxfile
+ \tryauxfile
+ % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
+ \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
\fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
\openindices
- \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
- \global\let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
+ \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
%
% If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
% Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
- % Just to be on the safe side, close the input stream before the \input.
\openin 1 texinfo.cnf
- \ifeof1 \let\temp=\relax \else \def\temp{\input texinfo.cnf }\fi
- \closein1
- \temp
+ \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi
+ \closein 1
%
\comment % Ignore the actual filename.
}
@@ -864,111 +1253,294 @@
\newif\ifpdf
\newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
+% when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
+% can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined,
+% borrowed from ifpdf.sty.
\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
- \pdffalse
- \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
- \let\pdfurl = \gobble
- \let\endlink = \relax
- \let\linkcolor = \relax
- \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
\else
- \pdftrue
- \pdfoutput = 1
- \input pdfcolor
+ \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
+ \else
+ \ifcase\pdfoutput
+ \else
+ \pdftrue
+ \fi
+ \fi
+\fi
+
+% PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
+% for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
+% double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
+% interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
+%
http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html
+% (and related messages, the final outcome is that it is up to the TeX
+% user to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
+% that's what we do).
+
+% double active backslashes.
+%
+{\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active
+ @gdef@activebackslashdouble{%
+ @catcode`@\=@active
+ @let\=@doublebackslash}
+}
+
+% To handle parens, we must adopt a different approach, since parens are
+% not active characters. hyperref.dtx (which has the same problem as
+% us) handles it with this amazing macro to replace tokens, with minor
+% changes for Texinfo. It is included here under the GPL by permission
+% from the author, Heiko Oberdiek.
+%
+% #1 is the tokens to replace.
+% #2 is the replacement.
+% #3 is the control sequence with the string.
+%
+\def\HyPsdSubst#1#2#3{%
+ \def\HyPsdReplace##1#1##2\END{%
+ ##1%
+ \ifx\\##2\\%
+ \else
+ #2%
+ \HyReturnAfterFi{%
+ \HyPsdReplace##2\END
+ }%
+ \fi
+ }%
+ \xdef#3{\expandafter\HyPsdReplace#3#1\END}%
+}
+\long\def\HyReturnAfterFi#1\fi{\fi#1}
+
+% #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements.
+\def\backslashparens#1{%
+ \xdef#1{#1}% redefine it as its expansion; the definition is simply
+ % \lastnode when called from \setref -> \pdfmkdest.
+ \HyPsdSubst{(}{\realbackslash(}{#1}%
+ \HyPsdSubst{)}{\realbackslash)}{#1}%
+}
+
+\newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
+with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
+be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
+output) for that.)}
+
+\ifpdf
+ %
+ % Color manipulation macros based on pdfcolor.tex.
+ \def\cmykDarkRed{0.28 1 1 0.35}
+ \def\cmykBlack{0 0 0 1}
+ %
+ \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 k}}
+ % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
+ % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
+ \def\setcolor#1{%
+ \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
+ \domark
+ \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
+ }
+ %
+ \def\maincolor{\cmykBlack}
+ \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
+ \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
+ \def\lastcolordefs{}
+ %
+ \def\makefootline{%
+ \baselineskip24pt
+ \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
+ }
+ %
+ \def\makeheadline{%
+ \vbox to 0pt{%
+ \vskip-22.5pt
+ \line{%
+ \vbox to8.5pt{}%
+ % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
+ \getcolormarks
+ % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
+ \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
+ }%
+ \vss
+ }%
+ \nointerlineskip
+ }
+ %
+ %
+ \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
+ %
+ % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
\def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
- \def\imagewidth{#2}%
- \def\imageheight{#3}%
+ \def\imagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
+ \def\imageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
+ %
+ % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .png, .jpg, .pdf (among
+ % others). Let's try in that order.
+ \let\pdfimgext=\empty
+ \begingroup
+ \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
+ \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
+ \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
+ \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
+ \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
+ \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
+ \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
+ \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
+ \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}%
+ \fi
+ \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
+ \fi
+ \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
+ \fi
+ \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
+ \fi
+ \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
+ \fi
+ \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
+ \fi
+ \closein 1
+ \endgroup
+ %
+ % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is
+ % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
\ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
- \pdfimage
- \else
- \pdfximage
- \fi
- \ifx\empty\imagewidth\else width \imagewidth \fi
- \ifx\empty\imageheight\else height \imageheight \fi
- {#1.pdf}%
+ \immediate\pdfimage
+ \else
+ \immediate\pdfximage
+ \fi
+ \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \imagewidth \fi
+ \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \imageheight \fi
+ \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
+ #1.\pdfimgext
+ \else
+ {#1.\pdfimgext}%
+ \fi
\ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
\pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
\fi}
- \def\pdfmkdest#1{\pdfdest name{#1@} xyz}
- \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1@}
- \let\linkcolor = \Cyan
- \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink}
+ %
+ \def\pdfmkdest#1{{%
+ % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
+ % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
+ \indexnofonts
+ \turnoffactive
+ \activebackslashdouble
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
+ \backslashparens\pdfdestname
+ \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
+ }}
+ %
+ % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
+ \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
+ %
+ % by default, use a color that is dark enough to print on paper as
+ % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing.
+ \def\urlcolor{\cmykDarkRed}
+ \def\linkcolor{\cmykDarkRed}
+ \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
+ %
% Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
% come from Petr Olsak
\def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
\else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
\def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
- \advance\tempnum by1
+ \advance\tempnum by 1
\expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
- \def\pdfmakeoutlines{{%
- \openin 1 \jobname.toc
- \ifeof 1\else\bgroup
- \closein 1
- \indexnofonts
- \def\tt{}
- % thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks
+ %
+ % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
+ % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
+ % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
+ % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
+ % #4 is the page number
+ %
+ \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
+ % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
+ % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
+ % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
+ % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
+ \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
+ \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
+ \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
+ \else
+ % Doubled backslashes in the name.
+ {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
+ \backslashparens\pdfoutlinedest}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Also double the backslashes in the display string.
+ {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
+ \backslashparens\pdfoutlinetext}%
+ %
+ \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
+ }
+ %
+ \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
+ \begingroup
+ % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks
\edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace
\edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace
%
- \def\chapentry ##1##2##3{}
- \def\unnumbchapentry ##1##2{}
- \def\secentry ##1##2##3##4{\advancenumber{chap##2}}
- \def\unnumbsecentry ##1##2{}
- \def\subsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{\advancenumber{sec##2.##3}}
- \def\unnumbsubsecentry ##1##2{}
- \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{\advancenumber{subsec##2.##3.##4}}
- \def\unnumbsubsubsecentry ##1##2{}
- \input \jobname.toc
- \def\chapentry ##1##2##3{%
- \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##3}}count-\expnumber{chap##2}{##1}}
- \def\unnumbchapentry ##1##2{%
- \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##2}}{##1}}
- \def\secentry ##1##2##3##4{%
- \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##4}}count-\expnumber{sec##2.##3}{##1}}
- \def\unnumbsecentry ##1##2{%
- \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##2}}{##1}}
- \def\subsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{%
- \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##5}}count-\expnumber{subsec##2.##3.##4}{##1}}
- \def\unnumbsubsecentry ##1##2{%
- \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##2}}{##1}}
- \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{%
- \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##6}}{##1}}
- \def\unnumbsubsubsecentry ##1##2{%
- \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##2}}{##1}}
- \input \jobname.toc
- \egroup\fi
- }}
- \def\makelinks #1,{%
- \def\params{#1}\def\E{END}%
- \ifx\params\E
- \let\nextmakelinks=\relax
- \else
- \let\nextmakelinks=\makelinks
- \ifnum\lnkcount>0,\fi
- \picknum{#1}%
- \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}
- goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\the\pgn}}%
- \linkcolor #1%
- \advance\lnkcount by 1%
- \endlink
- \fi
- \nextmakelinks
- }
- \def\picknum#1{\expandafter\pn#1}
- \def\pn#1{%
- \def\p{#1}%
- \ifx\p\lbrace
- \let\nextpn=\ppn
- \else
- \let\nextpn=\ppnn
- \def\first{#1}
- \fi
- \nextpn
- }
- \def\ppn#1{\pgn=#1\gobble}
- \def\ppnn{\pgn=\first}
- \def\pdfmklnk#1{\lnkcount=0\makelinks #1,END,}
- \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
+ % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
+ \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \def\thischapnum{##2}%
+ \def\thissecnum{0}%
+ \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
+ }%
+ \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
+ \def\thissecnum{##2}%
+ \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
+ }%
+ \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
+ \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
+ }%
+ \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
+ }%
+ \def\thischapnum{0}%
+ \def\thissecnum{0}%
+ \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
+ %
+ % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
+ % al. a second time, below.
+ \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
+ \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
+ \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
+ \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
+ \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
+ \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
+ \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
+ \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
+ \readdatafile{toc}%
+ %
+ % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
+ % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
+ % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
+ %
+ % We use the node names as the destinations.
+ \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
+ \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
+ \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
+ \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
+ \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
+ %
+ % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
+ % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
+ % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
+ % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
+ % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
+ %
+ % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
+ % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right
+ % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way.
+ \indexnofonts
+ \setupdatafile
+ \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
+ \input \tocreadfilename
+ \endgroup
+ }
+ %
\def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
\ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
\else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
@@ -983,24 +1555,32 @@
\else
\let \startlink \pdfstartlink
\fi
+ % make a live url in pdf output.
\def\pdfurl#1{%
\begingroup
- \normalturnoffactive\def\@{@}%
- \leavevmode\Red
+ % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
+ % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
+ % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
+ % people have actually reported a problem with.
+ %
+ \normalturnoffactive
+ \def\@{@}%
+ \let\/=\empty
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
\startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
- % #1
\endgroup}
\def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
\def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
\def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
\def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
\def\maketoks{%
- \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|
+ \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
\ifx\first0\adn0
\else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
\else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
- \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
+ \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
\else
\ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
\ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
@@ -1013,33 +1593,348 @@
\def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
{\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
\def\pdflink#1{%
- \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\mkpgn{#1}}
- \linkcolor #1\endlink}
- \def\mkpgn#1{#1@}
+ \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
+ \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
\def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
-\fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
+\else
+ \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
+ \let\pdfurl = \gobble
+ \let\endlink = \relax
+ \let\setcolor = \gobble
+ \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble
+ \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
+\fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
\message{fonts,}
-% Font-change commands.
+
+% Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
+% For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
+% italics, not bold italics.
+%
+\def\setfontstyle#1{%
+ \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
+ \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font
+}
+
+% Select #1 fonts with the current style.
+%
+\def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
+
+\def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
+\def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
+\def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
+\def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
+\def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
% Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
-% So we set up a \sf analogous to plain's \rm, etc.
+% So we set up a \sf.
\newfam\sffam
-\def\sf{\fam=\sffam \tensf}
+\def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
\let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
-% We don't need math for this one.
-\def\ttsl{\tenttsl}
-
-% Use Computer Modern fonts at \magstephalf (11pt).
-\newcount\mainmagstep
-\mainmagstep=\magstephalf
+% We don't need math for this font style.
+\def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
+
+
+% Default leading.
+\newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt
+
+% Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
+% correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
+% used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
+%
+\def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
+\def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
+\def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
+%
+% can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
+\def\baselinefactor{1}
+%
+\def\setleading#1{%
+ \dimen0 = #1\relax
+ \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0
+ \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
+ \normalbaselines
+ \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
+ \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
+ depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
+ }%
+}
+
+% PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
+%
+% do nothing with this by default.
+\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
+\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
+\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
+
+% if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
+% (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
+% older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
+\ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\undefined \else
+ \begingroup
+ \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
+ \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
+%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
+%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
+%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
+%%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
+%%Version: 1.000
+%%EndComments
+/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
+12 dict begin
+begincmap
+/CIDSystemInfo
+<< /Registry (TeX)
+/Ordering (OT1)
+/Supplement 0
+>> def
+/CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
+/CMapType 2 def
+1 begincodespacerange
+<00> <7F>
+endcodespacerange
+8 beginbfrange
+<00> <01> <0393>
+<09> <0A> <03A8>
+<23> <26> <0023>
+<28> <3B> <0028>
+<3F> <5B> <003F>
+<5D> <5E> <005D>
+<61> <7A> <0061>
+<7B> <7C> <2013>
+endbfrange
+40 beginbfchar
+<02> <0398>
+<03> <039B>
+<04> <039E>
+<05> <03A0>
+<06> <03A3>
+<07> <03D2>
+<08> <03A6>
+<0B> <00660066>
+<0C> <00660069>
+<0D> <0066006C>
+<0E> <006600660069>
+<0F> <00660066006C>
+<10> <0131>
+<11> <0237>
+<12> <0060>
+<13> <00B4>
+<14> <02C7>
+<15> <02D8>
+<16> <00AF>
+<17> <02DA>
+<18> <00B8>
+<19> <00DF>
+<1A> <00E6>
+<1B> <0153>
+<1C> <00F8>
+<1D> <00C6>
+<1E> <0152>
+<1F> <00D8>
+<21> <0021>
+<22> <201D>
+<27> <2019>
+<3C> <00A1>
+<3D> <003D>
+<3E> <00BF>
+<5C> <201C>
+<5F> <02D9>
+<60> <2018>
+<7D> <02DD>
+<7E> <007E>
+<7F> <00A8>
+endbfchar
+endcmap
+CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
+end
+end
+%%EndResource
+%%EOF
+ }\endgroup
+ \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
+ \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
+ }%
+%
+% \cmapOT1IT
+ \begingroup
+ \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
+ \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
+%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
+%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
+%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
+%%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
+%%Version: 1.000
+%%EndComments
+/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
+12 dict begin
+begincmap
+/CIDSystemInfo
+<< /Registry (TeX)
+/Ordering (OT1IT)
+/Supplement 0
+>> def
+/CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
+/CMapType 2 def
+1 begincodespacerange
+<00> <7F>
+endcodespacerange
+8 beginbfrange
+<00> <01> <0393>
+<09> <0A> <03A8>
+<25> <26> <0025>
+<28> <3B> <0028>
+<3F> <5B> <003F>
+<5D> <5E> <005D>
+<61> <7A> <0061>
+<7B> <7C> <2013>
+endbfrange
+42 beginbfchar
+<02> <0398>
+<03> <039B>
+<04> <039E>
+<05> <03A0>
+<06> <03A3>
+<07> <03D2>
+<08> <03A6>
+<0B> <00660066>
+<0C> <00660069>
+<0D> <0066006C>
+<0E> <006600660069>
+<0F> <00660066006C>
+<10> <0131>
+<11> <0237>
+<12> <0060>
+<13> <00B4>
+<14> <02C7>
+<15> <02D8>
+<16> <00AF>
+<17> <02DA>
+<18> <00B8>
+<19> <00DF>
+<1A> <00E6>
+<1B> <0153>
+<1C> <00F8>
+<1D> <00C6>
+<1E> <0152>
+<1F> <00D8>
+<21> <0021>
+<22> <201D>
+<23> <0023>
+<24> <00A3>
+<27> <2019>
+<3C> <00A1>
+<3D> <003D>
+<3E> <00BF>
+<5C> <201C>
+<5F> <02D9>
+<60> <2018>
+<7D> <02DD>
+<7E> <007E>
+<7F> <00A8>
+endbfchar
+endcmap
+CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
+end
+end
+%%EndResource
+%%EOF
+ }\endgroup
+ \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
+ \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
+ }%
+%
+% \cmapOT1TT
+ \begingroup
+ \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
+ \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
+%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
+%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
+%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
+%%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
+%%Version: 1.000
+%%EndComments
+/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
+12 dict begin
+begincmap
+/CIDSystemInfo
+<< /Registry (TeX)
+/Ordering (OT1TT)
+/Supplement 0
+>> def
+/CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
+/CMapType 2 def
+1 begincodespacerange
+<00> <7F>
+endcodespacerange
+5 beginbfrange
+<00> <01> <0393>
+<09> <0A> <03A8>
+<21> <26> <0021>
+<28> <5F> <0028>
+<61> <7E> <0061>
+endbfrange
+32 beginbfchar
+<02> <0398>
+<03> <039B>
+<04> <039E>
+<05> <03A0>
+<06> <03A3>
+<07> <03D2>
+<08> <03A6>
+<0B> <2191>
+<0C> <2193>
+<0D> <0027>
+<0E> <00A1>
+<0F> <00BF>
+<10> <0131>
+<11> <0237>
+<12> <0060>
+<13> <00B4>
+<14> <02C7>
+<15> <02D8>
+<16> <00AF>
+<17> <02DA>
+<18> <00B8>
+<19> <00DF>
+<1A> <00E6>
+<1B> <0153>
+<1C> <00F8>
+<1D> <00C6>
+<1E> <0152>
+<1F> <00D8>
+<20> <2423>
+<27> <2019>
+<60> <2018>
+<7F> <00A8>
+endbfchar
+endcmap
+CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
+end
+end
+%%EndResource
+%%EOF
+ }\endgroup
+ \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
+ \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
+ }%
+\fi\fi
+
% Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
% specified font prefix (normally `cm').
-% #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor
-\def\setfont#1#2#3#4{\font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4}
+% #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
+% encoding (currently only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, pass
+% empty to omit).
+\def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
+ \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
+ \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
+}
+% This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
+\let\cmap\gobble
+% emacs-page end of cmaps
% Use cm as the default font prefix.
% To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
@@ -1064,165 +1959,409 @@
\def\scshape{csc}
\def\scbshape{csc}
-\ifx\bigger\relax
-\let\mainmagstep=\magstep1
-\setfont\textrm\rmshape{12}{1000}
-\setfont\texttt\ttshape{12}{1000}
-\else
-\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\fi
-% Instead of cmb10, you many want to use cmbx10.
-% cmbx10 is a prettier font on its own, but cmb10
-% looks better when embedded in a line with cmr10.
-\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+% Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. This is the default in
+% Texinfo.
+%
+\def\definetextfontsizexi{%
+% Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
+\def\textnominalsize{11pt}
+\edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
+\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
-
-% A few fonts for @defun, etc.
-\setfont\defbf\bxshape{10}{\magstep1} %was 1314
-\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}
-\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \bf}
+\def\textecsize{1095}
+
+% A few fonts for @defun names and args.
+\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
+\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
-\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}
-\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}
-\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}
+\def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
+\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
\font\smalli=cmmi9
\font\smallsy=cmsy9
-
-% Fonts for title page:
-\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}
-\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}
-\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}
-\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}
-\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}
-\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}
+\def\smallecsize{0900}
+
+% Fonts for small examples (8pt).
+\def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
+\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
+\font\smalleri=cmmi8
+\font\smallersy=cmsy8
+\def\smallerecsize{0800}
+
+% Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
+\def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
+\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
+\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
+\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
\let\titlebf=\titlerm
-\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}
+\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
\def\authorrm{\secrm}
+\def\authortt{\sectt}
+\def\titleecsize{2074}
% Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
-\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}
-\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}
-\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}
-\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}
-\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}
-\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}
+\def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
+\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
+\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
+\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
\let\chapbf=\chaprm
-\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}
+\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
+\def\chapecsize{1728}
% Section fonts (14.4pt).
-\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}
-\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}
-\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}
-\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}
-\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}
-\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}
+\def\secnominalsize{14pt}
+\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
+\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
\let\secbf\secrm
-\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}
+\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
\font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
-
-% \setfont\ssecrm\bxshape{10}{\magstep1} % This size an font looked bad.
-% \setfont\ssecit\itshape{10}{\magstep1} % The letters were too crowded.
-% \setfont\ssecsl\slshape{10}{\magstep1}
-% \setfont\ssectt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}
-% \setfont\ssecsf\sfshape{10}{\magstep1}
-
-%\setfont\ssecrm\bfshape{10}{1315} % Note the use of cmb rather than cmbx.
-%\setfont\ssecit\itshape{10}{1315} % Also, the size is a little larger than
-%\setfont\ssecsl\slshape{10}{1315} % being scaled magstep1.
-%\setfont\ssectt\ttshape{10}{1315}
-%\setfont\ssecsf\sfshape{10}{1315}
-
-%\let\ssecbf=\ssecrm
+\def\sececsize{1440}
% Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
-\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
-\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}
-\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}
-\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
-\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}
-\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
+\def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
+\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
+\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
+\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
\let\ssecbf\ssecrm
-\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}
+\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
\font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
\font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
-% The smallcaps and symbol fonts should actually be scaled \magstep1.5,
-% but that is not a standard magnification.
+\def\ssececsize{1200}
+
+% Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
+\def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
+\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\font\reducedi=cmmi10
+\font\reducedsy=cmsy10
+\def\reducedecsize{1000}
+
+% reset the current fonts
+\textfonts
+\rm
+} % end of 11pt text font size definitions
+
+
+% Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
+% section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
+% Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
+% future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
+%
+\def\definetextfontsizex{%
+% Text fonts (10pt).
+\def\textnominalsize{10pt}
+\edef\mainmagstep{1000}
+\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
+\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
+\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
+\def\textecsize{1000}
+
+% A few fonts for @defun names and args.
+\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
+\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
+\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
+
+% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
+\def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
+\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
+\font\smalli=cmmi9
+\font\smallsy=cmsy9
+\def\smallecsize{0900}
+
+% Fonts for small examples (8pt).
+\def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
+\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
+\font\smalleri=cmmi8
+\font\smallersy=cmsy8
+\def\smallerecsize{0800}
+
+% Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
+\def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
+\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
+\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
+\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\let\titlebf=\titlerm
+\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
+\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
+\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
+\def\authorrm{\secrm}
+\def\authortt{\sectt}
+\def\titleecsize{2074}
+
+% Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
+\def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
+\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
+\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\let\chapbf\chaprm
+\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
+\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
+\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
+\def\chapecsize{1440}
+
+% Section fonts (12pt).
+\def\secnominalsize{12pt}
+\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
+\let\secbf\secrm
+\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\font\seci=cmmi12
+\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
+\def\sececsize{1200}
+
+% Subsection fonts (10pt).
+\def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
+\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\let\ssecbf\ssecrm
+\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\font\sseci=cmmi10
+\font\ssecsy=cmsy10
+\def\ssececsize{1000}
+
+% Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt).
+\def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
+\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
+\font\reducedi=cmmi9
+\font\reducedsy=cmsy9
+\def\reducedecsize{0900}
+
+% reduce space between paragraphs
+\divide\parskip by 2
+
+% reset the current fonts
+\textfonts
+\rm
+} % end of 10pt text font size definitions
+
+
+% We provide the user-level command
+% @fonttextsize 10
+% (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
+%
+\def\xword{10}
+\def\xiword{11}
+%
+\parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
+ \def\textsizearg{#1}%
+ \wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
+ %
+ % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
+ % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
+ %
+ \begingroup \globaldefs=1
+ \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
+ \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
+ \else
+ \errhelp=\EMsimple
+ \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not
`\textsizearg'}
+ \fi\fi
+ \endgroup
+}
+
% In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
% we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
-% texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts, we
-% don't bother to reset \scriptfont and \scriptscriptfont (which would
-% also require loading a lot more fonts).
+% texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except
+% in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and
+% \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts).
%
\def\resetmathfonts{%
- \textfont0 = \tenrm \textfont1 = \teni \textfont2 = \tensy
- \textfont\itfam = \tenit \textfont\slfam = \tensl \textfont\bffam = \tenbf
- \textfont\ttfam = \tentt \textfont\sffam = \tensf
-}
-
+ \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy
+ \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf
+ \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf
+}
% The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
-% of just \STYLE. We do this so that font changes will continue to work
-% in math mode, where it is the current \fam that is relevant in most
-% cases, not the current font. Plain TeX does \def\bf{\fam=\bffam
-% \tenbf}, for example. By redefining \tenbf, we obviate the need to
-% redefine \bf itself.
+% of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
+% current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
+% \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
+%
+% Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
+% and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in
+% the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
+%
+% This all needs generalizing, badly.
+%
\def\textfonts{%
\let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl
\let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc
- \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy \let\tenttsl=\textttsl
- \resetmathfonts}
+ \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy
+ \let\tenttsl=\textttsl
+ \def\curfontsize{text}%
+ \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
\def\titlefonts{%
\let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl
\let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc
\let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy
\let\tenttsl=\titlettsl
+ \def\curfontsize{title}%
+ \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}%
\resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}}
\def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
\def\chapfonts{%
\let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl
\let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc
- \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl
+ \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy
+ \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl
+ \def\curfontsize{chap}%
+ \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}%
\resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}}
\def\secfonts{%
\let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl
\let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc
- \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy \let\tenttsl=\secttsl
+ \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy
+ \let\tenttsl=\secttsl
+ \def\curfontsize{sec}%
+ \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}%
\resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}}
\def\subsecfonts{%
\let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl
\let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc
- \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl
+ \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy
+ \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl
+ \def\curfontsize{ssec}%
+ \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}%
\resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}}
-\let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts % Maybe make sssec fonts scaled magstephalf?
+\let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts
+\def\reducedfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl
+ \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc
+ \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy
+ \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl
+ \def\curfontsize{reduced}%
+ \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
\def\smallfonts{%
\let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl
\let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc
\let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy
\let\tenttsl=\smallttsl
- \resetmathfonts \setleading{11pt}}
+ \def\curfontsize{small}%
+ \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
+\def\smallerfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl
+ \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc
+ \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy
+ \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl
+ \def\curfontsize{smaller}%
+ \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}}
+
+% Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
+\let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
+
+% About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
+% can fit this many characters:
+% 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
+% If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
+% 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
+% For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
+% the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
+%
+% By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
+% 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
+%
+% I wish the USA used A4 paper.
+% --karl, 24jan03.
+
% Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
%
-\textfonts
+\definetextfontsizexi
% Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
\def\angleleft{$\langle$}
@@ -1232,27 +2371,41 @@
\newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
% Fonts for short table of contents.
-\setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}
-\setfont\shortcontbf\bxshape{12}{1000}
-\setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}
+\setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12
+\setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
%% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans
%% serif) and @ii for TeX italic
% \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction
% unless the following character is such as not to need one.
-\def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else\/\fi\fi\fi}
-\def\smartslanted#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
-\def\smartitalic#1{{\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
+\def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else
+ \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi}
+\def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
+\def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
+
+% like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl.
+% @var is set to this for defun arguments.
+\def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
+
+% like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
+% ttsl for book titles, do we?
+\def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
\let\i=\smartitalic
+\let\slanted=\smartslanted
\let\var=\smartslanted
\let\dfn=\smartslanted
\let\emph=\smartitalic
-\let\cite=\smartslanted
-
+
+% @b, explicit bold.
\def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
\let\strong=\b
+
+% @sansserif, explicit sans.
+\def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
% We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
% the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
@@ -1261,13 +2414,30 @@
\def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
\def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
+% Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
+% Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
+% sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
+%
+\catcode`@=11
+ \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
+ \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
+ \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m
+ \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
+ }
+ \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
+ \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
+ \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
+ \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
+ }
+\catcode`@=\other
+\def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
+
\def\t#1{%
- {\tt \rawbackslash \frenchspacing #1}%
+ {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
\null
}
-\let\ttfont=\t
\def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null}
-\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}
+\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
\font\keysy=cmsy9
\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
@@ -1275,6 +2445,7 @@
\hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
\kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
\kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
+\def\key #1{{\nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
% The old definition, with no lozenge:
%\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
\def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
@@ -1300,13 +2471,13 @@
\nohyphenation
%
\rawbackslash
- \frenchspacing
+ \plainfrenchspacing
#1%
}%
\null
}
-% We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in \code.
+% We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
% Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
% in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
@@ -1316,26 +2487,61 @@
% and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash.
% -- rms.
{
- \catcode`\-=\active
- \catcode`\_=\active
+ \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
+ \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
%
\global\def\code{\begingroup
- \catcode`\-=\active \let-\codedash
- \catcode`\_=\active \let_\codeunder
+ \catcode\rquoteChar=\active \catcode\lquoteChar=\active
+ \let'\codequoteright \let`\codequoteleft
+ %
+ \catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active
+ \ifallowcodebreaks
+ \let-\codedash
+ \let_\codeunder
+ \else
+ \let-\realdash
+ \let_\realunder
+ \fi
\codex
}
- %
- % If we end up with any active - characters when handling the index,
- % just treat them as a normal -.
- \global\def\indexbreaks{\catcode`\-=\active \let-\realdash}
}
\def\realdash{-}
\def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}}
-\def\codeunder{\ifusingtt{\normalunderscore\discretionary{}{}{}}{\_}}
+\def\codeunder{%
+ % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
+ % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
+ % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
+ % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
+ \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
+ \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
+ \else\normalunderscore \fi
+ \discretionary{}{}{}}%
+ {\_}%
+}
\def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
-%\let\exp=\tclose %Was temporary
+% An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
+% each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is undesirable in
+% some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in
+% general. @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this.
+%
+\newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
+
+\def\keywordtrue{true}
+\def\keywordfalse{false}
+
+\parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
+ \def\txiarg{#1}%
+ \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
+ \allowcodebreakstrue
+ \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
+ \allowcodebreaksfalse
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg'}%
+ \fi\fi
+}
% @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
% then @kbd has no effect.
@@ -1343,24 +2549,25 @@
% @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
% `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
% or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
-\def\kbdinputstyle{\parsearg\kbdinputstylexxx}
-\def\kbdinputstylexxx#1{%
- \def\arg{#1}%
- \ifx\arg\worddistinct
+\parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
+ \def\txiarg{#1}%
+ \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
\gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
- \else\ifx\arg\wordexample
+ \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
\gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
- \else\ifx\arg\wordcode
+ \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
\gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\txiarg'}%
\fi\fi\fi
}
\def\worddistinct{distinct}
\def\wordexample{example}
\def\wordcode{code}
-% Default is kbdinputdistinct. (Too much of a hassle to call the macro,
-% the catcodes are wrong for parsearg to work.)
-\gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}
+% Default is `distinct.'
+\kbdinputstyle distinct
\def\xkey{\key}
\def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
@@ -1368,10 +2575,17 @@
\else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi
\else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi}
-% For @url, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
-\let\url=\code
+% For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
+\let\indicateurl=\code
\let\env=\code
\let\command=\code
+
+% @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...}
+\def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup}
+
+% @clickstyle @arrow (by default)
+\parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}}
+\def\click{\arrow}
% @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated)
% second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third
@@ -1401,9 +2615,13 @@
\endlink
\endgroup}
+% @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
+%
+\let\url=\uref
+
% rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
% So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
-%
+%
%\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
\ifpdf
\def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
@@ -1442,11 +2660,139 @@
\def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
\def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
-% @acronym downcases the argument and prints in smallcaps.
-\def\acronym#1{{\smallcaps \lowercase{#1}}}
-
-% @pounds{} is a sterling sign.
+% @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
+% We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
+% all-uppercase.
+%
+\def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
+\def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
+ {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
+ \def\temp{#2}%
+ \ifx\temp\empty \else
+ \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
+ \fi
+}
+
+% @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
+% No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
+%
+\def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
+\def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
+ {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
+ \def\temp{#2}%
+ \ifx\temp\empty \else
+ \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
+ \fi
+}
+
+% @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
+%
\def\pounds{{\it\$}}
+
+% @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
+% We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
+% Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
+% "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
+% It is available from
http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
+%
+% Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
+% that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
+% font height.
+%
+% feymr - regular
+% feymo - slanted
+% feybr - bold
+% feybo - bold slanted
+%
+% There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
+% A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
+% Hmm.
+%
+% Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
+% Hope not.
+%
+%
+\def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
+\def\eurofont{%
+ % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
+ % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
+ % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
+ % font installed.
+ %
+ % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
+ % that to the current nominal size.
+ %
+ % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
+ % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
+ %
+ \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
+ %
+ \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
+ % bold:
+ \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
+ \else
+ % regular:
+ \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
+ \fi
+ \thiseurofont
+}
+
+% Hacks for glyphs from the EC fonts similar to \euro. We don't
+% use \let for the aliases, because sometimes we redefine the original
+% macro, and the alias should reflect the redefinition.
+\def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}}
+\def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
+\def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}}
+\def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
+\def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}}
+\def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}}
+\def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}}
+\def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}}
+%
+\def\ecfont{%
+ % We can't distinguish serif/sanserif and italic/slanted, but this
+ % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
+ % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
+ % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
+ \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}%
+ \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
+ \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
+ % bold:
+ \font\thisecfont = ecb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
+ \else
+ % regular:
+ \font\thisecfont = ec\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
+ \fi
+ \thisecfont
+}
+
+% @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
+% be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
+% Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
+%
+\def\registeredsymbol{%
+ $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}%
+ \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
+ }$%
+}
+
+% @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
+%
+\def\textdegree{$^\circ$}
+
+% Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
+% Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
+% so we'll define it if necessary.
+%
+\ifx\Orb\undefined
+\def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
+\fi
+
+% Quotes.
+\chardef\quotedblleft="5C
+\chardef\quotedblright=`\"
+\chardef\quoteleft=`\`
+\chardef\quoteright=`\'
\message{page headings,}
@@ -1466,85 +2812,102 @@
\newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
\let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
-\def\shorttitlepage{\parsearg\shorttitlepagezzz}
-\def\shorttitlepagezzz #1{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
+\parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
\endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
-\def\titlepage{\begingroup \parindent=0pt \textfonts
- \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
- \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}%
- %
- \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines}%
- %
- % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
- \vglue\titlepagetopglue
- %
- % Now you can print the title using @title.
- \def\title{\parsearg\titlezzz}%
- \def\titlezzz##1{\leftline{\titlefonts\rm ##1}
- % print a rule at the page bottom also.
- \finishedtitlepagefalse
- \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt}%
- % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
- \finishedtitlepagetrue
- %
- % Now you can put text using @subtitle.
- \def\subtitle{\parsearg\subtitlezzz}%
- \def\subtitlezzz##1{{\subtitlefont \rightline{##1}}}%
- %
- % @author should come last, but may come many times.
- \def\author{\parsearg\authorzzz}%
- \def\authorzzz##1{\ifseenauthor\else\vskip 0pt plus 1filll\seenauthortrue\fi
- {\authorfont \leftline{##1}}}%
- %
- % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
- % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
- \let\oldpage = \page
- \def\page{%
+\envdef\titlepage{%
+ % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
+ \begingroup
+ \parindent=0pt \textfonts
+ % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
+ \vglue\titlepagetopglue
+ % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
+ \finishedtitlepagetrue
+ %
+ % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
+ % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
+ \let\oldpage = \page
+ \def\page{%
\iffinishedtitlepage\else
- \finishtitlepage
- \fi
- \oldpage
+ \finishtitlepage
+ \fi
\let\page = \oldpage
- \hbox{}}%
-% \def\page{\oldpage \hbox{}}
+ \page
+ \null
+ }%
}
\def\Etitlepage{%
- \iffinishedtitlepage\else
- \finishtitlepage
- \fi
- % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
- % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
- % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
- % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
- \oldpage
- \endgroup
- %
- % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
- \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
- \shortcontents
- \contents
- \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
- \global\let\contents = \relax
- \fi
- %
- \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
- \contents
- \global\let\contents = \relax
- \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
- \fi
- %
- \ifpdf \pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
- %
- \HEADINGSon
+ \iffinishedtitlepage\else
+ \finishtitlepage
+ \fi
+ % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
+ % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
+ % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
+ % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
+ \oldpage
+ \endgroup
+ %
+ % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
+ % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
+ \HEADINGSon
+ %
+ % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
+ \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
+ \shortcontents
+ \contents
+ \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
+ \global\let\contents = \relax
+ \fi
+ %
+ \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
+ \contents
+ \global\let\contents = \relax
+ \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
+ \fi
}
\def\finishtitlepage{%
- \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
- \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
- \finishedtitlepagetrue
-}
+ \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
+ \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
+ \finishedtitlepagetrue
+}
+
+%%% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
+
+\let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
+\def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
+
+\def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines
+ \let\tt=\authortt}
+
+\parseargdef\title{%
+ \checkenv\titlepage
+ \leftline{\titlefonts\rm #1}
+ % print a rule at the page bottom also.
+ \finishedtitlepagefalse
+ \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
+}
+
+\parseargdef\subtitle{%
+ \checkenv\titlepage
+ {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
+}
+
+% @author should come last, but may come many times.
+% It can also be used inside @quotation.
+%
+\parseargdef\author{%
+ \def\temp{\quotation}%
+ \ifx\thisenv\temp
+ \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
+ \else
+ \checkenv\titlepage
+ \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
+ {\authorfont \leftline{#1}}%
+ \fi
+}
+
%%% Set up page headings and footings.
@@ -1555,7 +2918,7 @@
\newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
\newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
-% Now make Tex use those variables
+% Now make TeX use those variables
\headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
\else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
\footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
@@ -1569,43 +2932,64 @@
% @evenfooting @thisfile||
% @oddfooting ||@thisfile
+
\def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
+\def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
+\def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
+\global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
+
\def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
-\def\everyheading{\parsearg\everyheadingxxx}
+\def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
+\def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
+\global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
+
+\parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
\def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
+\def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
+\def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
+\global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
+
\def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
-\def\everyfooting{\parsearg\everyfootingxxx}
-
-{\catcode`\@=0 %
-
-\gdef\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
-\gdef\evenheadingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
-\global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
-
-\gdef\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
-\gdef\oddheadingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
-\global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
-
-\gdef\everyheadingxxx#1{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
-
-\gdef\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
-\gdef\evenfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
-\global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
-
-\gdef\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
-\gdef\oddfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
+\def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
+\def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
\global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
%
% Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
% @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
- \global\advance\pageheight by -\baselineskip
- \global\advance\vsize by -\baselineskip
-}
-
-\gdef\everyfootingxxx#1{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
-%
-}% unbind the catcode of @.
+ \global\advance\pageheight by -12pt
+ \global\advance\vsize by -12pt
+}
+
+\parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
+
+% @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
+% @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
+%
+% The same set of arguments for:
+%
+% @oddheadingmarks
+% @evenfootingmarks
+% @oddfootingmarks
+% @everyheadingmarks
+% @everyfootingmarks
+
+\def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}}
+\def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}}
+\def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}}
+\def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}}
+\def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1}
+ \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} }
+\def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1}
+ \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} }
+% #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
+\def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
+ \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname
+ \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp
+}
+
+\everyheadingmarks bottom
+\everyfootingmarks bottom
% @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
% @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
@@ -1619,7 +3003,7 @@
\def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
-\def\HEADINGSoff{
+\def\HEADINGSoff{%
\global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
\global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}}
\HEADINGSoff
@@ -1628,7 +3012,7 @@
% chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
% title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
% edge of all pages.
-\def\HEADINGSdouble{
+\def\HEADINGSdouble{%
\global\pageno=1
\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
@@ -1640,7 +3024,7 @@
% For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
% page number on top right.
-\def\HEADINGSsingle{
+\def\HEADINGSsingle{%
\global\pageno=1
\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
@@ -1670,7 +3054,10 @@
}
% Subroutines used in generating headings
-% Produces Day Month Year style of output.
+% This produces Day Month Year style of output.
+% Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
+% up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
+\ifx\today\undefined
\def\today{%
\number\day\space
\ifcase\month
@@ -1679,16 +3066,16 @@
\or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
\fi
\space\number\year}
+\fi
% @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
% It generates no output of its own.
\def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
-\def\settitle{\parsearg\settitlezzz}
-\def\settitlezzz #1{\gdef\thistitle{#1}}
+\def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
\message{tables,}
-% Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x), @kitem(x), @xitem(x).
+% Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
% default indentation of table text
\newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
@@ -1700,7 +3087,7 @@
% used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
\newdimen\itemmax
-% Note @table, @vtable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
+% Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
% these defs.
% They also define \itemindex
% to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
@@ -1712,22 +3099,10 @@
\def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
\def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
-\def\internalBxitem "#1"{\def\xitemsubtopix{#1} \smallbreak
\parsearg\xitemzzz}
-\def\internalBxitemx "#1"{\def\xitemsubtopix{#1} \itemxpar \parsearg\xitemzzz}
-
-\def\internalBkitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\kitemzzz}
-\def\internalBkitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\kitemzzz}
-
-\def\kitemzzz #1{\dosubind {kw}{\code{#1}}{for {\bf \lastfunction}}%
- \itemzzz {#1}}
-
-\def\xitemzzz #1{\dosubind {kw}{\code{#1}}{for {\bf \xitemsubtopic}}%
- \itemzzz {#1}}
-
\def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
\advance\hsize by -\rightskip
\advance\hsize by -\tableindent
- \setbox0=\hbox{\itemfont{#1}}%
+ \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
\itemindex{#1}%
\nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
%
@@ -1751,10 +3126,14 @@
% \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
\nobreak \vskip-\parskip
%
- % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. Unfortunately
- % we can't prevent a possible page break at the following
- % \baselineskip glue.
- \nobreak
+ % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
+ % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
+ % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
+ % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
+ % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
+ % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
+ %
+ \penalty 10001
\endgroup
\itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
\else
@@ -1773,97 +3152,106 @@
\fi
}
-\def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a table}}
-\def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a table}}
-\def\kitem{\errmessage{@kitem while not in a table}}
-\def\kitemx{\errmessage{@kitemx while not in a table}}
-\def\xitem{\errmessage{@xitem while not in a table}}
-\def\xitemx{\errmessage{@xitemx while not in a table}}
-
-% Contains a kludge to get @end[description] to work.
-\def\description{\tablez{\dontindex}{1}{}{}{}{}}
+\def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
+\def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
% @table, @ftable, @vtable.
-\def\table{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\tablex}
-{\obeylines\obeyspaces%
-\gdef\tablex #1^^M{%
-\tabley\dontindex#1 \endtabley}}
-
-\def\ftable{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\ftablex}
-{\obeylines\obeyspaces%
-\gdef\ftablex #1^^M{%
-\tabley\fnitemindex#1 \endtabley
-\def\Eftable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}%
-\let\Etable=\relax}}
-
-\def\vtable{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\vtablex}
-{\obeylines\obeyspaces%
-\gdef\vtablex #1^^M{%
-\tabley\vritemindex#1 \endtabley
-\def\Evtable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}%
-\let\Etable=\relax}}
-
-\def\dontindex #1{}
-\def\fnitemindex #1{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}}%
-\def\vritemindex #1{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}}%
-
-{\obeyspaces %
-\gdef\tabley#1#2 #3 #4 #5 #6 #7\endtabley{\endgroup%
-\tablez{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}}}
-
-\def\tablez #1#2#3#4#5#6{%
-\aboveenvbreak %
-\begingroup %
-\def\Edescription{\Etable}% Necessary kludge.
-\let\itemindex=#1%
-\ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \leftskip by #3\mil \fi %
-\ifnum 0#4>0 \tableindent=#4\mil \fi %
-\ifnum 0#5>0 \advance \rightskip by #5\mil \fi %
-\def\itemfont{#2}%
-\itemmax=\tableindent %
-\advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin %
-\advance \leftskip by \tableindent %
-\exdentamount=\tableindent
-\parindent = 0pt
-\parskip = \smallskipamount
-\ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi%
-\def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}%
-\let\item = \internalBitem %
-\let\itemx = \internalBitemx %
-\let\kitem = \internalBkitem %
-\let\kitemx = \internalBkitemx %
-\let\xitem = \internalBxitem %
-\let\xitemx = \internalBxitemx %
-}
+\envdef\table{%
+ \let\itemindex\gobble
+ \tablecheck{table}%
+}
+\envdef\ftable{%
+ \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
+ \tablecheck{ftable}%
+}
+\envdef\vtable{%
+ \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
+ \tablecheck{vtable}%
+}
+\def\tablecheck#1{%
+ \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
+ \endgroup
+ \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
+ that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
+ \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
+ \else
+ \let\next\tablex
+ \fi
+ \next
+}
+\def\tablex#1{%
+ \def\itemindicate{#1}%
+ \parsearg\tabley
+}
+\def\tabley#1{%
+ {%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
+ \expandafter
+ }\temp \endtablez
+}
+\def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
+ \aboveenvbreak
+ \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
+ \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
+ \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
+ \itemmax=\tableindent
+ \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
+ \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
+ \exdentamount=\tableindent
+ \parindent = 0pt
+ \parskip = \smallskipamount
+ \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
+ \let\item = \internalBitem
+ \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
+}
+\def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
+\let\Eftable\Etable
+\let\Evtable\Etable
+\let\Eitemize\Etable
+\let\Eenumerate\Etable
% This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
\newcount \itemno
-\def\itemize{\parsearg\itemizezzz}
-
-\def\itemizezzz #1{%
- \begingroup % ended by the @end itemize
- \itemizey {#1}{\Eitemize}
-}
-
-\def\itemizey #1#2{%
-\aboveenvbreak %
-\itemmax=\itemindent %
-\advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin %
-\advance \leftskip by \itemindent %
-\exdentamount=\itemindent
-\parindent = 0pt %
-\parskip = \smallskipamount %
-\ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi%
-\def#2{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}%
-\def\itemcontents{#1}%
-\let\item=\itemizeitem}
-
-% Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
-% These are `.?!:;,'
-\def\frenchspacing{\sfcode46=1000 \sfcode63=1000 \sfcode33=1000
- \sfcode58=1000 \sfcode59=1000 \sfcode44=1000 }
+\envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
+
+\def\doitemize#1{%
+ \aboveenvbreak
+ \itemmax=\itemindent
+ \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
+ \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
+ \exdentamount=\itemindent
+ \parindent=0pt
+ \parskip=\smallskipamount
+ \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
+ \def\itemcontents{#1}%
+ % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
+ \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
+ \let\item=\itemizeitem
+}
+
+% Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
+%
+\def\itemizeitem{%
+ \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
+ {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
+ {%
+ % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
+ % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
+ % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
+ % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
+ % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
+ % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
+ % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
+ % that's the theory.
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
+ \noindent
+ \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
+ \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
+ \flushcr
+}
% \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
% TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
@@ -1874,11 +3262,8 @@
% or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
% argument is the same as `1'.
%
-\def\enumerate{\parsearg\enumeratezzz}
-\def\enumeratezzz #1{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
+\envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
\def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
- \begingroup % ended by the @end enumerate
- %
% If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
\def\thearg{#1}%
\ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
@@ -1949,13 +3334,13 @@
}%
}
-% Call itemizey, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
+% Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
% common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
% \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
%
\def\startenumeration#1{%
\advance\itemno by -1
- \itemizey{#1.}\Eenumerate\flushcr
+ \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
}
% @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
@@ -1966,16 +3351,6 @@
\def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
\def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
-% Definition of @item while inside @itemize.
-
-\def\itemizeitem{%
-\advance\itemno by 1
-{\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}%
-\ifhmode \errmessage{In hmode at itemizeitem}\fi
-{\parskip=0in \hskip 0pt
-\hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents\hskip \itemmargin}%
-\vadjust{\penalty 1200}}%
-\flushcr}
% @multitable macros
% Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
@@ -2002,24 +3377,14 @@
% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
% @item ...
% using the widest term desired in each column.
-%
-% For those who want to use more than one line's worth of words in
-% the preamble, break the line within one argument and it
-% will parse correctly, i.e.,
-%
-% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3
-% template}
-% Not:
-% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template}
-% {Column 3 template}
% Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
% starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
% with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
% ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
-% @item, @tab, @multitable or @end multitable do not need to be on their
-% own lines, but it will not hurt if they are.
+% @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
+% if they are.
% Sample multitable:
@@ -2063,13 +3428,12 @@
\def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
\newif\ifsetpercent
-% #1 is the part of the @columnfraction before the decimal point, which
-% is presumably either 0 or the empty string (but we don't check, we
-% just throw it away). #2 is the decimal part, which we use as the
-% percent of \hsize for this column.
-\def\pickupwholefraction#1.#2 {%
+% #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
+% be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
+%
+\def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
\global\advance\colcount by 1
- \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{.#2\hsize}%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
\setuptable
}
@@ -2086,8 +3450,8 @@
\let\go\pickupwholefraction
\else
\global\advance\colcount by 1
- \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip }% Add a normal word space as a separator;
- % typically that is always in the input, anyway.
+ \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
+ % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
\expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
\fi
\fi
@@ -2102,18 +3466,33 @@
\go
}
-% This used to have \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template line is
-% not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just & until we
-% encounter the problem it was intended to solve again.
-% --karl, nathan(a)acm.org, 20apr99.
-\def\tab{&}
+% multitable-only commands.
+%
+% @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
+% Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
+% of an alignment entry. Note that \everycr resets \everytab.
+\def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab={\bf}\the\everytab}%
+%
+% A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
+% line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
+% we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again.
+% --karl, nathan(a)acm.org, 20apr99.
+\def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
% @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
%
-\def\multitable{\parsearg\dotable}
-\def\dotable#1{\bgroup
+\newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
+%
+\envdef\multitable{%
\vskip\parskip
- \let\item\crcr
+ \startsavinginserts
+ %
+ % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
+ % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
+ % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
+ % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
+ \def\item{\crcr}%
+ %
\tolerance=9500
\hbadness=9500
\setmultitablespacing
@@ -2121,81 +3500,93 @@
\parindent=\multitableparindent
\overfullrule=0pt
\global\colcount=0
- \def\Emultitable{\global\setpercentfalse\cr\egroup\egroup}%
- %
+ %
+ \everycr = {%
+ \noalign{%
+ \global\everytab={}%
+ \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
+ % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
+ \checkinserts
+ % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
+ %\filbreak
+ % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
+ % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the
+ % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
+ }%
+ }%
+ %
+ \parsearg\domultitable
+}
+\def\domultitable#1{%
% To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
\setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
- %
- % \everycr will reset column counter, \colcount, at the end of
- % each line. Every column entry will cause \colcount to advance by one.
- % The table preamble
- % looks at the current \colcount to find the correct column width.
- \everycr{\noalign{%
- %
- % \filbreak%% keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
- % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the table
- % breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the problem
- % manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
- \global\colcount=0\relax}}%
%
% This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
% be used as many times as user calls for columns.
% \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
% continue for many paragraphs if desired.
- \halign\bgroup&\global\advance\colcount by 1\relax
- \multistrut\vtop{\hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
- %
- % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
- % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
- % the first one.
- %
- % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
- % to the width of each template entry.
- %
- % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
- % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
- % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
- % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
- %
- % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
- \rightskip=0pt
- \ifnum\colcount=1
- % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
- \advance\hsize by\leftskip
- \else
- \ifsetpercent \else
- % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
- % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
- \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
- \fi
- % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
- \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
- \fi
- % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
- % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
- % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
- % For example:
- % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
- % @item @code{#}
- % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
- % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively marking
- % characters.
- \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut}\cr
-}
-
-\def\setmultitablespacing{% test to see if user has set \multitablelinespace.
-% If so, do nothing. If not, give it an appropriate dimension based on
-% current baselineskip.
+ \halign\bgroup &%
+ \global\advance\colcount by 1
+ \multistrut
+ \vtop{%
+ % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
+ \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
+ %
+ % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
+ % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
+ % the first one.
+ %
+ % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
+ % to the width of each template entry.
+ %
+ % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
+ % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
+ % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
+ % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
+ %
+ % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
+ \rightskip=0pt
+ \ifnum\colcount=1
+ % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
+ \advance\hsize by\leftskip
+ \else
+ \ifsetpercent \else
+ % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
+ % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
+ \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
+ \fi
+ % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
+ \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
+ \fi
+ % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
+ % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
+ % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
+ % For example:
+ % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
+ % @item @code{#}
+ % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
+ % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
+ % marking characters.
+ \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
+ }\cr
+}
+\def\Emultitable{%
+ \crcr
+ \egroup % end the \halign
+ \global\setpercentfalse
+}
+
+\def\setmultitablespacing{%
+ \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
+ %
+ % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
+ % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
+ % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
+ % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
\ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
\setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
\global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
-%% strut to put in table in case some entry doesn't have descenders,
-%% to keep lines equally spaced
-\let\multistrut = \strut
-\else
-%% FIXME: what is \box0 supposed to be?
-\gdef\multistrut{\vrule height\multitablelinespace depth\dp0
-width0pt\relax} \fi
+\fi
%% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
%% table. If not, do nothing.
%% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
@@ -2212,225 +3603,114 @@
\message{conditionals,}
-% Prevent errors for section commands.
-% Used in @ignore and in failing conditionals.
-\def\ignoresections{%
- \let\chapter=\relax
- \let\unnumbered=\relax
- \let\top=\relax
- \let\unnumberedsec=\relax
- \let\unnumberedsection=\relax
- \let\unnumberedsubsec=\relax
- \let\unnumberedsubsection=\relax
- \let\unnumberedsubsubsec=\relax
- \let\unnumberedsubsubsection=\relax
- \let\section=\relax
- \let\subsec=\relax
- \let\subsubsec=\relax
- \let\subsection=\relax
- \let\subsubsection=\relax
- \let\appendix=\relax
- \let\appendixsec=\relax
- \let\appendixsection=\relax
- \let\appendixsubsec=\relax
- \let\appendixsubsection=\relax
- \let\appendixsubsubsec=\relax
- \let\appendixsubsubsection=\relax
- \let\contents=\relax
- \let\smallbook=\relax
- \let\titlepage=\relax
-}
-
-% Used in nested conditionals, where we have to parse the Texinfo source
-% and so want to turn off most commands, in case they are used
-% incorrectly.
-%
-\def\ignoremorecommands{%
- \let\defcodeindex = \relax
- \let\defcv = \relax
- \let\deffn = \relax
- \let\deffnx = \relax
- \let\defindex = \relax
- \let\defivar = \relax
- \let\defmac = \relax
- \let\defmethod = \relax
- \let\defop = \relax
- \let\defopt = \relax
- \let\defspec = \relax
- \let\deftp = \relax
- \let\deftypefn = \relax
- \let\deftypefun = \relax
- \let\deftypeivar = \relax
- \let\deftypeop = \relax
- \let\deftypevar = \relax
- \let\deftypevr = \relax
- \let\defun = \relax
- \let\defvar = \relax
- \let\defvr = \relax
- \let\ref = \relax
- \let\xref = \relax
- \let\printindex = \relax
- \let\pxref = \relax
- \let\settitle = \relax
- \let\setchapternewpage = \relax
- \let\setchapterstyle = \relax
- \let\everyheading = \relax
- \let\evenheading = \relax
- \let\oddheading = \relax
- \let\everyfooting = \relax
- \let\evenfooting = \relax
- \let\oddfooting = \relax
- \let\headings = \relax
- \let\include = \relax
- \let\lowersections = \relax
- \let\down = \relax
- \let\raisesections = \relax
- \let\up = \relax
- \let\set = \relax
- \let\clear = \relax
- \let\item = \relax
-}
-
-% Ignore @ignore ... @end ignore.
-%
+
+% @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
+% @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
+% attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
+% have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
+% attempt to close an environment group.
+%
+\def\makecond#1{%
+ \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
+ \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
+}
+\makecond{iftex}
+\makecond{ifnotdocbook}
+\makecond{ifnothtml}
+\makecond{ifnotinfo}
+\makecond{ifnotplaintext}
+\makecond{ifnotxml}
+
+% Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
+%
+\def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
+\def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
+\def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
+\def\html{\doignore{html}}
+\def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
+\def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
+\def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
+\def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
+\def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
+\def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
\def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
-
-% Ignore @ifinfo, @ifhtml, @ifnottex, @html, @menu, and @direntry text.
-%
-\def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
-\def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
-\def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
-\def\html{\doignore{html}}
\def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
-\def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
-
-% @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
-% which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
-\let\dircategory = \comment
-
-% Ignore text until a line `@end #1'.
-%
+\def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
+
+% Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
+%
+% A count to remember the depth of nesting.
+\newcount\doignorecount
+
\def\doignore#1{\begingroup
- % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer.
- \ignoresections
- %
- % Define a command to swallow text until we reach `@end #1'.
- % This @ is a catcode 12 token (that is the normal catcode of @ in
- % this texinfo.tex file). We change the catcode of @ below to match.
- \long\def\doignoretext##1@end #1{\enddoignore}%
+ % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
+ \obeylines
+ \catcode`\@ = \other
+ \catcode`\{ = \other
+ \catcode`\} = \other
%
% Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
- \catcode32 = 10
- %
- % Ignore braces, too, so mismatched braces don't cause trouble.
- \catcode`\{ = 9
- \catcode`\} = 9
- %
- % We must not have @c interpreted as a control sequence.
- \catcode`\@ = 12
- %
- % Make the letter c a comment character so that the rest of the line
- % will be ignored. This way, the document can have (for example)
- % @c @end ifinfo
- % and the @end ifinfo will be properly ignored.
- % (We've just changed @ to catcode 12.)
- \catcode`\c = 14
- %
- % And now expand that command.
- \doignoretext
-}
-
-% What we do to finish off ignored text.
-%
-\def\enddoignore{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
-
-\newif\ifwarnedobs\warnedobsfalse
-\def\obstexwarn{%
- \ifwarnedobs\relax\else
- % We need to warn folks that they may have trouble with TeX 3.0.
- % This uses \immediate\write16 rather than \message to get newlines.
- \immediate\write16{}
- \immediate\write16{WARNING: for users of Unix TeX 3.0!}
- \immediate\write16{This manual trips a bug in TeX version 3.0 (tex hangs).}
- \immediate\write16{If you are running another version of TeX, relax.}
- \immediate\write16{If you are running Unix TeX 3.0, kill this TeX process.}
- \immediate\write16{ Then upgrade your TeX installation if you can.}
- \immediate\write16{ (See
ftp://ftp.gnu.org/pub/gnu/TeX.README.)}
- \immediate\write16{If you are stuck with version 3.0, run the}
- \immediate\write16{ script ``tex3patch'' from the Texinfo distribution}
- \immediate\write16{ to use a workaround.}
- \immediate\write16{}
- \global\warnedobstrue
- \fi
-}
-
-% **In TeX 3.0, setting text in \nullfont hangs tex. For a
-% workaround (which requires the file ``dummy.tfm'' to be installed),
-% uncomment the following line:
-%%%%%\font\nullfont=dummy\let\obstexwarn=\relax
-
-% Ignore text, except that we keep track of conditional commands for
-% purposes of nesting, up to an `@end #1' command.
-%
-\def\nestedignore#1{%
- \obstexwarn
- % We must actually expand the ignored text to look for the @end
- % command, so that nested ignore constructs work. Thus, we put the
- % text into a \vbox and then do nothing with the result. To minimize
- % the change of memory overflow, we follow the approach outlined on
- % page 401 of the TeXbook: make the current font be a dummy font.
- %
- \setbox0 = \vbox\bgroup
- % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer.
- \ignoresections
- %
- % Define `@end #1' to end the box, which will in turn undefine the
- % @end command again.
- \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\egroup\ignorespaces}%
- %
- % We are going to be parsing Texinfo commands. Most cause no
- % trouble when they are used incorrectly, but some commands do
- % complicated argument parsing or otherwise get confused, so we
- % undefine them.
- %
- % We can't do anything about stray @-signs, unfortunately;
- % they'll produce `undefined control sequence' errors.
- \ignoremorecommands
- %
- % Set the current font to be \nullfont, a TeX primitive, and define
- % all the font commands to also use \nullfont. We don't use
- % dummy.tfm, as suggested in the TeXbook, because not all sites
- % might have that installed. Therefore, math mode will still
- % produce output, but that should be an extremely small amount of
- % stuff compared to the main input.
- %
- \nullfont
- \let\tenrm=\nullfont \let\tenit=\nullfont \let\tensl=\nullfont
- \let\tenbf=\nullfont \let\tentt=\nullfont \let\smallcaps=\nullfont
- \let\tensf=\nullfont
- % Similarly for index fonts (mostly for their use in smallexample).
- \let\smallrm=\nullfont \let\smallit=\nullfont \let\smallsl=\nullfont
- \let\smallbf=\nullfont \let\smalltt=\nullfont \let\smallsc=\nullfont
- \let\smallsf=\nullfont
- %
- % Don't complain when characters are missing from the fonts.
- \tracinglostchars = 0
- %
- % Don't bother to do space factor calculations.
- \frenchspacing
- %
- % Don't report underfull hboxes.
- \hbadness = 10000
- %
- % Do minimal line-breaking.
- \pretolerance = 10000
- %
- % Do not execute instructions in @tex
- \def\tex{\doignore{tex}}%
- % Do not execute macro definitions.
- % `c' is a comment character, so the word `macro' will get cut off.
- \def\macro{\doignore{ma}}%
-}
+ \spaceisspace
+ %
+ % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
+ \doignorecount = 0
+ %
+ % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
+ \dodoignore{#1}%
+}
+
+{ \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
+ \obeylines %
+ %
+ \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
+ % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
+ %
+ % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
+ \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{%
+ \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
+ %
+ % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
+ % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
+ % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
+ \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
+ %
+ % And now expand that command.
+ \doignoretext ^^M%
+ }%
+}
+
+\def\doignoreyyy#1{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
+ \let\next\doignoretextzzz
+ \else % Found a nested condition, ...
+ \advance\doignorecount by 1
+ \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
+ % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
+ \fi
+ \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
+}
+
+% We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
+%
+\def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
+ \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
+ \let\next\enddoignore
+ \else % Still inside a nested condition.
+ \advance\doignorecount by -1
+ \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
+ \fi
+ \next
+}
+
+% Finish off ignored text.
+{ \obeylines%
+ % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
+ % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
+ % would result in a blank line in the output.
+ \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
+}
+
% @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
% @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
@@ -2438,56 +3718,63 @@
% Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
% empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
% own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
-% didn't need it. Make sure the catcode of space is correct to avoid
-% losing inside @example, for instance.
-%
-\def\set{\begingroup\catcode` =10
- \catcode`\-=12 \catcode`\_=12 % Allow - and _ in VAR.
- \parsearg\setxxx}
-\def\setxxx#1{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
+% didn't need it.
+% We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
+%
+\parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
\def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
- \def\temp{#2}%
- \ifx\temp\empty \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname = \empty
- \else \setzzz{#1}#2\endsetzzz % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
- \fi
- \endgroup
-}
-% Can't use \xdef to pre-expand #2 and save some time, since \temp or
-% \next or other control sequences that we've defined might get us into
-% an infinite loop. Consider `@set foo @cite{bar}'.
-\def\setzzz#1#2 \endsetzzz{\expandafter\gdef\csname SET#1\endcsname{#2}}
+ {%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \def\temp{#2}%
+ \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
+ \ifx\temp\empty
+ \next{}%
+ \else
+ \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
+ \fi
+ }%
+}
+% Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
+\def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
% @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
%
-\def\clear{\parsearg\clearxxx}
-\def\clearxxx#1{\global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax}
+\parseargdef\clear{%
+ {%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
+ }%
+}
% @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
+\def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
+\def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
{
- \catcode`\_ = \active
- %
- % We might end up with active _ or - characters in the argument if
- % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}. So \let any
- % such active characters to their normal equivalents.
- \gdef\value{\begingroup
- \catcode`\-=12 \catcode`\_=12
- \indexbreaks \let_\normalunderscore
- \valuexxx}
-}
-\def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
+ \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active
+ %
+ \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
+ \let\value = \expandablevalue
+ % We don't want these characters active, ...
+ \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
+ % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
+ % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
+ % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
+ \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore
+ }
+}
% We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
-% properly in indexes (we \let\value to this in \indexdummies). Ones
-% whose names contain - or _ still won't work, but we can't do anything
-% about that. The command has to be fully expandable, since the result
-% winds up in the index file. This means that if the variable's value
-% contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain it will fail
-% (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work to do a
-% one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
+% properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
+% The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
+% the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
+% variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
+% it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
+% to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
%
\def\expandablevalue#1{%
\expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
{[No value for ``#1'']}%
+ \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
\else
\csname SET#1\endcsname
\fi
@@ -2496,66 +3783,36 @@
% @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
% with @set.
%
-\def\ifset{\parsearg\ifsetxxx}
-\def\ifsetxxx #1{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
- \expandafter\ifsetfail
- \else
- \expandafter\ifsetsucceed
- \fi
-}
-\def\ifsetsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifset}}
-\def\ifsetfail{\nestedignore{ifset}}
-\defineunmatchedend{ifset}
+% To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine.
+%
+\makecond{ifset}
+\def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
+\def\doifset#1#2{%
+ {%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \let\next=\empty
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
+ #1% If not set, redefine \next.
+ \fi
+ \expandafter
+ }\next
+}
+\def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
% @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
% defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
%
-\def\ifclear{\parsearg\ifclearxxx}
-\def\ifclearxxx #1{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
- \expandafter\ifclearsucceed
- \else
- \expandafter\ifclearfail
- \fi
-}
-\def\ifclearsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifclear}}
-\def\ifclearfail{\nestedignore{ifclear}}
-\defineunmatchedend{ifclear}
-
-% @iftex, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo always succeed; we read the text
-% following, through the first @end iftex (etc.). Make `@end iftex'
-% (etc.) valid only after an @iftex.
-%
-\def\iftex{\conditionalsucceed{iftex}}
-\def\ifnothtml{\conditionalsucceed{ifnothtml}}
-\def\ifnotinfo{\conditionalsucceed{ifnotinfo}}
-\defineunmatchedend{iftex}
-\defineunmatchedend{ifnothtml}
-\defineunmatchedend{ifnotinfo}
-
-% We can't just want to start a group at @iftex (for example) and end it
-% at @end iftex, since then @set commands inside the conditional have no
-% effect (they'd get reverted at the end of the group). So we must
-% define \Eiftex to redefine itself to be its previous value. (We can't
-% just define it to fail again with an ``unmatched end'' error, since
-% the @ifset might be nested.)
-%
-\def\conditionalsucceed#1{%
- \edef\temp{%
- % Remember the current value of \E#1.
- \let\nece{prevE#1} = \nece{E#1}%
- %
- % At the `@end #1', redefine \E#1 to be its previous value.
- \def\nece{E#1}{\let\nece{E#1} = \nece{prevE#1}}%
- }%
- \temp
-}
-
-% We need to expand lots of \csname's, but we don't want to expand the
-% control sequences after we've constructed them.
-%
-\def\nece#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
+% The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
+% above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
+% then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
+%
+\makecond{ifclear}
+\def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
+\def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
+
+% @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
+% which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
+\let\dircategory=\comment
% @defininfoenclose.
\let\definfoenclose=\comment
@@ -2565,9 +3822,8 @@
% Index generation facilities
% Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
-% except not \outer, so it can be used within \newindex.
-{\catcode`\@=11
-\gdef\newwrite{\alloc@7\write\chardef\sixt@@n}}
+% except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
+\edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
% \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
% It automatically defines \fooindex such that
@@ -2587,42 +3843,48 @@
}
% @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
-
+%
\def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
% Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
-
+%
+\def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
+%
\def\newcodeindex#1{%
\iflinks
\expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
\openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1
\fi
\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
- \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}
-}
-
-\def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
+ \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
+}
+
% @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
% Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
-% The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
-% Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
-\def\synindex#1 #2 {%
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\synindexfoo\expandafter=\csname#2indfile\endcsname
- \expandafter\closeout\csname#1indfile\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\csname#1indfile\endcsname=\synindexfoo
- \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% define \xxxindex
- \noexpand\doindex{#2}}%
-}
-
+%
% @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
% inside @code.
-\def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {%
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\synindexfoo\expandafter=\csname#2indfile\endcsname
- \expandafter\closeout\csname#1indfile\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\csname#1indfile\endcsname=\synindexfoo
- \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% define \xxxindex
- \noexpand\docodeindex{#2}}%
+%
+\def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
+\def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
+
+% #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
+% #3 the target index (bar).
+\def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
+ % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
+ % closing the target index.
+ \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \undefined
+ % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
+ % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
+ \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname
+ \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1
+ \fi
+ % redefine \fooindfile:
+ \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
+ \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
+ % redefine \fooindex:
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
}
% Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
@@ -2642,265 +3904,445 @@
\def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
\def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
+% Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
+% Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
+% we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
+%
\def\indexdummies{%
-\def\ { }%
-% Take care of the plain tex accent commands.
-\def\"{\realbackslash "}%
-\def\`{\realbackslash `}%
-\def\'{\realbackslash '}%
-\def\^{\realbackslash ^}%
-\def\~{\realbackslash ~}%
-\def\={\realbackslash =}%
-\def\b{\realbackslash b}%
-\def\c{\realbackslash c}%
-\def\d{\realbackslash d}%
-\def\u{\realbackslash u}%
-\def\v{\realbackslash v}%
-\def\H{\realbackslash H}%
-% Take care of the plain tex special European modified letters.
-\def\oe{\realbackslash oe}%
-\def\ae{\realbackslash ae}%
-\def\aa{\realbackslash aa}%
-\def\OE{\realbackslash OE}%
-\def\AE{\realbackslash AE}%
-\def\AA{\realbackslash AA}%
-\def\o{\realbackslash o}%
-\def\O{\realbackslash O}%
-\def\l{\realbackslash l}%
-\def\L{\realbackslash L}%
-\def\ss{\realbackslash ss}%
-% Take care of texinfo commands likely to appear in an index entry.
-% (Must be a way to avoid doing expansion at all, and thus not have to
-% laboriously list every single command here.)
-\def\@{@}% will be @@ when we switch to @ as escape char.
-% Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
-% But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
-% braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.
-\let\{ = \mylbrace
-\let\} = \myrbrace
-\def\_{{\realbackslash _}}%
-\def\w{\realbackslash w }%
-\def\bf{\realbackslash bf }%
-%\def\rm{\realbackslash rm }%
-\def\sl{\realbackslash sl }%
-\def\sf{\realbackslash sf}%
-\def\tt{\realbackslash tt}%
-\def\gtr{\realbackslash gtr}%
-\def\less{\realbackslash less}%
-\def\hat{\realbackslash hat}%
-\def\TeX{\realbackslash TeX}%
-\def\dots{\realbackslash dots }%
-\def\result{\realbackslash result}%
-\def\equiv{\realbackslash equiv}%
-\def\expansion{\realbackslash expansion}%
-\def\print{\realbackslash print}%
-\def\error{\realbackslash error}%
-\def\point{\realbackslash point}%
-\def\copyright{\realbackslash copyright}%
-\def\tclose##1{\realbackslash tclose {##1}}%
-\def\code##1{\realbackslash code {##1}}%
-\def\uref##1{\realbackslash uref {##1}}%
-\def\url##1{\realbackslash url {##1}}%
-\def\env##1{\realbackslash env {##1}}%
-\def\command##1{\realbackslash command {##1}}%
-\def\option##1{\realbackslash option {##1}}%
-\def\dotless##1{\realbackslash dotless {##1}}%
-\def\samp##1{\realbackslash samp {##1}}%
-\def\,##1{\realbackslash ,{##1}}%
-\def\t##1{\realbackslash t {##1}}%
-\def\r##1{\realbackslash r {##1}}%
-\def\i##1{\realbackslash i {##1}}%
-\def\b##1{\realbackslash b {##1}}%
-\def\sc##1{\realbackslash sc {##1}}%
-\def\cite##1{\realbackslash cite {##1}}%
-\def\key##1{\realbackslash key {##1}}%
-\def\file##1{\realbackslash file {##1}}%
-\def\var##1{\realbackslash var {##1}}%
-\def\kbd##1{\realbackslash kbd {##1}}%
-\def\dfn##1{\realbackslash dfn {##1}}%
-\def\emph##1{\realbackslash emph {##1}}%
-\def\acronym##1{\realbackslash acronym {##1}}%
-%
-% Handle some cases of @value -- where the variable name does not
-% contain - or _, and the value does not contain any
-% (non-fully-expandable) commands.
-\let\value = \expandablevalue
-%
-\unsepspaces
-% Turn off macro expansion
-\turnoffmacros
-}
-
-% If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
-% therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
-% expansion of \tie (\\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
-{\obeyspaces
- \gdef\unsepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\space}}
-
-% \indexnofonts no-ops all font-change commands.
-% This is used when outputting the strings to sort the index by.
-\def\indexdummyfont#1{#1}
-\def\indexdummytex{TeX}
-\def\indexdummydots{...}
-
+ \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
+ \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
+ \def\ {\realbackslash\space }%
+ %
+ % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
+ % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
+ % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.
+ \let\{ = \mylbrace
+ \let\} = \myrbrace
+ %
+ % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is
+ % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts
+ % causes processing to be prematurely terminated. This is,
+ % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput
+ % is an expandable command. The redefinition below makes \endinput
+ % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that
+ % processing continues to some further point. On the other hand, it
+ % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that
+ % is still getting written without apparent harm.
+ %
+ % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to
+ % help-texinfo, 22may06):
+ % @macro funindex {WORD}
+ % @findex xyz
+ % @end macro
+ % ...
+ % @funindex commtest
+ %
+ % The above is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor.
+ %
+ % Sample whatsit resulting:
+ % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}}
+ %
+ % So:
+ \let\endinput = \empty
+ %
+ % Do the redefinitions.
+ \commondummies
+}
+
+% For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to
+% redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
+% \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @,
+% this will be simpler.
+%
+\def\atdummies{%
+ \def\@{@@}%
+ \def\ {@ }%
+ \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd
+ \let\} = \rbraceatcmd
+ %
+ % Do the redefinitions.
+ \commondummies
+ \otherbackslash
+}
+
+% Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
+%
+\def\commondummies{%
+ %
+ % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
+ % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control% words,
+ % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
+ % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
+ % from whatever follows.
+ %
+ % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
+ % space.
+ %
+ % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
+ % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
+ % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
+ %
+ \def\definedummyword ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}%
+ \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}%
+ \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
+ %
+ \commondummiesnofonts
+ %
+ \definedummyletter\_%
+ %
+ % Non-English letters.
+ \definedummyword\AA
+ \definedummyword\AE
+ \definedummyword\L
+ \definedummyword\OE
+ \definedummyword\O
+ \definedummyword\aa
+ \definedummyword\ae
+ \definedummyword\l
+ \definedummyword\oe
+ \definedummyword\o
+ \definedummyword\ss
+ \definedummyword\exclamdown
+ \definedummyword\questiondown
+ \definedummyword\ordf
+ \definedummyword\ordm
+ %
+ % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
+ \definedummyword\bf
+ \definedummyword\gtr
+ \definedummyword\hat
+ \definedummyword\less
+ \definedummyword\sf
+ \definedummyword\sl
+ \definedummyword\tclose
+ \definedummyword\tt
+ %
+ \definedummyword\LaTeX
+ \definedummyword\TeX
+ %
+ % Assorted special characters.
+ \definedummyword\bullet
+ \definedummyword\comma
+ \definedummyword\copyright
+ \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
+ \definedummyword\dots
+ \definedummyword\enddots
+ \definedummyword\equiv
+ \definedummyword\error
+ \definedummyword\euro
+ \definedummyword\guillemetleft
+ \definedummyword\guillemetright
+ \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
+ \definedummyword\guilsinglright
+ \definedummyword\expansion
+ \definedummyword\minus
+ \definedummyword\pounds
+ \definedummyword\point
+ \definedummyword\print
+ \definedummyword\quotedblbase
+ \definedummyword\quotedblleft
+ \definedummyword\quotedblright
+ \definedummyword\quoteleft
+ \definedummyword\quoteright
+ \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
+ \definedummyword\result
+ \definedummyword\textdegree
+ %
+ % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
+ \macrolist
+ %
+ \normalturnoffactive
+ %
+ % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
+ % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
+ \makevalueexpandable
+}
+
+% \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
+%
+\def\commondummiesnofonts{%
+ % Control letters and accents.
+ \definedummyletter\!%
+ \definedummyaccent\"%
+ \definedummyaccent\'%
+ \definedummyletter\*%
+ \definedummyaccent\,%
+ \definedummyletter\.%
+ \definedummyletter\/%
+ \definedummyletter\:%
+ \definedummyaccent\=%
+ \definedummyletter\?%
+ \definedummyaccent\^%
+ \definedummyaccent\`%
+ \definedummyaccent\~%
+ \definedummyword\u
+ \definedummyword\v
+ \definedummyword\H
+ \definedummyword\dotaccent
+ \definedummyword\ringaccent
+ \definedummyword\tieaccent
+ \definedummyword\ubaraccent
+ \definedummyword\udotaccent
+ \definedummyword\dotless
+ %
+ % Texinfo font commands.
+ \definedummyword\b
+ \definedummyword\i
+ \definedummyword\r
+ \definedummyword\sc
+ \definedummyword\t
+ %
+ % Commands that take arguments.
+ \definedummyword\acronym
+ \definedummyword\cite
+ \definedummyword\code
+ \definedummyword\command
+ \definedummyword\dfn
+ \definedummyword\emph
+ \definedummyword\env
+ \definedummyword\file
+ \definedummyword\kbd
+ \definedummyword\key
+ \definedummyword\math
+ \definedummyword\option
+ \definedummyword\pxref
+ \definedummyword\ref
+ \definedummyword\samp
+ \definedummyword\strong
+ \definedummyword\tie
+ \definedummyword\uref
+ \definedummyword\url
+ \definedummyword\var
+ \definedummyword\verb
+ \definedummyword\w
+ \definedummyword\xref
+}
+
+% \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
+% by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
+% control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
+% would be for a given command (usually its argument).
+%
\def\indexnofonts{%
-% Just ignore accents.
-\let\,=\indexdummyfont
-\let\"=\indexdummyfont
-\let\`=\indexdummyfont
-\let\'=\indexdummyfont
-\let\^=\indexdummyfont
-\let\~=\indexdummyfont
-\let\==\indexdummyfont
-\let\b=\indexdummyfont
-\let\c=\indexdummyfont
-\let\d=\indexdummyfont
-\let\u=\indexdummyfont
-\let\v=\indexdummyfont
-\let\H=\indexdummyfont
-\let\dotless=\indexdummyfont
-% Take care of the plain tex special European modified letters.
-\def\oe{oe}%
-\def\ae{ae}%
-\def\aa{aa}%
-\def\OE{OE}%
-\def\AE{AE}%
-\def\AA{AA}%
-\def\o{o}%
-\def\O{O}%
-\def\l{l}%
-\def\L{L}%
-\def\ss{ss}%
-\let\w=\indexdummyfont
-\let\t=\indexdummyfont
-\let\r=\indexdummyfont
-\let\i=\indexdummyfont
-\let\b=\indexdummyfont
-\let\emph=\indexdummyfont
-\let\strong=\indexdummyfont
-\let\cite=\indexdummyfont
-\let\sc=\indexdummyfont
-%Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
-% and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |...
-%\let\tt=\indexdummyfont
-\let\tclose=\indexdummyfont
-\let\code=\indexdummyfont
-\let\url=\indexdummyfont
-\let\uref=\indexdummyfont
-\let\env=\indexdummyfont
-\let\acronym=\indexdummyfont
-\let\command=\indexdummyfont
-\let\option=\indexdummyfont
-\let\file=\indexdummyfont
-\let\samp=\indexdummyfont
-\let\kbd=\indexdummyfont
-\let\key=\indexdummyfont
-\let\var=\indexdummyfont
-\let\TeX=\indexdummytex
-\let\dots=\indexdummydots
-\def\@{@}%
-}
-
-% To define \realbackslash, we must make \ not be an escape.
-% We must first make another character (@) an escape
-% so we do not become unable to do a definition.
-
-{\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\other
- @gdef@realbackslash{\}}
+ % Accent commands should become @asis.
+ \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
+ % We can just ignore other control letters.
+ \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
+ % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis.
+ \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
+ %
+ \commondummiesnofonts
+ %
+ % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
+ % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
+ % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
+ %\let\tt=\asis
+ %
+ \def\ { }%
+ \def\@{@}%
+ % how to handle braces?
+ \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
+ %
+ % Non-English letters.
+ \def\AA{AA}%
+ \def\AE{AE}%
+ \def\L{L}%
+ \def\OE{OE}%
+ \def\O{O}%
+ \def\aa{aa}%
+ \def\ae{ae}%
+ \def\l{l}%
+ \def\oe{oe}%
+ \def\o{o}%
+ \def\ss{ss}%
+ \def\exclamdown{!}%
+ \def\questiondown{?}%
+ \def\ordf{a}%
+ \def\ordm{o}%
+ %
+ \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
+ \def\TeX{TeX}%
+ %
+ % Assorted special characters.
+ % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
+ \def\bullet{bullet}%
+ \def\comma{,}%
+ \def\copyright{copyright}%
+ \def\registeredsymbol{R}%
+ \def\dots{...}%
+ \def\enddots{...}%
+ \def\equiv{==}%
+ \def\error{error}%
+ \def\euro{euro}%
+ \def\guillemetleft{<<}%
+ \def\guillemetright{>>}%
+ \def\guilsinglleft{<}%
+ \def\guilsinglright{>}%
+ \def\expansion{==>}%
+ \def\minus{-}%
+ \def\pounds{pounds}%
+ \def\point{.}%
+ \def\print{-|}%
+ \def\quotedblbase{"}%
+ \def\quotedblleft{"}%
+ \def\quotedblright{"}%
+ \def\quoteleft{`}%
+ \def\quoteright{'}%
+ \def\quotesinglbase{,}%
+ \def\result{=>}%
+ \def\textdegree{degrees}%
+ %
+ % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
+ % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
+ % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
+ % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
+ % that starts with \.
+ %
+ % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
+ % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
+ % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
+ %
+ \macrolist
+}
\let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex.
\let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
-% For \ifx comparisons.
-\def\emptymacro{\empty}
-
% Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
-%
-\def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}\empty}
+% #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
+\def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
% Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
% #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
-% \empty if called from \doind, as we usually are. The main exception
-% is with defuns, which call us directly.
+% empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
+% is with most defuns, which call us directly).
%
\def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
+ \iflinks
+ {%
+ % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
+ \toks0 = {#2}%
+ % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
+ \def\thirdarg{#3}%
+ \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
+ \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
+ %
+ \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
+ }%
+ \fi
+}
+
+% Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
+%
+\def\dosubindwrite{%
% Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
\ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
- \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt #2}}%
- \fi
- {%
- \count255=\lastpenalty
- {%
- \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
- \escapechar=`\\
- {%
- \let\folio = 0% We will expand all macros now EXCEPT \folio.
- \def\rawbackslashxx{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
- % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
- %
- \def\thirdarg{#3}%
- %
- % If third arg is present, precede it with space in sort key.
- \ifx\thirdarg\emptymacro
- \let\subentry = \empty
- \else
- \def\subentry{ #3}%
- \fi
- %
- % First process the index entry with all font commands turned
- % off to get the string to sort by.
- {\indexnofonts \xdef\indexsorttmp{#2\subentry}}%
- %
- % Now the real index entry with the fonts.
- \toks0 = {#2}%
- %
- % If third (subentry) arg is present, add it to the index
- % string. And include a space.
- \ifx\thirdarg\emptymacro \else
- \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
- \fi
- %
- % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key
- % and the original text, including any font commands. We write
- % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file, texindex reduces to
- % two when writing the .??s sorted result.
- \edef\temp{%
- \write\csname#1indfile\endcsname{%
- \realbackslash entry{\indexsorttmp}{\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
- }%
- %
- % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
- % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
- % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
- % \write will make \lastskip zero. The result is that sequences
- % like this:
- % @end defun
- % @tindex whatever
- % @defun ...
- % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
- % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
- % the previous defun.
- %
- % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
- % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
- %
- % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
- %
- \iflinks
- \ifvmode
- \skip0 = \lastskip
- \ifdim\lastskip = 0pt \else \nobreak\vskip-\lastskip \fi
- \fi
- %
- \temp % do the write
- %
- %
- \ifvmode \ifdim\skip0 = 0pt \else \nobreak\vskip\skip0 \fi \fi
- \fi
- }%
- }%
- \penalty\count255
- }%
+ \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Remember, we are within a group.
+ \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
+ \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
+ % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
+ %
+ % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
+ % get the string to sort by.
+ {\indexnofonts
+ \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
+ \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
+ }%
+ %
+ % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
+ % the original text, including any font commands. We write
+ % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
+ % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
+ % sorted result.
+ \edef\temp{%
+ \write\writeto{%
+ \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
+ }%
+ \temp
+}
+
+% Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
+%
+% If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
+% by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
+% the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
+% \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
+% sequences like this:
+% @end defun
+% @tindex whatever
+% @defun ...
+% will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
+% start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
+% the previous defun.
+%
+% But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
+% don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
+%
+% Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
+%
+% But wait, there is a catch there:
+% We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
+% sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
+% of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
+% representation of the skip.
+%
+% The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
+% the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
+%
+\edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
+%
+\newskip\whatsitskip
+\newcount\whatsitpenalty
+%
+% ..., ready, GO:
+%
+\def\safewhatsit#1{%
+\ifhmode
+ #1%
+\else
+ % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
+ \whatsitskip = \lastskip
+ \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
+ \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
+ %
+ % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
+ % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
+ % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
+ % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
+ % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
+ \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
+ \else
+ \vskip-\whatsitskip
+ \fi
+ %
+ #1%
+ %
+ \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
+ % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
+ % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
+ % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
+ % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
+ % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
+ %
+ % @deffn deffn-whatever
+ % @vindex index-whatever
+ % Description.
+ % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
+ % and the "Description." paragraph.
+ \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
+ \else
+ % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
+ % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
+ % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
+ \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
+ \fi
+\fi
}
% The index entry written in the file actually looks like
@@ -2938,13 +4380,13 @@
% @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
% It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
%
-\def\printindex{\parsearg\doprintindex}
-\def\doprintindex#1{\begingroup
+\parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
\dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
%
\smallfonts \rm
\tolerance = 9500
- \indexbreaks
+ \plainfrenchspacing
+ \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
%
% See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
% Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
@@ -2971,7 +4413,7 @@
% Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
% character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
% to make right now.
- \def\indexbackslash{\rawbackslashxx}%
+ \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
\catcode`\\ = 0
\escapechar = `\\
\begindoublecolumns
@@ -2993,7 +4435,10 @@
\removelastskip
%
% We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
- \penalty -300
+ \nobreak
+ \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip
+ \penalty 0
+ \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip
%
% Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
% baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
@@ -3003,93 +4448,117 @@
% No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
\vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip
\leftline{\secbf #1}%
- \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
- %
% Do our best not to break after the initial.
\nobreak
-}}
-
-% This typesets a paragraph consisting of #1, dot leaders, and then #2
-% flush to the right margin. It is used for index and table of contents
-% entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
-%
-\def\entry#1#2{\begingroup
- %
- % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
- % affect previous text.
+ \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
+}}
+
+% \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
+% then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
+% and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
+%
+% A straightforward implementation would start like this:
+% \def\entry#1#2{...
+% But this freezes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
+% @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
+% ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
+%
+% The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
+% --kasal, 21nov03
+\def\entry{%
+ \begingroup
+ %
+ % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
+ % affect previous text.
+ \par
+ %
+ % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
+ \parfillskip = 0in
+ %
+ % No extra space above this paragraph.
+ \parskip = 0in
+ %
+ % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
+ \finalhyphendemerits = 0
+ %
+ % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
+ % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
+ % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
+ % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
+ % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
+ %
+ % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
+ % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
+ \hangindent = 2em
+ %
+ % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
+ % with blank space.
+ \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
+ %
+ % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
+ % columns.
+ \vskip 0pt plus1pt
+ %
+ % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
+ \afterassignment\doentry
+ \let\temp =
+}
+\def\doentry{%
+ \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
+ \noindent
+ \aftergroup\finishentry
+ % And now comes the text of the entry.
+}
+\def\finishentry#1{%
+ % #1 is the page number.
+ %
+ % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
+ % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
+ % cursed by a Unix daemon.
+ \setbox\boxA = \hbox{#1}%
+ \ifdim\wd\boxA = 0pt
+ \ %
+ \else
+ %
+ % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
+ % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
+ % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
+ \hfil\penalty50
+ \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
+ %
+ % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
+ % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
+ % \hbox ensues.
+ \ifpdf
+ \pdfgettoks#1.%
+ \ \the\toksA
+ \else
+ \ #1%
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \par
+ \endgroup
+}
+
+% Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
+\def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
+ \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
+
+\def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
+
+\newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
+\def\secondary#1#2{{%
+ \parfillskip=0in
+ \parskip=0in
+ \hangindent=1in
+ \hangafter=1
+ \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
+ \ifpdf
+ \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
+ \else
+ #2
+ \fi
\par
- %
- % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
- \parfillskip = 0in
- %
- % No extra space above this paragraph.
- \parskip = 0in
- %
- % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
- \finalhyphendemerits = 0
- %
- % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
- % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
- % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
- % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
- % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
- %
- % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
- % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
- \hangindent = 2em
- %
- % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
- % with blank space.
- \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
- %
- % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing columns.
- \vskip 0pt plus1pt
- %
- % Start a ``paragraph'' for the index entry so the line breaking
- % parameters we've set above will have an effect.
- \noindent
- %
- % Insert the text of the index entry. TeX will do line-breaking on it.
- #1%
- % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
- % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
- % cursed by a Unix daemon.
- \def\tempa{{\rm }}%
- \def\tempb{#2}%
- \edef\tempc{\tempa}%
- \edef\tempd{\tempb}%
- \ifx\tempc\tempd\ \else%
- %
- % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
- % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
- % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
- \hfil\penalty50
- \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
- %
- % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
- % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
- % \hbox ensues.
- \ifpdf
- \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
- \else
- \ #2% The page number ends the paragraph.
- \fi
- \fi%
- \par
-\endgroup}
-
-% Like \dotfill except takes at least 1 em.
-\def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
- \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu ${\it .}$ \mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
-
-\def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
-
-\newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
-
-\def\secondary #1#2{
-{\parfillskip=0in \parskip=0in
-\hangindent =1in \hangafter=1
-\noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill #2\par
}}
% Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
@@ -3149,7 +4618,6 @@
%
% Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
% since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
- \advance\vsize by -\ht\partialpage
\vsize = 2\vsize
}
@@ -3163,6 +4631,7 @@
% previous page.
\dimen@ = \vsize
\divide\dimen@ by 2
+ \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage
%
% box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
\setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@
@@ -3170,16 +4639,47 @@
\unvbox255
\penalty\outputpenalty
}
+%
+% Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
+% followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
\def\pagesofar{%
- % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
- % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
\unvbox\partialpage
%
\hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
\wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
\hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
}
+%
+% All done with double columns.
\def\enddoublecolumns{%
+ % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
+ % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
+ % following situation:
+ %
+ % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
+ % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
+ % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
+ % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
+ % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
+ % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
+ % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
+ % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
+ % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
+ % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
+ % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
+ % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
+ % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
+ % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
+ % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
+ % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
+ % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
+ % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see
+ % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
+ %
+ % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
+ % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
+ \penalty0
+ %
\output = {%
% Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
% current page, no automatic page break.
@@ -3203,8 +4703,9 @@
% \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
\pagegoal = \vsize
}
+%
+% Called at the end of the double column material.
\def\balancecolumns{%
- % Called at the end of the double column material.
\setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
\dimen@ = \ht0
\advance\dimen@ by \topskip
@@ -3234,6 +4735,12 @@
\message{sectioning,}
% Chapters, sections, etc.
+% \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered
+% sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
+% outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
+% numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
+% chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
+\newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
\newcount\chapno
\newcount\secno \secno=0
\newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
@@ -3241,9 +4748,12 @@
% This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
\newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
+%
% \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
-% We do the following for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
+% We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
+% construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
% letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
+%
\def\appendixletter{%
\ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
\else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
@@ -3279,13 +4789,18 @@
\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
-% Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter.
-% page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise.
+% Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
+% and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
+% these. @section does likewise.
\def\thischapter{}
+\def\thischapternum{}
+\def\thischaptername{}
\def\thissection{}
+\def\thissectionnum{}
+\def\thissectionname{}
\newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
-\newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raise/lowersections modify this count
+\newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
% @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
\def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
@@ -3295,287 +4810,246 @@
\def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
\let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
-% Choose a numbered-heading macro
-% #1 is heading level if unmodified by @raisesections or @lowersections
-% #2 is text for heading
-\def\numhead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1
-\ifcase\absseclevel
- \chapterzzz{#2}
-\or
- \seczzz{#2}
-\or
- \numberedsubseczzz{#2}
-\or
- \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2}
-\else
- \ifnum \absseclevel<0
- \chapterzzz{#2}
- \else
- \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2}
- \fi
-\fi
-}
-
-% like \numhead, but chooses appendix heading levels
-\def\apphead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1
-\ifcase\absseclevel
- \appendixzzz{#2}
-\or
- \appendixsectionzzz{#2}
-\or
- \appendixsubseczzz{#2}
-\or
- \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2}
-\else
- \ifnum \absseclevel<0
- \appendixzzz{#2}
- \else
- \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2}
- \fi
-\fi
-}
-
-% like \numhead, but chooses numberless heading levels
-\def\unnmhead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1
-\ifcase\absseclevel
- \unnumberedzzz{#2}
-\or
- \unnumberedseczzz{#2}
-\or
- \unnumberedsubseczzz{#2}
-\or
- \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2}
-\else
- \ifnum \absseclevel<0
- \unnumberedzzz{#2}
- \else
- \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2}
- \fi
-\fi
-}
-
-% @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered.
-\def\thischaptername{No Chapter Title}
-\outer\def\chapter{\parsearg\chapteryyy}
-\def\chapteryyy #1{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
-\def\chapterzzz #1{%
-\secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0
-\global\advance \chapno by 1 \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}%
-\chapmacro {#1}{\the\chapno}%
-\gdef\thissection{#1}%
-\gdef\thischaptername{#1}%
-% We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter
-% because we don't want its macros evaluated now.
-\xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno: \noexpand\thischaptername}%
-\toks0 = {#1}%
-\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash chapentry{\the\toks0}%
- {\the\chapno}}}%
-\temp
-\donoderef
-\global\let\section = \numberedsec
-\global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
-\global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
-}
-
-\outer\def\appendix{\parsearg\appendixyyy}
-\def\appendixyyy #1{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
-\def\appendixzzz #1{%
-\secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0
-\global\advance \appendixno by 1
-\message{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}%
-\chapmacro {#1}{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter}%
-\gdef\thissection{#1}%
-\gdef\thischaptername{#1}%
-\xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter: \noexpand\thischaptername}%
-\toks0 = {#1}%
-\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash chapentry{\the\toks0}%
- {\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter}}}%
-\temp
-\appendixnoderef
-\global\let\section = \appendixsec
-\global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
-\global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
+% we only have subsub.
+\chardef\maxseclevel = 3
+%
+% A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
+% To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
+\chardef\unmlevel = \maxseclevel
+%
+% Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
+% \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
+\def\chapheadtype{N}
+
+% Choose a heading macro
+% #1 is heading type
+% #2 is heading level
+% #3 is text for heading
+\def\genhead#1#2#3{%
+ % Compute the abs. sec. level:
+ \absseclevel=#2
+ \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
+ % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
+ \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
+ \absseclevel = 0
+ \else
+ \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
+ \absseclevel = 3
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ % The heading type:
+ \def\headtype{#1}%
+ \if \headtype U%
+ \ifnum \absseclevel < \unmlevel
+ \chardef\unmlevel = \absseclevel
+ \fi
+ \else
+ % Check for appendix sections:
+ \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
+ \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
+ \else
+ \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
+ \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
+ \fi\fi
+ \fi
+ % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
+ \ifnum \absseclevel > \unmlevel
+ \def\headtype{U}%
+ \else
+ \chardef\unmlevel = 3
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ % Now print the heading:
+ \if \headtype U%
+ \ifcase\absseclevel
+ \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
+ \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
+ \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
+ \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
+ \fi
+ \else
+ \if \headtype A%
+ \ifcase\absseclevel
+ \appendixzzz{#3}%
+ \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
+ \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
+ \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
+ \fi
+ \else
+ \ifcase\absseclevel
+ \chapterzzz{#3}%
+ \or \seczzz{#3}%
+ \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
+ \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \suppressfirstparagraphindent
+}
+
+% an interface:
+\def\numhead{\genhead N}
+\def\apphead{\genhead A}
+\def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
+
+% @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
+% all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
+%
+% Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
+% (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
+\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
+%
+\outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
+\def\chapterzzz#1{%
+ % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
+ % as an @include file.
+ \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
+ \global\advance\chapno by 1
+ %
+ % Used for \float.
+ \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
+ \resetallfloatnos
+ %
+ \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}%
+ %
+ % Write the actual heading.
+ \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
+ %
+ % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
+ \global\let\section = \numberedsec
+ \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
+ \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
+\def\appendixzzz#1{%
+ \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
+ \global\advance\appendixno by 1
+ \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
+ \resetallfloatnos
+ %
+ \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}%
+ \message{\appendixnum}%
+ %
+ \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
+ %
+ \global\let\section = \appendixsec
+ \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
+ \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
+\def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
+ \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
+ \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
+ %
+ % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
+ \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
+ \resetallfloatnos
+ %
+ % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
+ % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
+ % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
+ % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
+ % to be executed, not expanded).
+ %
+ % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
+ % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
+ % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
+ % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
+ % the toc entries.)
+ \toks0 = {#1}%
+ \message{(\the\toks0)}%
+ %
+ \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
+ %
+ \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
+ \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
+ \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
}
% @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
-\outer\def\centerchap{\parsearg\centerchapyyy}
-\def\centerchapyyy #1{{\let\unnumbchapmacro=\centerchapmacro \unnumberedyyy{#1}}}
+\outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
+ % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
+ % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
+ % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
+ \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
+ \unnmhead0{#1}%
+ \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
+}
% @top is like @unnumbered.
-\outer\def\top{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy}
-
-\outer\def\unnumbered{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy}
-\def\unnumberedyyy #1{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
-\def\unnumberedzzz #1{%
-\secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0
-%
-% This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
-% argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
-% expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
-% expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
-% to be executed, not expanded).
-%
-% Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
-% as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
-% \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
-% simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
-% the toc entries.)
-\toks0 = {#1}\message{(\the\toks0)}%
-%
-\unnumbchapmacro {#1}%
-\gdef\thischapter{#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}%
-\toks0 = {#1}%
-\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash unnumbchapentry{\the\toks0}}}%
-\temp
-\unnumbnoderef
-\global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
-\global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
-\global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
-}
+\let\top\unnumbered
% Sections.
-\outer\def\numberedsec{\parsearg\secyyy}
-\def\secyyy #1{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
-\def\seczzz #1{%
-\subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \secno by 1 %
-\gdef\thissection{#1}\secheading {#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}%
-\toks0 = {#1}%
-\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash secentry{\the\toks0}%
- {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}}}%
-\temp
-\donoderef
-\nobreak
-}
-
-\outer\def\appendixsection{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy}
-\outer\def\appendixsec{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy}
-\def\appendixsecyyy #1{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
-\def\appendixsectionzzz #1{%
-\subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \secno by 1 %
-\gdef\thissection{#1}\secheading {#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}%
-\toks0 = {#1}%
-\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash secentry{\the\toks0}%
- {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}}}%
-\temp
-\appendixnoderef
-\nobreak
-}
-
-\outer\def\unnumberedsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsecyyy}
-\def\unnumberedsecyyy #1{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
-\def\unnumberedseczzz #1{%
-\plainsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}%
-\toks0 = {#1}%
-\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash unnumbsecentry{\the\toks0}}}%
-\temp
-\unnumbnoderef
-\nobreak
+\outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
+\def\seczzz#1{%
+ \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
+\def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
+ \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
+}
+\let\appendixsec\appendixsection
+
+\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
+\def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
+ \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
}
% Subsections.
-\outer\def\numberedsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsecyyy}
-\def\numberedsubsecyyy #1{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
-\def\numberedsubseczzz #1{%
-\gdef\thissection{#1}\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \subsecno by 1 %
-\subsecheading {#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}%
-\toks0 = {#1}%
-\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash subsecentry{\the\toks0}%
- {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}}}%
-\temp
-\donoderef
-\nobreak
-}
-
-\outer\def\appendixsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsecyyy}
-\def\appendixsubsecyyy #1{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
-\def\appendixsubseczzz #1{%
-\gdef\thissection{#1}\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \subsecno by 1 %
-\subsecheading {#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}%
-\toks0 = {#1}%
-\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash subsecentry{\the\toks0}%
- {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}}}%
-\temp
-\appendixnoderef
-\nobreak
-}
-
-\outer\def\unnumberedsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsecyyy}
-\def\unnumberedsubsecyyy #1{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
-\def\unnumberedsubseczzz #1{%
-\plainsubsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}%
-\toks0 = {#1}%
-\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash unnumbsubsecentry%
- {\the\toks0}}}%
-\temp
-\unnumbnoderef
-\nobreak
+\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
+\def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
+ \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
+\def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
+ \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
+ {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
+\def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
+ \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
+ {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
}
% Subsubsections.
-\outer\def\numberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsubsecyyy}
-\def\numberedsubsubsecyyy #1{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
-\def\numberedsubsubseczzz #1{%
-\gdef\thissection{#1}\global\advance \subsubsecno by 1 %
-\subsubsecheading {#1}
- {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}%
-\toks0 = {#1}%
-\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash subsubsecentry{\the\toks0}%
- {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}}}%
-\temp
-\donoderef
-\nobreak
-}
-
-\outer\def\appendixsubsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsubsecyyy}
-\def\appendixsubsubsecyyy #1{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
-\def\appendixsubsubseczzz #1{%
-\gdef\thissection{#1}\global\advance \subsubsecno by 1 %
-\subsubsecheading {#1}
- {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}%
-\toks0 = {#1}%
-\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash subsubsecentry{\the\toks0}%
- {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}}}%
-\temp
-\appendixnoderef
-\nobreak
-}
-
-\outer\def\unnumberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy}
-\def\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy #1{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
-\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz #1{%
-\plainsubsubsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}%
-\toks0 = {#1}%
-\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash unnumbsubsubsecentry%
- {\the\toks0}}}%
-\temp
-\unnumbnoderef
-\nobreak
-}
-
-% These are variants which are not "outer", so they can appear in @ifinfo.
-% Actually, they should now be obsolete; ordinary section commands should work.
-\def\infotop{\parsearg\unnumberedzzz}
-\def\infounnumbered{\parsearg\unnumberedzzz}
-\def\infounnumberedsec{\parsearg\unnumberedseczzz}
-\def\infounnumberedsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubseczzz}
-\def\infounnumberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsubseczzz}
-
-\def\infoappendix{\parsearg\appendixzzz}
-\def\infoappendixsec{\parsearg\appendixseczzz}
-\def\infoappendixsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubseczzz}
-\def\infoappendixsubsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsubseczzz}
-
-\def\infochapter{\parsearg\chapterzzz}
-\def\infosection{\parsearg\sectionzzz}
-\def\infosubsection{\parsearg\subsectionzzz}
-\def\infosubsubsection{\parsearg\subsubsectionzzz}
+\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
+\def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
+ \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
+ {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
+\def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
+ \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
+ {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
+\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
+ \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
+ {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
+}
% These macros control what the section commands do, according
% to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
% Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
-\global\let\section = \numberedsec
-\global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
-\global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
+\let\section = \numberedsec
+\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
+\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
% Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
@@ -3588,23 +5062,27 @@
% if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright.
-\def\majorheading{\parsearg\majorheadingzzz}
-\def\majorheadingzzz #1{%
-{\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
-{\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
- \parindent=0pt\raggedright
- \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 200}
-
-\def\chapheading{\parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
-\def\chapheadingzzz #1{\chapbreak %
-{\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
- \parindent=0pt\raggedright
- \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 200}
+\def\majorheading{%
+ {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
+ \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
+}
+
+\def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
+\def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
+ {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
+ \parindent=0pt\raggedright
+ \rm #1\hfill}}%
+ \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax
+ \suppressfirstparagraphindent
+}
% @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
-\def\heading{\parsearg\plainsecheading}
-\def\subheading{\parsearg\plainsubsecheading}
-\def\subsubheading{\parsearg\plainsubsubsecheading}
+\parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
+ \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
+\parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
+ \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
+\parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
+ \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
% These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
% (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
@@ -3613,8 +5091,6 @@
%%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
\def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
-\def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
-
%%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it
% Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
@@ -3622,7 +5098,20 @@
\def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
\def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
-\def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to 0pt{} \chappager\fi}
+% Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
+% get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
+% care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
+\def\chapoddpage{%
+ \chappager
+ \ifodd\pageno \else
+ \begingroup
+ \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}%
+ \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}%
+ \hbox to 0pt{}%
+ \chappager
+ \endgroup
+ \fi
+}
\def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
@@ -3637,7 +5126,7 @@
\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
-\def\CHAPPAGodd{
+\def\CHAPPAGodd{%
\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
@@ -3645,107 +5134,275 @@
\CHAPPAGon
-\def\CHAPFplain{
-\global\let\chapmacro=\chfplain
-\global\let\unnumbchapmacro=\unnchfplain
-\global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfplain}
-
-% Plain chapter opening.
-% #1 is the text, #2 the chapter number or empty if unnumbered.
-\def\chfplain#1#2{%
+% Chapter opening.
+%
+% #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
+% Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
+%
+% To test against our argument.
+\def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
+\def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
+\def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
+%
+\def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
+ % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
+ \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
+ \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
+ \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
+ \gdef\thissection{}}%
+ %
+ \def\temptype{#2}%
+ \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
+ \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
+ \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
+ \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
+ \gdef\thischapter{}}%
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
+ \toks0={#1}%
+ \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \noexpand\thischapternum:
+ \noexpand\thischaptername}%
+ }%
+ \else
+ \toks0={#1}%
+ \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \noexpand\thischapternum:
+ \noexpand\thischaptername}%
+ }%
+ \fi\fi\fi
+ %
+ % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
+ % the preceding space.
+ \safewhatsit\domark
+ %
+ % Insert the chapter heading break.
\pchapsepmacro
+ %
+ % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
+ % between here and the heading.
+ \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
+ \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
+ \domark
+ %
{%
\chapfonts \rm
- \def\chapnum{#2}%
- \setbox0 = \hbox{#2\ifx\chapnum\empty\else\enspace\fi}%
+ %
+ % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
+ % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
+ % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
+ \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
+ %
+ % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
+ % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
+ \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
+ \def\toctype{unnchap}%
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
+ \def\toctype{omit}%
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
+ \def\toctype{app}%
+ \else
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
+ \def\toctype{numchap}%
+ \fi\fi\fi
+ %
+ % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
+ % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
+ % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
+ \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
+ %
+ % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
+ % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
+ % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
+ % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
+ % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
+ \donoderef{#2}%
+ %
+ % Typeset the actual heading.
+ \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
\vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
- \hangindent = \wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
+ \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
\unhbox0 #1\par}%
}%
\nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
\nobreak
}
-% Plain opening for unnumbered.
-\def\unnchfplain#1{\chfplain{#1}{}}
-
% @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
\let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
-\def\centerchfplain#1{{%
- \def\centerparametersmaybe{%
- \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
- \leftskip = \rightskip
- \parfillskip = 0pt
- }%
- \chfplain{#1}{}%
-}}
-
-\CHAPFplain % The default
-
+\def\centerparameters{%
+ \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
+ \leftskip = \rightskip
+ \parfillskip = 0pt
+}
+
+
+% I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
+% updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
+%
+\def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
+%
\def\unnchfopen #1{%
\chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
\parindent=0pt\raggedright
\rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
}
-
\def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
\vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
\par\penalty 5000 %
}
-
\def\centerchfopen #1{%
\chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
\parindent=0pt
\hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
}
-
-\def\CHAPFopen{
-\global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
-\global\let\unnumbchapmacro=\unnchfopen
-\global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen}
-
-
-% Section titles.
+\def\CHAPFopen{%
+ \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
+ \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen}
+
+
+% Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
+% call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
+%
\newskip\secheadingskip
-\def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip {-1000}}
-\def\secheading#1#2#3{\sectionheading{sec}{#2.#3}{#1}}
-\def\plainsecheading#1{\sectionheading{sec}{}{#1}}
+\def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
% Subsection titles.
-\newskip \subsecheadingskip
-\def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip {-500}}
-\def\subsecheading#1#2#3#4{\sectionheading{subsec}{#2.#3.#4}{#1}}
-\def\plainsubsecheading#1{\sectionheading{subsec}{}{#1}}
+\newskip\subsecheadingskip
+\def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
% Subsubsection titles.
-\let\subsubsecheadingskip = \subsecheadingskip
-\let\subsubsecheadingbreak = \subsecheadingbreak
-\def\subsubsecheading#1#2#3#4#5{\sectionheading{subsubsec}{#2.#3.#4.#5}{#1}}
-\def\plainsubsubsecheading#1{\sectionheading{subsubsec}{}{#1}}
-
-
-% Print any size section title.
-%
-% #1 is the section type (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #2 is the section
-% number (maybe empty), #3 the text.
-\def\sectionheading#1#2#3{%
- {%
- \expandafter\advance\csname #1headingskip\endcsname by \parskip
- \csname #1headingbreak\endcsname
- }%
+\def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
+\def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
+
+
+% Print any size, any type, section title.
+%
+% #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
+% the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
+% section number.
+%
+\def\seckeyword{sec}
+%
+\def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
{%
% Switch to the right set of fonts.
- \csname #1fonts\endcsname \rm
- %
- % Only insert the separating space if we have a section number.
- \def\secnum{#2}%
- \setbox0 = \hbox{#2\ifx\secnum\empty\else\enspace\fi}%
- %
+ \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm
+ %
+ \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
+ \def\temptype{#3}%
+ %
+ % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
+ \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
+ \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
+ \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
+ \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
+ \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
+ \fi
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
+ % Don't redefine \thissection.
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
+ \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
+ \toks0={#1}%
+ \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\putwordSection{} \noexpand\thissectionnum:
+ \noexpand\thissectionname}%
+ }%
+ \fi
+ \else
+ \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
+ \toks0={#1}%
+ \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\putwordSection{} \noexpand\thissectionnum:
+ \noexpand\thissectionname}%
+ }%
+ \fi
+ \fi\fi\fi
+ %
+ % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
+ % the preceding space.
+ \safewhatsit\domark
+ %
+ % Insert space above the heading.
+ \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
+ %
+ % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
+ % between here and the heading.
+ \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
+ \domark
+ %
+ % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
+ \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
+ \def\toctype{unn}%
+ \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
+ % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
+ % and don't redefine \lastsection.
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
+ \def\toctype{omit}%
+ \let\sectionlevel=\empty
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
+ \def\toctype{app}%
+ \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
+ \else
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
+ \def\toctype{num}%
+ \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
+ \fi\fi\fi
+ %
+ % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
+ \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
+ %
+ % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
+ % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
+ \donoderef{#3}%
+ %
+ % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
+ % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
+ % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
+ % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
+ % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
+ % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
+ \nobreak
+ %
+ % Output the actual section heading.
\vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
- \hangindent = \wd0 % zero if no section number
- \unhbox0 #3}%
- }%
- \ifdim\parskip<10pt \nobreak\kern10pt\nobreak\kern-\parskip\fi \nobreak
+ \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
+ \unhbox0 #1}%
+ }%
+ % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
+ % Don't allow stretch, though.
+ \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
+ %
+ % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
+ % was followed by glue.
+ \nobreak
+ %
+ % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
+ % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
+ % discardable item.)
+ \vskip-\parskip
+ %
+ % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty >
+ % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after
+ % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between:
+ %
+ % @section sec-whatever
+ % @deffn def-whatever
+ \penalty 10001
}
@@ -3754,161 +5411,224 @@
\newwrite\tocfile
% Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
-% Called from @chapter, etc. We supply {\folio} at the end of the
-% argument, which will end up as the last argument to the \...entry macro.
-%
-% We open the .toc file here instead of at @setfilename or any other
-% given time so that @contents can be put in the document anywhere.
+% Called from @chapter, etc.
+%
+% Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
+% We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
+% arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
+% read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
+% destination to jump to.
+%
+% We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
+% any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
+% But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
+% table of contents chapter openings themselves.
%
\newif\iftocfileopened
-\def\writetocentry#1{%
- \iftocfileopened\else
- \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
- \global\tocfileopenedtrue
- \fi
- \iflinks \write\tocfile{#1{\folio}}\fi
+\def\omitkeyword{omit}%
+%
+\def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
+ \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
+ \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
+ \iftocfileopened\else
+ \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
+ \global\tocfileopenedtrue
+ \fi
+ %
+ \iflinks
+ {\atdummies
+ \edef\temp{%
+ \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+ \temp
+ }%
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
+ % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
+ % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
+ % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
+ % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
+ % `1', and two named `2'.
+ \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
+}
+
+
+% These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
+% fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
+% with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
+%
+\def\activecatcodes{%
+ \catcode`\"=\active
+ \catcode`\$=\active
+ \catcode`\<=\active
+ \catcode`\>=\active
+ \catcode`\\=\active
+ \catcode`\^=\active
+ \catcode`\_=\active
+ \catcode`\|=\active
+ \catcode`\~=\active
+}
+
+
+% Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
+\def\readtocfile{%
+ \setupdatafile
+ \activecatcodes
+ \input \tocreadfilename
}
\newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
\newcount\savepageno
\newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
-% Finish up the main text and prepare to read what we've written
-% to \tocfile.
+% Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
%
\def\startcontents#1{%
- % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
- % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
- % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
- % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege(a)matematik.su.se>
- \contentsalignmacro
- \immediate\closeout\tocfile
- %
- % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
- % It is abundantly clear what they are.
- \unnumbchapmacro{#1}\def\thischapter{}%
- \savepageno = \pageno
- \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
- \catcode`\\=0 \catcode`\{=1 \catcode`\}=2 \catcode`\@=11
- % We can't do this, because then an actual ^ in a section
- % title fails, e.g., @chapter ^ -- exponentiation. --karl, 9jul97.
- %\catcode`\^=7 % to see ^^e4 as \"a etc. juha(a)piuha.ydi.vtt.fi
- \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
- \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
- %
- % Roman numerals for page numbers.
- \ifnum \pageno>0 \pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
-}
-
+ % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
+ % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
+ % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
+ % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege(a)matematik.su.se>
+ \contentsalignmacro
+ \immediate\closeout\tocfile
+ %
+ % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
+ % It is abundantly clear what they are.
+ \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
+ %
+ \savepageno = \pageno
+ \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
+ \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
+ \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
+ %
+ % Roman numerals for page numbers.
+ \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
+}
+
+% redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
+% \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
+%
+\def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
% Normal (long) toc.
+%
\def\contents{%
- \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
- \openin 1 \jobname.toc
- \ifeof 1 \else
- \closein 1
- \input \jobname.toc
- \fi
- \vfill \eject
- \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
- \pdfmakeoutlines
- \endgroup
- \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
- \pageno = \savepageno
+ \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
+ \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
+ \ifeof 1 \else
+ \readtocfile
+ \fi
+ \vfill \eject
+ \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
+ \ifeof 1 \else
+ \pdfmakeoutlines
+ \fi
+ \closein 1
+ \endgroup
+ \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
+ \global\pageno = \savepageno
}
% And just the chapters.
\def\summarycontents{%
- \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
- %
- \let\chapentry = \shortchapentry
- \let\unnumbchapentry = \shortunnumberedentry
- % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
- \secfonts
- \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf \let\sl=\shortcontsl
- \rm
- \hyphenpenalty = 10000
- \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
- \def\secentry ##1##2##3##4{}
- \def\unnumbsecentry ##1##2{}
- \def\subsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{}
- \def\unnumbsubsecentry ##1##2{}
- \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{}
- \def\unnumbsubsubsecentry ##1##2{}
- \openin 1 \jobname.toc
- \ifeof 1 \else
- \closein 1
- \input \jobname.toc
- \fi
- \vfill \eject
- \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
- \endgroup
- \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
- \pageno = \savepageno
+ \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
+ %
+ \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
+ \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
+ \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
+ % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
+ \secfonts
+ \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
+ \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
+ \rm
+ \hyphenpenalty = 10000
+ \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
+ \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
+ \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
+ \ifeof 1 \else
+ \readtocfile
+ \fi
+ \closein 1
+ \vfill \eject
+ \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
+ \endgroup
+ \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
+ \global\pageno = \savepageno
}
\let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
-\ifpdf
- \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}%
-\fi
+% Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
+% The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
+%
+\def\shortchaplabel#1{%
+ % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
+ % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
+ % But use \hss just in case.
+ % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
+ % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
+ %
+ % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
+ % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
+ % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
+ % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
+ % there are before deciding ...
+ \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
+}
% These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
% The first argument is the chapter or section name.
% The last argument is the page number.
% The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
-% Chapter-level things, for both the long and short contents.
-\def\chapentry#1#2#3{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#3}}
-
-% See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings
-\def\shortchapentry#1#2#3{%
- \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#3\egroup}%
-}
-
-% Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
-% The arg is, e.g. `Appendix A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
-% We could simplify the code here by writing out an \appendixentry
-% command in the toc file for appendices, instead of using \chapentry
-% for both, but it doesn't seem worth it.
-%
-\newdimen\shortappendixwidth
-%
-\def\shortchaplabel#1{%
- % Compute width of word "Appendix", may change with language.
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\shortcontrm \putwordAppendix}%
- \shortappendixwidth = \wd0
- %
- % We typeset #1 in a box of constant width, regardless of the text of
- % #1, so the chapter titles will come out aligned.
- \setbox0 = \hbox{#1}%
- \dimen0 = \ifdim\wd0 > \shortappendixwidth \shortappendixwidth \else 0pt \fi
- %
- % This space should be plenty, since a single number is .5em, and the
- % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
- % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
- % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
- \advance\dimen0 by 1.1em
- \hbox to \dimen0{#1\hfil}%
-}
-
-\def\unnumbchapentry#1#2{\dochapentry{#1}{#2}}
-\def\shortunnumberedentry#1#2{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#2\egroup}}
+% Chapters, in the main contents.
+\def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
+%
+% Chapters, in the short toc.
+% See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
+\def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
+ \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
+}
+
+% Appendices, in the main contents.
+% Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
+%
+\def\appendixbox#1{%
+ % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
+ \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
+%
+\def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
+
+% Unnumbered chapters.
+\def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
+\def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
% Sections.
-\def\secentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2.#3\labelspace#1}{#4}}
-\def\unnumbsecentry#1#2{\dosecentry{#1}{#2}}
+\def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
+\let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
+\def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
% Subsections.
-\def\subsecentry#1#2#3#4#5{\dosubsecentry{#2.#3.#4\labelspace#1}{#5}}
-\def\unnumbsubsecentry#1#2{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#2}}
+\def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
+\let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
+\def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
% And subsubsections.
-\def\subsubsecentry#1#2#3#4#5#6{%
- \dosubsubsecentry{#2.#3.#4.#5\labelspace#1}{#6}}
-\def\unnumbsubsubsecentry#1#2{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#2}}
+\def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
+\let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
+\def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
% This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
-\newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 3pc
+% Same as \defaultparindent.
+\newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
% Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
% page number.
@@ -3939,17 +5659,8 @@
\tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
\endgroup}
-% Final typesetting of a toc entry; we use the same \entry macro as for
-% the index entries, but we want to suppress hyphenation here. (We
-% can't do that in the \entry macro, since index entries might consist
-% of hyphenated-identifiers-that-do-not-fit-on-a-line-and-nothing-else.)
-\def\tocentry#1#2{\begingroup
- \vskip 0pt plus1pt % allow a little stretch for the sake of nice page breaks
- % Do not use \turnoffactive in these arguments. Since the toc is
- % typeset in cmr, so characters such as _ would come out wrong; we
- % have to do the usual translation tricks.
- \entry{#1}{#2}%
-\endgroup}
+% We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
+\let\tocentry = \entry
% Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
\def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
@@ -3959,72 +5670,62 @@
\def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
\def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
-\let\subsecentryfonts = \textfonts
-\let\subsubsecentryfonts = \textfonts
+\def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
+\def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
\message{environments,}
% @foo ... @end foo.
-% Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of
+% @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
+%
+% Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of
% \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
-% Furthermore, these definitions must come after we define our fonts.
-\newbox\dblarrowbox \newbox\longdblarrowbox
-\newbox\pushcharbox \newbox\bullbox
-\newbox\equivbox \newbox\errorbox
-
-%{\tentt
-%\global\setbox\dblarrowbox = \hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}
-%\global\setbox\longdblarrowbox = \hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}
-%\global\setbox\pushcharbox = \hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}
-%\global\setbox\equivbox = \hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}
-% Adapted from the manmac format (p.420 of TeXbook)
-%\global\setbox\bullbox = \hbox to 1em{\kern.15em\vrule height .75ex width .85ex
-% depth .1ex\hfil}
-%}
-
-% @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
+%
\def\point{$\star$}
-\def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
-\def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
+\def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}}
+\def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
+\def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
\def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
-\def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
-
+\def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
+
+% The @error{} command.
% Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
+%
+\newbox\errorbox
+%
{\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
\dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
% The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
-\setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \tensf error\kern-1.5pt}
-
-\global\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
+\setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf error\kern-1.5pt}
+%
+\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
\hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
\advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
- \vbox{
+ \vbox{%
\hrule height\dimen2
\hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
\vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
\kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
\hrule height\dimen2}
\hfil}
-
-% The @error{} command.
+%
\def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
% @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily.
% One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
% But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character.
-\def\tex{\begingroup
+\envdef\tex{%
\catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
\catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
- \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=13 \let~=\tie
+ \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
\catcode `\%=14
- \catcode 43=12 % plus
- \catcode`\"=12
- \catcode`\==12
- \catcode`\|=12
- \catcode`\<=12
- \catcode`\>=12
+ \catcode `\+=\other
+ \catcode `\"=\other
+ \catcode `\|=\other
+ \catcode `\<=\other
+ \catcode `\>=\other
\escapechar=`\\
%
\let\b=\ptexb
@@ -4036,20 +5737,26 @@
\let\equiv=\ptexequiv
\let\!=\ptexexclam
\let\i=\ptexi
+ \let\indent=\ptexindent
+ \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
\let\{=\ptexlbrace
\let\+=\tabalign
\let\}=\ptexrbrace
+ \let\/=\ptexslash
\let\*=\ptexstar
\let\t=\ptext
+ \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop % outer
+ \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
%
\def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
\def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
\def\@{@}%
-\let\Etex=\endgroup}
-
-% Define @lisp ... @endlisp.
-% @lisp does a \begingroup so it can rebind things,
-% including the definition of @endlisp (which normally is erroneous).
+}
+% There is no need to define \Etex.
+
+% Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
+% @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
+% including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
% Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
\newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
@@ -4059,34 +5766,34 @@
% have any width.
\def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
-% Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
-% space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
-% is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
-% should produce a line of output anyway.
-%
-{\obeyspaces %
-\gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}}
-
-% Define \obeyedspace to be our active space, whatever it is. This is
-% for use in \parsearg.
-{\sepspaces%
-\global\let\obeyedspace= }
-
% This space is always present above and below environments.
\newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
% Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
% to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
% is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
-% start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip
-%
-\def\aboveenvbreak{{\advance\envskipamount by \parskip
-\endgraf \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
-\removelastskip \penalty-50 \vskip\envskipamount \fi}}
+% start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
+%
+\def\aboveenvbreak{{%
+ % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
+ % \sectionheading, q.v.
+ \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
+ \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
+ \endgraf
+ \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
+ \removelastskip
+ % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
+ % or better ...
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
+ \vskip\envskipamount
+ \fi
+ \fi
+}}
\let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak
-% \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins.
+% \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it
will
+% also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
\let\nonarrowing=\relax
% @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
@@ -4110,738 +5817,733 @@
%
\newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
-\long\def\cartouche{%
-\begingroup
- \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
- \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt %we want these *outside*.
- \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
- \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
- \cartouter=\hsize
- \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
-% side, and for 6pt waste from
-% each corner char, and rule thickness
- \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
- % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
- \let\nonarrowing=\comment
- \vbox\bgroup
- \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
- \carttop
- \hbox\bgroup
- \hskip\lskip
- \vrule\kern3pt
- \vbox\bgroup
- \hsize=\cartinner
- \kern3pt
- \begingroup
- \baselineskip=\normbskip
- \lineskip=\normlskip
- \parskip=\normpskip
- \vskip -\parskip
+\envdef\cartouche{%
+ \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
+ \startsavinginserts
+ \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
+ \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
+ \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
+ \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
+ \cartouter=\hsize
+ \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
+ % side, and for 6pt waste from
+ % each corner char, and rule thickness
+ \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
+ % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
+ \let\nonarrowing = t%
+ \vbox\bgroup
+ \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
+ \carttop
+ \hbox\bgroup
+ \hskip\lskip
+ \vrule\kern3pt
+ \vbox\bgroup
+ \kern3pt
+ \hsize=\cartinner
+ \baselineskip=\normbskip
+ \lineskip=\normlskip
+ \parskip=\normpskip
+ \vskip -\parskip
+ \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group.
+}
\def\Ecartouche{%
- \endgroup
- \kern3pt
- \egroup
- \kern3pt\vrule
- \hskip\rskip
- \egroup
- \cartbot
- \egroup
-\endgroup
-}}
+ \ifhmode\par\fi
+ \kern3pt
+ \egroup
+ \kern3pt\vrule
+ \hskip\rskip
+ \egroup
+ \cartbot
+ \egroup
+ \checkinserts
+}
% This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
% inside a group.
\def\nonfillstart{%
\aboveenvbreak
- \inENV % This group ends at the end of the body
\hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy
\sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
- \singlespace
\let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
\obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
\parskip = 0pt
\parindent = 0pt
\emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
- % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing
- % at next level down.
\ifx\nonarrowing\relax
\advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
\exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
- \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
- \let\nonarrowing=\relax
- \fi
-}
-
-% Define the \E... control sequence only if we are inside the particular
-% environment, so the error checking in \end will work.
-%
-% To end an @example-like environment, we first end the paragraph (via
-% \afterenvbreak's vertical glue), and then the group. That way we keep
-% the zero \parskip that the environments set -- \parskip glue will be
-% inserted at the beginning of the next paragraph in the document, after
-% the environment.
-%
-\def\nonfillfinish{\afterenvbreak\endgroup}
-
-% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font.
-\def\lisp{\begingroup
+ \else
+ \let\nonarrowing = \relax
+ \fi
+ \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
+}
+
+% If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
+% If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
+% This affects the following displayed environments:
+% @example, @display, @format, @lisp
+%
+\def\smallword{small}
+\def\nosmallword{nosmall}
+\let\SETdispenvsize\relax
+\def\setnormaldispenv{%
+ \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
+ % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
+ % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
+ % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
+ % to change the fonts afterward.
+ \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
+ \smallexamplefonts \rm
+ \fi
+}
+\def\setsmalldispenv{%
+ \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
+ \else
+ \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
+ \smallexamplefonts \rm
+ \fi
+}
+
+% We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
+% Let's do it by one command:
+\def\makedispenv #1#2{
+ \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}
+ \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}
+ \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
+ \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
+}
+
+% Define two synonyms:
+\def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{
+ \makedispenv{#1}{#3}
+ \makedispenv{#2}{#3}
+}
+
+% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp.
+%
+% @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
+% Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
+%
+\maketwodispenvs {lisp}{example}{%
\nonfillstart
- \let\Elisp = \nonfillfinish
- \tt
+ \tt\quoteexpand
\let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
\gobble % eat return
}
-
-% @example: Same as @lisp.
-\def\example{\begingroup \def\Eexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp}
-
-% @small... is usually equivalent to the non-small (@smallbook
-% redefines). We must call \example (or whatever) last in the
-% definition, since it reads the return following the @example (or
-% whatever) command.
-%
-% This actually allows (for example) @end display inside an
-% @smalldisplay. Too bad, but makeinfo will catch the error anyway.
-%
-\def\smalldisplay{\begingroup\def\Esmalldisplay{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\display}
-\def\smallexample{\begingroup\def\Esmallexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp}
-\def\smallformat{\begingroup\def\Esmallformat{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\format}
-\def\smalllisp{\begingroup\def\Esmalllisp{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp}
-
-% Real @smallexample and @smalllisp (when @smallbook): use smaller fonts.
-% Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
-\def\smalllispx{\begingroup
- \def\Esmalllisp{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}%
- \def\Esmallexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}%
- \smallfonts
- \lisp
-}
-
-% @display: same as @lisp except keep current font.
-%
-\def\display{\begingroup
+% @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
+%
+\makedispenv {display}{%
\nonfillstart
- \let\Edisplay = \nonfillfinish
\gobble
}
-% @smalldisplay (when @smallbook): @display plus smaller fonts.
-%
-\def\smalldisplayx{\begingroup
- \def\Esmalldisplay{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}%
- \smallfonts \rm
- \display
-}
-
-% @format: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
-%
-\def\format{\begingroup
- \let\nonarrowing = t
+% @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
+%
+\makedispenv{format}{%
+ \let\nonarrowing = t%
\nonfillstart
- \let\Eformat = \nonfillfinish
\gobble
}
-% @smallformat (when @smallbook): @format plus smaller fonts.
-%
-\def\smallformatx{\begingroup
- \def\Esmallformat{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}%
- \smallfonts \rm
- \format
-}
-
-% @flushleft (same as @format).
-%
-\def\flushleft{\begingroup \def\Eflushleft{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\format}
+% @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
+\envdef\flushleft{%
+ \let\nonarrowing = t%
+ \nonfillstart
+ \gobble
+}
+\let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
% @flushright.
%
-\def\flushright{\begingroup
- \let\nonarrowing = t
+\envdef\flushright{%
+ \let\nonarrowing = t%
\nonfillstart
- \let\Eflushright = \nonfillfinish
\advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill
\gobble
}
+\let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
+
% @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
-% and narrows the margins.
-%
-\def\quotation{%
- \begingroup\inENV %This group ends at the end of the @quotation body
+% and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
+% we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
+% \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
+%
+\envdef\quotation{%
{\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
- \singlespace
\parindent=0pt
- % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
- % doing normal filling. So to avoid extra space below the environment...
- \def\Equotation{\parskip = 0pt \nonfillfinish}%
%
% @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
\ifx\nonarrowing\relax
\advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
\advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
\exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
+ \else
\let\nonarrowing = \relax
\fi
+ \parsearg\quotationlabel
+}
+
+% We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
+% doing normal filling.
+%
+\def\Equotation{%
+ \par
+ \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else
+ % indent a bit.
+ \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
+ \fi
+ {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
+}
+
+% If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
+\def\quotationlabel#1{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\empty \else
+ {\bf #1: }%
+ \fi
+}
+
+
+% LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
+% If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
+% we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
+% `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke(a)gnu.org
+%
+% [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
+%
+% [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
+% active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
+% verbatim line.
+\def\dospecials{%
+ \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
+ \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
+ \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
+}
+%
+% [Knuth] p. 380
+\def\uncatcodespecials{%
+ \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
+%
+% [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
+% Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font
+\begingroup
+ \catcode`\`=\active\gdef`{\relax\lq}
+\endgroup
+%
+% Setup for the @verb command.
+%
+% Eight spaces for a tab
+\begingroup
+ \catcode`\^^I=\active
+ \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
+\endgroup
+%
+\def\setupverb{%
+ \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
+ \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
+ \catcode`\`=\active
+ \tabeightspaces
+ % Respect line breaks,
+ % print special symbols as themselves, and
+ % make each space count
+ % must do in this order:
+ \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
+}
+
+% Setup for the @verbatim environment
+%
+% Real tab expansion
+\newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
+%
+\def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup}
+
+% Allow an option to not replace quotes with a regular directed right
+% quote/apostrophe (char 0x27), but instead use the undirected quote
+% from cmtt (char 0x0d). The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it
+% the default, but it works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least
+% evince), the lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the
+% regular 0x27.
+%
+\def\codequoteright{%
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
+ '%
+ \else \char'15 \fi
+ \else \char'15 \fi
+}
+%
+% and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
+% Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
+% the code environments to do likewise.
+%
+\def\codequoteleft{%
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
+ `%
+ \else \char'22 \fi
+ \else \char'22 \fi
+}
+%
+\begingroup
+ \catcode`\^^I=\active
+ \gdef\tabexpand{%
+ \catcode`\^^I=\active
+ \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
+ \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab
+ \divide\dimen0 by\tabw
+ \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
+ \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
+ \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox
+ }%
+ }
+ \catcode`\'=\active
+ \gdef\rquoteexpand{\catcode\rquoteChar=\active \def'{\codequoteright}}%
+ %
+ \catcode`\`=\active
+ \gdef\lquoteexpand{\catcode\lquoteChar=\active \def`{\codequoteleft}}%
+ %
+ \gdef\quoteexpand{\rquoteexpand \lquoteexpand}%
+\endgroup
+
+% start the verbatim environment.
+\def\setupverbatim{%
+ \let\nonarrowing = t%
+ \nonfillstart
+ % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
+ \tt
+ \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}%
+ \catcode`\`=\active
+ \tabexpand
+ \quoteexpand
+ % Respect line breaks,
+ % print special symbols as themselves, and
+ % make each space count
+ % must do in this order:
+ \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
+ \everypar{\starttabbox}%
+}
+
+% Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
+% delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
+% right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
+%
+% \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
+%
+% [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
+\begingroup
+ \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
+ \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
+\endgroup
+%
+\def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
+%
+%
+% Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
+% the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
+%
+% \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
+%
+% For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
+% because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
+% we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
+%
+% Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
+%
+\begingroup
+ \catcode`\ =\active
+ \obeylines %
+ % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
+ % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
+ % line in the output.
+ \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
+ % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
+ % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
+\endgroup
+%
+\envdef\verbatim{%
+ \setupverbatim\doverbatim
+}
+\let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
+
+
+% @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
+%
+\def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
+%
+\def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
+ {%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \setupverbatim
+ \input #1
+ \afterenvbreak
+ }%
+}
+
+% @copying ... @end copying.
+% Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
+%
+% We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
+% Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
+% typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
+% beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
+% file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
+% possible is very desirable.
+%
+\def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
+\def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
+%
+\def\insertcopying{%
+ \begingroup
+ \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
+ \scanexp\copyingtext
+ \endgroup
}
\message{defuns,}
% @defun etc.
-% Allow user to change definition object font (\df) internally
-\def\setdeffont #1 {\csname DEF#1\endcsname}
-
\newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
\newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
-\newskip\deftypemargin \deftypemargin=12pt
\newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
-
-\newcount\parencount
-% define \functionparens, which makes ( and ) and & do special things.
-% \functionparens affects the group it is contained in.
+\newcount\defunpenalty
+
+% Start the processing of @deffn:
+\def\startdefun{%
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
+ \medbreak
+ \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
+ % following @def command, see below.
+ \else
+ % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
+ % which is there to keep the function description together with its
+ % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
+ % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
+ % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
+ % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
+ % a break between a section heading and a defun.
+ %
+ % As a minor refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
+ % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
+ % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
+ % @def command.
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
+ %
+ % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
+ % But do insert the glue.
+ \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
+ \fi
+ %
+ \parindent=0in
+ \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
+ \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
+}
+
+\def\dodefunx#1{%
+ % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
+ \checkenv#1%
+ %
+ % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
+ % It's not a great place, though.
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
+ %
+ % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
+ \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
+}
+\def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
+
+% \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
+%
+\def\printdefunline#1#2{%
+ \begingroup
+ % call \deffnheader:
+ #1#2 \endheader
+ % common ending:
+ \interlinepenalty = 10000
+ \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
+ \endgraf
+ \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
+ \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
+ % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
+ % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
+ \checkparencounts
+ \endgroup
+}
+
+\def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
+
+% \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
+% the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader.
+%
+\def\makedefun#1{%
+ \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
+ \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
+ \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
+ \temp
+}
+
+% \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
+%
+% Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
+% \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
+%
+\def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
+ \envdef#1{%
+ \startdefun
+ \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
+ }%
+ \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
+ \def#3%
+}
+
+%%% Untyped functions:
+
+% @deffn category name args
+\makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
+
+% @deffn category class name args
+\makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
+
+% \defopon {category on}class name args
+\def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
+
+% \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
+%
+\def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
+ % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
+ \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
+ \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
+}
+
+%%% Typed functions:
+
+% @deftypefn category type name args
+\makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
+
+% @deftypeop category class type name args
+\makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
+
+% \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
+\def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
+
+% \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
+%
+\def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
+ \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
+ \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
+}
+
+%%% Typed variables:
+
+% @deftypevr category type var args
+\makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
+
+% @deftypecv category class type var args
+\makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
+
+% \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
+\def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
+
+% \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
+%
+\def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
+ \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
+ \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
+}
+
+%%% Untyped variables:
+
+% @defvr category var args
+\makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
+
+% @defcv category class var args
+\makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
+
+% \defcvof {category of}class var args
+\def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
+
+%%% Type:
+% @deftp category name args
+\makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
+ \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
+ \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
+}
+
+% Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
+\makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
+\makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
+\makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
+\makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
+\makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
+\makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
+\makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
+\makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
+\makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
+\makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
+\makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
+
+% \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
+% #1 is the category, such as "Function".
+% #2 is the return type, if any.
+% #3 is the function name.
+%
+% We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
+%
+\def\defname#1#2#3{%
+ % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
+ \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
+ %
+ % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps
+ % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
+ % just below it.
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
+ %
+ % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.
+ % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
+ % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
+ \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
+ % The continuations:
+ \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
+ % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.)
+ \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2
+ %
+ % Put the type name to the right margin.
+ \noindent
+ \hbox to 0pt{%
+ \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
+ % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
+ \kern\leftskip
+ % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
+ }%
+ %
+ % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
+ \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
+ \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
+ {%
+ % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
+ % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
+ % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
+ % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
+ % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
+ % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
+ % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
+ % one has made identifiers using them :).
+ \df \tt
+ \def\temp{#2}% return value type
+ \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi
+ #3% output function name
+ }%
+ {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
+ %
+ \boldbrax
+ % arguments will be output next, if any.
+}
+
+% Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
+% tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
+% the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
+% distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
+%
+\def\defunargs#1{%
+ % use sl by default (not ttsl),
+ % tt for the names.
+ \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
+ %
+ % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
+ % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that.
+ \let\var=\ttslanted
+ #1%
+ \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
+}
+
+% We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
+%
\def\activeparens{%
-\catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active \catcode`\&=\active
-\catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active}
+ \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
+ \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
+ \catcode`\&=\active
+}
% Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
\let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
-
-{\activeparens % Now, smart parens don't turn on until &foo (see \amprm)
% Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
% if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
% so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
-\global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
-\global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
-
-\gdef\functionparens{\boldbrax\let&=\amprm\parencount=0 }
-\gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
-% This is used to turn on special parens
-% but make & act ordinary (given that it's active).
-\gdef\boldbraxnoamp{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb\let&=\ampnr}
-
-% Definitions of (, ) and & used in args for functions.
-% This is the definition of ( outside of all parentheses.
-\gdef\oprm#1 {{\rm\char`\(}#1 \bf \let(=\opnested
+{
+ \activeparens
+ \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
+ \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
+ \global\let& = \&
+
+ \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
+ \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
+}
+
+\newcount\parencount
+
+% If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
+\newif\ifampseen
+\def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\ }}
+
+\def\parenfont{%
+ \ifampseen
+ % At the first level, print parens in roman,
+ % otherwise use the default font.
+ \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
+ \else
+ % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
+ % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
+ \sf
+ \fi
+}
+\def\infirstlevel#1{%
+ \ifampseen
+ \ifnum\parencount=1
+ #1%
+ \fi
+ \fi
+}
+\def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
+
+\def\opnr{%
\global\advance\parencount by 1
-}
-%
-% This is the definition of ( when already inside a level of parens.
-\gdef\opnested{\char`\(\global\advance\parencount by 1 }
-%
-\gdef\clrm{% Print a paren in roman if it is taking us back to depth of 0.
- % also in that case restore the outer-level definition of (.
- \ifnum \parencount=1 {\rm \char `\)}\sl \let(=\oprm \else \char `\) \fi
- \global\advance \parencount by -1 }
-% If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
-\gdef\amprm#1 {{\rm\}\let(=\oprm \let)=\clrm\ }
-%
-\gdef\normalparens{\boldbrax\let&=\ampnr}
-} % End of definition inside \activeparens
-%% These parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than the
-%% contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ]
-\def\opnr{{\sf\char`\(}\global\advance\parencount by 1 }
-\def\clnr{{\sf\char`\)}\global\advance\parencount by -1 }
-\let\ampnr = \&
-\def\lbrb{{\bf\char`\[}}
-\def\rbrb{{\bf\char`\]}}
-
-% Active &'s sneak into the index arguments, so make sure it's defined.
-{
- \catcode`& = 13
- \global\let& = \ampnr
-}
-
-% First, defname, which formats the header line itself.
-% #1 should be the function name.
-% #2 should be the type of definition, such as "Function".
-
-\def\defname #1#2{%
-% Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were
-% outside the @def...
-\dimen2=\leftskip
-\advance\dimen2 by -\defbodyindent
-\noindent
-\setbox0=\hbox{\hskip \deflastargmargin{\rm #2}\hskip \deftypemargin}%
-\dimen0=\hsize \advance \dimen0 by -\wd0 % compute size for first line
-\dimen1=\hsize \advance \dimen1 by -\defargsindent %size for continuations
-\parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen1
-% Now output arg 2 ("Function" or some such)
-% ending at \deftypemargin from the right margin,
-% but stuck inside a box of width 0 so it does not interfere with linebreaking
-{% Adjust \hsize to exclude the ambient margins,
-% so that \rightline will obey them.
-\advance \hsize by -\dimen2
-\rlap{\rightline{{\rm #2}\hskip -1.25pc }}}%
-% Make all lines underfull and no complaints:
-\tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
-\advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
-\exdentamount=\defbodyindent
-{\df #1}\enskip % Generate function name
-}
-
-% Actually process the body of a definition
-% #1 should be the terminating control sequence, such as \Edefun.
-% #2 should be the "another name" control sequence, such as \defunx.
-% #3 should be the control sequence that actually processes the header,
-% such as \defunheader.
-
-\def\defparsebody #1#2#3{\begingroup\inENV% Environment for definitionbody
-\medbreak %
-% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies
-% so that it will exit this group.
-\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
-\def#2{\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit#3}%
-\parindent=0in
-\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
-\exdentamount=\defbodyindent
-\begingroup %
-\catcode 61=\active % 61 is `='
-\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit#3}
-
-% #1 is the \E... control sequence to end the definition (which we define).
-% #2 is the \...x control sequence for consecutive fns (which we define).
-% #3 is the control sequence to call to resume processing.
-% #4, delimited by the space, is the class name.
-%
-\def\defmethparsebody#1#2#3#4 {\begingroup\inENV %
-\medbreak %
-% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies
-% so that it will exit this group.
-\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
-\def#2##1 {\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##1}}}%
-\parindent=0in
-\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
-\exdentamount=\defbodyindent
-\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#4}}}
-
-% Used for @deftypemethod and @deftypeivar.
-% #1 is the \E... control sequence to end the definition (which we define).
-% #2 is the \...x control sequence for consecutive fns (which we define).
-% #3 is the control sequence to call to resume processing.
-% #4, delimited by a space, is the class name.
-% #5 is the method's return type.
-%
-\def\deftypemethparsebody#1#2#3#4 #5 {\begingroup\inENV
- \medbreak
- \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
- \def#2##1 ##2 {\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##1}{##2}}}%
- \parindent=0in
- \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
- \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
- \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#4}{#5}}}
-
-% Used for @deftypeop. The change from \deftypemethparsebody is an
-% extra argument at the beginning which is the `category', instead of it
-% being the hardwired string `Method' or `Instance Variable'. We have
-% to account for this both in the \...x definition and in parsing the
-% input at hand. Thus also need a control sequence (passed as #5) for
-% the \E... definition to assign the category name to.
-%
-\def\deftypeopparsebody#1#2#3#4#5 #6 {\begingroup\inENV
- \medbreak
- \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
- \def#2##1 ##2 ##3 {%
- \def#4{##1}%
- \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##2}{##3}}}%
- \parindent=0in
- \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
- \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
- \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#5}{#6}}}
-
-\def\defopparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {\begingroup\inENV %
-\medbreak %
-% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies
-% so that it will exit this group.
-\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
-\def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}%
-\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##2}}}%
-\parindent=0in
-\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
-\exdentamount=\defbodyindent
-\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#5}}}
-
-% These parsing functions are similar to the preceding ones
-% except that they do not make parens into active characters.
-% These are used for "variables" since they have no arguments.
-
-\def\defvarparsebody #1#2#3{\begingroup\inENV% Environment for definitionbody
-\medbreak %
-% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies
-% so that it will exit this group.
-\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
-\def#2{\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit#3}%
-\parindent=0in
-\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
-\exdentamount=\defbodyindent
-\begingroup %
-\catcode 61=\active %
-\obeylines\spacesplit#3}
-
-% This is used for \def{tp,vr}parsebody. It could probably be used for
-% some of the others, too, with some judicious conditionals.
-%
-\def\parsebodycommon#1#2#3{%
- \begingroup\inENV %
- \medbreak %
- % Define the end token that this defining construct specifies
- % so that it will exit this group.
- \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
- \def#2##1 {\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{##1}}}%
- \parindent=0in
- \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
- \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
- \begingroup\obeylines
-}
-
-\def\defvrparsebody#1#2#3#4 {%
- \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}%
- \spacesplit{#3{#4}}%
-}
-
-% This loses on `@deftp {Data Type} {struct termios}' -- it thinks the
-% type is just `struct', because we lose the braces in `{struct
-% termios}' when \spacesplit reads its undelimited argument. Sigh.
-% \let\deftpparsebody=\defvrparsebody
-%
-% So, to get around this, we put \empty in with the type name. That
-% way, TeX won't find exactly `{...}' as an undelimited argument, and
-% won't strip off the braces.
-%
-\def\deftpparsebody #1#2#3#4 {%
- \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}%
- \spacesplit{\parsetpheaderline{#3{#4}}}\empty
-}
-
-% Fine, but then we have to eventually remove the \empty *and* the
-% braces (if any). That's what this does.
-%
-\def\removeemptybraces\empty#1\relax{#1}
-
-% After \spacesplit has done its work, this is called -- #1 is the final
-% thing to call, #2 the type name (which starts with \empty), and #3
-% (which might be empty) the arguments.
-%
-\def\parsetpheaderline#1#2#3{%
- #1{\removeemptybraces#2\relax}{#3}%
-}%
-
-\def\defopvarparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {\begingroup\inENV %
-\medbreak %
-% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies
-% so that it will exit this group.
-\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
-\def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}%
-\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{##2}}}%
-\parindent=0in
-\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
-\exdentamount=\defbodyindent
-\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{#5}}}
-
-% Split up #2 at the first space token.
-% call #1 with two arguments:
-% the first is all of #2 before the space token,
-% the second is all of #2 after that space token.
-% If #2 contains no space token, all of it is passed as the first arg
-% and the second is passed as empty.
-
-{\obeylines
-\gdef\spacesplit#1#2^^M{\endgroup\spacesplitfoo{#1}#2 \relax\spacesplitfoo}%
-\long\gdef\spacesplitfoo#1#2 #3#4\spacesplitfoo{%
-\ifx\relax #3%
-#1{#2}{}\else #1{#2}{#3#4}\fi}}
-
-% So much for the things common to all kinds of definitions.
-
-% Define @defun.
-
-% First, define the processing that is wanted for arguments of \defun
-% Use this to expand the args and terminate the paragraph they make up
-
-\def\defunargs#1{\functionparens \sl
-% Expand, preventing hyphenation at `-' chars.
-% Note that groups don't affect changes in \hyphenchar.
-% Set the font temporarily and use \font in case \setfont made \tensl a macro.
-{\tensl\hyphenchar\font=0}%
-#1%
-{\tensl\hyphenchar\font=45}%
-\ifnum\parencount=0 \else \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}\fi%
-\interlinepenalty=10000
-\advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
-\endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak
-}
-
-\def\deftypefunargs #1{%
-% Expand, preventing hyphenation at `-' chars.
-% Note that groups don't affect changes in \hyphenchar.
-% Use \boldbraxnoamp, not \functionparens, so that & is not special.
-\boldbraxnoamp
-\tclose{#1}% avoid \code because of side effects on active chars
-\interlinepenalty=10000
-\advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
-\endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak
-}
-
-% Do complete processing of one @defun or @defunx line already parsed.
-
-% @deffn Command forward-char nchars
-
-\def\deffn{\defmethparsebody\Edeffn\deffnx\deffnheader}
-
-\def\deffnheader #1#2#3{\doind {fn}{\code{#2}}%
-\begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\defunargs{#3}\endgroup %
-\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
-}
-
-% @defun == @deffn Function
-
-\def\defun{\defparsebody\Edefun\defunx\defunheader}
-
-\def\defunheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index
-\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDeffunc}%
-\defunargs {#2}\endgroup %
-\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
-}
-
-% @deftypefun int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar})
-
-\def\deftypefun{\defparsebody\Edeftypefun\deftypefunx\deftypefunheader}
-
-% #1 is the data type. #2 is the name and args.
-\def\deftypefunheader #1#2{\deftypefunheaderx{#1}#2 \relax}
-% #1 is the data type, #2 the name, #3 the args.
-\def\deftypefunheaderx #1#2 #3\relax{%
-\doind {fn}{\code{#2}}% Make entry in function index
-\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$$$#2}{\putwordDeftypefun}%
-\deftypefunargs {#3}\endgroup %
-\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
-}
-
-% @deftypefn {Library Function} int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar})
-
-\def\deftypefn{\defmethparsebody\Edeftypefn\deftypefnx\deftypefnheader}
-
-% \defheaderxcond#1\relax$$$
-% puts #1 in @code, followed by a space, but does nothing if #1 is null.
-\def\defheaderxcond#1#2$$${\ifx#1\relax\else\code{#1#2} \fi}
-
-% #1 is the classification. #2 is the data type. #3 is the name and args.
-\def\deftypefnheader #1#2#3{\deftypefnheaderx{#1}{#2}#3 \relax}
-% #1 is the classification, #2 the data type, #3 the name, #4 the args.
-\def\deftypefnheaderx #1#2#3 #4\relax{%
-\doind {fn}{\code{#3}}% Make entry in function index
-\begingroup
-\normalparens % notably, turn off `&' magic, which prevents
-% at least some C++ text from working
-\defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$$$#3}{#1}%
-\deftypefunargs {#4}\endgroup %
-\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
-}
-
-% @defmac == @deffn Macro
-
-\def\defmac{\defparsebody\Edefmac\defmacx\defmacheader}
-
-\def\defmacheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index
-\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefmac}%
-\defunargs {#2}\endgroup %
-\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
-}
-
-% @defspec == @deffn Special Form
-
-\def\defspec{\defparsebody\Edefspec\defspecx\defspecheader}
-
-\def\defspecheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index
-\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefspec}%
-\defunargs {#2}\endgroup %
-\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
-}
-
-% @defop CATEGORY CLASS OPERATION ARG...
-%
-\def\defop #1 {\def\defoptype{#1}%
-\defopparsebody\Edefop\defopx\defopheader\defoptype}
-%
-\def\defopheader#1#2#3{%
-\dosubind {fn}{\code{#2}}{\putwordon\ #1}% Make entry in function index
-\begingroup\defname {#2}{\defoptype\ \putwordon\ #1}%
-\defunargs {#3}\endgroup %
-}
-
-% @deftypeop CATEGORY CLASS TYPE OPERATION ARG...
-%
-\def\deftypeop #1 {\def\deftypeopcategory{#1}%
- \deftypeopparsebody\Edeftypeop\deftypeopx\deftypeopheader
- \deftypeopcategory}
-%
-% #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the operation name, #4 the args.
-\def\deftypeopheader#1#2#3#4{%
- \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index
- \begingroup
- \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$$$#3}
- {\deftypeopcategory\ \putwordon\ \code{#1}}%
- \deftypefunargs{#4}%
- \endgroup
-}
-
-% @deftypemethod CLASS TYPE METHOD ARG...
-%
-\def\deftypemethod{%
- \deftypemethparsebody\Edeftypemethod\deftypemethodx\deftypemethodheader}
-%
-% #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the method name, #4 the args.
-\def\deftypemethodheader#1#2#3#4{%
- \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index
- \begingroup
- \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$$$#3}{\putwordMethodon\ \code{#1}}%
- \deftypefunargs{#4}%
- \endgroup
-}
-
-% @deftypeivar CLASS TYPE VARNAME
-%
-\def\deftypeivar{%
- \deftypemethparsebody\Edeftypeivar\deftypeivarx\deftypeivarheader}
-%
-% #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the variable name.
-\def\deftypeivarheader#1#2#3{%
- \dosubind{vr}{\code{#3}}{\putwordof\ \code{#1}}% entry in variable index
- \begingroup
- \defname{#3}{\putwordInstanceVariableof\ \code{#1}}%
- \defvarargs{#3}%
- \endgroup
-}
-
-% @defmethod == @defop Method
-%
-\def\defmethod{\defmethparsebody\Edefmethod\defmethodx\defmethodheader}
-%
-% #1 is the class name, #2 the method name, #3 the args.
-\def\defmethodheader#1#2#3{%
- \dosubind{fn}{\code{#2}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index
- \begingroup
- \defname{#2}{\putwordMethodon\ \code{#1}}%
- \defunargs{#3}%
- \endgroup
-}
-
-% @defcv {Class Option} foo-class foo-flag
-
-\def\defcv #1 {\def\defcvtype{#1}%
-\defopvarparsebody\Edefcv\defcvx\defcvarheader\defcvtype}
-
-\def\defcvarheader #1#2#3{%
-\dosubind {vr}{\code{#2}}{\putwordof\ #1}% Make entry in var index
-\begingroup\defname {#2}{\defcvtype\ \putwordof\ #1}%
-\defvarargs {#3}\endgroup %
-}
-
-% @defivar CLASS VARNAME == @defcv {Instance Variable} CLASS VARNAME
-%
-\def\defivar{\defvrparsebody\Edefivar\defivarx\defivarheader}
-%
-\def\defivarheader#1#2#3{%
- \dosubind {vr}{\code{#2}}{\putwordof\ #1}% entry in var index
- \begingroup
- \defname{#2}{\putwordInstanceVariableof\ #1}%
- \defvarargs{#3}%
- \endgroup
-}
-
-% @defvar
-% First, define the processing that is wanted for arguments of @defvar.
-% This is actually simple: just print them in roman.
-% This must expand the args and terminate the paragraph they make up
-\def\defvarargs #1{\normalparens #1%
-\interlinepenalty=10000
-\endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak}
-
-% @defvr Counter foo-count
-
-\def\defvr{\defvrparsebody\Edefvr\defvrx\defvrheader}
-
-\def\defvrheader #1#2#3{\doind {vr}{\code{#2}}%
-\begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\defvarargs{#3}\endgroup}
-
-% @defvar == @defvr Variable
-
-\def\defvar{\defvarparsebody\Edefvar\defvarx\defvarheader}
-
-\def\defvarheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index
-\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefvar}%
-\defvarargs {#2}\endgroup %
-}
-
-% @defopt == @defvr {User Option}
-
-\def\defopt{\defvarparsebody\Edefopt\defoptx\defoptheader}
-
-\def\defoptheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index
-\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefopt}%
-\defvarargs {#2}\endgroup %
-}
-
-% @deftypevar int foobar
-
-\def\deftypevar{\defvarparsebody\Edeftypevar\deftypevarx\deftypevarheader}
-
-% #1 is the data type. #2 is the name, perhaps followed by text that
-% is actually part of the data type, which should not be put into the index.
-\def\deftypevarheader #1#2{%
-\dovarind#2 \relax% Make entry in variables index
-\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$$$#2}{\putwordDeftypevar}%
-\interlinepenalty=10000
-\endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak
-\endgroup}
-\def\dovarind#1 #2\relax{\doind{vr}{\code{#1}}}
-
-% @deftypevr {Global Flag} int enable
-
-\def\deftypevr{\defvrparsebody\Edeftypevr\deftypevrx\deftypevrheader}
-
-\def\deftypevrheader #1#2#3{\dovarind#3 \relax%
-\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$$$#3}{#1}
-\interlinepenalty=10000
-\endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak
-\endgroup}
-
-% Now define @deftp
-% Args are printed in bold, a slight difference from @defvar.
-
-\def\deftpargs #1{\bf \defvarargs{#1}}
-
-% @deftp Class window height width ...
-
-\def\deftp{\deftpparsebody\Edeftp\deftpx\deftpheader}
-
-\def\deftpheader #1#2#3{\doind {tp}{\code{#2}}%
-\begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\deftpargs{#3}\endgroup}
-
-% These definitions are used if you use @defunx (etc.)
-% anywhere other than immediately after a @defun or @defunx.
-%
-\def\defcvx#1 {\errmessage{@defcvx in invalid context}}
-\def\deffnx#1 {\errmessage{@deffnx in invalid context}}
-\def\defivarx#1 {\errmessage{@defivarx in invalid context}}
-\def\defmacx#1 {\errmessage{@defmacx in invalid context}}
-\def\defmethodx#1 {\errmessage{@defmethodx in invalid context}}
-\def\defoptx #1 {\errmessage{@defoptx in invalid context}}
-\def\defopx#1 {\errmessage{@defopx in invalid context}}
-\def\defspecx#1 {\errmessage{@defspecx in invalid context}}
-\def\deftpx#1 {\errmessage{@deftpx in invalid context}}
-\def\deftypefnx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypefnx in invalid context}}
-\def\deftypefunx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypefunx in invalid context}}
-\def\deftypeivarx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypeivarx in invalid context}}
-\def\deftypemethodx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypemethodx in invalid context}}
-\def\deftypeopx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypeopx in invalid context}}
-\def\deftypevarx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypevarx in invalid context}}
-\def\deftypevrx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypevrx in invalid context}}
-\def\defunx#1 {\errmessage{@defunx in invalid context}}
-\def\defvarx#1 {\errmessage{@defvarx in invalid context}}
-\def\defvrx#1 {\errmessage{@defvrx in invalid context}}
+ {\parenfont(}%
+ \infirstlevel \bfafterword
+}
+\def\clnr{%
+ {\parenfont)}%
+ \infirstlevel \sl
+ \global\advance\parencount by -1
+}
+
+\newcount\brackcount
+\def\lbrb{%
+ \global\advance\brackcount by 1
+ {\bf[}%
+}
+\def\rbrb{%
+ {\bf]}%
+ \global\advance\brackcount by -1
+}
+
+\def\checkparencounts{%
+ \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
+ \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
+}
+% these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
+% has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
+\def\badparencount{%
+ \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}%
+ \global\parencount=0
+}
+\def\badbrackcount{%
+ \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}%
+ \global\brackcount=0
+}
\message{macros,}
@@ -4850,42 +6552,68 @@
% To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
% which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
\ifx\eTeXversion\undefined
- \newwrite\macscribble
- \def\scanmacro#1{%
- \begingroup \newlinechar`\^^M
- % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
- \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=12 \escapechar=`\@
- % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
- \toks0={#1\endinput}%
- \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
- \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
- \immediate\closeout\macscribble
- \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
- \input \jobname.tmp
- \endgroup
-}
-\else
+ \newwrite\macscribble
+ \def\scantokens#1{%
+ \toks0={#1}%
+ \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
+ \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
+ \immediate\closeout\macscribble
+ \input \jobname.tmp
+ }
+\fi
+
\def\scanmacro#1{%
-\begingroup \newlinechar`\^^M
-% Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
-\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=12 \escapechar=`\@
-\let\xeatspaces\eatspaces\scantokens{#1\endinput}\endgroup}
-\fi
+ \begingroup
+ \newlinechar`\^^M
+ \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
+ % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
+ % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
+ % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
+ % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
+ % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
+ \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
+ % ... and \example
+ \spaceisspace
+ %
+ % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
+ % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX
+ % --kasal, 29nov03
+ \scantokens{#1\endinput}%
+ \endgroup
+}
+
+\def\scanexp#1{%
+ \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
+ \temp
+}
\newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
\newtoks\macname % Macro name
\newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
-\def\macrolist{} % List of all defined macros in the form
- % \do\macro1\do\macro2...
+
+% List of all defined macros in the form
+% \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
+% Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
+% if there is a need.
+\def\macrolist{}
+
+% Add the macro to \macrolist
+\def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
+\def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
+ \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
+ \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
+}
% Utility routines.
-% Thisdoes \let #1 = #2, except with \csnames.
+% This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
+% \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
+% (except of course we have to play expansion games).
+%
\def\cslet#1#2{%
-\expandafter\expandafter
-\expandafter\let
-\expandafter\expandafter
-\csname#1\endcsname
-\csname#2\endcsname}
+ \expandafter\let
+ \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
+ \csname#2\endcsname
+}
% Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
% Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
@@ -4898,7 +6626,7 @@
}
% Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
-{\catcode`\^^M=12\catcode`\Q=3%
+{\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
\gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
\gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
\gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
@@ -4908,34 +6636,45 @@
% all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
% (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \.
+% Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
+% them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
+% confine the change to the current group.
+
% It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
% done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
% body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
+\def\scanctxt{%
+ \catcode`\"=\other
+ \catcode`\+=\other
+ \catcode`\<=\other
+ \catcode`\>=\other
+ \catcode`\@=\other
+ \catcode`\^=\other
+ \catcode`\_=\other
+ \catcode`\|=\other
+ \catcode`\~=\other
+ \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi
+}
+
+\def\scanargctxt{%
+ \scanctxt
+ \catcode`\\=\other
+ \catcode`\^^M=\other
+}
+
\def\macrobodyctxt{%
- \catcode`\~=12
- \catcode`\^=12
- \catcode`\_=12
- \catcode`\|=12
- \catcode`\<=12
- \catcode`\>=12
- \catcode`\+=12
- \catcode`\{=12
- \catcode`\}=12
- \catcode`\@=12
- \catcode`\^^M=12
- \usembodybackslash}
+ \scanctxt
+ \catcode`\{=\other
+ \catcode`\}=\other
+ \catcode`\^^M=\other
+ \usembodybackslash
+}
\def\macroargctxt{%
- \catcode`\~=12
- \catcode`\^=12
- \catcode`\_=12
- \catcode`\|=12
- \catcode`\<=12
- \catcode`\>=12
- \catcode`\+=12
- \catcode`\@=12
- \catcode`\\=12}
+ \scanctxt
+ \catcode`\\=\other
+}
% \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
% It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
@@ -4963,42 +6702,39 @@
\message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
\else
\expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
- \else \errmessage{The name \the\macname\space is reserved}\fi
+ \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
\global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
\global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
- % Add the macroname to \macrolist
- \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\do}%
- \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname\endcsname}%
+ \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
\fi
\begingroup \macrobodyctxt
\ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
\else \expandafter\parsemacbody
\fi}
-\def\unmacro{\parsearg\unmacroxxx}
-\def\unmacroxxx#1{%
+\parseargdef\unmacro{%
\if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
\global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
\global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
- % Remove the macro name from \macrolist
+ % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
\begingroup
- \edef\tempa{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}%
- \def\do##1{%
- \def\tempb{##1}%
- \ifx\tempa\tempb
- % remove this
- \else
- \toks0 = \expandafter{\newmacrolist\do}%
- \edef\newmacrolist{\the\toks0\expandafter\noexpand\tempa}%
- \fi}%
- \def\newmacrolist{}%
- % Execute macro list to define \newmacrolist
- \macrolist
- \global\let\macrolist\newmacrolist
+ \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
+ \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
+ \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
\endgroup
\else
\errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
+ \fi
+}
+
+% Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
+% macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
+%
+\def\unmacrodo#1{%
+ \ifx #1\relax
+ % remove this
+ \else
+ \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
\fi
}
@@ -5111,34 +6847,31 @@
% {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
% line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
% as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg)
-\def\braceorline#1{\let\next=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
+\def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
\def\braceorlinexxx{%
\ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
\expandafter\parsearg
- \fi \next}
-
-% We mant to disable all macros during \shipout so that they are not
-% expanded by \write.
-\def\turnoffmacros{\begingroup \def\do##1{\let\noexpand##1=\relax}%
- \edef\next{\macrolist}\expandafter\endgroup\next}
+ \fi \macnamexxx}
% @alias.
% We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
% sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
-\def\alias{\begingroup\obeyspaces\parsearg\aliasxxx}
+\def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
\def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
-\def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{\ignoreactivespaces
-\edef\next{\global\let\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname=%
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname#2\endcsname}%
-\expandafter\endgroup\next}
+\def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
+ {%
+ \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
+ \addtomacrolist{#1}%
+ \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
+ }%
+ \next
+}
\message{cross references,}
-% @xref etc.
\newwrite\auxfile
-
\newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
\newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
@@ -5147,56 +6880,68 @@
\def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{}
\file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
-% @node's job is to define \lastnode.
-\def\node{\ENVcheck\parsearg\nodezzz}
-\def\nodezzz#1{\nodexxx [#1,]}
-\def\nodexxx[#1,#2]{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
+% @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
+% cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
+% might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
+% @node foo , bar , ...
+% We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
+%
+\parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
+%
+% also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
+% @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
+\def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
+\def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
+
\let\nwnode=\node
-\let\lastnode=\relax
-
-% The sectioning commands (@chapter, etc.) call these.
-\def\donoderef{%
- \ifx\lastnode\relax\else
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}%
- {Ysectionnumberandtype}%
- \global\let\lastnode=\relax
- \fi
-}
-\def\unnumbnoderef{%
- \ifx\lastnode\relax\else
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}{Ynothing}%
- \global\let\lastnode=\relax
- \fi
-}
-\def\appendixnoderef{%
- \ifx\lastnode\relax\else
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}%
- {Yappendixletterandtype}%
- \global\let\lastnode=\relax
- \fi
-}
-
+\let\lastnode=\empty
+
+% Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
+% type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
+%
+\def\donoderef#1{%
+ \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
+ \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
+ \global\let\lastnode=\empty
+ \fi
+}
% @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
%
\newcount\savesfregister
-\gdef\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
-\gdef\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
-\gdef\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
-
-% \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME, namely
-% NAME-title, NAME-pg, and NAME-SNT. Called from \foonoderef. We have
-% to set \indexdummies so commands such as @code in a section title
-% aren't expanded. It would be nicer not to expand the titles in the
-% first place, but there's so many layers that that is hard to do.
-%
-\def\setref#1#2{{%
- \indexdummies
+%
+\def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
+\def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
+\def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
+
+% \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
+% anchor), which consists of three parts:
+% 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
+% or the anchor name.
+% 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
+% empty for anchors.
+% 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
+%
+% This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
+% floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
+% 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
+%
+\def\setref#1#2{%
\pdfmkdest{#1}%
- \dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}%
- \dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}%
- \dosetq{#1-snt}{#2}%
-}}
+ \iflinks
+ {%
+ \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
+ \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
+ \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
+ ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
+ }%
+ \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}%
+ \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
+ \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
+ \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, during \shipout
+ }%
+ \fi
+}
% @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
% the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
@@ -5209,135 +6954,162 @@
\def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
\unsepspaces
\def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
- \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #3}%
- \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual}%
- \setbox0=\hbox{\printednodename}%
+ \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
+ \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
+ \setbox0=\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
\ifdim \wd0 = 0pt
% No printed node name was explicitly given.
\expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax
% Use the node name inside the square brackets.
- \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}%
+ \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
\else
% Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside
% the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it.
\ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
% It is in another manual, so we don't have it.
- \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}%
+ \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
\else
\ifhavexrefs
% We know the real title if we have the xref values.
- \def\printednodename{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
+ \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
\else
% Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
- \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}%
+ \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
\fi%
\fi
\fi
\fi
%
- % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
- % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
- % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
- % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
- % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
- % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
+ % Make link in pdf output.
\ifpdf
- \leavevmode
- \getfilename{#4}%
- \ifnum\filenamelength>0
- \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
- goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{#1@}%
- \else
- \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
- goto name{#1@}%
- \fi
- \linkcolor
- \fi
- %
- \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
- \putwordsection{} ``\printednodename'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
- \else
- % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
- % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
- % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
- % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
- % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
- {\normalturnoffactive
- % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
- % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
- \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
- \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
- }%
- % [mynode],
- [\printednodename],\space
- % page 3
- \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
+ {\indexnofonts
+ \turnoffactive
+ % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
+ % etc. don't get their TeX definitions.
+ \getfilename{#4}%
+ %
+ % See comments at \activebackslashdouble.
+ {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
+ \backslashparens\pdfxrefdest}%
+ %
+ \leavevmode
+ \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
+ \ifnum\filenamelength>0
+ goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}%
+ \else
+ goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
+ \fi
+ }%
+ \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
+ % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
+ % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
+ {%
+ % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
+ % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
+ \indexnofonts
+ \turnoffactive
+ \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
+ \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
+ }%
+ \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
+ % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
+ % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
+ \ifdim\wd0 = 0pt
+ \refx{#1-snt}{}%
+ \else
+ \printedrefname
+ \fi
+ %
+ % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
+ % "in MANUALNAME".
+ \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
+ \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
+ \fi
+ \else
+ % node/anchor (non-float) references.
+ %
+ % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
+ % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
+ % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
+ % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
+ % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
+ % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
+ \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
+ \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
+ \else
+ % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
+ % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
+ % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
+ % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
+ % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
+ {\turnoffactive
+ % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
+ % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
+ \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
+ \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
+ }%
+ % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden.
+ \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
+ %
+ % But we always want a comma and a space:
+ ,\space
+ %
+ % output the `page 3'.
+ \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
+ \fi
\fi
\endlink
\endgroup}
-% \dosetq is the interface for calls from other macros
-
-% Use \normalturnoffactive so that punctuation chars such as underscore
-% and backslash work in node names. (\turnoffactive doesn't do \.)
-\def\dosetq#1#2{%
- {\let\folio=0%
- \normalturnoffactive
- \edef\next{\write\auxfile{\internalsetq{#1}{#2}}}%
- \iflinks
- \next
- \fi
- }%
-}
-
-% \internalsetq {foo}{page} expands into
-% CHARACTERS 'xrdef {foo}{...expansion of \Ypage...}
-% When the aux file is read, ' is the escape character
-
-\def\internalsetq #1#2{'xrdef {#1}{\csname #2\endcsname}}
-
-% Things to be expanded by \internalsetq
-
-\def\Ypagenumber{\folio}
-
-\def\Ytitle{\thissection}
-
+% This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
+% output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
+% since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
+% one that Bob is working on :).
+%
+\def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
+
+% Things referred to by \setref.
+%
\def\Ynothing{}
-
-\def\Ysectionnumberandtype{%
-\ifnum\secno=0 \putwordChapter\xreftie\the\chapno %
-\else \ifnum \subsecno=0 \putwordSection\xreftie\the\chapno.\the\secno %
-\else \ifnum \subsubsecno=0 %
-\putwordSection\xreftie\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno %
-\else %
-\putwordSection\xreftie\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno %
-\fi \fi \fi }
-
-\def\Yappendixletterandtype{%
-\ifnum\secno=0 \putwordAppendix\xreftie'char\the\appendixno{}%
-\else \ifnum \subsecno=0 \putwordSection\xreftie'char\the\appendixno.\the\secno %
-\else \ifnum \subsubsecno=0 %
-\putwordSection\xreftie'char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno %
-\else %
-\putwordSection\xreftie'char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
%
-\fi \fi \fi }
-
-\gdef\xreftie{'tie}
-
-% Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
-% messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
-%
-\ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
- \let\linenumber = \empty % Non-3.0.
-\else
- \def\linenumber{\the\inputlineno:\space}
-\fi
+\def\Yomitfromtoc{}
+\def\Ynumbered{%
+ \ifnum\secno=0
+ \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
+ \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
+ \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
+ \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
+ \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
+ \else
+ \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
+ \fi\fi\fi
+}
+\def\Yappendix{%
+ \ifnum\secno=0
+ \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
+ \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
+ \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
+ \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
+ \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
+ \else
+ \putwordSection@tie
+ @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
+ \fi\fi\fi
+}
% Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
% If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
-
+%
\def\refx#1#2{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname X#1\endcsname\relax
+ {%
+ \indexnofonts
+ \otherbackslash
+ \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
+ \csname XR#1\endcsname
+ }%
+ \ifx\thisrefX\relax
% If not defined, say something at least.
\angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
\iflinks
@@ -5352,22 +7124,59 @@
\fi
\else
% It's defined, so just use it.
- \csname X#1\endcsname
+ \thisrefX
\fi
#2% Output the suffix in any case.
}
-% This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file.
-%
-\def\xrdef#1{\begingroup
- % Reenable \ as an escape while reading the second argument.
- \catcode`\\ = 0
- \afterassignment\endgroup
- \expandafter\gdef\csname X#1\endcsname
+% This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
+% just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
+% collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
+%
+\def\xrdef#1#2{%
+ {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current
+ % implementation are changed to commands like @'e. Don't let these
+ % mess up the control sequence name.
+ \indexnofonts
+ \turnoffactive
+ \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
+ }%
+ %
+ \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref
+ %
+ % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
+ \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname
+ % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
+ \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
+ \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
+ %
+ % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
+ \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
+ \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
+ \else
+ % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
+ \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
+ % for later use in \listoffloats.
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
+ {\safexrefname}}%
+ \fi
}
% Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
-\def\readauxfile{\begingroup
+%
+\def\tryauxfile{%
+ \openin 1 \jobname.aux
+ \ifeof 1 \else
+ \readdatafile{aux}%
+ \global\havexrefstrue
+ \fi
+ \closein 1
+}
+
+\def\setupdatafile{%
\catcode`\^^@=\other
\catcode`\^^A=\other
\catcode`\^^B=\other
@@ -5395,9 +7204,7 @@
\catcode`\^^]=\other
\catcode`\^^^=\other
\catcode`\^^_=\other
- \catcode`\@=\other
- \catcode`\^=\other
- % It was suggested to define this as 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
+ % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
% in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
% supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
% that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
@@ -5410,6 +7217,9 @@
% \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
% and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
%
+ \catcode`\^=\other
+ %
+ % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
\catcode`\~=\other
\catcode`\[=\other
\catcode`\]=\other
@@ -5421,41 +7231,43 @@
\catcode`\$=\other
\catcode`\#=\other
\catcode`\&=\other
+ \catcode`\%=\other
\catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
- % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters
- {%
- \count 1=128
+ %
+ % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
+ % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
+ % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
+ % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
+ % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
+ % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
+ % now. --karl, 15jan04.
+ \catcode`\\=\other
+ %
+ % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
+ {%
+ \count1=128
\def\loop{%
- \catcode\count 1=\other
- \advance\count 1 by 1
- \ifnum \count 1<256 \loop \fi
- }%
- }%
- % The aux file uses ' as the escape (for now).
- % Turn off \ as an escape so we do not lose on
- % entries which were dumped with control sequences in their names.
- % For example, 'xrdef {$\leq $-fun}{page ...} made by @defun ^^
- % Reference to such entries still does not work the way one would wish,
- % but at least they do not bomb out when the aux file is read in.
+ \catcode\count1=\other
+ \advance\count1 by 1
+ \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi
+ }%
+ }%
+ %
+ % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
\catcode`\{=1
\catcode`\}=2
- \catcode`\%=\other
- \catcode`\'=0
- \catcode`\\=\other
- %
- \openin 1 \jobname.aux
- \ifeof 1 \else
- \closein 1
- \input \jobname.aux
- \global\havexrefstrue
- \global\warnedobstrue
- \fi
- % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
- \openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
-\endgroup}
-
-
-% Footnotes.
+ \catcode`\@=0
+}
+
+\def\readdatafile#1{%
+\begingroup
+ \setupdatafile
+ \input\jobname.#1
+\endgroup}
+
+
+\message{insertions,}
+% including footnotes.
\newcount \footnoteno
@@ -5469,37 +7281,39 @@
% @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only.
\let\footnotestyle=\comment
-\let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
-
{\catcode `\@=11
%
% Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
\gdef\footnote{%
+ \let\indent=\ptexindent
+ \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
\global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
\edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
%
% In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
% extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
\let\@sf\empty
- \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\/\fi
+ \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
%
% Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
\unskip
\thisfootno\@sf
- \footnotezzz
+ \dofootnote
}%
% Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
% footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
%
-% Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset and anything else that uses
-% \parseargline fail inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
+% Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
+% \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
% the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
%
-\long\gdef\footnotezzz{\insert\footins\bgroup
+\gdef\dofootnote{%
+ \insert\footins\bgroup
% We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
% footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
% So reset some parameters.
+ \hsize=\pagewidth
\interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
\splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
\splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
@@ -5512,8 +7326,15 @@
%
\smallfonts \rm
%
- % Hang the footnote text off the number.
- \hang
+ % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
+ % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
+ % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
+ % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
+ \let\noindent = \relax
+ %
+ % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
+ % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
+ \everypar = {\hang}%
\textindent{\thisfootno}%
%
% Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
@@ -5522,66 +7343,68 @@
\footstrut
\futurelet\next\fo@t
}
-\def\fo@t{\ifcat\bgroup\noexpand\next \let\next\f@@t
- \else\let\next\f@t\fi \next}
-\def\f@@t{\bgroup\aftergroup\@foot\let\next}
-\def\f@t#1{#1\@foot}
-\def\@foot{\strut\par\egroup}
-
}%end \catcode `\@=11
-% Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
-% correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
-% used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
-%
-\def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
-\def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
-\def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
-%
-\def\setleading#1{%
- \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax
- \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
- \normalbaselines
- \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
- \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
- depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
- }%
-}
-
-% @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
-% surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
-% change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
-% have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
-% vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
-%
-\def\|{%
- % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
- \leavevmode
- %
- % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
- \vadjust{%
- % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
- % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
- \vskip-\baselineskip
- %
- % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
- % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
- \llap{%
- %
- % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
- \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
- %
- % This is the space between the bar and the text.
- \hskip 12pt
- }%
- }%
-}
-
-% For a final copy, take out the rectangles
-% that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
-% that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
-%
-\def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt}
+% In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
+% the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
+% would be lost.
+% Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
+% text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
+% And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
+
+% Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
+% Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
+% out prematurely.
+%
+\def\startsavinginserts{%
+ \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
+ \let\insert\saveinsert
+ \else
+ \let\checkinserts\relax
+ \fi
+}
+
+% This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
+% \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
+%
+\def\saveinsert#1{%
+ \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
+ \afterassignment\next
+ % swallow the left brace
+ \let\temp =
+}
+\def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
+\def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
+
+\def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
+
+\def\placesaveins#1{%
+ \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
+ {\box#1}%
+}
+
+% eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
+{
+ \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
+ \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
+}
+
+% initialization:
+\def\newsaveins #1{%
+ \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
+ \next
+}
+\def\newsaveinsX #1{%
+ \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
+ \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
+ \checksaveins #1}%
+}
+
+% initialize:
+\let\checkinserts\empty
+\newsaveins\footins
+\newsaveins\margin
+
% @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
% If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
@@ -5591,12 +7414,12 @@
% undone and the next image would fail.
\openin 1 = epsf.tex
\ifeof 1 \else
- \closein 1
- % Do not bother showing banner with post-v2.7 epsf.tex (available in
- % doc/epsf.tex until it shows up on ctan).
+ % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
+ % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
\def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
\input epsf.tex
\fi
+\closein 1
%
% We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
\newif\ifwarnednoepsf
@@ -5612,77 +7435,1180 @@
\global\warnednoepsftrue
\fi
\else
- \imagexxx #1,,,\finish
+ \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
\fi
}
%
% Arguments to @image:
% #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
% #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
-% #4 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff.
-\def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
+% #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
+% #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
+% #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff.
+\newif\ifimagevmode
+\def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
+ \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
+ \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
+ % If the image is by itself, center it.
+ \ifvmode
+ \imagevmodetrue
+ \nobreak\medskip
+ % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
+ % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
+ % above and below.
+ \nobreak\vskip\parskip
+ \nobreak
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing
+ % environment such as @quotation is respected. On the other hand, if
+ % it's at the top level, we don't want the normal paragraph indentation.
+ \noindent
+ %
+ % Output the image.
\ifpdf
- \centerline{\dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}}%
+ \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
\else
% \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
+ \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ \ifimagevmode \medskip \fi % space after the standalone image
+\endgroup}
+
+
+% @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
+% etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
+% float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
+%
+\envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
+
+% There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
+\def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
+
+% #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
+% "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain
commas. If omitted,
+% this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
+%
+% #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
+% be referable.
+%
+% #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
+% will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
+%
+% We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
+% chapter-level command.
+\let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
+%
+\def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
+ \let\thiscaption=\empty
+ \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
+ %
+ % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
+ %
+ % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
+ % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
+ %
+ \startsavinginserts
+ %
+ % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
+ \par
+ %
+ \vtop\bgroup
+ \def\floattype{#1}%
+ \def\floatlabel{#2}%
+ \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
+ %
+ \ifx\floattype\empty
+ \let\safefloattype=\empty
+ \else
+ {%
+ % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
+ % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
+ \indexnofonts
+ \turnoffactive
+ \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
+ }%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
+ \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
+ % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
+ % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
+ %
+ \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
+ \global\advance\floatno by 1
+ %
+ {%
+ % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
+ % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
+ % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
+ % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
+ % lists of floats.
+ %
+ \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
+ \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
+ }%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
+ \vskip\parskip
+ %
+ % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
+ \restorefirstparagraphindent
+}
+
+% we have these possibilities:
+% @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
+% @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
+% @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
+% @float Foo & no caption: Foo
+% @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
+% @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
+% @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
+% @float & no caption:
+%
+\def\Efloat{%
+ \let\floatident = \empty
+ %
+ % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
+ \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
+ %
+ % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
+ \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
+ \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
+ \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
+ \fi
+ % the number.
+ \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
+ % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
+ \let\captionline = \floatident
+ %
+ \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
+ \ifx\floatident\empty \else
+ \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
+ \fi
+ %
+ % caption text.
+ \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
+ % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
+ \ifx\captionline\empty \else
+ \vskip.5\parskip
+ \captionline
+ %
+ % Space below caption.
+ \vskip\parskip
+ \fi
+ %
+ % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
+ % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
+ \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
+ % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
+ % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
+ % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
+ {%
+ \atdummies
+ %
+ % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
+ % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
+ % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux
file.
+ \scanexp{%
+ \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
+ \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
+ \thiscaption
+ \else
+ \thisshortcaption
+ \fi
+ }%
+ }%
+ \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
+ \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
+ }%
+ \fi
+ \egroup % end of \vtop
+ %
+ % place the captured inserts
+ %
+ % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning
+ % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly
+ % float. --kasal, 26may04
+ %
+ \checkinserts
+}
+
+% Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
+%
+\def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
+ \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
+}
+
+% @caption, @shortcaption
+%
+\def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
+\def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
+\def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
+\def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
+
+% The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
+% going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
+\def\getfloatno#1{%
+ \ifx#1\relax
+ % Haven't seen this figure type before.
+ \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
+ %
+ % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
+ \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
+ \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
+ \fi
+ \let\floatno#1%
+}
+
+% \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
+% to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
+% first read the @float command.
+%
+\def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
+
+% Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
+% distinguish floats from other xref types.
+\def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
+
+% #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
+% which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
+% \lastsection value which we \setref above.
+%
+\def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
+%
+% #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
+% (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
+%
+\def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \def\iffloattype{#2}%
+ \ifx\temp\floatmagic
+}
+
+% @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
+%
+\parseargdef\listoffloats{%
+ \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
+ {%
+ % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
+ % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
+ \indexnofonts
+ \turnoffactive
+ \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
+ }%
+ %
+ % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
+ \ifhavexrefs
+ % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
+ \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
+ \fi
+ \else
\begingroup
- \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
- % If the image is by itself, center it.
- \ifvmode
- \nobreak\bigskip
- % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
- % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
- % above and below.
- \nobreak\vskip\parskip
- \nobreak
- \centerline{\epsfbox{#1.eps}}%
- \bigbreak
- \else
- % In the middle of a paragraph, no extra space.
- \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
- \fi
- \endgroup
- \fi
-}
+ \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
+ \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
+ \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
+ \endgroup
+ \fi
+}
+
+% This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
+% xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
+% aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
+% has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
+%
+% Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
+% they won't appear in the aux file).
+%
+\def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
+\def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
+ % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
+ % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
+ % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
+ % in pdf output.
+ \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
+ %
+ % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
+ \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
+ \writeentry
+}}
\message{localization,}
-% and i18n.
% @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after
% @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything
-% properly. Single argument is the language abbreviation.
-% It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file here.
-%
-\def\documentlanguage{\parsearg\dodocumentlanguage}
-\def\dodocumentlanguage#1{%
+% properly. Single argument is the language (de) or locale (de_DE)
+% abbreviation. It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file.
+%
+{
+ \catcode`\_ = \active
+ \globaldefs=1
+\parseargdef\documentlanguage{\begingroup
+ \let_=\normalunderscore % normal _ character for filenames
\tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
- % Read the file if it exists.
+ % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
+ \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
+ \ifeof 1
+ \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore{#1_\finish}%
+ \else
+ \input txi-#1.tex
+ \fi
+ \closein 1
+ \endgroup
+\endgroup}
+}
+%
+% If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
+% try txi-de.tex.
+%
+\def\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
\openin 1 txi-#1.tex
- \ifeof1
+ \ifeof 1
\errhelp = \nolanghelp
\errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
- \let\temp = \relax
- \else
- \def\temp{\input txi-#1.tex }%
- \fi
- \temp
- \endgroup
-}
+ \else
+ \input txi-#1.tex
+ \fi
+ \closein 1
+}
+%
\newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory
should work if nowhere else does.}
-
-% @documentencoding should change something in TeX eventually, most
-% likely, but for now just recognize it.
-\let\documentencoding = \comment
-
-
-% Page size parameters.
-%
+% Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
+%
+\def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
+ \count255=128
+ \loop\ifnum\count255<256
+ \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax
+ \advance\count255 by 1
+ \repeat
+}
+
+\def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
+ \count255=128
+ \loop\ifnum\count255<256
+ \catcode\count255=#1\relax
+ \advance\count255 by 1
+ \repeat
+}
+
+% @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
+% according to the specified encoding.
+%
+\parseargdef\documentencoding{%
+ % Encoding being declared for the document.
+ \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
+ %
+ % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
+ % to compare them with \ifx.
+ \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}%
+ \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}%
+ \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}%
+ \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}%
+ \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}%
+ %
+ \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
+ \asciichardefs
+ %
+ \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
+ \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
+ \lattwochardefs
+ %
+ \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
+ \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
+ \latonechardefs
+ %
+ \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
+ \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
+ \latninechardefs
+ %
+ \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
+ \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
+ \utfeightchardefs
+ %
+ \else
+ \message{Unknown document encoding #1, ignoring.}%
+ %
+ \fi % utfeight
+ \fi % latnine
+ \fi % latone
+ \fi % lattwo
+ \fi % ascii
+}
+
+% A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
+% the default font encoding (OT1).
+%
+\def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding: #1.}}
+
+% Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
+\def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
+
+% First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
+% correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
+% macros containing the character definitions.
+\setnonasciicharscatcode\active
+%
+% Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
+\def\latonechardefs{%
+ \gdef^^a0{~}
+ \gdef^^a1{\exclamdown}
+ \gdef^^a2{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN}}
+ \gdef^^a3{{\pounds}}
+ \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
+ \gdef^^a5{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN}}
+ \gdef^^a6{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR}}
+ \gdef^^a7{\S}
+ \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
+ \gdef^^a9{\copyright}
+ \gdef^^aa{\ordf}
+ \gdef^^ab{\missingcharmsg{LEFT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK}}
+ \gdef^^ac{$\lnot$}
+ \gdef^^ad{\-}
+ \gdef^^ae{\registeredsymbol}
+ \gdef^^af{\={}}
+ %
+ \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
+ \gdef^^b1{$\pm$}
+ \gdef^^b2{$^2$}
+ \gdef^^b3{$^3$}
+ \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
+ \gdef^^b5{$\mu$}
+ \gdef^^b6{\P}
+ %
+ \gdef^^b7{$^.$}
+ \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
+ \gdef^^b9{$^1$}
+ \gdef^^ba{\ordm}
+ %
+ \gdef^^bb{\missingcharmsg{RIGHT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK}}
+ \gdef^^bc{$1\over4$}
+ \gdef^^bd{$1\over2$}
+ \gdef^^be{$3\over4$}
+ \gdef^^bf{\questiondown}
+ %
+ \gdef^^c0{\`A}
+ \gdef^^c1{\'A}
+ \gdef^^c2{\^A}
+ \gdef^^c3{\~A}
+ \gdef^^c4{\"A}
+ \gdef^^c5{\ringaccent A}
+ \gdef^^c6{\AE}
+ \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
+ \gdef^^c8{\`E}
+ \gdef^^c9{\'E}
+ \gdef^^ca{\^E}
+ \gdef^^cb{\"E}
+ \gdef^^cc{\`I}
+ \gdef^^cd{\'I}
+ \gdef^^ce{\^I}
+ \gdef^^cf{\"I}
+ %
+ \gdef^^d0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER ETH}}
+ \gdef^^d1{\~N}
+ \gdef^^d2{\`O}
+ \gdef^^d3{\'O}
+ \gdef^^d4{\^O}
+ \gdef^^d5{\~O}
+ \gdef^^d6{\"O}
+ \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
+ \gdef^^d8{\O}
+ \gdef^^d9{\`U}
+ \gdef^^da{\'U}
+ \gdef^^db{\^U}
+ \gdef^^dc{\"U}
+ \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
+ \gdef^^de{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER THORN}}
+ \gdef^^df{\ss}
+ %
+ \gdef^^e0{\`a}
+ \gdef^^e1{\'a}
+ \gdef^^e2{\^a}
+ \gdef^^e3{\~a}
+ \gdef^^e4{\"a}
+ \gdef^^e5{\ringaccent a}
+ \gdef^^e6{\ae}
+ \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
+ \gdef^^e8{\`e}
+ \gdef^^e9{\'e}
+ \gdef^^ea{\^e}
+ \gdef^^eb{\"e}
+ \gdef^^ec{\`{\dotless i}}
+ \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless i}}
+ \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
+ \gdef^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
+ %
+ \gdef^^f0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER ETH}}
+ \gdef^^f1{\~n}
+ \gdef^^f2{\`o}
+ \gdef^^f3{\'o}
+ \gdef^^f4{\^o}
+ \gdef^^f5{\~o}
+ \gdef^^f6{\"o}
+ \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
+ \gdef^^f8{\o}
+ \gdef^^f9{\`u}
+ \gdef^^fa{\'u}
+ \gdef^^fb{\^u}
+ \gdef^^fc{\"u}
+ \gdef^^fd{\'y}
+ \gdef^^fe{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER THORN}}
+ \gdef^^ff{\"y}
+}
+
+% Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
+\def\latninechardefs{%
+ % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
+ \latonechardefs
+ %
+ \gdef^^a4{\euro}
+ \gdef^^a6{\v S}
+ \gdef^^a8{\v s}
+ \gdef^^b4{\v Z}
+ \gdef^^b8{\v z}
+ \gdef^^bc{\OE}
+ \gdef^^bd{\oe}
+ \gdef^^be{\"Y}
+}
+
+% Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
+\def\lattwochardefs{%
+ \gdef^^a0{~}
+ \gdef^^a1{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A WITH OGONEK}}
+ \gdef^^a2{\u{}}
+ \gdef^^a3{\L}
+ \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
+ \gdef^^a5{\v L}
+ \gdef^^a6{\'S}
+ \gdef^^a7{\S}
+ \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
+ \gdef^^a9{\v S}
+ \gdef^^aa{\cedilla S}
+ \gdef^^ab{\v T}
+ \gdef^^ac{\'Z}
+ \gdef^^ad{\-}
+ \gdef^^ae{\v Z}
+ \gdef^^af{\dotaccent Z}
+ %
+ \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
+ \gdef^^b1{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER A WITH OGONEK}}
+ \gdef^^b2{\missingcharmsg{OGONEK}}
+ \gdef^^b3{\l}
+ \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
+ \gdef^^b5{\v l}
+ \gdef^^b6{\'s}
+ \gdef^^b7{\v{}}
+ \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
+ \gdef^^b9{\v s}
+ \gdef^^ba{\cedilla s}
+ \gdef^^bb{\v t}
+ \gdef^^bc{\'z}
+ \gdef^^bd{\H{}}
+ \gdef^^be{\v z}
+ \gdef^^bf{\dotaccent z}
+ %
+ \gdef^^c0{\'R}
+ \gdef^^c1{\'A}
+ \gdef^^c2{\^A}
+ \gdef^^c3{\u A}
+ \gdef^^c4{\"A}
+ \gdef^^c5{\'L}
+ \gdef^^c6{\'C}
+ \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
+ \gdef^^c8{\v C}
+ \gdef^^c9{\'E}
+ \gdef^^ca{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER E WITH OGONEK}}
+ \gdef^^cb{\"E}
+ \gdef^^cc{\v E}
+ \gdef^^cd{\'I}
+ \gdef^^ce{\^I}
+ \gdef^^cf{\v D}
+ %
+ \gdef^^d0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D WITH STROKE}}
+ \gdef^^d1{\'N}
+ \gdef^^d2{\v N}
+ \gdef^^d3{\'O}
+ \gdef^^d4{\^O}
+ \gdef^^d5{\H O}
+ \gdef^^d6{\"O}
+ \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
+ \gdef^^d8{\v R}
+ \gdef^^d9{\ringaccent U}
+ \gdef^^da{\'U}
+ \gdef^^db{\H U}
+ \gdef^^dc{\"U}
+ \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
+ \gdef^^de{\cedilla T}
+ \gdef^^df{\ss}
+ %
+ \gdef^^e0{\'r}
+ \gdef^^e1{\'a}
+ \gdef^^e2{\^a}
+ \gdef^^e3{\u a}
+ \gdef^^e4{\"a}
+ \gdef^^e5{\'l}
+ \gdef^^e6{\'c}
+ \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
+ \gdef^^e8{\v c}
+ \gdef^^e9{\'e}
+ \gdef^^ea{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER E WITH OGONEK}}
+ \gdef^^eb{\"e}
+ \gdef^^ec{\v e}
+ \gdef^^ed{\'\i}
+ \gdef^^ee{\^\i}
+ \gdef^^ef{\v d}
+ %
+ \gdef^^f0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER D WITH STROKE}}
+ \gdef^^f1{\'n}
+ \gdef^^f2{\v n}
+ \gdef^^f3{\'o}
+ \gdef^^f4{\^o}
+ \gdef^^f5{\H o}
+ \gdef^^f6{\"o}
+ \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
+ \gdef^^f8{\v r}
+ \gdef^^f9{\ringaccent u}
+ \gdef^^fa{\'u}
+ \gdef^^fb{\H u}
+ \gdef^^fc{\"u}
+ \gdef^^fd{\'y}
+ \gdef^^fe{\cedilla t}
+ \gdef^^ff{\dotaccent{}}
+}
+
+% UTF-8 character definitions.
+%
+% This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
+% changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
+% permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
+%
+\newcount\countUTFx
+\newcount\countUTFy
+\newcount\countUTFz
+
+\gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
+ \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}
+%
+\gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
+ \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
+%
+\gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
+ \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
+
+\gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
+ \ifx #1\relax
+ \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}%
+ \else
+ \expandafter #1%
+ \fi
+}
+
+\begingroup
+ \catcode`\~13
+ \catcode`\"12
+
+ \def\UTFviiiLoop{%
+ \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
+ \uccode`\~\countUTFx
+ \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
+ \advance\countUTFx by 1
+ \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy
+ \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
+ \fi}
+
+ \countUTFx = "C2
+ \countUTFy = "E0
+ \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
+ \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~}}
+ \UTFviiiLoop
+
+ \countUTFx = "E0
+ \countUTFy = "F0
+ \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
+ \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~}}
+ \UTFviiiLoop
+
+ \countUTFx = "F0
+ \countUTFy = "F4
+ \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
+ \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~}}
+ \UTFviiiLoop
+\endgroup
+
+\begingroup
+ \catcode`\"=12
+ \catcode`\<=12
+ \catcode`\.=12
+ \catcode`\,=12
+ \catcode`\;=12
+ \catcode`\!=12
+ \catcode`\~=13
+
+ \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{%
+ \countUTFz = "#1\relax
+ \wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}%
+ \begingroup
+ \parseXMLCharref
+ \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets##1##2{%
+ \csname u8:##1\string ##2\endcsname}%
+ \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets##1##2##3{%
+ \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\endcsname}%
+ \def\UTFviiiFourOctets##1##2##3##4{%
+ \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\string ##4\endcsname}%
+ \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
+ \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
+ \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
+ \endgroup}
+
+ \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
+ \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}%
+ \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax
+ \parseUTFviiiA,%
+ \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,%
+ \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax
+ \parseUTFviiiA;%
+ \parseUTFviiiA,%
+ \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctets.{,;}%
+ \else
+ \parseUTFviiiA;%
+ \parseUTFviiiA,%
+ \parseUTFviiiA!%
+ \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctets.{!,;}%
+ \fi\fi\fi
+ }
+
+ \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
+ \countUTFx = \countUTFz
+ \divide\countUTFz by 64
+ \countUTFy = \countUTFz
+ \multiply\countUTFz by 64
+ \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz
+ \advance\countUTFx by 128
+ \uccode `#1\countUTFx
+ \countUTFz = \countUTFy}
+
+ \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
+ \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax
+ \uccode `#3\countUTFz
+ \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
+\endgroup
+
+\def\utfeightchardefs{%
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv}
+}% end of \utfeightchardefs
+
+
+% US-ASCII character definitions.
+\def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
+ \relax
+}
+
+% Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
+% existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
+% document encoding.
+%
+\setnonasciicharscatcode \other
+
+
+\message{formatting,}
+
\newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
\chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
@@ -5695,7 +8621,7 @@
% Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
\hbadness = 2000
-% Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans.
+% Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
\widowpenalty=10000
\clubpenalty=10000
@@ -5713,11 +8639,14 @@
\fi
}
-% Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth; 3) voffset;
-% 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip. Then whoever calls us can
-% set \parskip and call \setleading for \baselineskip.
-%
-\def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6{%
+% Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
+% 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
+% 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
+%
+% We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
+% \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
+%
+\def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
\voffset = #3\relax
\topskip = #6\relax
\splittopskip = \topskip
@@ -5736,6 +8665,17 @@
\normaloffset = #4\relax
\bindingoffset = #5\relax
%
+ \ifpdf
+ \pdfpageheight #7\relax
+ \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
+ % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
+ % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
+ \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
+ \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
+ \fi
+ %
+ \setleading{\textleading}
+ %
\parindent = \defaultparindent
\setemergencystretch
}
@@ -5743,76 +8683,140 @@
% @letterpaper (the default).
\def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
\parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
- \setleading{13.2pt}%
+ \textleading = 13.2pt
%
% If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
- \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}{\voffset}{.25in}{\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
-}}
-
-% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.5 (or so) format.
+ \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines
+ {\voffset}{.25in}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
+ {11in}{8.5in}%
+}}
+
+% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
\def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
\parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
- \setleading{12pt}%
- %
- \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5.in}{\voffset}{.25in}{\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
+ \textleading = 12pt
+ %
+ \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
+ {-.2in}{0in}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
+ {9.25in}{7in}%
%
\lispnarrowing = 0.3in
\tolerance = 700
\hfuzz = 1pt
\contentsrightmargin = 0pt
- \deftypemargin = 0pt
\defbodyindent = .5cm
- %
- \let\smalldisplay = \smalldisplayx
- \let\smallexample = \smalllispx
- \let\smallformat = \smallformatx
- \let\smalllisp = \smalllispx
+}}
+
+% Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
+% (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
+\def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
+ \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
+ \textleading = 12pt
+ %
+ \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
+ {-.2in}{-.4in}%
+ {0pt}{14pt}%
+ {9in}{6in}%
+ %
+ \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
+ \tolerance = 700
+ \hfuzz = 1pt
+ \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
+ \defbodyindent = .4cm
}}
% Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
\def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
- \setleading{12pt}%
\parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
- %
- \internalpagesizes{53\baselineskip}{160mm}{\voffset}{4mm}{\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
+ \textleading = 13.2pt
+ %
+ % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
+ % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
+ % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
+ % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
+ % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
+ % your texinfo source file like this:
+ % @tex
+ % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
+ % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
+ % @end tex
+ \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines
+ {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
+ {297mm}{210mm}%
%
\tolerance = 700
\hfuzz = 1pt
-}}
-
-% A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper. Top margin
-% 29mm, hence bottom margin 28mm, nominal side margin 3cm.
+ \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
+ \defbodyindent = 5mm
+}}
+
+% Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
+% From romildo(a)urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
+% He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
+\def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
+ \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
+ \textleading = 12.5pt
+ %
+ \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
+ {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
+ {210mm}{148mm}%
+ %
+ \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
+ \tolerance = 800
+ \hfuzz = 1.2pt
+ \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
+ \defbodyindent = 2mm
+ \tableindent = 12mm
+}}
+
+% A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
\def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
- \setleading{13.6pt}%
- %
\afourpaper
- \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}{3.6mm}{3.6mm}{3mm}{7mm}%
- %
+ \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
+ {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
+ {297mm}{210mm}%
+ %
+ % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
\globaldefs = 0
}}
-% Use @afourwide to print on European A4 paper in wide format.
-\def\afourwide{%
+% Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
+\def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
\afourpaper
- \internalpagesizes{9.5in}{6.5in}{\hoffset}{\normaloffset}{\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
- %
+ \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
+ {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
+ {297mm}{210mm}%
\globaldefs = 0
-}
+}}
% @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
% Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
% and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
%
-\def\pagesizes{\parsearg\pagesizesxxx}
-\def\pagesizesxxx#1{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
+\parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
\def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
\globaldefs = 1
%
\parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
- \setleading{13.2pt}%
- %
- \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}{\voffset}{\normaloffset}{\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
+ \setleading{\textleading}%
+ %
+ \dimen0 = #1\relax
+ \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
+ %
+ \dimen2 = \hsize
+ \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
+ %
+ \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
+ {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
+ {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
}}
% Set default to letter.
@@ -5840,10 +8844,10 @@
\def\normalless{<}
\def\normalgreater{>}
\def\normalplus{+}
-\def\normaldollar{$}
-
-% This macro is used to make a character print one way in ttfont
-% where it can probably just be output, and another way in other fonts,
+\def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
+
+% This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
+% (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
% where something hairier probably needs to be done.
%
% #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
@@ -5875,8 +8879,9 @@
\catcode`\_=\active
\def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
+\let\realunder=_
% Subroutine for the previous macro.
-\def\_{\leavevmode \kern.06em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}}
+\def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
\catcode`\|=\active
\def|{{\tt\char124}}
@@ -5889,16 +8894,7 @@
\catcode`\+=\active
\def+{{\tt \char 43}}
\catcode`\$=\active
-\def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}
-%\catcode 27=\active
-%\def^^[{$\diamondsuit$}
-
-% Set up an active definition for =, but don't enable it most of the time.
-{\catcode`\==\active
-\global\def={{\tt \char 61}}}
-
-\catcode`+=\active
-\catcode`\_=\active
+\def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
% If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
% name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
@@ -5906,46 +8902,53 @@
% \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
\def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other}
+% Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
+% parsing them.
+\def\turnoffactive{%
+ \normalturnoffactive
+ \otherbackslash
+}
+
\catcode`\@=0
-% \rawbackslashxx output one backslash character in current font
-\global\chardef\rawbackslashxx=`\\
-%{\catcode`\\=\other
-%@gdef@rawbackslashxx{\}}
-
-% \rawbackslash redefines \ as input to do \rawbackslashxx.
-{\catcode`\\=\active
-@gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@rawbackslashxx }}
-
-% \normalbackslash outputs one backslash in fixed width font.
-\def\normalbackslash{{\tt\rawbackslashxx}}
-
-% \catcode 17=0 % Define control-q
+% \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
+% as in \char`\\.
+\global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
+\global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
+
+% \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
+% \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
+{\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}}
+
+% In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
+% in fixed width font.
\catcode`\\=\active
-
-% Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters
-% even after parsing them.
-@def@turnoffactive{@let"=@normaldoublequote
-@let\=@realbackslash
-@let~=@normaltilde
-@let^=@normalcaret
-@let_=@normalunderscore
-@let|=@normalverticalbar
-@let<=@normalless
-@let>=@normalgreater
-@let+=@normalplus
-@let$=@normaldollar}
-
-@def@normalturnoffactive{@let"=@normaldoublequote
-@let\=@normalbackslash
-@let~=@normaltilde
-@let^=@normalcaret
-@let_=@normalunderscore
-@let|=@normalverticalbar
-@let<=@normalless
-@let>=@normalgreater
-@let+=@normalplus
-@let$=@normaldollar}
+@def@normalbackslash{{@tt@backslashcurfont}}
+% On startup, @fixbackslash assigns:
+% @let \ = @normalbackslash
+
+% \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
+% \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
+% catcode other.
+@gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
+@gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
+
+% Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
+% the literal character `\'.
+%
+@def@normalturnoffactive{%
+ @let\=@normalbackslash
+ @let"=@normaldoublequote
+ @let~=@normaltilde
+ @let^=@normalcaret
+ @let_=@normalunderscore
+ @let|=@normalverticalbar
+ @let<=@normalless
+ @let>=@normalgreater
+ @let+=@normalplus
+ @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
+ @unsepspaces
+}
% Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
% This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
@@ -5959,9 +8962,9 @@
@global@let\ = @eatinput
% On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
-% the first `\{ in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
+% the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
% that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
-% Also back turn on active characters that might appear in the input
+% Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
% file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
%
@gdef@fixbackslash{%
@@ -5973,14 +8976,10 @@
% Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
@escapechar = `@@
-% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
+% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
@catcode`@& = @other
@catcode`@# = @other
@catcode`@% = @other
-
-@c Set initial fonts.
-@textfonts
-@rm
@c Local variables:
@@ -5990,3 +8989,9 @@
@c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
@c time-stamp-end: "}"
@c End:
+
+@c vim:sw=2:
+
+@ignore
+ arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115
+@end ignore
diff -r a7da359711ce -r 64be8a494bdc man/texinfo.texi
--- a/man/texinfo.texi Mon May 02 10:35:36 2011 +0100
+++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
@@ -1,17286 +0,0 @@
-\input texinfo.tex @c -*-texinfo-*-
-@c $Id: texinfo.texi,v 1.16 2002/07/05 20:35:47 adrian Exp $
-@c %**start of header
-
-@c All text is ignored before the setfilename.
-@setfilename ../info/texinfo.info
-@settitle Texinfo @value{edition}
-
-@c Edition number is now the same as the Texinfo distribution version number.
-@set edition 3.12
-@set update-month February 1998
-@set update-date 27 @value{update-month}
-
-@c Define a new index for options.
-@defcodeindex op
-@c Put everything except function (command, in this case) names in one
-@c index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index).
-@syncodeindex op cp
-@syncodeindex vr cp
-@syncodeindex pg cp
-
-@footnotestyle separate
-@paragraphindent 2
-@finalout
-@comment %**end of header
-
-@c Before release, run C-u C-c C-u C-a (texinfo-all-menus-update with a
-@c prefix arg). This updates the node pointers, which texinfmt.el needs.
-
-@dircategory Texinfo documentation system
-@direntry
-* Texinfo: (texinfo). The GNU documentation format.
-* install-info: (texinfo)Invoking install-info. Updating info/dir entries.
-* texi2dvi: (texinfo)Format with texi2dvi. Printing Texinfo documentation.
-* texindex: (texinfo)Format with tex/texindex. Sorting Texinfo index files.
-* makeinfo: (texinfo)makeinfo Preferred. Translate Texinfo source.
-@end direntry
-
-@c Set smallbook if printing in smallbook format so the example of the
-@c smallbook font is actually written using smallbook; in bigbook, a kludge
-@c is used for TeX output. Do this through the -t option to texi2dvi,
-@c so this same source can be used for other paper sizes as well.
-@c smallbook
-@c set smallbook
-@c @@clear smallbook
-
-@c Currently undocumented command, 5 December 1993:
-@c nwnode (Same as node, but no warnings; for `makeinfo'.)
-
-@ifinfo
-This file documents Texinfo, a documentation system that can produce
-both on-line information and a printed manual from a single source file.
-
-Copyright (C) 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97, 98
-Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This edition is for Texinfo version @value{edition}.
-
-Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
-this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
-are preserved on all copies.
-
-@ignore
-Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
-results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
-notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
-(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
-
-@end ignore
-Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
-manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that the entire
-resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a permission
-notice identical to this one.
-
-Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
-into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions,
-except that this permission notice may be stated in a translation approved
-by the Free Software Foundation.
-@end ifinfo
-
-@setchapternewpage odd
-
-@shorttitlepage Texinfo
-
-@titlepage
-@c use the new format for titles
-@title Texinfo
-@subtitle The GNU Documentation Format
-@subtitle for Texinfo version @value{edition}
-@subtitle @value{update-month}
-
-@author Robert J.@: Chassell
-@author Richard M.@: Stallman
-
-@c Include the Distribution inside the titlepage so
-@c that headings are turned off.
-
-@page
-@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
-Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97, 98
-Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
-59 Temple Place Suite 330 @*
-Boston, MA 02111-1307 @*
-USA @*
-ISBN 1-882114-65-5
-@c ISBN 1-882114-63-9 is for edition 2.20 of 28 February 1995
-@c ISBN 1-882114-64-7 is for edition 2.24 of November 1996.
-
-Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
-this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
-are preserved on all copies.
-
-Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
-manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that the entire
-resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a permission
-notice identical to this one.
-
-Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
-into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions,
-except that this permission notice may be stated in a translation approved
-by the Free Software Foundation.
-@sp 2
-Cover art by Etienne Suvasa.
-@end titlepage
-
-@ifinfo
-@node Top, Copying, (dir), (dir)
-@top Texinfo
-
-Texinfo is a documentation system that uses a single source file to
-produce both on-line information and printed output.@refill
-
-The first part of this master menu lists the major nodes in this Info
-document, including the @@-command and concept indices. The rest of
-the menu lists all the lower level nodes in the document.@refill
-
-This is Edition @value{edition} of the Texinfo documentation,
-@w{@value{update-date}}.
-@end ifinfo
-
-@c Here is a spare copy of the chapter menu entry descriptions,
-@c in case they are accidentally deleted
-@ignore
-Your rights.
-Texinfo in brief.
-How to use Texinfo mode.
-What is at the beginning of a Texinfo file?
-What is at the end of a Texinfo file?
-How to create chapters, sections, subsections,
- appendices, and other parts.
-How to provide structure for a document.
-How to write nodes.
-How to write menus.
-How to write cross references.
-How to mark words and phrases as code,
- keyboard input, meta-syntactic
- variables, and the like.
-How to write quotations, examples, etc.
-How to write lists and tables.
-How to create indices.
-How to insert @@-signs, braces, etc.
-How to indicate results of evaluation,
- expansion of macros, errors, etc.
-How to force and prevent line and page breaks.
-How to describe functions and the like in a uniform manner.
-How to write footnotes.
-How to specify text for either @TeX{} or Info.
-How to print hardcopy.
-How to create an Info file.
-How to install an Info file
-A list of all the Texinfo @@-commands.
-Hints on how to write a Texinfo document.
-A sample Texinfo file to look at.
-Tell readers they have the right to copy
- and distribute.
-How to incorporate other Texinfo files.
-How to write page headings and footings.
-How to find formatting mistakes.
-All about paragraph refilling.
-A description of @@-Command syntax.
-Texinfo second edition features.
-A menu containing commands and variables.
-A menu covering many topics.
-@end ignore
-
-@menu
-* Copying:: Your rights.
-* Overview:: Texinfo in brief.
-* Texinfo Mode:: How to use Texinfo mode.
-* Beginning a File:: What is at the beginning of a Texinfo file?
-* Ending a File:: What is at the end of a Texinfo file?
-* Structuring:: How to create chapters, sections, subsections,
- appendices, and other parts.
-* Nodes:: How to write nodes.
-* Menus:: How to write menus.
-* Cross References:: How to write cross references.
-* Marking Text:: How to mark words and phrases as code,
- keyboard input, meta-syntactic
- variables, and the like.
-* Quotations and Examples:: How to write quotations, examples, etc.
-* Lists and Tables:: How to write lists and tables.
-* Indices:: How to create indices.
-* Insertions:: How to insert @@-signs, braces, etc.
-* Breaks:: How to force and prevent line and page breaks.
-* Definition Commands:: How to describe functions and the like
- in a uniform manner.
-* Footnotes:: How to write footnotes.
-* Conditionals:: How to specify text for either @TeX{} or Info.
-* Macros:: Defining new Texinfo commands.
-* Format/Print Hardcopy:: How to convert a Texinfo file to a file
- for printing and how to print that file.
-* Create an Info File:: Convert a Texinfo file into an Info file.
-* Install an Info File:: Make an Info file accessible to users.
-* Command List:: All the Texinfo @@-commands.
-* Tips:: Hints on how to write a Texinfo document.
-* Sample Texinfo File:: A sample Texinfo file to look at.
-* Sample Permissions:: Tell readers they have the right to copy
- and distribute.
-* Include Files:: How to incorporate other Texinfo files.
-* Headings:: How to write page headings and footings.
-* Catching Mistakes:: How to find formatting mistakes.
-* Refilling Paragraphs:: All about paragraph refilling.
-* Command Syntax:: A description of @@-Command syntax.
-* Obtaining TeX:: How to Obtain @TeX{}.
-* Command and Variable Index:: A menu containing commands and variables.
-* Concept Index:: A menu covering many topics.
-
-@detailmenu
-
- --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
-
-Overview of Texinfo
-
-* Using Texinfo:: Create a conventional printed book
- or an Info file.
-* Info Files:: What is an Info file?
-* Printed Books:: Characteristics of a printed book or manual.
-* Formatting Commands:: @@-commands are used for formatting.
-* Conventions:: General rules for writing a Texinfo file.
-* Comments:: How to write comments and mark regions that
- the formatting commands will ignore.
-* Minimum:: What a Texinfo file must have.
-* Six Parts:: Usually, a Texinfo file has six parts.
-* Short Sample:: A short sample Texinfo file.
-* Acknowledgements::
-
-Using Texinfo Mode
-
-* Texinfo Mode Overview:: How Texinfo mode can help you.
-* Emacs Editing:: Texinfo mode adds to GNU Emacs' general
- purpose editing features.
-* Inserting:: How to insert frequently used @@-commands.
-* Showing the Structure:: How to show the structure of a file.
-* Updating Nodes and Menus:: How to update or create new nodes and menus.
-* Info Formatting:: How to format for Info.
-* Printing:: How to format and print part or all of a file.
-* Texinfo Mode Summary:: Summary of all the Texinfo mode commands.
-
-Updating Nodes and Menus
-
-* Updating Commands:: Five major updating commands.
-* Updating Requirements:: How to structure a Texinfo file for
- using the updating command.
-* Other Updating Commands:: How to indent descriptions, insert
- missing nodes lines, and update
- nodes in sequence.
-
-Beginning a Texinfo File
-
-* Four Parts:: Four parts begin a Texinfo file.
-* Sample Beginning:: Here is a sample beginning for a Texinfo file.
-* Header:: The very beginning of a Texinfo file.
-* Info Summary and Permissions:: Summary and copying permissions for Info.
-* Titlepage & Copyright Page:: Creating the title and copyright pages.
-* The Top Node:: Creating the `Top' node and master menu.
-* Software Copying Permissions:: Ensure that you and others continue to
- have the right to use and share software.
-
-The Texinfo File Header
-
-* First Line:: The first line of a Texinfo file.
-* Start of Header:: Formatting a region requires this.
-* setfilename:: Tell Info the name of the Info file.
-* settitle:: Create a title for the printed work.
-* setchapternewpage:: Start chapters on right-hand pages.
-* paragraphindent:: An option to specify paragraph indentation.
-* End of Header:: Formatting a region requires this.
-
-The Title and Copyright Pages
-
-* titlepage:: Create a title for the printed document.
-* titlefont center sp:: The @code{@@titlefont}, @code{@@center},
- and @code{@@sp} commands.
-* title subtitle author:: The @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle},
- and @code{@@author} commands.
-* Copyright & Permissions:: How to write the copyright notice and
- include copying permissions.
-* end titlepage:: Turn on page headings after the title and
- copyright pages.
-* headings on off:: An option for turning headings on and off
- and double or single sided printing.
-
-The `Top' Node and Master Menu
-
-* Title of Top Node:: Sketch what the file is about.
-* Master Menu Parts:: A master menu has three or more parts.
-
-Ending a Texinfo File
-
-* Printing Indices & Menus:: How to print an index in hardcopy and
- generate index menus in Info.
-* Contents:: How to create a table of contents.
-* File End:: How to mark the end of a file.
-
-Chapter Structuring
-
-* Tree Structuring:: A manual is like an upside down tree @dots{}
-* Structuring Command Types:: How to divide a manual into parts.
-* makeinfo top:: The @code{@@top} command, part of the `Top' node.
-* chapter::
-* unnumbered & appendix::
-* majorheading & chapheading::
-* section::
-* unnumberedsec appendixsec heading::
-* subsection::
-* unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading::
-* subsubsection:: Commands for the lowest level sections.
-* Raise/lower sections:: How to change commands' hierarchical level.
-
-Nodes
-
-* Two Paths:: Different commands to structure
- Info output and printed output.
-* Node Menu Illustration:: A diagram, and sample nodes and menus.
-* node:: How to write a node, in detail.
-* makeinfo Pointer Creation:: How to create node pointers with @code{makeinfo}.
-
-The @code{@@node} Command
-
-* Node Names:: How to choose node and pointer names.
-* Writing a Node:: How to write an @code{@@node} line.
-* Node Line Tips:: Keep names short.
-* Node Line Requirements:: Keep names unique, without @@-commands.
-* First Node:: How to write a `Top' node.
-* makeinfo top command:: How to use the @code{@@top} command.
-* Top Node Summary:: Write a brief description for readers.
-
-Menus
-
-* Menu Location:: Put a menu in a short node.
-* Writing a Menu:: What is a menu?
-* Menu Parts:: A menu entry has three parts.
-* Less Cluttered Menu Entry:: Two part menu entry.
-* Menu Example:: Two and three part menu entries.
-* Other Info Files:: How to refer to a different Info file.
-
-Cross References
-
-* References:: What cross references are for.
-* Cross Reference Commands:: A summary of the different commands.
-* Cross Reference Parts:: A cross reference has several parts.
-* xref:: Begin a reference with `See' @dots{}
-* Top Node Naming:: How to refer to the beginning of another file.
-* ref:: A reference for the last part of a sentence.
-* pxref:: How to write a parenthetical cross reference.
-* inforef:: How to refer to an Info-only file.
-* uref:: How to refer to a uniform resource locator.
-
-@code{@@xref}
-
-* Reference Syntax:: What a reference looks like and requires.
-* One Argument:: @code{@@xref} with one argument.
-* Two Arguments:: @code{@@xref} with two arguments.
-* Three Arguments:: @code{@@xref} with three arguments.
-* Four and Five Arguments:: @code{@@xref} with four and five arguments.
-
-Marking Words and Phrases
-
-* Indicating:: How to indicate definitions, files, etc.
-* Emphasis:: How to emphasize text.
-
-Indicating Definitions, Commands, etc.
-
-* Useful Highlighting:: Highlighting provides useful information.
-* code:: How to indicate code.
-* kbd:: How to show keyboard input.
-* key:: How to specify keys.
-* samp:: How to show a literal sequence of characters.
-* var:: How to indicate a metasyntactic variable.
-* file:: How to indicate the name of a file.
-* dfn:: How to specify a definition.
-* cite:: How to refer to a book that is not in Info.
-* url:: How to indicate a world wide web reference.
-* email:: How to indicate an electronic mail address.
-
-Emphasizing Text
-
-* emph & strong:: How to emphasize text in Texinfo.
-* Smallcaps:: How to use the small caps font.
-* Fonts:: Various font commands for printed output.
-* Customized Highlighting:: How to define highlighting commands.
-
-Quotations and Examples
-
-* Block Enclosing Commands:: Use different constructs for
- different purposes.
-* quotation:: How to write a quotation.
-* example:: How to write an example in a fixed-width font.
-* noindent:: How to prevent paragraph indentation.
-* Lisp Example:: How to illustrate Lisp code.
-* smallexample & smalllisp:: Forms for the @code{@@smallbook} option.
-* display:: How to write an example in the current font.
-* format:: How to write an example that does not narrow
- the margins.
-* exdent:: How to undo the indentation of a line.
-* flushleft & flushright:: How to push text flushleft or flushright.
-* cartouche:: How to draw cartouches around examples.
-
-Lists and Tables
-
-* Introducing Lists:: Texinfo formats lists for you.
-* itemize:: How to construct a simple list.
-* enumerate:: How to construct a numbered list.
-* Two-column Tables:: How to construct a two-column table.
-* Multi-column Tables:: How to construct generalized tables.
-
-Making a Two-column Table
-
-* table:: How to construct a two-column table.
-* ftable vtable:: Automatic indexing for two-column tables.
-* itemx:: How to put more entries in the first column.
-
-Multi-column Tables
-
-* Multitable Column Widths:: Defining multitable column widths.
-* Multitable Rows:: Defining multitable rows, with examples.
-
-Creating Indices
-
-* Index Entries:: Choose different words for index entries.
-* Predefined Indices:: Use different indices for different kinds
- of entry.
-* Indexing Commands:: How to make an index entry.
-* Combining Indices:: How to combine indices.
-* New Indices:: How to define your own indices.
-
-Combining Indices
-
-* syncodeindex:: How to merge two indices, using @code{@@code}
- font for the merged-from index.
-* synindex:: How to merge two indices, using the
- default font of the merged-to index.
-
-Special Insertions
-
-* Braces Atsigns:: How to insert braces, @samp{@@}.
-* Inserting Space:: How to insert the right amount of space
- within a sentence.
-* Inserting Accents:: How to insert accents and special characters.
-* Dots Bullets:: How to insert dots and bullets.
-* TeX and copyright:: How to insert the @TeX{} logo
- and the copyright symbol.
-* pounds:: How to insert the pounds currency symbol.
-* minus:: How to insert a minus sign.
-* math:: How to format a mathematical expression.
-* Glyphs:: How to indicate results of evaluation,
- expansion of macros, errors, etc.
-* Images:: How to include graphics.
-
-Inserting @@ and Braces
-
-* Inserting An Atsign:: How to insert @samp{@@}.
-* Inserting Braces:: How to insert @samp{@{} and @samp{@}}.
-
-Inserting Space
-
-* Not Ending a Sentence:: Sometimes a . doesn't end a sentence.
-* Ending a Sentence:: Sometimes it does.
-* Multiple Spaces:: Inserting multiple spaces.
-* dmn:: How to format a dimension.
-
-Inserting Ellipsis, Dots, and Bullets
-
-* dots:: How to insert dots @dots{}
-* bullet:: How to insert a bullet.
-
-Inserting @TeX{} and the Copyright Symbol
-
-* tex:: How to insert the @TeX{} logo.
-* copyright symbol:: How to use @code{@@copyright}@{@}.
-
-Glyphs for Examples
-
-* Glyphs Summary::
-* result:: How to show the result of expression.
-* expansion:: How to indicate an expansion.
-* Print Glyph:: How to indicate printed output.
-* Error Glyph:: How to indicate an error message.
-* Equivalence:: How to indicate equivalence.
-* Point Glyph:: How to indicate the location of point.
-
-Glyphs Summary
-
-* result::
-* expansion::
-* Print Glyph::
-* Error Glyph::
-* Equivalence::
-* Point Glyph::
-
-Making and Preventing Breaks
-
-* Break Commands:: Cause and prevent splits.
-* Line Breaks:: How to force a single line to use two lines.
-* - and hyphenation:: How to tell TeX about hyphenation points.
-* w:: How to prevent unwanted line breaks.
-* sp:: How to insert blank lines.
-* page:: How to force the start of a new page.
-* group:: How to prevent unwanted page breaks.
-* need:: Another way to prevent unwanted page breaks.
-
-Definition Commands
-
-* Def Cmd Template:: How to structure a description using a
- definition command.
-* Optional Arguments:: How to handle optional and repeated arguments.
-* deffnx:: How to group two or more `first' lines.
-* Def Cmds in Detail:: All the definition commands.
-* Def Cmd Conventions:: Conventions for writing definitions.
-* Sample Function Definition::
-
-The Definition Commands
-
-* Functions Commands:: Commands for functions and similar entities.
-* Variables Commands:: Commands for variables and similar entities.
-* Typed Functions:: Commands for functions in typed languages.
-* Typed Variables:: Commands for variables in typed languages.
-* Abstract Objects:: Commands for object-oriented programming.
-* Data Types:: The definition command for data types.
-
-Footnotes
-
-* Footnote Commands:: How to write a footnote in Texinfo.
-* Footnote Styles:: Controlling how footnotes appear in Info.
-
-Conditionally Visible Text
-
-* Conditional Commands:: Specifying text for HTML, Info, or @TeX{}.
-* Conditional Not Commands:: Specifying text for not HTML, Info, or @TeX{}.
-* Raw Formatter Commands:: Using raw @TeX{} or HTML commands.
-* set clear value:: Designating which text to format (for
- all output formats); and how to set a
- flag to a string that you can insert.
-
-@code{@@set}, @code{@@clear}, and @code{@@value}
-
-* ifset ifclear:: Format a region if a flag is set.
-* value:: Replace a flag with a string.
-* value Example:: An easy way to update edition information.
-
-Macros: Defining New Texinfo Commands
-
-* Defining Macros:: Both defining and undefining new commands.
-* Invoking Macros:: Using a macro, once you've defined it.
-
-Format and Print Hardcopy
-
-* Use TeX:: Use @TeX{} to format for hardcopy.
-* Format with tex/texindex:: How to format in a shell.
-* Format with texi2dvi:: A simpler way to use the shell.
-* Print with lpr:: How to print.
-* Within Emacs:: How to format and print from an Emacs shell.
-* Texinfo Mode Printing:: How to format and print in Texinfo mode.
-* Compile-Command:: How to print using Emacs's compile command.
-* Requirements Summary:: @TeX{} formatting requirements summary.
-* Preparing for TeX:: What you need to do to use @TeX{}.
-* Overfull hboxes:: What are and what to do with overfull hboxes.
-* smallbook:: How to print small format books and manuals.
-* A4 Paper:: How to print on European A4 paper.
-* Cropmarks and Magnification:: How to print marks to indicate the size
- of pages and how to print scaled up output.
-
-Creating an Info File
-
-* makeinfo advantages:: @code{makeinfo} provides better error checking.
-* Invoking makeinfo:: How to run @code{makeinfo} from a shell.
-* makeinfo options:: Specify fill-column and other options.
-* Pointer Validation:: How to check that pointers point somewhere.
-* makeinfo in Emacs:: How to run @code{makeinfo} from Emacs.
-* texinfo-format commands:: Two Info formatting commands written
- in Emacs Lisp are an alternative
- to @code{makeinfo}.
-* Batch Formatting:: How to format for Info in Emacs Batch mode.
-* Tag and Split Files:: How tagged and split files help Info
- to run better.
-
-Installing an Info File
-
-* Directory file:: The top level menu for all Info files.
-* New Info File:: Listing a new info file.
-* Other Info Directories:: How to specify Info files that are
- located in other directories.
-* Installing Dir Entries:: How to specify what menu entry to add
- to the Info directory.
-* Invoking install-info:: @code{install-info} options.
-
-Sample Permissions
-
-* Inserting Permissions:: How to put permissions in your document.
-* ifinfo Permissions:: Sample @samp{ifinfo} copying permissions.
-* Titlepage Permissions:: Sample Titlepage copying permissions.
-
-Include Files
-
-* Using Include Files:: How to use the @code{@@include} command.
-* texinfo-multiple-files-update:: How to create and update nodes and
- menus when using included files.
-* Include File Requirements:: What @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update} expects.
-* Sample Include File:: A sample outer file with included files
- within it; and a sample included file.
-* Include Files Evolution:: How use of the @code{@@include} command
- has changed over time.
-
-Page Headings
-
-* Headings Introduced:: Conventions for using page headings.
-* Heading Format:: Standard page heading formats.
-* Heading Choice:: How to specify the type of page heading.
-* Custom Headings:: How to create your own headings and footings.
-
-Formatting Mistakes
-
-* makeinfo Preferred:: @code{makeinfo} finds errors.
-* Debugging with Info:: How to catch errors with Info formatting.
-* Debugging with TeX:: How to catch errors with @TeX{} formatting.
-* Using texinfo-show-structure:: How to use @code{texinfo-show-structure}.
-* Using occur:: How to list all lines containing a pattern.
-* Running Info-Validate:: How to find badly referenced nodes.
-
-Finding Badly Referenced Nodes
-
-* Using Info-validate:: How to run @code{Info-validate}.
-* Unsplit:: How to create an unsplit file.
-* Tagifying:: How to tagify a file.
-* Splitting:: How to split a file manually.
-
-How to Obtain @TeX{}
-
-@c * New Texinfo Mode Commands:: The updating commands are especially useful.
-@c * New Commands:: Many newly described @@-commands.
-@end detailmenu
-@end menu
-
-@node Copying, Overview, Top, Top
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@unnumbered Texinfo Copying Conditions
-@cindex Copying conditions
-@cindex Conditions for copying Texinfo
-
-The programs currently being distributed that relate to Texinfo include
-portions of GNU Emacs, plus other separate programs (including
-@code{makeinfo}, @code{info}, @code{texindex}, and @file{texinfo.tex}).
-These programs are @dfn{free}; this means that everyone is free to use
-them and free to redistribute them on a free basis. The Texinfo-related
-programs are not in the public domain; they are copyrighted and there
-are restrictions on their distribution, but these restrictions are
-designed to permit everything that a good cooperating citizen would want
-to do. What is not allowed is to try to prevent others from further
-sharing any version of these programs that they might get from
-you.@refill
-
- Specifically, we want to make sure that you have the right to give
-away copies of the programs that relate to Texinfo, that you receive
-source code or else can get it if you want it, that you can change these
-programs or use pieces of them in new free programs, and that you know
-you can do these things.@refill
-
- To make sure that everyone has such rights, we have to forbid you to
-deprive anyone else of these rights. For example, if you distribute
-copies of the Texinfo related programs, you must give the recipients all
-the rights that you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or
-can get the source code. And you must tell them their rights.@refill
-
- Also, for our own protection, we must make certain that everyone finds
-out that there is no warranty for the programs that relate to Texinfo.
-If these programs are modified by someone else and passed on, we want
-their recipients to know that what they have is not what we distributed,
-so that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on our
-reputation.@refill
-
- The precise conditions of the licenses for the programs currently
-being distributed that relate to Texinfo are found in the General Public
-Licenses that accompany them.@refill
-
-@node Overview, Texinfo Mode, Copying, Top
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@chapter Overview of Texinfo
-@cindex Overview of Texinfo
-@cindex Texinfo overview
-
-@dfn{Texinfo}@footnote{Note that the first syllable of ``Texinfo'' is
-pronounced like ``speck'', not ``hex''. This odd pronunciation is
-derived from, but is not the same as, the pronunciation of @TeX{}. In
-the word @TeX{}, the @samp{X} is actually the Greek letter ``chi''
-rather than the English letter ``ex''. Pronounce @TeX{} as if the
-@samp{X} were the last sound in the name `Bach'; but pronounce Texinfo
-as if the @samp{x} were a `k'. Spell ``Texinfo'' with a capital
``T''
-and write the other letters in lower case.}
-is a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
-on-line information and printed output. This means that instead of
-writing two different documents, one for the on-line help or other on-line
-information and the other for a typeset manual or other printed work, you
-need write only one document. When the work is revised, you need revise
-only one document. (You can read the on-line information, known as an
-@dfn{Info file}, with an Info documentation-reading program.)@refill
-
-@menu
-* Using Texinfo:: Create a conventional printed book
- or an Info file.
-* Info Files:: What is an Info file?
-* Printed Books:: Characteristics of a printed book or manual.
-* Formatting Commands:: @@-commands are used for formatting.
-* Conventions:: General rules for writing a Texinfo file.
-* Comments:: How to write comments and mark regions that
- the formatting commands will ignore.
-* Minimum:: What a Texinfo file must have.
-* Six Parts:: Usually, a Texinfo file has six parts.
-* Short Sample:: A short sample Texinfo file.
-* Acknowledgements::
-@end menu
-
-@node Using Texinfo, Info Files, Overview, Overview
-@ifinfo
-@heading Using Texinfo
-@end ifinfo
-
-Using Texinfo, you can create a printed document with the normal
-features of a book, including chapters, sections, cross references,
-and indices. From the same Texinfo source file, you can create a
-menu-driven, on-line Info file with nodes, menus, cross references,
-and indices. You can, if you wish, make the chapters and sections of
-the printed document correspond to the nodes of the on-line
-information; and you use the same cross references and indices for
-both the Info file and the printed work. @cite{The XEmacs User's
-Manual} is a good example of a Texinfo file, as is this manual.@refill
-
-To make a printed document, you process a Texinfo source file with the
-@TeX{} typesetting program. This creates a DVI file that you can
-typeset and print as a book or report. (Note that the Texinfo language
-is completely different from @TeX{}'s usual language, plain @TeX{}.) If
-you do not have @TeX{}, but do have @code{troff} or @code{nroff}, you
-can use the @code{texi2roff} program instead.@refill
-
-To make an Info file, you process a Texinfo source file with the
-@code{makeinfo} utility or Emacs's @code{texinfo-format-buffer} command;
-this creates an Info file that you can install on-line.@refill
-
-@TeX{} and @code{texi2roff} work with many types of printers; similarly,
-Info works with almost every type of computer terminal. This power
-makes Texinfo a general purpose system, but brings with it a constraint,
-which is that a Texinfo file may contain only the customary
-``typewriter'' characters (letters, numbers, spaces, and punctuation
-marks) but no special graphics.@refill
-
-A Texinfo file is a plain @sc{ascii} file containing text and
-@dfn{@@-commands} (words preceded by an @samp{@@}) that tell the
-typesetting and formatting programs what to do. You may edit a
-Texinfo file with any text editor; but it is especially convenient to
-use GNU Emacs since that editor has a special mode, called Texinfo
-mode, that provides various Texinfo-related features. (@xref{Texinfo
-Mode}.)@refill
-
-Before writing a Texinfo source file, you should become familiar with
-the Info documentation reading program and learn about nodes,
-menus, cross references, and the rest. (@inforef{Top, info, info},
-for more information.)@refill
-
-You can use Texinfo to create both on-line help and printed manuals;
-moreover, Texinfo is freely redistributable. For these reasons, Texinfo
-is the format in which documentation for GNU utilities and libraries is
-written.@refill
-
-@node Info Files, Printed Books, Using Texinfo, Overview
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Info files
-@cindex Info files
-
-An Info file is a Texinfo file formatted so that the Info documentation
-reading program can operate on it. (@code{makeinfo}
-and @code{texinfo-format-buffer} are two commands that convert a Texinfo file
-into an Info file.)@refill
-
-Info files are divided into pieces called @dfn{nodes}, each of which
-contains the discussion of one topic. Each node has a name, and
-contains both text for the user to read and pointers to other nodes,
-which are identified by their names. The Info program displays one node
-at a time, and provides commands with which the user can move to other
-related nodes.@refill
-
-@ifinfo
-@inforef{Top, info, info}, for more information about using Info.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-
-Each node of an Info file may have any number of child nodes that
-describe subtopics of the node's topic. The names of child
-nodes are listed in a @dfn{menu} within the parent node; this
-allows you to use certain Info commands to move to one of the child
-nodes. Generally, an Info file is organized like a book. If a node
-is at the logical level of a chapter, its child nodes are at the level
-of sections; likewise, the child nodes of sections are at the level
-of subsections.@refill
-
-All the children of any one parent are linked together in a
-bidirectional chain of `Next' and `Previous' pointers. The `Next'
-pointer provides a link to the next section, and the `Previous' pointer
-provides a link to the previous section. This means that all the nodes
-that are at the level of sections within a chapter are linked together.
-Normally the order in this chain is the same as the order of the
-children in the parent's menu. Each child node records the parent node
-name as its `Up' pointer. The last child has no `Next' pointer, and the
-first child has the parent both as its `Previous' and as its `Up'
-pointer.@footnote{In some documents, the first child has no `Previous'
-pointer. Occasionally, the last child has the node name of the next
-following higher level node as its `Next' pointer.}@refill
-
-The book-like structuring of an Info file into nodes that correspond
-to chapters, sections, and the like is a matter of convention, not a
-requirement. The `Up', `Previous', and `Next' pointers of a node can
-point to any other nodes, and a menu can contain any other nodes.
-Thus, the node structure can be any directed graph. But it is usually
-more comprehensible to follow a structure that corresponds to the
-structure of chapters and sections in a printed book or report.@refill
-
-In addition to menus and to `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers, Info
-provides pointers of another kind, called references, that can be
-sprinkled throughout the text. This is usually the best way to
-represent links that do not fit a hierarchical structure.@refill
-
-Usually, you will design a document so that its nodes match the
-structure of chapters and sections in the printed output. But
-occasionally there are times when this is not right for the material
-being discussed. Therefore, Texinfo uses separate commands to specify
-the node structure for the Info file and the section structure for the
-printed output.@refill
-
-Generally, you enter an Info file through a node that by convention is
-named `Top'. This node normally contains just a brief summary of the
-file's purpose, and a large menu through which the rest of the file is
-reached. From this node, you can either traverse the file
-systematically by going from node to node, or you can go to a specific
-node listed in the main menu, or you can search the index menus and then
-go directly to the node that has the information you want. Alternatively,
-with the standalone Info program, you can specify specific menu items on
-the command line (@pxref{Top,,, info, Info}).
-
-If you want to read through an Info file in sequence, as if it were a
-printed manual, you can hit @key{SPC} repeatedly, or you get the whole
-file with the advanced Info command @kbd{g *}. (@inforef{Expert,
-Advanced Info commands, info}.)@refill
-
-@c !!! dir file may be located in one of many places:
-@c /usr/local/emacs/info mentioned in info.c DEFAULT_INFOPATH
-@c /usr/local/lib/emacs/info mentioned in info.c DEFAULT_INFOPATH
-@c /usr/gnu/info mentioned in info.c DEFAULT_INFOPATH
-@c /usr/local/info
-@c /usr/local/lib/info
-The @file{dir} file in the @file{info} directory serves as the
-departure point for the whole Info system. From it, you can reach the
-`Top' nodes of each of the documents in a complete Info system.@refill
-
-@node Printed Books, Formatting Commands, Info Files, Overview
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Printed Books
-@cindex Printed book and manual characteristics
-@cindex Manual characteristics, printed
-@cindex Book characteristics, printed
-@cindex Texinfo printed book characteristics
-@cindex Characteristics, printed books or manuals
-
-@cindex Knuth, Donald
-A Texinfo file can be formatted and typeset as a printed book or manual.
-To do this, you need @TeX{}, a powerful, sophisticated typesetting
-program written by Donald Knuth.@footnote{You can also use the
-@code{texi2roff} program if you do not have @TeX{}; since Texinfo is
-designed for use with @TeX{}, @code{texi2roff} is not described here.
-@code{texi2roff} is not part of the standard GNU distribution.}
-
-A Texinfo-based book is similar to any other typeset, printed work: it
-can have a title page, copyright page, table of contents, and preface,
-as well as chapters, numbered or unnumbered sections and subsections,
-page headers, cross references, footnotes, and indices.@refill
-
-You can use Texinfo to write a book without ever having the intention
-of converting it into on-line information. You can use Texinfo for
-writing a printed novel, and even to write a printed memo, although
-this latter application is not recommended since electronic mail is so
-much easier.@refill
-
-@TeX{} is a general purpose typesetting program. Texinfo provides a
-file called @file{texinfo.tex} that contains information (definitions or
-@dfn{macros}) that @TeX{} uses when it typesets a Texinfo file.
-((a)file{texinfo.tex} tells @TeX{} how to convert the Texinfo @@-commands
-to @TeX{} commands, which @TeX{} can then process to create the typeset
-document.) @file{texinfo.tex} contains the specifications for printing
-a document.@refill
-
-Most often, documents are printed on 8.5 inch by 11 inch
-pages (216@dmn{mm} by 280@dmn{mm}; this is the default size), but you
-can also print for 7 inch by 9.25 inch pages (178@dmn{mm} by
-235@dmn{mm}; the @code{@@smallbook} size) or on European A4 size paper
-(@code{@@afourpaper}). (@xref{smallbook, , Printing ``Small'' Books}.
-Also, see @ref{A4 Paper, ,Printing on A4 Paper}.)@refill
-
-By changing the parameters in @file{texinfo.tex}, you can change the
-size of the printed document. In addition, you can change the style in
-which the printed document is formatted; for example, you can change the
-sizes and fonts used, the amount of indentation for each paragraph, the
-degree to which words are hyphenated, and the like. By changing the
-specifications, you can make a book look dignified, old and serious, or
-light-hearted, young and cheery.@refill
-
-@TeX{} is freely distributable. It is written in a superset of Pascal
-called WEB and can be compiled either in Pascal or (by using a
-conversion program that comes with the @TeX{} distribution) in C.
-(@xref{TeX Mode, ,@TeX{} Mode, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}, for information
-about @TeX{}.)@refill
-
-@TeX{} is very powerful and has a great many features. Because a
-Texinfo file must be able to present information both on a
-character-only terminal in Info form and in a typeset book, the
-formatting commands that Texinfo supports are necessarily
-limited.@refill
-
-@xref{Obtaining TeX, , How to Obtain @TeX{}}.
-
-
-@node Formatting Commands, Conventions, Printed Books, Overview
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @@-commands
-@cindex @@-commands
-@cindex Formatting commands
-
-In a Texinfo file, the commands that tell @TeX{} how to typeset the
-printed manual and tell @code{makeinfo} and
-@code{texinfo-format-buffer} how to create an Info file are preceded
-by @samp{@@}; they are called @dfn{@@-commands}. For example,
-@code{@@node} is the command to indicate a node and @code{@@chapter}
-is the command to indicate the start of a chapter.@refill
-
-@quotation
-@strong{Please note:} All the @@-commands, with the exception of the
-@code{@@TeX@{@}} command, must be written entirely in lower
-case.@refill
-@end quotation
-
-The Texinfo @@-commands are a strictly limited set of constructs. The
-strict limits make it possible for Texinfo files to be understood both
-by @TeX{} and by the code that converts them into Info files. You can
-display Info files on any terminal that displays alphabetic and
-numeric characters. Similarly, you can print the output generated by
-@TeX{} on a wide variety of printers.@refill
-
-Depending on what they do or what arguments@footnote{The word
-@dfn{argument} comes from the way it is used in mathematics and does
-not refer to a disputation between two people; it refers to the
-information presented to the command. According to the @cite{Oxford
-English Dictionary}, the word derives from the Latin for @dfn{to make
-clear, prove}; thus it came to mean `the evidence offered as proof',
-which is to say, `the information offered', which led to its
-mathematical meaning. In its other thread of derivation, the word
-came to mean `to assert in a manner against which others may make
-counter assertions', which led to the meaning of `argument' as a
-disputation.} they take, you need to write @@-commands on lines of
-their own or as part of sentences:@refill
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-Write a command such as @code{@@noindent} at the beginning of a line as
-the only text on the line. (@code{@@noindent} prevents the beginning of
-the next line from being indented as the beginning of a
-paragraph.)@refill
-
-@item
-Write a command such as @code{@@chapter} at the beginning of a line
-followed by the command's arguments, in this case the chapter title, on
-the rest of the line. (@code{@@chapter} creates chapter titles.)@refill
-
-@item
-Write a command such as @code{@@dots@{@}} wherever you wish but usually
-within a sentence. (@code{@@dots@{@}} creates dots @dots{})@refill
-
-@item
-Write a command such as @code{@@code@{@var{sample-code}@}} wherever you
-wish (but usually within a sentence) with its argument,
-@var{sample-code} in this example, between the braces. (@code{@@code}
-marks text as being code.)@refill
-
-@item
-Write a command such as @code{@@example} at the beginning of a line of
-its own; write the body-text on following lines; and write the matching
-@code{@@end} command, @code{@@end example} in this case, at the
-beginning of a line of its own after the body-text. (@code{@@example}
-@dots{} @code{@@end example} indents and typesets body-text as an
-example.)@refill
-@end itemize
-
-@noindent
-@cindex Braces, when to use
-As a general rule, a command requires braces if it mingles among other
-text; but it does not need braces if it starts a line of its own. The
-non-alphabetic commands, such as @code{@@:}, are exceptions to the rule;
-they do not need braces.@refill
-
-As you gain experience with Texinfo, you will rapidly learn how to
-write the different commands: the different ways to write commands
-make it easier to write and read Texinfo files than if all commands
-followed exactly the same syntax. (For details about @@-command
-syntax, see @ref{Command Syntax, , @@-Command Syntax}.)@refill
-
-@node Conventions, Comments, Formatting Commands, Overview
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section General Syntactic Conventions
-@cindex General syntactic conventions
-@cindex Syntactic conventions
-@cindex Conventions, syntactic
-
-All printable @sc{ascii} characters except @samp{@@}, @samp{@{} and
-@samp{@}} can appear in a Texinfo file and stand for themselves.
-@samp{@@} is the escape character which introduces commands.
-@samp{@{} and @samp{@}} should be used only to surround arguments to
-certain commands. To put one of these special characters into the
-document, put an @samp{@@} character in front of it, like this:
-@samp{@@@@}, @samp{@@@{}, and @samp{@@@}}.(a)refill
-
-@ifinfo
-It is customary in @TeX{} to use doubled single-quote characters to
-begin and end quotations: ` ` and ' ' (but without a space between the
-two single-quote characters). This convention should be followed in
-Texinfo files. @TeX{} converts doubled single-quote characters to
-left- and right-hand doubled quotation marks and Info converts doubled
-single-quote characters to @sc{ascii} double-quotes: ` ` and ' ' to "
.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-@iftex
-It is customary in @TeX{} to use doubled single-quote characters to
-begin and end quotations: @w{@tt{ `` }} and @w{@tt{ '' }}. This
-convention should be followed in Texinfo files. @TeX{} converts
-doubled single-quote characters to left- and right-hand doubled
-quotation marks, ``like this'', and Info converts doubled single-quote
-characters to @sc{ascii} double-quotes: @w{@tt{ `` }} and
-@w{@tt{ '' }} to @w{@tt{ " }}.@refill
-@end iftex
-
-Use three hyphens in a row, @samp{---}, for a dash---like this. In
-@TeX{}, a single or double hyphen produces a printed dash that is
-shorter than the usual typeset dash. Info reduces three hyphens to two
-for display on the screen.
-
-To prevent a paragraph from being indented in the printed manual, put
-the command @code{@@noindent} on a line by itself before the
-paragraph.@refill
-
-If you mark off a region of the Texinfo file with the @code{@@iftex}
-and @w{@code{@@end iftex}} commands, that region will appear only in
-the printed copy; in that region, you can use certain commands
-borrowed from plain @TeX{} that you cannot use in Info. Likewise, if
-you mark off a region with the @code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end ifinfo}
-commands, that region will appear only in the Info file; in that
-region, you can use Info commands that you cannot use in @TeX{}.
-Similarly for @code{@@ifhtml @dots{} @@end ifhtml},
-@code{@@ifnothtml @dots{} @@end ifnothtml},
-@code{@@ifnotinfo @dots{} @@end ifnotinfo},
-@code{@@ifnottex @dots{} @@end ifnottex},
-@xref{Conditionals}.
-
-@cindex Tabs; don't use!
-@quotation
-@strong{Caution:} Do not use tabs in a Texinfo file! @TeX{} uses
-variable-width fonts, which means that it cannot predefine a tab to work
-in all circumstances. Consequently, @TeX{} treats tabs like single
-spaces, and that is not what they look like. Furthermore,
-@code{makeinfo} does nothing special with tabs, and thus a tab character
-in your input file may appear differently in the output.
-
-@noindent
-To avoid this problem, Texinfo mode causes GNU Emacs to insert multiple
-spaces when you press the @key{TAB} key.@refill
-
-@noindent
-Also, you can run @code{untabify} in Emacs to convert tabs in a region
-to multiple spaces.@refill
-
-@noindent
-Don't use tabs.
-@end quotation
-
-@node Comments, Minimum, Conventions, Overview
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Comments
-
-You can write comments in a Texinfo file that will not appear in
-either the Info file or the printed manual by using the
-@code{@@comment} command (which may be abbreviated to @code{@@c}).
-Such comments are for the person who reads the Texinfo file. All the
-text on a line that follows either @code{@@comment} or @code{@@c} is a
-comment; the rest of the line does not appear in either the Info file
-or the printed manual. (Often, you can write the @code{@@comment} or
-@code{@@c} in the middle of a line, and only the text that follows after
-the @code{@@comment} or @code{@@c} command does not appear; but some
-commands, such as @code{@@settitle} and @code{@@setfilename}, work on a
-whole line. You cannot use @code{@@comment} or @code{@@c} in a line
-beginning with such a command.)@refill
-@cindex Comments
-@findex comment
-@findex c @r{(comment)}
-
-You can write long stretches of text that will not appear in either
-the Info file or the printed manual by using the @code{@@ignore} and
-@code{@@end ignore} commands. Write each of these commands on a line
-of its own, starting each command at the beginning of the line. Text
-between these two commands does not appear in the processed output.
-You can use @code{@@ignore} and @code{@@end ignore} for writing
-comments. Often, @code{@@ignore} and @code{@@end ignore} is used
-to enclose a part of the copying permissions that applies to the
-Texinfo source file of a document, but not to the Info or printed
-version of the document.@refill
-@cindex Ignored text
-@cindex Unprocessed text
-@findex ignore
-@c !!! Perhaps include this comment about ignore and ifset:
-@ignore
-Text enclosed by @code{@@ignore} or by failing @code{@@ifset} or
-@code{@@ifclear} conditions is ignored in the sense that it will not
-contribute to the formatted output. However, TeX and makeinfo must
-still parse the ignored text, in order to understand when to
-@emph{stop} ignoring text from the source file; that means that you
-will still get error messages if you have invalid Texinfo markup
-within ignored text.
-@end ignore
-
-@node Minimum, Six Parts, Comments, Overview
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section What a Texinfo File Must Have
-@cindex Minimal Texinfo file (requirements)
-@cindex Must have in Texinfo file
-@cindex Required in Texinfo file
-@cindex Texinfo file minimum
-
-By convention, the names of Texinfo files end with one of the
-extensions @file{.texinfo}, @file{.texi}, or @file{.tex}. The longer
-extension is preferred since it describes more clearly to a human
-reader the nature of the file. The shorter extensions are for
-operating systems that cannot handle long file names.@refill
-
-In order to be made into a printed manual and an Info file, a Texinfo
-file @strong{must} begin with lines like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-\input texinfo
-@@setfilename @var{info-file-name}
-@@settitle @var{name-of-manual}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-The contents of the file follow this beginning, and then you @strong{must} end
-a Texinfo file with a line like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@bye
-@end example
-
-@findex input @r{(@TeX{} command)}
-@noindent
-The @samp{\input texinfo} line tells @TeX{} to use the
-(a)file{texinfo.tex} file, which tells @TeX{} how to translate the Texinfo
-@@-commands into @TeX{} typesetting commands. (Note the use of the
-backslash, @samp{\}; this is correct for @TeX{}.) The
-@samp{@@setfilename} line provides a name for the Info file and tells
-@TeX{} to open auxiliary files. The @samp{@@settitle} line specifies a
-title for the page headers (or footers) of the printed manual.@refill
-
-The @code{@@bye} line at the end of the file on a line of its own tells
-the formatters that the file is ended and to stop formatting.@refill
-
-Usually, you will not use quite such a spare format, but will include
-mode setting and start-of-header and end-of-header lines at the
-beginning of a Texinfo file, like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*-
-@@c %**start of header
-@@setfilename @var{info-file-name}
-@@settitle @var{name-of-manual}
-@@c %**end of header
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-In the first line, @samp{-*-texinfo-*-} causes Emacs to switch into
-Texinfo mode when you edit the file.
-
-The @code{@@c} lines which surround the @samp{@@setfilename} and
-@samp{@@settitle} lines are optional, but you need them in order to
-run @TeX{} or Info on just part of the file. (@xref{Start of Header},
-for more information.)@refill
-
-Furthermore, you will usually provide a Texinfo file with a title
-page, indices, and the like. But the minimum, which can be useful
-for short documents, is just the three lines at the beginning and the
-one line at the end.@refill
-
-@node Six Parts, Short Sample, Minimum, Overview
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Six Parts of a Texinfo File
-
-Generally, a Texinfo file contains more than the minimal
-beginning and end---it usually contains six parts:@refill
-
-@table @r
-@item 1. Header
-The @dfn{Header} names the file, tells @TeX{} which definitions' file to
-use, and performs other ``housekeeping'' tasks.@refill
-
-@item 2. Summary Description and Copyright
-The @dfn{Summary Description and Copyright} segment describes the document
-and contains the copyright notice and copying permissions for the Info
-file. The segment must be enclosed between @code{@@ifinfo} and
-@code{@@end ifinfo} commands so that the formatters place it only in the Info
-file.@refill
-
-@item 3. Title and Copyright
-The @dfn{Title and Copyright} segment contains the title and copyright pages
-and copying permissions for the printed manual. The segment must be
-enclosed between @code{@@titlepage} and @code{@@end titlepage} commands.
-The title and copyright page appear only in the printed @w{manual}.@refill
-
-@item 4. `Top' Node and Master Menu
-The @dfn{Master Menu} contains a complete menu of all the nodes in the whole
-Info file. It appears only in the Info file, in the `Top' node.@refill
-
-@item 5. Body
-The @dfn{Body} of the document may be structured like a traditional book or
-encyclopedia or it may be free form.@refill
-
-@item 6. End
-The @dfn{End} contains commands for printing indices and generating
-the table of contents, and the @code{@@bye} command on a line of its
-own.@refill
-@end table
-
-@node Short Sample, Acknowledgements, Six Parts, Overview
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section A Short Sample Texinfo File
-@cindex Sample Texinfo file
-
-Here is a complete but very short Texinfo file, in six parts. The first
-three parts of the file, from @samp{\input texinfo} through to
-@samp{@@end titlepage}, look more intimidating than they are. Most of
-the material is standard boilerplate; when you write a manual, simply
-insert the names for your own manual in this segment. (@xref{Beginning a
-File}.)@refill
-
-@noindent
-In the following, the sample text is @emph{indented}; comments on it are
-not. The complete file, without any comments, is shown in
-@ref{Sample Texinfo File}.
-
-@subheading Part 1: Header
-
-@noindent
-The header does not appear in either the Info file or the
-printed output. It sets various parameters, including the
-name of the Info file and the title used in the header.
-
-@example
-@group
-\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*-
-@@c %**start of header
-@@setfilename sample.info
-@@settitle Sample Document
-@@c %**end of header
-
-@@setchapternewpage odd
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@subheading Part 2: Summary Description and Copyright
-
-@noindent
-The summary description and copyright segment does not
-appear in the printed document.
-
-@example
-@group
-@@ifinfo
-This is a short example of a complete Texinfo file.
-
-Copyright @@copyright@{@} 1990 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-@@end ifinfo
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@subheading Part 3: Titlepage and Copyright
-
-@noindent
-The titlepage segment does not appear in the Info file.
-
-@example
-@group
-@@titlepage
-@@sp 10
-@@comment The title is printed in a large font.
-@@center @@titlefont@{Sample Title@}
-@end group
-
-@group
-@@c The following two commands start the copyright page.
-@@page
-@@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
-Copyright @@copyright@{@} 1990 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-@@end titlepage
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@subheading Part 4: `Top' Node and Master Menu
-
-@noindent
-The `Top' node contains the master menu for the Info file.
-Since a printed manual uses a table of contents rather than
-a menu, the master menu appears only in the Info file.
-
-@example
-@group
-@@node Top, First Chapter, , (dir)
-@@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@example
-@group
-@@menu
-* First Chapter:: The first chapter is the
- only chapter in this sample.
-* Concept Index:: This index has two entries.
-@@end menu
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@subheading Part 5: The Body of the Document
-
-@noindent
-The body segment contains all the text of the document, but not the
-indices or table of contents. This example illustrates a node and a
-chapter containing an enumerated list.@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@node First Chapter, Concept Index, Top, Top
-@@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@@chapter First Chapter
-@@cindex Sample index entry
-@end group
-
-@group
-This is the contents of the first chapter.
-@@cindex Another sample index entry
-@end group
-
-@group
-Here is a numbered list.
-
-@@enumerate
-@@item
-This is the first item.
-
-@@item
-This is the second item.
-@@end enumerate
-@end group
-
-@group
-The @@code@{makeinfo@} and @@code@{texinfo-format-buffer@}
-commands transform a Texinfo file such as this into
-an Info file; and @@TeX@{@} typesets it for a printed
-manual.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@subheading Part 6: The End of the Document
-
-@noindent
-The end segment contains commands both for generating an index in a node
-and unnumbered chapter of its own and for generating the table of
-contents; and it contains the @code{@@bye} command that marks the end of
-the document.@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@node Concept Index, , First Chapter, Top
-@@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@@unnumbered Concept Index
-@end group
-
-@group
-@@printindex cp
-
-@@contents
-@@bye
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@subheading The Results
-
-Here is what the contents of the first chapter of the sample look like:
-
-@sp 1
-@need 700
-@quotation
-This is the contents of the first chapter.
-
-Here is a numbered list.
-
-@enumerate
-@item
-This is the first item.
-
-@item
-This is the second item.
-@end enumerate
-
-The @code{makeinfo} and @code{texinfo-format-buffer}
-commands transform a Texinfo file such as this into
-an Info file; and @TeX{} typesets it for a printed
-manual.
-@end quotation
-
-@node Acknowledgements, , Short Sample, Overview
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Acknowledgements
-
-@cindex Stallman, Richard M.
-@cindex Chassell, Robert J.
-@cindex Berry, Karl
-Richard M.@: Stallman wrote Edition 1.0 of this manual. @w{Robert J.@:
-Chassell} revised and extended it, starting with Edition 1.1. Karl
-Berry made updates for the Texinfo 3.8 and subsequent releases, starting
-with Edition 2.22.
-
-@cindex Pinard, Fran@,{c}ois
-@cindex Zuhn, David D.
-@cindex Weisshaus, Melissa
-Our thanks go out to all who helped improve this work, particularly to
-Fran@,{c}ois Pinard and @w{David D.@: Zuhn}, who tirelessly recorded and
-reported mistakes and obscurities; our special thanks go to Melissa
-Weisshaus for her frequent and often tedious reviews of nearly similar
-editions. Our mistakes are our own.
-
-Please send suggestions and corrections to:
-
-@example
-@group
-@r{Internet address:}
- bug-texinfo@(a)gnu.org
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-Please include the manual's edition number and update date in your messages.
-
-@node Texinfo Mode, Beginning a File, Overview, Top
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@chapter Using Texinfo Mode
-@cindex Texinfo mode
-@cindex Mode, using Texinfo
-@cindex GNU Emacs
-@cindex Emacs
-
-You may edit a Texinfo file with any text editor you choose. A Texinfo
-file is no different from any other @sc{ascii} file. However, GNU Emacs
-comes with a special mode, called Texinfo
-mode, that provides Emacs commands and tools to help ease your work.@refill
-
-This chapter describes features of GNU Emacs' Texinfo mode but not any
-features of the Texinfo formatting language. If you are reading this
-manual straight through from the beginning, you may want to skim through
-this chapter briefly and come back to it after reading succeeding
-chapters which describe the Texinfo formatting language in
-detail.@refill
-
-@menu
-* Texinfo Mode Overview:: How Texinfo mode can help you.
-* Emacs Editing:: Texinfo mode adds to GNU Emacs' general
- purpose editing features.
-* Inserting:: How to insert frequently used @@-commands.
-* Showing the Structure:: How to show the structure of a file.
-* Updating Nodes and Menus:: How to update or create new nodes and menus.
-* Info Formatting:: How to format for Info.
-* Printing:: How to format and print part or all of a file.
-* Texinfo Mode Summary:: Summary of all the Texinfo mode commands.
-@end menu
-
-@node Texinfo Mode Overview, Emacs Editing, Texinfo Mode, Texinfo Mode
-@ifinfo
-@heading Texinfo Mode Overview
-@end ifinfo
-
-Texinfo mode provides special features for working with Texinfo
-files:@refill
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-Insert frequently used @@-commands. @refill
-
-@item
-Automatically create @code{@@node} lines.
-
-@item
-Show the structure of a Texinfo source file.@refill
-
-@item
-Automatically create or update the `Next',
-`Previous', and `Up' pointers of a node.
-
-@item
-Automatically create or update menus.@refill
-
-@item
-Automatically create a master menu.@refill
-
-@item
-Format a part or all of a file for Info.@refill
-
-@item
-Typeset and print part or all of a file.@refill
-@end itemize
-
-Perhaps the two most helpful features are those for inserting frequently
-used @@-commands and for creating node pointers and menus.@refill
-
-@node Emacs Editing, Inserting, Texinfo Mode Overview, Texinfo Mode
-@section The Usual GNU Emacs Editing Commands
-
-In most cases, the usual Text mode commands work the same in Texinfo
-mode as they do in Text mode. Texinfo mode adds new editing commands
-and tools to GNU Emacs' general purpose editing features. The major
-difference concerns filling. In Texinfo mode, the paragraph
-separation variable and syntax table are redefined so that Texinfo
-commands that should be on lines of their own are not inadvertently
-included in paragraphs. Thus, the @kbd{M-q} (@code{fill-paragraph})
-command will refill a paragraph but not mix an indexing command on a
-line adjacent to it into the paragraph.@refill
-
-In addition, Texinfo mode sets the @code{page-delimiter} variable to
-the value of @code{texinfo-chapter-level-regexp}; by default, this is
-a regular expression matching the commands for chapters and their
-equivalents, such as appendices. With this value for the page
-delimiter, you can jump from chapter title to chapter title with the
-@kbd{C-x ]} (@code{forward-page}) and @kbd{C-x [}
-(@code{backward-page}) commands and narrow to a chapter with the
-@kbd{C-x p} (@code{narrow-to-page}) command. (@xref{Pages, , , xemacs,
-XEmacs User's Manual}, for details about the page commands.)@refill
-
-You may name a Texinfo file however you wish, but the convention is to
-end a Texinfo file name with one of the three extensions
-(a)file{.texinfo}, @file{.texi}, or @file{.tex}. A longer extension is
-preferred, since it is explicit, but a shorter extension may be
-necessary for operating systems that limit the length of file names.
-GNU Emacs automatically enters Texinfo mode when you visit a file with
-a @file{.texinfo} or @file{.texi}
-extension. Also, Emacs switches to Texinfo mode
-when you visit a
-file that has @samp{-*-texinfo-*-} in its first line. If ever you are
-in another mode and wish to switch to Texinfo mode, type @code{M-x
-texinfo-mode}.@refill
-
-Like all other Emacs features, you can customize or enhance Texinfo
-mode as you wish. In particular, the keybindings are very easy to
-change. The keybindings described here are the default or standard
-ones.@refill
-
-@node Inserting, Showing the Structure, Emacs Editing, Texinfo Mode
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Inserting Frequently Used Commands
-@cindex Inserting frequently used commands
-@cindex Frequently used commands, inserting
-@cindex Commands, inserting them
-
-Texinfo mode provides commands to insert various frequently used
-@@-commands into the buffer. You can use these commands to save
-keystrokes.@refill
-
-The insert commands are invoked by typing @kbd{C-c} twice and then the
-first letter of the @@-command:@refill
-
-@table @kbd
-@item C-c C-c c
-@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@code
-@findex texinfo-insert-@@code
-Insert @code{@@code@{@}} and put the
-cursor between the braces.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-c d
-@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@dfn
-@findex texinfo-insert-@@dfn
-Insert @code{@@dfn@{@}} and put the
-cursor between the braces.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-c e
-@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@end
-@findex texinfo-insert-@@end
-Insert @code{@@end} and attempt to insert the correct following word,
-such as @samp{example} or @samp{table}. (This command does not handle
-nested lists correctly, but inserts the word appropriate to the
-immediately preceding list.)@refill
-
-@item C-c C-c i
-@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@item
-@findex texinfo-insert-@@item
-Insert @code{@@item} and put the
-cursor at the beginning of the next line.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-c k
-@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@kbd
-@findex texinfo-insert-@@kbd
-Insert @code{@@kbd@{@}} and put the
-cursor between the braces.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-c n
-@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@node
-@findex texinfo-insert-@@node
-Insert @code{@@node} and a comment line
-listing the sequence for the `Next',
-`Previous', and `Up' nodes.
-Leave point after the @code{@@node}.(a)refill
-
-@item C-c C-c o
-@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@noindent
-@findex texinfo-insert-@@noindent
-Insert @code{@@noindent} and put the
-cursor at the beginning of the next line.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-c s
-@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@samp
-@findex texinfo-insert-@@samp
-Insert @code{@@samp@{@}} and put the
-cursor between the braces.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-c t
-@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@table
-@findex texinfo-insert-@@table
-Insert @code{@@table} followed by a @key{SPC}
-and leave the cursor after the @key{SPC}.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-c v
-@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@var
-@findex texinfo-insert-@@var
-Insert @code{@@var@{@}} and put the
-cursor between the braces.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-c x
-@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@example
-@findex texinfo-insert-@@example
-Insert @code{@@example} and put the
-cursor at the beginning of the next line.@refill
-
-@c M-@{ was the binding for texinfo-insert-braces;
-@c in Emacs 19, backward-paragraph will take this binding.
-@item C-c C-c @{
-@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-braces
-@findex texinfo-insert-braces
-Insert @code{@{@}} and put the cursor between the braces.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-c @}
-@itemx C-c C-c ]
-@itemx M-x up-list
-@findex up-list
-Move from between a pair of braces forward past the closing brace.
-Typing @kbd{C-c C-c ]} is easier than typing @kbd{C-c C-c @}}, which
-is, however, more mnemonic; hence the two keybindings. (Also, you can
-move out from between braces by typing @kbd{C-f}.)@refill
-@end table
-
-To put a command such as @w{@code{@@code@{@dots{}@}}} around an
-@emph{existing} word, position the cursor in front of the word and type
-@kbd{C-u 1 C-c C-c c}. This makes it easy to edit existing plain text.
-The value of the prefix argument tells Emacs how many words following
-point to include between braces---@samp{1} for one word, @samp{2} for
-two words, and so on. Use a negative argument to enclose the previous
-word or words. If you do not specify a prefix argument, Emacs inserts
-the @@-command string and positions the cursor between the braces. This
-feature works only for those @@-commands that operate on a word or words
-within one line, such as @code{@@kbd} and @code{@@var}.(a)refill
-
-This set of insert commands was created after analyzing the frequency
-with which different @@-commands are used in the @cite{GNU Emacs
-Manual} and the @cite{GDB Manual}. If you wish to add your own insert
-commands, you can bind a keyboard macro to a key, use abbreviations,
-or extend the code in @file{texinfo.el}.@refill
-
-@findex texinfo-start-menu-description
-@cindex Menu description, start
-@cindex Description for menu, start
-@kbd{C-c C-c C-d} (@code{texinfo-start-menu-description}) is an insert
-command that works differently from the other insert commands. It
-inserts a node's section or chapter title in the space for the
-description in a menu entry line. (A menu entry has three parts, the
-entry name, the node name, and the description. Only the node name is
-required, but a description helps explain what the node is about.
-@xref{Menu Parts, , The Parts of a Menu}.)@refill
-
-To use @code{texinfo-start-menu-description}, position point in a menu
-entry line and type @kbd{C-c C-c C-d}. The command looks for and copies
-the title that goes with the node name, and inserts the title as a
-description; it positions point at beginning of the inserted text so you
-can edit it. The function does not insert the title if the menu entry
-line already contains a description.@refill
-
-This command is only an aid to writing descriptions; it does not do the
-whole job. You must edit the inserted text since a title tends to use
-the same words as a node name but a useful description uses different
-words.@refill
-
-@node Showing the Structure, Updating Nodes and Menus, Inserting, Texinfo Mode
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Showing the Section Structure of a File
-@cindex Showing the section structure of a file
-@cindex Section structure of a file, showing it
-@cindex Structure of a file, showing it
-@cindex Outline of file structure, showing it
-@cindex Contents-like outline of file structure
-@cindex File section structure, showing it
-@cindex Texinfo file section structure, showing it
-
-You can show the section structure of a Texinfo file by using the
-@kbd{C-c C-s} command (@code{texinfo-show-structure}). This command
-shows the section structure of a Texinfo file by listing the lines
-that begin with the @@-commands for @code{@@chapter},
-@code{@@section}, and the like. It constructs what amounts
-to a table of contents. These lines are displayed in another buffer
-called the @samp{*Occur*} buffer. In that buffer, you can position
-the cursor over one of the lines and use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command
-(@code{occur-mode-goto-occurrence}), to jump to the corresponding spot
-in the Texinfo file.@refill
-
-@table @kbd
-@item C-c C-s
-@itemx M-x texinfo-show-structure
-@findex texinfo-show-structure
-Show the @code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, and such lines of a
-Texinfo file.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-c
-@itemx M-x occur-mode-goto-occurrence
-@findex occur-mode-goto-occurrence
-Go to the line in the Texinfo file corresponding to the line under the
-cursor in the @file{*Occur*} buffer.@refill
-@end table
-
-If you call @code{texinfo-show-structure} with a prefix argument by
-typing @w{@kbd{C-u C-c C-s}}, it will list not only those lines with the
-@@-commands for @code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, and the like,
-but also the @code{@@node} lines. (This is how the
-@code{texinfo-show-structure} command worked without an argument in
-the first version of Texinfo. It was changed because @code{@@node}
-lines clutter up the @samp{*Occur*} buffer and are usually not
-needed.) You can use @code{texinfo-show-structure} with a prefix
-argument to check whether the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers of
-an @code{@@node} line are correct.@refill
-
-Often, when you are working on a manual, you will be interested only
-in the structure of the current chapter. In this case, you can mark
-off the region of the buffer that you are interested in by using the
-@kbd{C-x n n} (@code{narrow-to-region}) command and
-@code{texinfo-show-structure} will work on only that region. To see
-the whole buffer again, use @w{@kbd{C-x n w}} (@code{widen}).
-(@xref{Narrowing, , , xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}, for more
-information about the narrowing commands.)@refill
-
-@vindex page-delimiter
-@cindex Page delimiter in Texinfo mode
-In addition to providing the @code{texinfo-show-structure} command,
-Texinfo mode sets the value of the page delimiter variable to match
-the chapter-level @@-commands. This enables you to use the @kbd{C-x
-]} (@code{forward-page}) and @kbd{C-x [} (@code{backward-page})
-commands to move forward and backward by chapter, and to use the
-@kbd{C-x p} (@code{narrow-to-page}) command to narrow to a chapter.
-@xref{Pages, , , xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}, for more information
-about the page commands.@refill
-
-@node Updating Nodes and Menus, Info Formatting, Showing the Structure, Texinfo Mode
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Updating Nodes and Menus
-@cindex Updating nodes and menus
-@cindex Create nodes, menus automatically
-@cindex Insert nodes, menus automatically
-@cindex Automatically insert nodes, menus
-
-Texinfo mode provides commands for automatically creating or updating
-menus and node pointers. The commands are called ``update'' commands
-because their most frequent use is for updating a Texinfo file after
-you have worked on it; but you can use them to insert the `Next',
-`Previous', and `Up' pointers into an @code{@@node} line that has none and to
-create menus in a file that has none.@refill
-
-If you do not use the updating commands, you need to write menus and
-node pointers by hand, which is a tedious task.@refill
-
-@menu
-* Updating Commands:: Five major updating commands.
-* Updating Requirements:: How to structure a Texinfo file for
- using the updating command.
-* Other Updating Commands:: How to indent descriptions, insert
- missing nodes lines, and update
- nodes in sequence.
-@end menu
-
-@node Updating Commands, Updating Requirements, Updating Nodes and Menus, Updating Nodes
and Menus
-@ifinfo
-@subheading The Updating Commands
-@end ifinfo
-
-You can use the updating commands@refill
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-to insert or update the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers of a
-node,@refill
-
-@item
-to insert or update the menu for a section, and@refill
-
-@item
-to create a master menu for a Texinfo source file.@refill
-@end itemize
-
-You can also use the commands to update all the nodes and menus in a
-region or in a whole Texinfo file.@refill
-
-The updating commands work only with conventional Texinfo files, which
-are structured hierarchically like books. In such files, a structuring
-command line must follow closely after each @code{@@node} line, except
-for the `Top' @code{@@node} line. (A @dfn{structuring command line} is
-a line beginning with @code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, or other
-similar command.)
-
-You can write the structuring command line on the line that follows
-immediately after an @code{@@node} line or else on the line that
-follows after a single @code{@@comment} line or a single
-@code{@@ifinfo} line. You cannot interpose more than one line between
-the @code{@@node} line and the structuring command line; and you may
-interpose only an @code{@@comment} line or an @code{@@ifinfo} line.
-
-Commands which work on a whole buffer require that the `Top' node be
-followed by a node with an @code{@@chapter} or equivalent-level command.
-Note that the menu updating commands will not create a main or master
-menu for a Texinfo file that has only @code{@@chapter}-level nodes! The
-menu updating commands only create menus @emph{within} nodes for lower level
-nodes. To create a menu of chapters, you must provide a `Top'
-node.@refill
-
-The menu updating commands remove menu entries that refer to other Info
-files since they do not refer to nodes within the current buffer. This
-is a deficiency. Rather than use menu entries, you can use cross
-references to refer to other Info files. None of the updating commands
-affect cross references.@refill
-
-Texinfo mode has five updating commands that are used most often: two
-are for updating the node pointers or menu of a single node (or a
-region); two are for updating every node pointer and menu in a file;
-and one, the @code{texinfo-master-menu} command, is for creating a
-master menu for a complete file, and optionally, for updating every
-node and menu in the whole Texinfo file.@refill
-
-The @code{texinfo-master-menu} command is the primary command:@refill
-
-@table @kbd
-@item C-c C-u m
-@itemx M-x texinfo-master-menu
-@findex texinfo-master-menu
-Create or update a master menu that includes all the other menus
-(incorporating the descriptions from pre-existing menus, if
-any).@refill
-
-With an argument (prefix argument, @kbd{C-u,} if interactive), first create or
-update all the nodes and all the regular menus in the buffer before
-constructing the master menu. (@xref{The Top Node, , The Top Node and
-Master Menu}, for more about a master menu.)@refill
-
-For @code{texinfo-master-menu} to work, the Texinfo file must have a
-`Top' node and at least one subsequent node.@refill
-
-After extensively editing a Texinfo file, you can type the following:
-
-@example
-C-u M-x texinfo-master-menu
-@exdent or
-C-u C-c C-u m
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This updates all the nodes and menus completely and all at once.@refill
-@end table
-
-The other major updating commands do smaller jobs and are designed for
-the person who updates nodes and menus as he or she writes a Texinfo
-file.@refill
-
-@need 1000
-The commands are:@refill
-
-@table @kbd
-@item C-c C-u C-n
-@itemx M-x texinfo-update-node
-@findex texinfo-update-node
-Insert the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers for the node that point is
-within (i.e., for the @code{@@node} line preceding point). If the
-@code{@@node} line has pre-existing `Next', `Previous', or `Up'
-pointers in it, the old pointers are removed and new ones inserted.
-With an argument (prefix argument, @kbd{C-u}, if interactive), this command
-updates all @code{@@node} lines in the region (which is the text
-between point and mark).@refill
-
-@item C-c C-u C-m
-@itemx M-x texinfo-make-menu
-@findex texinfo-make-menu
-Create or update the menu in the node that point is within.
-With an argument (@kbd{C-u} as prefix argument, if
-interactive), the command makes or updates menus for the
-nodes which are either within or a part of the
-region.@refill
-
-Whenever @code{texinfo-make-menu} updates an existing menu, the
-descriptions from that menu are incorporated into the new menu. This
-is done by copying descriptions from the existing menu to the entries
-in the new menu that have the same node names. If the node names are
-different, the descriptions are not copied to the new menu.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-u C-e
-@itemx M-x texinfo-every-node-update
-@findex texinfo-every-node-update
-Insert or update the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers for every
-node in the buffer.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-u C-a
-@itemx M-x texinfo-all-menus-update
-@findex texinfo-all-menus-update
-Create or update all the menus in the buffer. With an argument
-(@kbd{C-u} as prefix argument, if interactive), first insert
-or update all the node
-pointers before working on the menus.@refill
-
-If a master menu exists, the @code{texinfo-all-menus-update} command
-updates it; but the command does not create a new master menu if none
-already exists. (Use the @code{texinfo-master-menu} command for
-that.)@refill
-
-When working on a document that does not merit a master menu, you can
-type the following:
-
-@example
-C-u C-c C-u C-a
-@exdent or
-C-u M-x texinfo-all-menus-update
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This updates all the nodes and menus.@refill
-@end table
-
-The @code{texinfo-column-for-description} variable specifies the
-column to which menu descriptions are indented. By default, the value
-is 32 although it is often useful to reduce it to as low as 24. You
-can set the variable with the @kbd{M-x edit-options} command
-(@pxref{Edit Options, , Editing Variable Values, xemacs, XEmacs User's
-Manual}) or with the @kbd{M-x set-variable} command (@pxref{Examining, ,
-Examining and Setting Variables, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}).@refill
-
-Also, the @code{texinfo-indent-menu-description} command may be used to
-indent existing menu descriptions to a specified column. Finally, if
-you wish, you can use the @code{texinfo-insert-node-lines} command to
-insert missing @code{@@node} lines into a file. (@xref{Other Updating
-Commands}, for more information.)@refill
-
-@node Updating Requirements, Other Updating Commands, Updating Commands, Updating Nodes
and Menus
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection Updating Requirements
-@cindex Updating requirements
-@cindex Requirements for updating commands
-
-To use the updating commands, you must organize the Texinfo file
-hierarchically with chapters, sections, subsections, and the like.
-When you construct the hierarchy of the manual, do not `jump down'
-more than one level at a time: you can follow the `Top' node with a
-chapter, but not with a section; you can follow a chapter with a
-section, but not with a subsection. However, you may `jump up' any
-number of levels at one time---for example, from a subsection to a
-chapter.@refill
-
-Each @code{@@node} line, with the exception of the line for the `Top'
-node, must be followed by a line with a structuring command such as
-@code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, or
-@code{@@unnumberedsubsec}.(a)refill
-
-Each @code{@@node} line/structuring-command line combination
-must look either like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@node Comments, Minimum, Conventions, Overview
-@@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@@section Comments
-@end group
-@end example
-
-or like this (without the @code{@@comment} line):
-
-@example
-@group
-@@node Comments, Minimum, Conventions, Overview
-@@section Comments
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-In this example, `Comments' is the name of both the node and the
-section. The next node is called `Minimum' and the previous node is
-called `Conventions'. The `Comments' section is within the `Overview'
-node, which is specified by the `Up' pointer. (Instead of an
-@code{@@comment} line, you can write an @code{@@ifinfo} line.)@refill
-
-If a file has a `Top' node, it must be called @samp{top} or @samp{Top}
-and be the first node in the file.@refill
-
-The menu updating commands create a menu of sections within a chapter,
-a menu of subsections within a section, and so on. This means that
-you must have a `Top' node if you want a menu of chapters.@refill
-
-Incidentally, the @code{makeinfo} command will create an Info file for
-a hierarchically organized Texinfo file that lacks `Next', `Previous'
-and `Up' pointers. Thus, if you can be sure that your Texinfo file
-will be formatted with @code{makeinfo}, you have no need for the
-`update node' commands. (@xref{Create an Info File, , Creating an
-Info File}, for more information about @code{makeinfo}.) However,
-both @code{makeinfo} and the @code{texinfo-format-@dots{}} commands
-require that you insert menus in the file.@refill
-
-@node Other Updating Commands, , Updating Requirements, Updating Nodes and Menus
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection Other Updating Commands
-
-In addition to the five major updating commands, Texinfo mode
-possesses several less frequently used updating commands:@refill
-
-@table @kbd
-@item M-x texinfo-insert-node-lines
-@findex texinfo-insert-node-lines
-Insert @code{@@node} lines before the @code{@@chapter},
-@code{@@section}, and other sectioning commands wherever they are
-missing throughout a region in a Texinfo file.@refill
-
-With an argument (@kbd{C-u} as prefix argument, if interactive), the
-@code{texinfo-insert-node-lines} command not only inserts
-@code{@@node} lines but also inserts the chapter or section titles as
-the names of the corresponding nodes. In addition, it inserts the
-titles as node names in pre-existing @code{@@node} lines that lack
-names. Since node names should be more concise than section or
-chapter titles, you must manually edit node names so inserted.@refill
-
-For example, the following marks a whole buffer as a region and inserts
-@code{@@node} lines and titles throughout:@refill
-
-@example
-C-x h C-u M-x texinfo-insert-node-lines
-@end example
-
-(Note that this command inserts titles as node names in @code{@@node}
-lines; the @code{texinfo-start-menu-description} command
-(@pxref{Inserting, Inserting Frequently Used Commands}) inserts titles
-as descriptions in menu entries, a different action. However, in both
-cases, you need to edit the inserted text.)@refill
-
-@item M-x texinfo-multiple-files-update
-@findex texinfo-multiple-files-update @r{(in brief)}
-Update nodes and menus in a document built from several separate files.
-With @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, create and insert a master menu in
-the outer file. With a numeric prefix argument, such as @kbd{C-u 2}, first
-update all the menus and all the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers
-of all the included files before creating and inserting a master menu in
-the outer file. The @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update} command is
-described in the appendix on @code{@@include} files.
-@ifinfo
-@xref{texinfo-multiple-files-update}.(a)refill
-@end ifinfo
-@iftex
-@xref{texinfo-multiple-files-update, ,
-@code{texinfo-multiple-files-update}}.(a)refill
-@end iftex
-
-@item M-x texinfo-indent-menu-description
-@findex texinfo-indent-menu-description
-Indent every description in the menu following point to the specified
-column. You can use this command to give yourself more space for
-descriptions. With an argument (@kbd{C-u} as prefix argument, if
-interactive), the @code{texinfo-indent-menu-description} command indents
-every description in every menu in the region. However, this command
-does not indent the second and subsequent lines of a multi-line
-description.@refill
-
-@item M-x texinfo-sequential-node-update
-@findex texinfo-sequential-node-update
-Insert the names of the nodes immediately following and preceding the
-current node as the `Next' or `Previous' pointers regardless of those
-nodes' hierarchical level. This means that the `Next' node of a
-subsection may well be the next chapter. Sequentially ordered nodes are
-useful for novels and other documents that you read through
-sequentially. (However, in Info, the @kbd{g *} command lets
-you look through the file sequentially, so sequentially ordered nodes
-are not strictly necessary.) With an argument (prefix argument, if
-interactive), the @code{texinfo-sequential-node-update} command
-sequentially updates all the nodes in the region.@refill
-@end table
-
-@node Info Formatting, Printing, Updating Nodes and Menus, Texinfo Mode
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Formatting for Info
-@cindex Formatting for Info
-@cindex Running an Info formatter
-@cindex Info formatting
-
-Texinfo mode provides several commands for formatting part or all of a
-Texinfo file for Info. Often, when you are writing a document, you
-want to format only part of a file---that is, a region.@refill
-
-You can use either the @code{texinfo-format-region} or the
-@code{makeinfo-region} command to format a region:@refill
-
-@table @kbd
-@findex texinfo-format-region
-@item C-c C-e C-r
-@itemx M-x texinfo-format-region
-@itemx C-c C-m C-r
-@itemx M-x makeinfo-region
-Format the current region for Info.@refill
-@end table
-
-You can use either the @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or the
-@code{makeinfo-buffer} command to format a whole buffer:@refill
-
-@table @kbd
-@findex texinfo-format-buffer
-@item C-c C-e C-b
-@itemx M-x texinfo-format-buffer
-@itemx C-c C-m C-b
-@itemx M-x makeinfo-buffer
-Format the current buffer for Info.@refill
-@end table
-
-@need 1000
-For example, after writing a Texinfo file, you can type the following:
-
-@example
-C-u C-c C-u m
-@exdent or
-C-u M-x texinfo-master-menu
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This updates all the nodes and menus. Then type the following to create
-an Info file:
-
-@example
-C-c C-m C-b
-@exdent or
-M-x makeinfo-buffer
-@end example
-
-For @TeX{} or the Info formatting commands to work, the file @emph{must}
-include a line that has @code{@@setfilename} in its header.@refill
-
-@xref{Create an Info File}, for details about Info formatting.@refill
-
-@node Printing, Texinfo Mode Summary, Info Formatting, Texinfo Mode
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Formatting and Printing
-@cindex Formatting for printing
-@cindex Printing a region or buffer
-@cindex Region formatting and printing
-@cindex Buffer formatting and printing
-@cindex Part of file formatting and printing
-
-Typesetting and printing a Texinfo file is a multi-step process in which
-you first create a file for printing (called a DVI file), and then
-print the file. Optionally, you may also create indices. To do this,
-you must run the @code{texindex} command after first running the
-@code{tex} typesetting command; and then you must run the @code{tex}
-command again. Or else run the @code{texi2dvi} command which
-automatically creates indices as needed (@pxref{Format with texi2dvi}).
-
-Often, when you are writing a document, you want to typeset and print
-only part of a file to see what it will look like. You can use the
-@code{texinfo-tex-region} and related commands for this purpose. Use
-the @code{texinfo-tex-buffer} command to format all of a
-buffer.@refill
-
-@table @kbd
-@item C-c C-t C-b
-@itemx M-x texinfo-tex-buffer
-@findex texinfo-tex-buffer
-Run @code{texi2dvi} on the buffer. In addition to running @TeX{} on the
-buffer, this command automatically creates or updates indices as
-needed.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-t C-r
-@itemx M-x texinfo-tex-region
-@findex texinfo-tex-region
-Run @TeX{} on the region.@refill
-
-@item C-c C-t C-i
-@itemx M-x texinfo-texindex
-Run @code{texindex} to sort the indices of a Texinfo file formatted with
-@code{texinfo-tex-region}. The @code{texinfo-tex-region} command does
-not run @code{texindex} automatically; it only runs the @code{tex}
-typesetting command. You must run the @code{texinfo-tex-region} command
-a second time after sorting the raw index files with the @code{texindex}
-command. (Usually, you do not format an index when you format a region,
-only when you format a buffer. Now that the @code{texi2dvi} command
-exists, there is little or no need for this command.)@refill
-
-@item C-c C-t C-p
-@itemx M-x texinfo-tex-print
-@findex texinfo-tex-print
-Print the file (or the part of the file) previously formatted with
-@code{texinfo-tex-buffer} or @code{texinfo-tex-region}.@refill
-@end table
-
-For @code{texinfo-tex-region} or @code{texinfo-tex-buffer} to work, the
-file @emph{must} start with a @samp{\input texinfo} line and must
-include an @code{@@settitle} line. The file must end with @code{@@bye}
-on a line by itself. (When you use @code{texinfo-tex-region}, you must
-surround the @code{@@settitle} line with start-of-header and
-end-of-header lines.)@refill
-
-@xref{Format/Print Hardcopy}, for a description of the other @TeX{} related
-commands, such as @code{tex-show-print-queue}.@refill
-
-@node Texinfo Mode Summary, , Printing, Texinfo Mode
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Texinfo Mode Summary
-
-In Texinfo mode, each set of commands has default keybindings that
-begin with the same keys. All the commands that are custom-created
-for Texinfo mode begin with @kbd{C-c}. The keys are somewhat
-mnemonic.@refill
-
-@subheading Insert Commands
-
-The insert commands are invoked by typing @kbd{C-c} twice and then the
-first letter of the @@-command to be inserted. (It might make more
-sense mnemonically to use @kbd{C-c C-i}, for `custom insert', but
-@kbd{C-c C-c} is quick to type.)@refill
-
-@example
-C-c C-c c @r{Insert} @samp{@@code}.
-C-c C-c d @r{Insert} @samp{@@dfn}.
-C-c C-c e @r{Insert} @samp{@@end}.
-C-c C-c i @r{Insert} @samp{@@item}.
-C-c C-c n @r{Insert} @samp{@@node}.
-C-c C-c s @r{Insert} @samp{@@samp}.
-C-c C-c v @r{Insert} @samp{@@var}.
-C-c C-c @{ @r{Insert braces.}
-C-c C-c ]
-C-c C-c @} @r{Move out of enclosing braces.}
-
-@group
-C-c C-c C-d @r{Insert a node's section title}
- @r{in the space for the description}
- @r{in a menu entry line.}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@subheading Show Structure
-
-The @code{texinfo-show-structure} command is often used within a
-narrowed region.@refill
-
-@example
-C-c C-s @r{List all the headings.}
-@end example
-
-@subheading The Master Update Command
-
-The @code{texinfo-master-menu} command creates a master menu; and can
-be used to update every node and menu in a file as well.@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-C-c C-u m
-M-x texinfo-master-menu
- @r{Create or update a master menu.}
-@end group
-
-@group
-C-u C-c C-u m @r{With @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, first}
- @r{create or update all nodes and regular}
- @r{menus, and then create a master menu.}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@subheading Update Pointers
-
-The update pointer commands are invoked by typing @kbd{C-c C-u} and
-then either @kbd{C-n} for @code{texinfo-update-node} or @kbd{C-e} for
-@code{texinfo-every-node-update}.(a)refill
-
-@example
-C-c C-u C-n @r{Update a node.}
-C-c C-u C-e @r{Update every node in the buffer.}
-@end example
-
-@subheading Update Menus
-
-Invoke the update menu commands by typing @kbd{C-c C-u}
-and then either @kbd{C-m} for @code{texinfo-make-menu} or
-@kbd{C-a} for @code{texinfo-all-menus-update}. To update
-both nodes and menus at the same time, precede @kbd{C-c C-u
-C-a} with @kbd{C-u}.@refill
-
-@example
-C-c C-u C-m @r{Make or update a menu.}
-
-@group
-C-c C-u C-a @r{Make or update all}
- @r{menus in a buffer.}
-@end group
-
-@group
-C-u C-c C-u C-a @r{With @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument,}
- @r{first create or update all nodes and}
- @r{then create or update all menus.}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@subheading Format for Info
-
-The Info formatting commands that are written in Emacs Lisp are
-invoked by typing @kbd{C-c C-e} and then either @kbd{C-r} for a region
-or @kbd{C-b} for the whole buffer.@refill
-
-The Info formatting commands that are written in C and based on the
-@code{makeinfo} program are invoked by typing @kbd{C-c C-m} and then
-either @kbd{C-r} for a region or @kbd{C-b} for the whole buffer.@refill
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-Use the @code{texinfo-format@dots{}} commands:
-
-@example
-@group
-C-c C-e C-r @r{Format the region.}
-C-c C-e C-b @r{Format the buffer.}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@need 750
-@noindent
-Use @code{makeinfo}:
-
-@example
-C-c C-m C-r @r{Format the region.}
-C-c C-m C-b @r{Format the buffer.}
-C-c C-m C-l @r{Recenter the @code{makeinfo} output buffer.}
-C-c C-m C-k @r{Kill the @code{makeinfo} formatting job.}
-@end example
-
-@subheading Typeset and Print
-
-The @TeX{} typesetting and printing commands are invoked by typing
-@kbd{C-c C-t} and then another control command: @kbd{C-r} for
-@code{texinfo-tex-region}, @kbd{C-b} for @code{texinfo-tex-buffer},
-and so on.@refill
-
-@example
-C-c C-t C-r @r{Run @TeX{} on the region.}
-C-c C-t C-b @r{Run} @code{texi2dvi} @r{on the buffer.}
-C-c C-t C-i @r{Run} @code{texindex}.
-C-c C-t C-p @r{Print the DVI file.}
-C-c C-t C-q @r{Show the print queue.}
-C-c C-t C-d @r{Delete a job from the print queue.}
-C-c C-t C-k @r{Kill the current @TeX{} formatting job.}
-C-c C-t C-x @r{Quit a currently stopped @TeX{} formatting job.}
-C-c C-t C-l @r{Recenter the output buffer.}
-@end example
-
-@subheading Other Updating Commands
-
-The `other updating commands' do not have standard keybindings because
-they are rarely used.
-
-@example
-@group
-M-x texinfo-insert-node-lines
- @r{Insert missing @code{@@node} lines in region.}
- @r{With @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument,}
- @r{use section titles as node names.}
-@end group
-
-@group
-M-x texinfo-multiple-files-update
- @r{Update a multi-file document.}
- @r{With @kbd{C-u 2} as a prefix argument,}
- @r{create or update all nodes and menus}
- @r{in all included files first.}
-@end group
-
-@group
-M-x texinfo-indent-menu-description
- @r{Indent descriptions.}
-@end group
-
-@group
-M-x texinfo-sequential-node-update
- @r{Insert node pointers in strict sequence.}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@node Beginning a File, Ending a File, Texinfo Mode, Top
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@chapter Beginning a Texinfo File
-@cindex Beginning a Texinfo file
-@cindex Texinfo file beginning
-@cindex File beginning
-
-Certain pieces of information must be provided at the beginning of a
-Texinfo file, such as the name of the file and the title of the
-document.@refill
-
-@menu
-* Four Parts:: Four parts begin a Texinfo file.
-* Sample Beginning:: Here is a sample beginning for a Texinfo file.
-* Header:: The very beginning of a Texinfo file.
-* Info Summary and Permissions:: Summary and copying permissions for Info.
-* Titlepage & Copyright Page:: Creating the title and copyright pages.
-* The Top Node:: Creating the `Top' node and master menu.
-* Software Copying Permissions:: Ensure that you and others continue to
- have the right to use and share software.
-@end menu
-
-@node Four Parts, Sample Beginning, Beginning a File, Beginning a File
-@ifinfo
-@heading Four Parts Begin a File
-@end ifinfo
-
-Generally, the beginning of a Texinfo file has four parts:@refill
-
-@enumerate
-@item
-The header, delimited by special comment lines, that includes the
-commands for naming the Texinfo file and telling @TeX{} what
-definitions file to use when processing the Texinfo file.@refill
-
-@item
-A short statement of what the file is about, with a copyright notice
-and copying permissions. This is enclosed in @code{@@ifinfo} and
-@code{@@end ifinfo} commands so that the formatters place it only
-in the Info file.@refill
-
-@item
-A title page and copyright page, with a copyright notice and copying
-permissions. This is enclosed between @code{@@titlepage} and
-@code{@@end titlepage} commands. The title and copyright page appear
-only in the printed @w{manual}.@refill
-
-@item
-The `Top' node that contains a menu for the whole Info file. The
-contents of this node appear only in the Info file.@refill
-@end enumerate
-
-Also, optionally, you may include the copying conditions for a program
-and a warranty disclaimer. The copying section will be followed by an
-introduction or else by the first chapter of the manual.@refill
-
-Since the copyright notice and copying permissions for the Texinfo
-document (in contrast to the copying permissions for a program) are in
-parts that appear only in the Info file or only in the printed manual,
-this information must be given twice.@refill
-
-@node Sample Beginning, Header, Four Parts, Beginning a File
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Sample Texinfo File Beginning
-
-The following sample shows what is needed.@refill
-
-@example
-\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*-
-@@c %**start of header
-@@setfilename @var{name-of-info-file}
-@@settitle @var{name-of-manual}
-@@setchapternewpage odd
-@@c %**end of header
-
-@@ifinfo
-This file documents @dots{}
-
-Copyright @var{year} @var{copyright-owner}
-
-@group
-Permission is granted to @dots{}
-@@end ifinfo
-@end group
-
-@group
-@@c This title page illustrates only one of the
-@@c two methods of forming a title page.
-@end group
-
-@group
-@@titlepage
-@@title @var{name-of-manual-when-printed}
-@@subtitle @var{subtitle-if-any}
-@@subtitle @var{second-subtitle}
-@@author @var{author}
-@end group
-
-@group
-@@c The following two commands
-@@c start the copyright page.
-@@page
-@@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
-Copyright @@copyright@{@} @var{year} @var{copyright-owner}
-@end group
-
-Published by @dots{}
-
-Permission is granted to @dots{}
-@@end titlepage
-
-@@node Top, Overview, , (dir)
-
-@@ifinfo
-This document describes @dots{}
-
-This document applies to version @dots{}
-of the program named @dots{}
-@@end ifinfo
-
-@group
-@@menu
-* Copying:: Your rights and freedoms.
-* First Chapter:: Getting started @dots{}
-* Second Chapter:: @dots{}
- @dots{}
- @dots{}
-@@end menu
-@end group
-
-@group
-@@node First Chapter, Second Chapter, top, top
-@@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@@chapter First Chapter
-@@cindex Index entry for First Chapter
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@node Header, Info Summary and Permissions, Sample Beginning, Beginning a File
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section The Texinfo File Header
-@cindex Header for Texinfo files
-@cindex Texinfo file header
-
-Texinfo files start with at least three lines that provide Info and
-@TeX{} with necessary information. These are the @code{\input
-texinfo} line, the @code{@@settitle} line, and the
-@code{@@setfilename} line. If you want to run @TeX{} on just a part
-of the Texinfo File, you must write the @code{@@settitle}
-and @code{@@setfilename} lines between start-of-header and end-of-header
-lines.@refill
-
-Thus, the beginning of a Texinfo file looks like this:
-
-@example
-@group
-\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*-
-@@setfilename sample.info
-@@settitle Sample Document
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-or else like this:
-
-@example
-@group
-\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*-
-@@c %**start of header
-@@setfilename sample.info
-@@settitle Sample Document
-@@c %**end of header
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@menu
-* First Line:: The first line of a Texinfo file.
-* Start of Header:: Formatting a region requires this.
-* setfilename:: Tell Info the name of the Info file.
-* settitle:: Create a title for the printed work.
-* setchapternewpage:: Start chapters on right-hand pages.
-* paragraphindent:: An option to specify paragraph indentation.
-* End of Header:: Formatting a region requires this.
-@end menu
-
-@node First Line, Start of Header, Header, Header
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection The First Line of a Texinfo File
-@cindex First line of a Texinfo file
-@cindex Beginning line of a Texinfo file
-@cindex Header of a Texinfo file
-
-Every Texinfo file that is to be the top-level input to @TeX{} must begin
-with a line that looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*-
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This line serves two functions:
-
-@enumerate
-@item
-When the file is processed by @TeX{}, the @samp{\input texinfo} command
-tells @TeX{} to load the macros needed for processing a Texinfo file.
-These are in a file called @file{texinfo.tex}, which is usually located
-in the @file{/usr/lib/tex/macros} directory. @TeX{} uses the backslash,
-@samp{\}, to mark the beginning of a command, just as Texinfo uses
-@samp{@@}. The @file{texinfo.tex} file causes the switch from @samp{\}
-to @samp{@@}; before the switch occurs, @TeX{} requires @samp{\}, which
-is why it appears at the beginning of the file.@refill
-
-@item
-When the file is edited in GNU Emacs, the @samp{-*-texinfo-*-} mode
-specification tells Emacs to use Texinfo mode.@refill
-@end enumerate
-
-@node Start of Header, setfilename, First Line, Header
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection Start of Header
-@cindex Start of header line
-
-Write a start-of-header line on the second line of a Texinfo file.
-Follow the start-of-header line with @code{@@setfilename} and
-@code{@@settitle} lines and, optionally, with other command lines, such
-as @code{@@smallbook} or @code{@@footnotestyle}; and then by an
-end-of-header line (@pxref{End of Header}).@refill
-
-With these lines, you can format part of a Texinfo file for Info or
-typeset part for printing.@refill
-
-A start-of-header line looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@c %**start of header
-@end example
-
-The odd string of characters, @samp{%**}, is to ensure that no other
-comment is accidentally taken for a start-of-header line.@refill
-
-@node setfilename, settitle, Start of Header, Header
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@setfilename}
-@cindex Info file requires @code{@@setfilename}
-@findex setfilename
-
-In order to serve as the primary input file for either @code{makeinfo}
-or @TeX{}, a Texinfo file must contain a line that looks like this:
-
-@example
-@@setfilename @var{info-file-name}
-@end example
-
-Write the @code{@@setfilename} command at the beginning of a line and
-follow it on the same line by the Info file name. Do not write anything
-else on the line; anything on the line after the command is considered
-part of the file name, including what would otherwise be a
-comment.
-
-The @code{@@setfilename} line specifies the name of the Info file to be
-generated. This name should be different from the name of the Texinfo
-file. There are two conventions for choosing the name: you can either
-remove the @samp{.texi} extension from the input file name, or replace
-it with the @samp{.info} extension.
-
-Some operating systems cannot handle long file names. You can run into
-a problem even when the file name you specify is itself short enough.
-This occurs because the Info formatters split a long Info file into
-short indirect subfiles, and name them by appending @samp{-1},
-@samp{-2}, @dots{}, @samp{-10}, @samp{-11}, and so on, to the original
-file name. (@xref{Tag and Split Files, , Tag Files and Split Files}.)
-The subfile name @file{texinfo.info-10}, for example, is too long for
-some systems; so the Info file name for this document is @file{texinfo}
-rather than @file{texinfo.info}.
-
-@cindex Ignored before @code{@@setfilename}
-The Info formatting commands ignore everything written before the
-@code{@@setfilename} line, which is why the very first line of
-the file (the @code{\input} line) does not show up in the output.
-
-@pindex texinfo.cnf
-The @code{@@setfilename} line produces no output when you typeset a
-manual with @TeX{}, but it nevertheless is essential: it opens the
-index, cross-reference, and other auxiliary files used by Texinfo, and
-also reads @file{texinfo.cnf} if that file is present on your system
-(@pxref{Preparing for TeX,, Preparing to Use @TeX{}}).
-
-
-@node settitle, setchapternewpage, setfilename, Header
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@settitle}
-@findex settitle
-
-In order to be made into a printed manual, a Texinfo file must contain
-a line that looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@settitle @var{title}
-@end example
-
-Write the @code{@@settitle} command at the beginning of a line and
-follow it on the same line by the title. This tells @TeX{} the title
-to use in a header or footer. Do not write anything else on the line;
-anything on the line after the command is considered part of the
-title, including a comment.@refill
-
-Conventionally, when @TeX{} formats a Texinfo file for double-sided
-output, the title is printed in the left-hand (even-numbered) page
-headings and the current chapter title is printed in the right-hand
-(odd-numbered) page headings. (@TeX{} learns the title of each chapter
-from each @code{@@chapter} command.) Page footers are not
-printed.@refill
-
-Even if you are printing in a single-sided style, @TeX{} looks for an
-@code{@@settitle} command line, in case you include the manual title
-in the heading. @refill
-
-The @code{@@settitle} command should precede everything that generates
-actual output in @TeX{}.@refill
-
-Although the title in the @code{@@settitle} command is usually the
-same as the title on the title page, it does not affect the title as
-it appears on the title page. Thus, the two do not need not match
-exactly; and the title in the @code{@@settitle} command can be a
-shortened or expanded version of the title as it appears on the title
-page. (@xref{titlepage, , @code{@@titlepage}}.)(a)refill
-
-@TeX{} prints page headings only for that text that comes after the
-@code{@@end titlepage} command in the Texinfo file, or that comes
-after an @code{@@headings} command that turns on headings.
-(@xref{headings on off, , The @code{@@headings} Command}, for more
-information.)@refill
-
-You may, if you wish, create your own, customized headings and
-footings. @xref{Headings, , Page Headings}, for a detailed discussion
-of this process.@refill
-
-@node setchapternewpage, paragraphindent, settitle, Header
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@setchapternewpage}
-@cindex Starting chapters
-@cindex Pages, starting odd
-@findex setchapternewpage
-
-In a book or a manual, text is usually printed on both sides of the
-paper, chapters start on right-hand pages, and right-hand pages have
-odd numbers. But in short reports, text often is printed only on one
-side of the paper. Also in short reports, chapters sometimes do not
-start on new pages, but are printed on the same page as the end of the
-preceding chapter, after a small amount of vertical whitespace.@refill
-
-You can use the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command with various
-arguments to specify how @TeX{} should start chapters and whether it
-should typeset pages for printing on one or both sides of the paper
-(single-sided or double-sided printing).@refill
-
-Write the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command at the beginning of a
-line followed by its argument.@refill
-
-For example, you would write the following to cause each chapter to
-start on a fresh odd-numbered page:@refill
-
-@example
-@@setchapternewpage odd
-@end example
-
-You can specify one of three alternatives with the
-@code{@@setchapternewpage} command:@refill
-
-@table @asis
-@ignore
-@item No @code{@@setchapternewpage} command
-If the Texinfo file does not contain an @code{@@setchapternewpage}
-command before the @code{@@titlepage} command, @TeX{} automatically
-begins chapters on new pages and prints headings in the standard
-format for single-sided printing. This is the conventional format for
-single-sided printing.@refill
-
-The result is exactly the same as when you write
-@code{@@setchapternewpage on}.@refill
-@end ignore
-@item @code{@@setchapternewpage off}
-Cause @TeX{} to typeset a new chapter on the same page as the last
-chapter, after skipping some vertical whitespace. Also, cause @TeX{} to
-format page headers for single-sided printing. (You can override the
-headers format with the @code{@@headings double} command; see
-@ref{headings on off, , The @code{@@headings} Command}.)@refill
-
-@item @code{@@setchapternewpage on}
-Cause @TeX{} to start new chapters on new pages and to typeset page
-headers for single-sided printing. This is the form most often
-used for short reports.@refill
-
-This alternative is the default.@refill
-
-@item @code{@@setchapternewpage odd}
-Cause @TeX{} to start new chapters on new, odd-numbered pages
-(right-handed pages) and to typeset for double-sided printing. This is
-the form most often used for books and manuals.@refill
-@end table
-
-@noindent
-Texinfo does not have an @code{@@setchapternewpage even} command.@refill
-
-@noindent
-(You can countermand or modify an @code{@@setchapternewpage} command
-with an @code{@@headings} command. @xref{headings on off, , The
-@code{@@headings} Command}.)@refill
-
-At the beginning of a manual or book, pages are not numbered---for
-example, the title and copyright pages of a book are not numbered.
-By convention, table of contents pages are numbered with roman
-numerals and not in sequence with the rest of the document.@refill
-
-Since an Info file does not have pages, the @code{@@setchapternewpage}
-command has no effect on it.@refill
-
-Usually, you do not write an @code{@@setchapternewpage} command for
-single-sided printing, but accept the default which is to typeset for
-single-sided printing and to start new chapters on new pages. Usually,
-you write an @code{@@setchapternewpage odd} command for double-sided
-printing.@refill
-
-@node paragraphindent, End of Header, setchapternewpage, Header
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection Paragraph Indenting
-@cindex Indenting paragraphs
-@cindex Paragraph indentation
-@findex paragraphindent
-
-The Info formatting commands may insert spaces at the beginning of the
-first line of each paragraph, thereby indenting that paragraph. You
-can use the @code{@@paragraphindent} command to specify the
-indentation. Write an @code{@@paragraphindent} command at the
-beginning of a line followed by either @samp{asis} or a number. The
-template is:@refill
-
-@example
-@@paragraphindent @var{indent}
-@end example
-
-The Info formatting commands indent according to the value of
-@var{indent}:@refill
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-If the value of @var{indent} is @samp{asis}, the Info formatting
-commands do not change the existing indentation.@refill
-
-@item
-If the value of @var{indent} is zero, the Info formatting commands delete
-existing indentation.@refill
-
-@item
-If the value of @var{indent} is greater than zero, the Info formatting
-commands indent the paragraph by that number of spaces.@refill
-@end itemize
-
-The default value of @var{indent} is @samp{asis}.@refill
-
-Write the @code{@@paragraphindent} command before or shortly after the
-end-of-header line at the beginning of a Texinfo file. (If you write
-the command between the start-of-header and end-of-header lines, the
-region formatting commands indent paragraphs as specified.)@refill
-
-A peculiarity of the @code{texinfo-format-buffer} and
-@code{texinfo-format-region} commands is that they do not indent (nor
-fill) paragraphs that contain @code{@@w} or @code{@@*} commands.
-@xref{Refilling Paragraphs}, for a detailed description of what goes
-on.@refill
-
-@node End of Header, , paragraphindent, Header
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection End of Header
-@cindex End of header line
-
-Follow the header lines with an @w{end-of-header} line.
-An end-of-header line looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@c %**end of header
-@end example
-
-If you include the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command between the
-start-of-header and end-of-header lines, @TeX{} will typeset a region as
-that command specifies. Similarly, if you include an @code{@@smallbook}
-command between the start-of-header and end-of-header lines, @TeX{} will
-typeset a region in the ``small'' book format.@refill
-
-@ifinfo
-The reason for the odd string of characters (@samp{%**}) is so that the
-@code{texinfo-tex-region} command does not accidentally find
-something that it should not when it is looking for the header.@refill
-
-The start-of-header line and the end-of-header line are Texinfo mode
-variables that you can change.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-
-@iftex
-@xref{Start of Header}.
-@end iftex
-
-@node Info Summary and Permissions, Titlepage & Copyright Page, Header, Beginning a
File
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Summary and Copying Permissions for Info
-
-The title page and the copyright page appear only in the printed copy of
-the manual; therefore, the same information must be inserted in a
-section that appears only in the Info file. This section usually
-contains a brief description of the contents of the Info file, a
-copyright notice, and copying permissions.@refill
-
-The copyright notice should read:@refill
-
-@example
-Copyright @var{year} @var{copyright-owner}
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and be put on a line by itself.@refill
-
-Standard text for the copyright permissions is contained in an appendix
-to this manual; see @ref{ifinfo Permissions, , @samp{ifinfo} Copying
-Permissions}, for the complete text.@refill
-
-The permissions text appears in an Info file @emph{before} the first
-node. This mean that a reader does @emph{not} see this text when
-reading the file using Info, except when using the advanced Info command
-@kbd{g *}.
-
-@node Titlepage & Copyright Page, The Top Node, Info Summary and Permissions,
Beginning a File
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section The Title and Copyright Pages
-
-A manual's name and author are usually printed on a title page.
-Sometimes copyright information is printed on the title page as well;
-more often, copyright information is printed on the back of the title
-page.
-
-The title and copyright pages appear in the printed manual, but not in the
-Info file. Because of this, it is possible to use several slightly
-obscure @TeX{} typesetting commands that cannot be used in an Info file.
-In addition, this part of the beginning of a Texinfo file contains the text
-of the copying permissions that will appear in the printed manual.@refill
-
-@xref{Titlepage Permissions, , Titlepage Copying Permissions}, for the
-standard text for the copyright permissions.@refill
-
-@menu
-* titlepage:: Create a title for the printed document.
-* titlefont center sp:: The @code{@@titlefont}, @code{@@center},
- and @code{@@sp} commands.
-* title subtitle author:: The @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle},
- and @code{@@author} commands.
-* Copyright & Permissions:: How to write the copyright notice and
- include copying permissions.
-* end titlepage:: Turn on page headings after the title and
- copyright pages.
-* headings on off:: An option for turning headings on and off
- and double or single sided printing.
-@end menu
-
-@node titlepage, titlefont center sp, Titlepage & Copyright Page, Titlepage &
Copyright Page
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@titlepage}
-@cindex Title page
-@findex titlepage
-
-Start the material for the title page and following copyright page
-with @code{@@titlepage} on a line by itself and end it with
-@code{@@end titlepage} on a line by itself.@refill
-
-The @code{@@end titlepage} command starts a new page and turns on page
-numbering. (@xref{Headings, , Page Headings}, for details about how to
-generate page headings.) All the material that you want to
-appear on unnumbered pages should be put between the
-@code{@@titlepage} and @code{@@end titlepage} commands. By using the
-@code{@@page} command you can force a page break within the region
-delineated by the @code{@@titlepage} and @code{@@end titlepage}
-commands and thereby create more than one unnumbered page. This is
-how the copyright page is produced. (The @code{@@titlepage} command
-might perhaps have been better named the
-@code{@@titleandadditionalpages} command, but that would have been
-rather long!)@refill
-
-@c !!! append refill to footnote when makeinfo can handle it.
-When you write a manual about a computer program, you should write the
-version of the program to which the manual applies on the title
-page. If the manual changes more frequently than the program or is
-independent of it, you should also include an edition
-number@footnote{We have found that it is helpful to refer to versions
-of manuals as `editions' and versions of programs as `versions';
-otherwise, we find we are liable to confuse each other in conversation
-by referring to both the documentation and the software with the same
-words.} for the manual. This helps readers keep track of which manual
-is for which version of the program. (The `Top' node
-should also contain this information; see @ref{makeinfo top, ,
-@code{@@top}}.)(a)refill
-
-Texinfo provides two main methods for creating a title page. One method
-uses the @code{@@titlefont}, @code{@@sp}, and @code{@@center} commands
-to generate a title page in which the words on the page are
-centered.@refill
-
-The second method uses the @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, and
-@code{@@author} commands to create a title page with black rules under
-the title and author lines and the subtitle text set flush to the
-right hand side of the page. With this method, you do not specify any
-of the actual formatting of the title page. You specify the text
-you want, and Texinfo does the formatting. You may use either
-method.@refill
-
-@findex shorttitlepage
-For extremely simple applications, Texinfo also provides a command
-@code{@@shorttitlepage} which takes a single argument as the title.
-The argument is typeset on a page by itself and followed by a blank
-page.
-
-
-@node titlefont center sp, title subtitle author, titlepage, Titlepage & Copyright
Page
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@titlefont}, @code{@@center}, and @code{@@sp}
-@findex titlefont
-@findex center
-@findex sp @r{(titlepage line spacing)}
-
-You can use the @code{@@titlefont}, @code{@@sp}, and @code{@@center}
-commands to create a title page for a printed document. (This is the
-first of the two methods for creating a title page in Texinfo.)@refill
-
-Use the @code{@@titlefont} command to select a large font suitable for
-the title itself.@refill
-
-@need 700
-For example:
-
-@example
-@@titlefont@{Texinfo@}
-@end example
-
-Use the @code{@@center} command at the beginning of a line to center
-the remaining text on that line. Thus,@refill
-
-@example
-@@center @@titlefont@{Texinfo@}
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-centers the title, which in this example is ``Texinfo'' printed
-in the title font.@refill
-
-Use the @code{@@sp} command to insert vertical space. For example:@refill
-
-@example
-@@sp 2
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This inserts two blank lines on the printed page. (@xref{sp, ,
-@code{@@sp}}, for more information about the @code{@@sp}
-command.)@refill
-
-A template for this method looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@titlepage
-@@sp 10
-@@center @@titlefont@{@var{name-of-manual-when-printed}@}
-@@sp 2
-@@center @var{subtitle-if-any}
-@@sp 2
-@@center @var{author}
-@dots{}
-@@end titlepage
-@end group
-@end example
-
-The spacing of the example fits an 8 1/2 by 11 inch manual.@refill
-
-@node title subtitle author, Copyright & Permissions, titlefont center sp, Titlepage
& Copyright Page
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, and @code{@@author}
-@findex title
-@findex subtitle
-@findex author
-
-You can use the @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, and @code{@@author}
-commands to create a title page in which the vertical and horizontal
-spacing is done for you automatically. This contrasts with the method
-described in
-the previous section, in which the @code{@@sp} command is needed to
-adjust vertical spacing.@refill
-
-Write the @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, or @code{@@author}
-commands at the beginning of a line followed by the title, subtitle,
-or author.@refill
-
-The @code{@@title} command produces a line in which the title is set
-flush to the left-hand side of the page in a larger than normal font.
-The title is underlined with a black rule.@refill
-
-The @code{@@subtitle} command sets subtitles in a normal-sized font
-flush to the right-hand side of the page.@refill
-
-The @code{@@author} command sets the names of the author or authors in
-a middle-sized font flush to the left-hand side of the page on a line
-near the bottom of the title page. The names are underlined with a
-black rule that is thinner than the rule that underlines the title.
-(The black rule only occurs if the @code{@@author} command line is
-followed by an @code{@@page} command line.)@refill
-
-There are two ways to use the @code{@@author} command: you can write
-the name or names on the remaining part of the line that starts with
-an @code{@@author} command:@refill
-
-@example
-@@author by Jane Smith and John Doe
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-or you can write the names one above each other by using two (or more)
-@code{@@author} commands:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@author Jane Smith
-@@author John Doe
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-(Only the bottom name is underlined with a black rule.)@refill
-
-@need 950
-A template for this method looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@titlepage
-@@title @var{name-of-manual-when-printed}
-@@subtitle @var{subtitle-if-any}
-@@subtitle @var{second-subtitle}
-@@author @var{author}
-@@page
-@dots{}
-@@end titlepage
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@ifinfo
-@noindent
-Contrast this form with the form of a title page written using the
-@code{@@sp}, @code{@@center}, and @code{@@titlefont} commands:@refill
-
-@example
-@@titlepage
-@@sp 10
-@@center @@titlefont@{Name of Manual When Printed@}
-@@sp 2
-@@center Subtitle, If Any
-@@sp 1
-@@center Second subtitle
-@@sp 2
-@@center Author
-@@page
-@dots{}
-@@end titlepage
-@end example
-@end ifinfo
-
-@node Copyright & Permissions, end titlepage, title subtitle author, Titlepage &
Copyright Page
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection Copyright Page and Permissions
-@cindex Copyright page
-@cindex Printed permissions
-@cindex Permissions, printed
-
-By international treaty, the copyright notice for a book should be
-either on the title page or on the back of the title page. The
-copyright notice should include the year followed by the name of the
-organization or person who owns the copyright.@refill
-
-When the copyright notice is on the back of the title page, that page
-is customarily not numbered. Therefore, in Texinfo, the information
-on the copyright page should be within @code{@@titlepage} and
-@code{@@end titlepage} commands.@refill
-
-@findex vskip
-@findex filll
-@cindex Vertical whitespace (@samp{vskip})
-Use the @code{@@page} command to cause a page break. To push the
-copyright notice and the other text on the copyright page towards the
-bottom of the page, you can write a somewhat mysterious line after the
-@code{@@page} command that reads like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This is a @TeX{} command that is not supported by the Info formatting
-commands. The @code{@@vskip} command inserts whitespace. The
-@samp{0pt plus 1filll} means to put in zero points of mandatory whitespace,
-and as much optional whitespace as needed to push the
-following text to the bottom of the page. Note the use of three
-@samp{l}s in the word @samp{filll}; this is the correct usage in
-@TeX{}.(a)refill
-
-@findex copyright
-In a printed manual, the @code{@@copyright@{@}} command generates a
-@samp{c} inside a circle. (In Info, it generates @samp{(C)}.) The
-copyright notice itself has the following legally defined sequence:@refill
-
-@example
-Copyright @copyright{} @var{year} @var{copyright-owner}
-@end example
-
-It is customary to put information on how to get a manual after the
-copyright notice, followed by the copying permissions for the
-manual.@refill
-
-Note that permissions must be given here as well as in the summary
-segment within @code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end ifinfo} that
-immediately follows the header since this text appears only in the
-printed manual and the @samp{ifinfo} text appears only in the Info
-file.@refill
-
-@xref{Sample Permissions}, for the standard text.@refill
-
-@node end titlepage, headings on off, Copyright & Permissions, Titlepage &
Copyright Page
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection Heading Generation
-@findex end titlepage
-@cindex Headings, page, begin to appear
-@cindex Titlepage end starts headings
-@cindex End titlepage starts headings
-
-An @code{@@end titlepage} command on a line by itself not only marks
-the end of the title and copyright pages, but also causes @TeX{} to start
-generating page headings and page numbers.
-
-To repeat what is said elsewhere, Texinfo has two standard page heading
-formats, one for documents which are printed on one side of each sheet of paper
-(single-sided printing), and the other for documents which are printed on both
-sides of each sheet (double-sided printing).
-(@xref{setchapternewpage, ,@code{@@setchapternewpage}}.)
-You can specify these formats in different ways:@refill
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-The conventional way is to write an @code{@@setchapternewpage} command
-before the title page commands, and then have the @code{@@end
-titlepage} command start generating page headings in the manner desired.
-(@xref{setchapternewpage, , @code{@@setchapternewpage}}.)(a)refill
-
-@item
-Alternatively, you can use the @code{@@headings} command to prevent page
-headings from being generated or to start them for either single or
-double-sided printing. (Write an @code{@@headings} command immediately
-after the @code{@@end titlepage} command. @xref{headings on off, , The
-@code{@@headings} Command}, for more information.)@refill
-
-@item
-Or, you may specify your own page heading and footing format.
-@xref{Headings, , Page Headings}, for detailed
-information about page headings and footings.@refill
-@end itemize
-
-Most documents are formatted with the standard single-sided or
-double-sided format, using @code{@@setchapternewpage odd} for
-double-sided printing and no @code{@@setchapternewpage} command for
-single-sided printing.@refill
-
-@node headings on off, , end titlepage, Titlepage & Copyright Page
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection The @code{@@headings} Command
-@findex headings
-
-The @code{@@headings} command is rarely used. It specifies what kind of
-page headings and footings to print on each page. Usually, this is
-controlled by the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command. You need the
-@code{@@headings} command only if the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command
-does not do what you want, or if you want to turn off pre-defined page
-headings prior to defining your own. Write an @code{@@headings} command
-immediately after the @code{@@end titlepage} command.@refill
-
-You can use @code{@@headings} as follows:@refill
-
-@table @code
-@item @@headings off
-Turn off printing of page headings.@refill
-
-@item @@headings single
-Turn on page headings appropriate for single-sided printing.
-@refill
-
-@item @@headings double
-Turn on page headings appropriate for double-sided printing. The two
-commands, @code{@@headings on} and @code{@@headings double}, are
-synonymous.@refill
-
-@item @@headings singleafter
-@itemx @@headings doubleafter
-Turn on @code{single} or @code{double} headings, respectively, after the
-current page is output.
-
-@item @@headings on
-Turn on page headings: @code{single} if @samp{@@setchapternewpage
-on}, @code{double} otherwise.
-@end table
-
-For example, suppose you write @code{@@setchapternewpage off} before the
-@code{@@titlepage} command to tell @TeX{} to start a new chapter on the
-same page as the end of the last chapter. This command also causes
-@TeX{} to typeset page headers for single-sided printing. To cause
-@TeX{} to typeset for double sided printing, write @code{@@headings
-double} after the @code{@@end titlepage} command.
-
-You can stop @TeX{} from generating any page headings at all by
-writing @code{@@headings off} on a line of its own immediately after the
-line containing the @code{@@end titlepage} command, like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@end titlepage
-@@headings off
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-The @code{@@headings off} command overrides the @code{@@end titlepage}
-command, which would otherwise cause @TeX{} to print page
-headings.@refill
-
-You can also specify your own style of page heading and footing.
-@xref{Headings, , Page Headings}, for more information.@refill
-
-@node The Top Node, Software Copying Permissions, Titlepage & Copyright Page,
Beginning a File
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section The `Top' Node and Master Menu
-@cindex @samp{@r{Top}} node
-@cindex Master menu
-@cindex Node, `Top'
-
-The `Top' node is the node from which you enter an Info file.@refill
-
-A `Top' node should contain a brief description of the Info file and an
-extensive, master menu for the whole Info file.
-This helps the reader understand what the Info file is
-about. Also, you should write the version number of the program to
-which the Info file applies; or, at least, the edition number.@refill
-
-The contents of the `Top' node should appear only in the Info file; none
-of it should appear in printed output, so enclose it between
-@code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end ifinfo} commands. (@TeX{} does not
-print either an @code{@@node} line or a menu; they appear only in Info;
-strictly speaking, you are not required to enclose these parts between
-@code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end ifinfo}, but it is simplest to do so.
-@xref{Conditionals, , Conditionally Visible Text}.)@refill
-
-@menu
-* Title of Top Node:: Sketch what the file is about.
-* Master Menu Parts:: A master menu has three or more parts.
-@end menu
-
-@node Title of Top Node, Master Menu Parts, The Top Node, The Top Node
-@ifinfo
-@subheading `Top' Node Title
-@end ifinfo
-
-Sometimes, you will want to place an @code{@@top} sectioning command
-line containing the title of the document immediately after the
-@code{@@node Top} line (@pxref{makeinfo top command, , The @code{@@top}
-Sectioning Command}, for more information).@refill
-
-For example, the beginning of the Top node of this manual contains an
-@code{@@top} sectioning command, a short description, and edition and
-version information. It looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@dots{}
-@@end titlepage
-
-@@ifinfo
-@@node Top, Copying, , (dir)
-@@top Texinfo
-
-Texinfo is a documentation system@dots{}
-@end group
-
-@group
-This is edition@dots{}
-@dots{}
-@@end ifinfo
-@end group
-
-@group
-@@menu
-* Copying:: Texinfo is freely
- redistributable.
-* Overview:: What is Texinfo?
-@dots{}
-@end group
-@@end menu
-@end example
-
-In a `Top' node, the `Previous', and `Up' nodes usually refer to the top
-level directory of the whole Info system, which is called @samp{(dir)}.
-The `Next' node refers to the first node that follows the main or master
-menu, which is usually the copying permissions, introduction, or first
-chapter.@refill
-
-@node Master Menu Parts, , Title of Top Node, The Top Node
-@subsection Parts of a Master Menu
-@cindex Master menu parts
-@cindex Parts of a master menu
-
-A @dfn{master menu} is a detailed main menu listing all the nodes in a
-file.
-
-A master menu is enclosed in @code{@@menu} and @code{@@end menu}
-commands and does not appear in the printed document.@refill
-
-Generally, a master menu is divided into parts.@refill
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-The first part contains the major nodes in the Texinfo file: the nodes
-for the chapters, chapter-like sections, and the appendices.@refill
-
-@item
-The second part contains nodes for the indices.@refill
-
-@item
-The third and subsequent parts contain a listing of the other, lower
-level nodes, often ordered by chapter. This way, rather than go
-through an intermediary menu, an inquirer can go directly to a
-particular node when searching for specific information. These menu
-items are not required; add them if you think they are a
-convenience. If you do use them, put @code{@@detailmenu} before the
-first one, and @code{@@end detailmenu} after the last; otherwise,
-@code{makeinfo} will get confused.
-@end itemize
-
-Each section in the menu can be introduced by a descriptive line. So
-long as the line does not begin with an asterisk, it will not be
-treated as a menu entry. (@xref{Writing a Menu}, for more
-information.)@refill
-
-For example, the master menu for this manual looks like the following
-(but has many more entries):@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@menu
-* Copying:: Texinfo is freely
- redistributable.
-* Overview:: What is Texinfo?
-* Texinfo Mode:: Special features in GNU Emacs.
-@dots{}
-@dots{}
-@end group
-@group
-* Command and Variable Index::
- An entry for each @@-command.
-* Concept Index:: An entry for each concept.
-@end group
-
-@group
-@@detailmenu
- --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
-
-Overview of Texinfo
-
-* Info Files:: What is an Info file?
-* Printed Manuals:: Characteristics of
- a printed manual.
-@dots{}
-@dots{}
-@end group
-
-@group
-Using Texinfo Mode
-
-* Info on a Region:: Formatting part of a file
- for Info.
-@dots{}
-@dots{}
-@@end detailmenu
-@@end menu
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@node Software Copying Permissions, , The Top Node, Beginning a File
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Software Copying Permissions
-@cindex Software copying permissions
-@cindex Copying software
-@cindex Distribution
-@cindex License agreement
-
-If the Texinfo file has a section containing the ``General Public
-License'' and the distribution information and a warranty disclaimer
-for the software that is documented, this section usually follows the
-`Top' node. The General Public License is very important to Project
-GNU software. It ensures that you and others will continue to have a
-right to use and share the software.@refill
-
-The copying and distribution information and the disclaimer are
-followed by an introduction or else by the first chapter of the
-manual.@refill
-
-@cindex Introduction, as part of file
-Although an introduction is not a required part of a Texinfo file, it
-is very helpful. Ideally, it should state clearly and concisely what
-the file is about and who would be interested in reading it. In
-general, an introduction would follow the licensing and distribution
-information, although sometimes people put it earlier in the document.
-Usually, an introduction is put in an @code{@@unnumbered} section.
-(@xref{unnumbered & appendix, , The @code{@@unnumbered} and
-@code{@@appendix} Commands}.)@refill
-
-@node Ending a File, Structuring, Beginning a File, Top
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@chapter Ending a Texinfo File
-@cindex Ending a Texinfo file
-@cindex Texinfo file ending
-@cindex File ending
-@findex bye
-
-The end of a Texinfo file should include the commands that create
-indices and generate detailed and summary tables of contents.
-And it must include the @code{@@bye} command that marks the last line
-processed by @TeX{}.@refill
-
-@need 700
-For example:
-
-@example
-@@node Concept Index, , Variables Index, Top
-@@c node-name, next, previous, up
-@@unnumbered Concept Index
-
-@@printindex cp
-
-@@contents
-@@bye
-@end example
-
-@menu
-* Printing Indices & Menus:: How to print an index in hardcopy and
- generate index menus in Info.
-* Contents:: How to create a table of contents.
-* File End:: How to mark the end of a file.
-@end menu
-
-@node Printing Indices & Menus, Contents, Ending a File, Ending a File
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Index Menus and Printing an Index
-@findex printindex
-@cindex Printing an index
-@cindex Indices, printing and menus
-@cindex Generating menus with indices
-@cindex Menus generated with indices
-
-To print an index means to include it as part of a manual or Info
-file. This does not happen automatically just because you use
-@code{@@cindex} or other index-entry generating commands in the
-Texinfo file; those just cause the raw data for the index to be
-accumulated. To generate an index, you must include the
-@code{@@printindex} command at the place in the document where you
-want the index to appear. Also, as part of the process of creating a
-printed manual, you must run a program called @code{texindex}
-(@pxref{Format/Print Hardcopy}) to sort the raw data to produce a sorted
-index file. The sorted index file is what is actually used to
-print the index.@refill
-
-Texinfo offers six different types of predefined index: the concept
-index, the function index, the variables index, the keystroke index, the
-program index, and the data type index (@pxref{Predefined Indices}). Each
-index type has a two-letter name: @samp{cp}, @samp{fn}, @samp{vr},
-@samp{ky}, @samp{pg}, and @samp{tp}. You may merge indices, or put them
-into separate sections (@pxref{Combining Indices}); or you may define
-your own indices (@pxref{New Indices, , Defining New Indices}).@refill
-
-The @code{@@printindex} command takes a two-letter index name, reads
-the corresponding sorted index file and formats it appropriately into
-an index.@refill
-
-@ignore
-The two-letter index names are:
-
-@table @samp
-@item cp
-concept index
-@item fn
-function index
-@item vr
-variable index
-@item ky
-key index
-@item pg
-program index
-@item tp
-data type index
-@end table
-@end ignore
-The @code{@@printindex} command does not generate a chapter heading
-for the index. Consequently, you should precede the
-@code{@@printindex} command with a suitable section or chapter command
-(usually @code{@@unnumbered}) to supply the chapter heading and put
-the index into the table of contents. Precede the @code{@@unnumbered}
-command with an @code{@@node} line.@refill
-
-@need 1200
-For example:
-
-@smallexample
-@group
-@@node Variable Index, Concept Index, Function Index, Top
-@@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@@unnumbered Variable Index
-
-@@printindex vr
-@end group
-
-@group
-@@node Concept Index, , Variable Index, Top
-@@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@@unnumbered Concept Index
-
-@@printindex cp
-@end group
-
-@group
-@@summarycontents
-@@contents
-@@bye
-@end group
-@end smallexample
-
-@noindent
-(Readers often prefer that the concept index come last in a book,
-since that makes it easiest to find.)@refill
-
-@ignore
-@c TeX can do sorting, just not conveniently enough to handle sorting
-@c Texinfo indexes. --karl, 5may97.
-In @TeX{}, the @code{@@printindex} command needs a sorted index file
-to work from. @TeX{} does not know how to do sorting; this is a
-deficiency. @TeX{} writes output files of raw index data; use the
-@code{texindex} program to convert these files to sorted index files.
-(@xref{Format/Print Hardcopy}, for more information.)@refill
-@end ignore
-
-
-@node Contents, File End, Printing Indices & Menus, Ending a File
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Generating a Table of Contents
-@cindex Table of contents
-@cindex Contents, Table of
-@findex contents
-@findex summarycontents
-@findex shortcontents
-
-The @code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, and other structuring commands
-supply the information to make up a table of contents, but they do not
-cause an actual table to appear in the manual. To do this, you must
-use the @code{@@contents} and @code{@@summarycontents}
-commands:@refill
-
-@table @code
-@item @@contents
-Generate a table of contents in a printed manual, including all
-chapters, sections, subsections, etc., as well as appendices and
-unnumbered chapters. (Headings generated by the @code{@@heading}
-series of commands do not appear in the table of contents.) The
-@code{@@contents} command should be written on a line by
-itself.@refill
-
-@item @@shortcontents
-@itemx @@summarycontents
-(@code{@@summarycontents} is a synonym for @code{@@shortcontents}; the
-two commands are exactly the same.)@refill
-
-Generate a short or summary table of contents that lists only the
-chapters (and appendices and unnumbered chapters). Omit sections, subsections
-and subsubsections. Only a long manual needs a short table
-of contents in addition to the full table of contents.@refill
-
-Write the @code{@@shortcontents} command on a line by itself right
-@emph{before} the @code{@@contents} command.@refill
-@end table
-
-The table of contents commands automatically generate a chapter-like
-heading at the top of the first table of contents page. Write the table
-of contents commands at the very end of a Texinfo file, just before the
-@code{@@bye} command, following any index sections---anything in the
-Texinfo file after the table of contents commands will be omitted from
-the table of contents.@refill
-
-When you print a manual with a table of contents, the table of
-contents are printed last and numbered with roman numerals. You need
-to place those pages in their proper place, after the title page,
-yourself. (This is the only collating you need to do for a printed
-manual. The table of contents is printed last because it is generated
-after the rest of the manual is typeset.)@refill
-
-@need 700
-Here is an example of where to write table of contents commands:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@var{indices}@dots{}
-@@shortcontents
-@@contents
-@@bye
-@end group
-@end example
-
-Since an Info file uses menus instead of tables of contents, the Info
-formatting commands ignore the @code{@@contents} and
-@code{@@shortcontents} commands.@refill
-
-@node File End, , Contents, Ending a File
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@bye} File Ending
-@findex bye
-
-An @code{@@bye} command terminates @TeX{} or Info formatting. None of
-the formatting commands see any of the file following @code{@@bye}.
-The @code{@@bye} command should be on a line by itself.@refill
-
-If you wish, you may follow the @code{@@bye} line with notes. These notes
-will not be formatted and will not appear in either Info or a printed
-manual; it is as if text after @code{@@bye} were within @code{@@ignore}
-@dots{} @code{@@end ignore}. Also, you may follow the @code{@@bye} line
-with a local variables list. @xref{Compile-Command, , Using Local
-Variables and the Compile Command}, for more information.@refill
-
-@node Structuring, Nodes, Ending a File, Top
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@chapter Chapter Structuring
-@cindex Chapter structuring
-@cindex Structuring of chapters
-
-The @dfn{chapter structuring} commands divide a document into a hierarchy of
-chapters, sections, subsections, and subsubsections. These commands
-generate large headings; they also provide information for the table
-of contents of a printed manual (@pxref{Contents, , Generating a Table
-of Contents}).@refill
-
-The chapter structuring commands do not create an Info node structure,
-so normally you should put an @code{@@node} command immediately before
-each chapter structuring command (@pxref{Nodes}). The only time you
-are likely to use the chapter structuring commands without using the
-node structuring commands is if you are writing a document that
-contains no cross references and will never be transformed into Info
-format.@refill
-
-It is unlikely that you will ever write a Texinfo file that is
-intended only as an Info file and not as a printable document. If you
-do, you might still use chapter structuring commands to create a
-heading at the top of each node---but you don't need to.@refill
-
-@menu
-* Tree Structuring:: A manual is like an upside down tree @dots{}
-* Structuring Command Types:: How to divide a manual into parts.
-* makeinfo top:: The @code{@@top} command, part of the `Top' node.
-* chapter::
-* unnumbered & appendix::
-* majorheading & chapheading::
-* section::
-* unnumberedsec appendixsec heading::
-* subsection::
-* unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading::
-* subsubsection:: Commands for the lowest level sections.
-* Raise/lower sections:: How to change commands' hierarchical level.
-@end menu
-
-@node Tree Structuring, Structuring Command Types, Structuring, Structuring
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Tree Structure of Sections
-@cindex Tree structuring
-
-A Texinfo file is usually structured like a book with chapters,
-sections, subsections, and the like. This structure can be visualized
-as a tree (or rather as an upside-down tree) with the root at the top
-and the levels corresponding to chapters, sections, subsection, and
-subsubsections.@refill
-
-Here is a diagram that shows a Texinfo file with three chapters,
-each of which has two sections.@refill
-
-@example
-@group
- Top
- |
- -------------------------------------
- | | |
- Chapter 1 Chapter 2 Chapter 3
- | | |
- -------- -------- --------
- | | | | | |
- Section Section Section Section Section Section
- 1.1 1.2 2.1 2.2 3.1 3.2
-
-@end group
-@end example
-
-In a Texinfo file that has this structure, the beginning of Chapter 2
-looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@node Chapter 2, Chapter 3, Chapter 1, top
-@@chapter Chapter 2
-@end group
-@end example
-
-The chapter structuring commands are described in the sections that
-follow; the @code{@@node} and @code{@@menu} commands are described in
-following chapters. (@xref{Nodes}, and see @ref{Menus}.)@refill
-
-@node Structuring Command Types, makeinfo top, Tree Structuring, Structuring
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Types of Structuring Commands
-
-The chapter structuring commands fall into four groups or series, each
-of which contains structuring commands corresponding to the
-hierarchical levels of chapters, sections, subsections, and
-subsubsections.@refill
-
-The four groups are the @code{@@chapter} series, the
-@code{@@unnumbered} series, the @code{@@appendix} series, and the
-@code{@@heading} series.@refill
-
-Each command produces titles that have a different appearance on the
-printed page or Info file; only some of the commands produce
-titles that are listed in the table of contents of a printed book or
-manual.@refill
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-The @code{@@chapter} and @code{@@appendix} series of commands produce
-numbered or lettered entries both in the body of a printed work and in
-its table of contents.@refill
-
-@item
-The @code{@@unnumbered} series of commands produce unnumbered entries
-both in the body of a printed work and in its table of contents. The
-@code{@@top} command, which has a special use, is a member of this
-series (@pxref{makeinfo top, , @code{@@top}}).(a)refill
-
-@item
-The @code{@@heading} series of commands produce unnumbered headings
-that do not appear in a table of contents. The heading commands never
-start a new page.@refill
-
-@item
-The @code{@@majorheading} command produces results similar to using
-the @code{@@chapheading} command but generates a larger vertical
-whitespace before the heading.@refill
-
-@item
-When an @code{@@setchapternewpage} command says to do so, the
-@code{@@chapter}, @code{@@unnumbered}, and @code{@@appendix} commands
-start new pages in the printed manual; the @code{@@heading} commands
-do not.@refill
-@end itemize
-
-@need 1000
-Here are the four groups of chapter structuring commands:@refill
-
-@c Slightly different formatting for regular sized books and smallbooks.
-@ifset smallbook
-@sp 1
-@tex
-{\let\rm=\indrm \let\tt=\indtt
-\halign{\hskip\itemindent#\hfil& \hskip.5em#\hfil& \hskip.5em#\hfil&
-\hskip.5em#\hfil\cr
-
-& & & \rm No new pages\cr
-\rm Numbered& \rm Unnumbered& \rm Lettered and numbered& \rm
Unnumbered\cr
-\rm In contents& \rm In contents& \rm In contents& \rm Not in contents\cr
-
-& & & \cr
- & \tt @@top& & \tt @@majorheading\cr
-\tt @@chapter& \tt @@unnumbered& \tt @@appendix& \tt @@chapheading\cr
-\tt @@section& \tt @@unnumberedsec& \tt @@appendixsec& \tt
@@heading\cr
-\tt @@subsection&\tt @@unnumberedsubsec&\tt @@appendixsubsec&
-\tt @@subheading\cr
-\tt @@subsubsection& \tt @@unnumberedsubsubsec& \tt @@appendixsubsubsec&
-\tt @@subsubheading\cr}}
-@end tex
-@end ifset
-@ifclear smallbook
-@sp 1
-@tex
-\vbox{
-\halign{\hskip\itemindent\hskip.5em#\hfil& \hskip.5em#\hfil&
-\hskip.5em#\hfil& \hskip.5em #\hfil\cr
-
-& & & \cr
-& & & \rm No new pages\cr
-\rm Numbered& \rm Unnumbered& \rm Lettered and numbered& \rm
Unnumbered\cr
-\rm In contents& \rm In contents& \rm In contents& \rm Not in contents\cr
-
-& & & \cr
- & \tt @@top& & \tt @@majorheading\cr
-\tt @@chapter& \tt @@unnumbered& \tt @@appendix& \tt @@chapheading\cr
-\tt @@section& \tt @@unnumberedsec& \tt @@appendixsec& \tt
@@heading\cr
-\tt @@subsection&\tt @@unnumberedsubsec&\tt @@appendixsubsec&
-\tt @@subheading\cr
-\tt @@subsubsection& \tt @@unnumberedsubsubsec& \tt @@appendixsubsubsec&
-\tt @@subsubheading\cr}}
-@end tex
-@end ifclear
-@ifinfo
-@example
-@group
- @r{No new pages}
-@r{Numbered} @r{Unnumbered} @r{Lettered and numbered} @r{Unnumbered}
-@r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{Not in contents}
-
- @@top @@majorheading
-@@chapter @@unnumbered @@appendix @@chapheading
-@@section @@unnumberedsec @@appendixsec @@heading
-@@subsection @@unnumberedsubsec @@appendixsubsec @@subheading
-@@subsubsection @@unnumberedsubsubsec @@appendixsubsubsec @@subsubheading
-@end group
-@end example
-@end ifinfo
-
-@c Cannot line up columns properly inside of an example because of roman
-@c proportional fonts.
-@ignore
-@ifset smallbook
-@iftex
-@smallexample
-@group
- @r{No new pages}
-@r{Numbered} @r{Unnumbered} @r{Lettered and numbered} @r{Unnumbered}
-@r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{Not in
contents}
-
- @@top @@majorheading
-@@chapter @@unnumbered @@appendix @@chapheading
-@@section @@unnumberedsec @@appendixsec @@heading
-@@subsection @@unnumberedsubsec @@appendixsubsec @@subheading
-@@subsubsection @@unnumberedsubsubsec @@appendixsubsubsec @@subsubheading
-@end group
-@end smallexample
-@end iftex
-@end ifset
-@ifclear smallbook
-@iftex
-@smallexample
-@group
- @r{No new pages}
-@r{Numbered} @r{Unnumbered} @r{Lettered and numbered} @r{Unnumbered}
-@r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{Not in
contents}
-
- @@top @@majorheading
-@@chapter @@unnumbered @@appendix @@chapheading
-@@section @@unnumberedsec @@appendixsec @@heading
-@@subsection @@unnumberedsubsec @@appendixsubsec @@subheading
-@@subsubsection @@unnumberedsubsubsec @@appendixsubsubsec @@subsubheading
-@end group
-@end smallexample
-@end iftex
-@end ignore
-
-@node makeinfo top, chapter, Structuring Command Types, Structuring
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@top}
-
-The @code{@@top} command is a special sectioning command that you use
-only after an @samp{@@node Top} line at the beginning of a Texinfo file.
-The @code{@@top} command tells the @code{makeinfo} formatter
-which node is the `Top'
-node. It has the same typesetting effect as @code{@@unnumbered}
-(@pxref{unnumbered & appendix, , @code{@@unnumbered}, @code{@@appendix}}).
-For detailed information, see
-@ref{makeinfo top command, , The @code{@@top} Command}.@refill
-
-@node chapter, unnumbered & appendix, makeinfo top, Structuring
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@chapter}
-@findex chapter
-
-@code{@@chapter} identifies a chapter in the document. Write the
-command at the beginning of a line and follow it on the same line by
-the title of the chapter.@refill
-
-For example, this chapter in this manual is entitled ``Chapter
-Structuring''; the @code{@@chapter} line looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@chapter Chapter Structuring
-@end example
-
-In @TeX{}, the @code{@@chapter} command creates a chapter in the
-document, specifying the chapter title. The chapter is numbered
-automatically.@refill
-
-In Info, the @code{@@chapter} command causes the title to appear on a
-line by itself, with a line of asterisks inserted underneath. Thus,
-in Info, the above example produces the following output:@refill
-
-@example
-Chapter Structuring
-*******************
-@end example
-
-@findex centerchap
-Texinfo also provides a command @code{@@centerchap}, which is analogous
-to @code{@@unnumbered}, but centers its argument in the printed output.
-This kind of stylistic choice is not usually offered by Texinfo.
-@c but the Hacker's Dictionary wanted it ...
-
-
-@node unnumbered & appendix, majorheading & chapheading, chapter, Structuring
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@unnumbered}, @code{@@appendix}
-@findex unnumbered
-@findex appendix
-
-Use the @code{@@unnumbered} command to create a chapter that appears
-in a printed manual without chapter numbers of any kind. Use the
-@code{@@appendix} command to create an appendix in a printed manual
-that is labelled by letter instead of by number.@refill
-
-For Info file output, the @code{@@unnumbered} and @code{@@appendix}
-commands are equivalent to @code{@@chapter}: the title is printed on a
-line by itself with a line of asterisks underneath. (@xref{chapter, ,
-@code{@@chapter}}.)(a)refill
-
-To create an appendix or an unnumbered chapter, write an
-@code{@@appendix} or @code{@@unnumbered} command at the beginning of a
-line and follow it on the same line by the title, as you would if you
-were creating a chapter.@refill
-
-
-@node majorheading & chapheading, section, unnumbered & appendix, Structuring
-@section @code{@@majorheading}, @code{@@chapheading}
-@findex majorheading
-@findex chapheading
-
-The @code{@@majorheading} and @code{@@chapheading} commands put
-chapter-like headings in the body of a document.@refill
-
-However, neither command causes @TeX{} to produce a numbered heading
-or an entry in the table of contents; and neither command causes
-@TeX{} to start a new page in a printed manual.@refill
-
-In @TeX{}, an @code{@@majorheading} command generates a larger vertical
-whitespace before the heading than an @code{@@chapheading} command but
-is otherwise the same.@refill
-
-In Info,
-the @code{@@majorheading} and
-@code{@@chapheading} commands are equivalent to
-@code{@@chapter}: the title is printed on a line by itself with a line
-of asterisks underneath. (@xref{chapter, , @code{@@chapter}}.)(a)refill
-
-@node section, unnumberedsec appendixsec heading, majorheading & chapheading,
Structuring
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@section}
-@findex section
-
-In a printed manual, an @code{@@section} command identifies a
-numbered section within a chapter. The section title appears in the
-table of contents. In Info, an @code{@@section} command provides a
-title for a segment of text, underlined with @samp{=}.@refill
-
-This section is headed with an @code{@@section} command and looks like
-this in the Texinfo file:@refill
-
-@example
-@@section @@code@{@@@@section@}
-@end example
-
-To create a section, write the @code{@@section} command at the
-beginning of a line and follow it on the same line by the section
-title.@refill
-
-Thus,
-
-@example
-@@section This is a section
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-@group
-This is a section
-=================
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-in Info.
-
-@node unnumberedsec appendixsec heading, subsection, section, Structuring
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@unnumberedsec}, @code{@@appendixsec}, @code{@@heading}
-@findex unnumberedsec
-@findex appendixsec
-@findex heading
-
-The @code{@@unnumberedsec}, @code{@@appendixsec}, and @code{@@heading}
-commands are, respectively, the unnumbered, appendix-like, and
-heading-like equivalents of the @code{@@section} command.
-(@xref{section, , @code{@@section}}.)(a)refill
-
-@table @code
-@item @@unnumberedsec
-The @code{@@unnumberedsec} command may be used within an
-unnumbered chapter or within a regular chapter or appendix to
-provide an unnumbered section.@refill
-
-@item @@appendixsec
-@itemx @@appendixsection
-@code{@@appendixsection} is a longer spelling of the
-@code{@@appendixsec} command; the two are synonymous.@refill
-@findex appendixsection
-
-Conventionally, the @code{@@appendixsec} or @code{@@appendixsection}
-command is used only within appendices.@refill
-
-@item @@heading
-You may use the @code{@@heading} command anywhere you wish for a
-section-style heading that will not appear in the table of contents.@refill
-@end table
-
-@node subsection, unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading, unnumberedsec appendixsec
heading, Structuring
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section The @code{@@subsection} Command
-@findex subsection
-
-Subsections are to sections as sections are to chapters.
-(@xref{section, , @code{@@section}}.) In Info, subsection titles are
-underlined with @samp{-}. For example,@refill
-
-@example
-@@subsection This is a subsection
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-@group
-This is a subsection
---------------------
-@end group
-@end example
-
-In a printed manual, subsections are listed in the table of contents
-and are numbered three levels deep.@refill
-
-@node unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading, subsubsection, subsection, Structuring
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section The @code{@@subsection}-like Commands
-@cindex Subsection-like commands
-@findex unnumberedsubsec
-@findex appendixsubsec
-@findex subheading
-
-The @code{@@unnumberedsubsec}, @code{@@appendixsubsec}, and
-@code{@@subheading} commands are, respectively, the unnumbered,
-appendix-like, and heading-like equivalents of the @code{@@subsection}
-command. (@xref{subsection, , @code{@@subsection}}.)(a)refill
-
-In Info, the @code{@@subsection}-like commands generate a title
-underlined with hyphens. In a printed manual, an @code{@@subheading}
-command produces a heading like that of a subsection except that it is
-not numbered and does not appear in the table of contents. Similarly,
-an @code{@@unnumberedsubsec} command produces an unnumbered heading like
-that of a subsection and an @code{@@appendixsubsec} command produces a
-subsection-like heading labelled with a letter and numbers; both of
-these commands produce headings that appear in the table of
-contents.@refill
-
-@node subsubsection, Raise/lower sections, unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading,
Structuring
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section The `subsub' Commands
-@cindex Subsub commands
-@findex subsubsection
-@findex unnumberedsubsubsec
-@findex appendixsubsubsec
-@findex subsubheading
-
-The fourth and lowest level sectioning commands in Texinfo are the
-`subsub' commands. They are:@refill
-
-@table @code
-@item @@subsubsection
-Subsubsections are to subsections as subsections are to sections.
-(@xref{subsection, , @code{@@subsection}}.) In a printed manual,
-subsubsection titles appear in the table of contents and are numbered
-four levels deep.@refill
-
-@item @@unnumberedsubsubsec
-Unnumbered subsubsection titles appear in the table of contents of a
-printed manual, but lack numbers. Otherwise, unnumbered
-subsubsections are the same as subsubsections. In Info, unnumbered
-subsubsections look exactly like ordinary subsubsections.@refill
-
-@item @@appendixsubsubsec
-Conventionally, appendix commands are used only for appendices and are
-lettered and numbered appropriately in a printed manual. They also
-appear in the table of contents. In Info, appendix subsubsections look
-exactly like ordinary subsubsections.@refill
-
-@item @@subsubheading
-The @code{@@subsubheading} command may be used anywhere that you need
-a small heading that will not appear in the table of contents. In
-Info, subsubheadings look exactly like ordinary subsubsection
-headings.@refill
-@end table
-
-In Info, `subsub' titles are underlined with periods.
-For example,@refill
-
-@example
-@@subsubsection This is a subsubsection
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-@group
-This is a subsubsection
-.......................
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@node Raise/lower sections, , subsubsection, Structuring
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@raisesections} and @code{@@lowersections}
-@findex raisesections
-@findex lowersections
-@cindex Raising and lowering sections
-@cindex Sections, raising and lowering
-
-The @code{@@raisesections} and @code{@@lowersections} commands raise and
-lower the hierarchical level of chapters, sections, subsections and the
-like. The @code{@@raisesections} command changes sections to chapters,
-subsections to sections, and so on. The @code{@@lowersections} command
-changes chapters to sections, sections to subsections, and so on.
-
-@cindex Include files, and section levels
-An @code{@@lowersections} command is useful if you wish to include text
-that is written as an outer or standalone Texinfo file in another
-Texinfo file as an inner, included file. If you write the command at
-the beginning of the file, all your @code{@@chapter} commands are
-formatted as if they were @code{@@section} commands, all your
-@code{@@section} command are formatted as if they were
-@code{@@subsection} commands, and so on.
-
-@need 1000
-@code{@@raisesections} raises a command one level in the chapter
-structuring hierarchy:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
- @r{Change} @r{To}
-
-@@subsection @@section,
-@@section @@chapter,
-@@heading @@chapheading,
- @r{etc.}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@need 1000
-@code{@@lowersections} lowers a command one level in the chapter
-structuring hierarchy:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
- @r{Change} @r{To}
-
-@@chapter @@section,
-@@subsection @@subsubsection,
-@@heading @@subheading,
- @r{etc.}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-An @code{@@raisesections} or @code{@@lowersections} command changes only
-those structuring commands that follow the command in the Texinfo file.
-Write an @code{@@raisesections} or @code{@@lowersections} command on a
-line of its own.
-
-An @code{@@lowersections} command cancels an @code{@@raisesections}
-command, and vice versa. Typically, the commands are used like this:
-
-@example
-@@lowersections
-@@include somefile.texi
-@@raisesections
-@end example
-
-Without the @code{@@raisesections}, all the subsequent sections in your
-document will be lowered.
-
-Repeated use of the commands continue to raise or lower the hierarchical
-level a step at a time.
-
-An attempt to raise above `chapters' reproduces chapter commands; an
-attempt to lower below `subsubsections' reproduces subsubsection
-commands.
-
-@node Nodes, Menus, Structuring, Top
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@chapter Nodes
-
-@dfn{Nodes} are the primary segments of a Texinfo file. They do not
-themselves impose a hierarchic or any other kind of structure on a file.
-Nodes contain @dfn{node pointers} that name other nodes, and can contain
-@dfn{menus} which are lists of nodes. In Info, the movement commands
-can carry you to a pointed-to node or to a node listed in a menu. Node
-pointers and menus provide structure for Info files just as chapters,
-sections, subsections, and the like, provide structure for printed
-books.@refill
-
-@menu
-* Two Paths:: Different commands to structure
- Info output and printed output.
-* Node Menu Illustration:: A diagram, and sample nodes and menus.
-* node:: How to write a node, in detail.
-* makeinfo Pointer Creation:: How to create node pointers with @code{makeinfo}.
-@end menu
-
-@node Two Paths, Node Menu Illustration, Nodes, Nodes
-@ifinfo
-@heading Two Paths
-@end ifinfo
-
-The node and menu commands and the chapter structuring commands are
-independent of each other:
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-In Info, node and menu commands provide structure. The chapter
-structuring commands generate headings with different kinds of
-underlining---asterisks for chapters, hyphens for sections, and so on;
-they do nothing else.@refill
-
-@item
-In @TeX{}, the chapter structuring commands generate chapter and section
-numbers and tables of contents. The node and menu commands provide
-information for cross references; they do nothing else.@refill
-@end itemize
-
-You can use node pointers and menus to structure an Info file any way
-you want; and you can write a Texinfo file so that its Info output has a
-different structure than its printed output. However, most Texinfo
-files are written such that the structure for the Info output
-corresponds to the structure for the printed output. It is not
-convenient to do otherwise.@refill
-
-Generally, printed output is structured in a tree-like hierarchy in
-which the chapters are the major limbs from which the sections branch
-out. Similarly, node pointers and menus are organized to create a
-matching structure in the Info output.@refill
-
-@node Node Menu Illustration, node, Two Paths, Nodes
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Node and Menu Illustration
-
-Here is a copy of the diagram shown earlier that illustrates a Texinfo
-file with three chapters, each of which contains two sections.@refill
-
-Note that the ``root'' is at the top of the diagram and the ``leaves''
-are at the bottom. This is how such a diagram is drawn conventionally;
-it illustrates an upside-down tree. For this reason, the root node is
-called the `Top' node, and `Up' node pointers carry you closer to the
-root.@refill
-
-@example
-@group
- Top
- |
- -------------------------------------
- | | |
- Chapter 1 Chapter 2 Chapter 3
- | | |
- -------- -------- --------
- | | | | | |
- Section Section Section Section Section Section
- 1.1 1.2 2.1 2.2 3.1 3.2
-
-@end group
-@end example
-
-Write the beginning of the node for Chapter 2 like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@node Chapter 2, Chapter 3, Chapter 1, top
-@@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This @code{@@node} line says that the name of this node is ``Chapter 2'', the
-name of the `Next' node is ``Chapter 3'', the name of the `Previous'
-node is ``Chapter 1'', and the name of the `Up' node is ``Top''.
-
-@quotation
-@strong{Please Note:} `Next' refers to the next node at the same
-hierarchical level in the manual, not necessarily to the next node
-within the Texinfo file. In the Texinfo file, the subsequent node may
-be at a lower level---a section-level node may follow a chapter-level
-node, and a subsection-level node may follow a section-level node.
-`Next' and `Previous' refer to nodes at the @emph{same} hierarchical
-level. (The `Top' node contains the exception to this rule. Since the
-`Top' node is the only node at that level, `Next' refers to the first
-following node, which is almost always a chapter or chapter-level
-node.)@refill
-@end quotation
-
-To go to Sections 2.1 and 2.2 using Info, you need a menu inside Chapter
-2. (@xref{Menus}.) You would write the menu just
-before the beginning of Section 2.1, like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
- @@menu
- * Sect. 2.1:: Description of this section.
- * Sect. 2.2::
- @@end menu
-@end group
-@end example
-
-Write the node for Sect. 2.1 like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
- @@node Sect. 2.1, Sect. 2.2, Chapter 2, Chapter 2
- @@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@end group
-@end example
-
-In Info format, the `Next' and `Previous' pointers of a node usually
-lead to other nodes at the same level---from chapter to chapter or from
-section to section (sometimes, as shown, the `Previous' pointer points
-up); an `Up' pointer usually leads to a node at the level above (closer
-to the `Top' node); and a `Menu' leads to nodes at a level below (closer
-to `leaves'). (A cross reference can point to a node at any level;
-see @ref{Cross References}.)@refill
-
-Usually, an @code{@@node} command and a chapter structuring command are
-used in sequence, along with indexing commands. (You may follow the
-@code{@@node} line with a comment line that reminds you which pointer is
-which.)@refill
-
-Here is the beginning of the chapter in this manual called ``Ending a
-Texinfo File''. This shows an @code{@@node} line followed by a comment
-line, an @code{@@chapter} line, and then by indexing lines.@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@node Ending a File, Structuring, Beginning a File, Top
-@@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@@chapter Ending a Texinfo File
-@@cindex Ending a Texinfo file
-@@cindex Texinfo file ending
-@@cindex File ending
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@node node, makeinfo Pointer Creation, Node Menu Illustration, Nodes
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section The @code{@@node} Command
-
-@cindex Node, defined
-A @dfn{node} is a segment of text that begins at an @code{@@node}
-command and continues until the next @code{@@node} command. The
-definition of node is different from that for chapter or section. A
-chapter may contain sections and a section may contain subsections;
-but a node cannot contain subnodes; the text of a node continues only
-until the next @code{@@node} command in the file. A node usually
-contains only one chapter structuring command, the one that follows
-the @code{@@node} line. On the other hand, in printed output nodes
-are used only for cross references, so a chapter or section may
-contain any number of nodes. Indeed, a chapter usually contains
-several nodes, one for each section, subsection, and
-subsubsection.@refill
-
-To create a node, write an @code{@@node} command at the beginning of a
-line, and follow it with four arguments, separated by commas, on the
-rest of the same line. These arguments are the name of the node, and
-the names of the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers, in that order.
-You may insert spaces before each pointer if you wish; the spaces are
-ignored. You must write the name of the node, and the names of the
-`Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers, all on the same line. Otherwise,
-the formatters fail. (@inforef{Top, info, info}, for more information
-about nodes in Info.)@refill
-
-Usually, you write one of the chapter-structuring command lines
-immediately after an @code{@@node} line---for example, an
-@code{@@section} or @code{@@subsection} line. (@xref{Structuring
-Command Types, , Types of Structuring Commands}.)@refill
-
-@quotation
-@strong{Please note:} The GNU Emacs Texinfo mode updating commands work
-only with Texinfo files in which @code{@@node} lines are followed by chapter
-structuring lines. @xref{Updating Requirements}.@refill
-@end quotation
-
-@TeX{} uses @code{@@node} lines to identify the names to use for cross
-references. For this reason, you must write @code{@@node} lines in a
-Texinfo file that you intend to format for printing, even if you do not
-intend to format it for Info. (Cross references, such as the one at the
-end of this sentence, are made with @code{@@xref} and its related
-commands; see @ref{Cross References}.)@refill
-
-@menu
-* Node Names:: How to choose node and pointer names.
-* Writing a Node:: How to write an @code{@@node} line.
-* Node Line Tips:: Keep names short.
-* Node Line Requirements:: Keep names unique, without @@-commands.
-* First Node:: How to write a `Top' node.
-* makeinfo top command:: How to use the @code{@@top} command.
-* Top Node Summary:: Write a brief description for readers.
-@end menu
-
-@node Node Names, Writing a Node, node, node
-@ifinfo
-@subheading Choosing Node and Pointer Names
-@end ifinfo
-
-The name of a node identifies the node. The pointers enable
-you to reach other nodes and consist of the names of those nodes.@refill
-
-Normally, a node's `Up' pointer contains the name of the node whose menu
-mentions that node. The node's `Next' pointer contains the name of the
-node that follows that node in that menu and its `Previous' pointer
-contains the name of the node that precedes it in that menu. When a
-node's `Previous' node is the same as its `Up' node, both node pointers
-name the same node.@refill
-
-Usually, the first node of a Texinfo file is the `Top' node, and its
-`Up' and `Previous' pointers point to the @file{dir} file, which
-contains the main menu for all of Info.@refill
-
-The `Top' node itself contains the main or master menu for the manual.
-Also, it is helpful to include a brief description of the manual in the
-`Top' node. @xref{First Node}, for information on how to write the
-first node of a Texinfo file.@refill
-
-@node Writing a Node, Node Line Tips, Node Names, node
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection How to Write an @code{@@node} Line
-@cindex Writing an @code{@@node} line
-@cindex @code{@@node} line writing
-@cindex Node line writing
-
-The easiest way to write an @code{@@node} line is to write @code{@@node}
-at the beginning of a line and then the name of the node, like
-this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@node @var{node-name}
-@end example
-
-If you are using GNU Emacs, you can use the update node commands
-provided by Texinfo mode to insert the names of the pointers; or you
-can leave the pointers out of the Texinfo file and let @code{makeinfo}
-insert node pointers into the Info file it creates. (@xref{Texinfo
-Mode}, and @ref{makeinfo Pointer Creation}.)@refill
-
-Alternatively, you can insert the `Next', `Previous', and `Up'
-pointers yourself. If you do this, you may find it helpful to use the
-Texinfo mode keyboard command @kbd{C-c C-c n}. This command inserts
-@samp{@@node} and a comment line listing the names of the pointers in
-their proper order. The comment line helps you keep track of which
-arguments are for which pointers. This comment line is especially useful
-if you are not familiar with Texinfo.@refill
-
-The template for a node line with `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers
-looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@node @var{node-name}, @var{next}, @var{previous}, @var{up}
-@end example
-
-If you wish, you can ignore @code{@@node} lines altogether in your first
-draft and then use the @code{texinfo-insert-node-lines} command to
-create @code{@@node} lines for you. However, we do not
-recommend this practice. It is better to name the node itself
-at the same time that you
-write a segment so you can easily make cross references. A large number
-of cross references are an especially important feature of a good Info
-file.@refill
-
-After you have inserted an @code{@@node} line, you should immediately
-write an @@-command for the chapter or section and insert its name.
-Next (and this is important!), put in several index entries. Usually,
-you will find at least two and often as many as four or five ways of
-referring to the node in the index. Use them all. This will make it
-much easier for people to find the node.@refill
-
-@node Node Line Tips, Node Line Requirements, Writing a Node, node
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@node} Line Tips
-
-Here are three suggestions:
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-Try to pick node names that are informative but short.@refill
-
-In the Info file, the file name, node name, and pointer names are all
-inserted on one line, which may run into the right edge of the window.
-(This does not cause a problem with Info, but is ugly.)@refill
-
-@item
-Try to pick node names that differ from each other near the beginnings
-of their names. This way, it is easy to use automatic name completion in
-Info.@refill
-
-@item
-By convention, node names are capitalized just as they would be for
-section or chapter titles---initial and significant words are
-capitalized; others are not.@refill
-@end itemize
-
-@node Node Line Requirements, First Node, Node Line Tips, node
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@node} Line Requirements
-
-@cindex Node line requirements
-Here are several requirements for @code{@@node} lines:
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@cindex Unique nodename requirement
-@cindex Nodename must be unique
-@item
-All the node names for a single Info file must be unique.@refill
-
-Duplicates confuse the Info movement commands. This means, for
-example, that if you end every chapter with a summary, you must name
-each summary node differently. You cannot just call each one
-``Summary''. You may, however, duplicate the titles of chapters, sections,
-and the like. Thus you can end each chapter in a book with a section
-called ``Summary'', so long as the node names for those sections are all
-different.@refill
-
-@item
-A pointer name must be the name of a node.@refill
-
-The node to which a pointer points may come before or after the
-node containing the pointer.@refill
-
-@cindex @@-command in nodename
-@cindex Nodename, cannot contain
-@item
-You cannot use any of the Texinfo @@-commands in a node name;
-@w{@@-commands} confuse Info.@refill
-
-@need 750
-Thus, the beginning of the section called @code{@@chapter} looks like
-this:@refill
-
-@smallexample
-@group
-@@node chapter, unnumbered & appendix, makeinfo top, Structuring
-@@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@@section @@code@{@@@@chapter@}
-@@findex chapter
-@end group
-@end smallexample
-
-@cindex Comma in nodename
-@cindex Apostrophe in nodename
-@item
-You cannot use commas or apostrophes within a node name; these
-confuse @TeX{} or the Info formatters.@refill
-
-@need 700
-For example, the following is a section title:
-
-@smallexample
-@@code@{@@@@unnumberedsec@}, @@code@{@@@@appendixsec@}, @@code@{@@@@heading@}
-@end smallexample
-
-@noindent
-The corresponding node name is:
-
-@smallexample
-unnumberedsec appendixsec heading
-@end smallexample
-
-@cindex Case in nodename
-@item
-Case is significant.
-@end itemize
-
-
-@node First Node, makeinfo top command, Node Line Requirements, node
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection The First Node
-@cindex Top node is first
-@cindex First node
-
-The first node of a Texinfo file is the @dfn{Top} node, except in an
-included file (@pxref{Include Files}). The Top node contains the main
-or master menu for the document, and a short summary of the document
-(@pxref{Top Node Summary}).
-
-@cindex Up node of Top node
-@cindex (dir) as Up node of Top node
-The Top node (which must be named @samp{top} or @samp{Top}) should have
-as its `Up' node the name of a node in another file, where there is a
-menu that leads to this file. Specify the file name in parentheses. If
-the file is to be installed directly in the Info directory file, use
-@samp{(dir)} as the parent of the Top node; this is short for
-@samp{(dir)top}, and specifies the Top node in the @file{dir} file,
-which contains the main menu for the Info system as a whole. For
-example, the @code{@@node Top} line of this manual looks like this:
-
-@example
-@@node Top, Copying, , (dir)
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-(You can use the Texinfo updating commands or the @code{makeinfo}
-utility to insert these pointers automatically.)
-
-@cindex Previous node of Top node
-Do not define the `Previous' node of the Top node to be @samp{(dir)}, as
-it causes confusing behavior for users: if you are in the Top node and
-hit @key{DEL} to go backwards, you wind up in the middle of some other
-entry in the @file{dir} file, which has nothing to do with what you were
-reading.
-
-@xref{Install an Info File}, for more information about installing
-an Info file in the @file{info} directory.
-
-
-@node makeinfo top command, Top Node Summary, First Node, node
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection The @code{@@top} Sectioning Command
-@findex top @r{(@@-command)}
-
-A special sectioning command, @code{@@top}, has been created for use
-with the @code{@@node Top} line. The @code{@@top} sectioning command tells
-@code{makeinfo} that it marks the `Top' node in the file. It provides
-the information that @code{makeinfo} needs to insert node
-pointers automatically. Write the @code{@@top} command at the
-beginning of the line immediately following the @code{@@node Top}
-line. Write the title on the remaining part of the same line as the
-@code{@@top} command.@refill
-
-In Info, the @code{@@top} sectioning command causes the title to appear on a
-line by itself, with a line of asterisks inserted underneath.@refill
-
-In @TeX{} and @code{texinfo-format-buffer}, the @code{@@top}
-sectioning command is merely a synonym for @code{@@unnumbered}.
-Neither of these formatters require an @code{@@top} command, and do
-nothing special with it. You can use @code{@@chapter} or
-@code{@@unnumbered} after the @code{@@node Top} line when you use
-these formatters. Also, you can use @code{@@chapter} or
-@code{@@unnumbered} when you use the Texinfo updating commands to
-create or update pointers and menus.@refill
-
-
-@node Top Node Summary, , makeinfo top command, node
-@subsection The `Top' Node Summary
-@cindex @samp{@r{Top}} node summary
-
-You can help readers by writing a summary in the `Top' node, after the
-@code{@@top} line, before the main or master menu. The summary should
-briefly describe the document. In Info, this summary will appear just
-before the master menu. In a printed manual, this summary will appear
-on a page of its own.@refill
-
-If you do not want the summary to appear on a page of its own in a
-printed manual, you can enclose the whole of the `Top' node, including
-the @code{@@node Top} line and the @code{@@top} sectioning command line
-or other sectioning command line between @code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end
-ifinfo}. This prevents any of the text from appearing in the printed
-output. (@pxref{Conditionals, , Conditionally Visible Text}). You can
-repeat the brief description from the `Top' node within @code{@@iftex}
-@dots{} @code{@@end iftex} at the beginning of the first chapter, for
-those who read the printed manual. This saves paper and may look
-neater.@refill
-
-You should write the version number of the program to which the manual
-applies in the summary. This helps the reader keep track of which
-manual is for which version of the program. If the manual changes more
-frequently than the program or is independent of it, you should also
-include an edition number for the manual. (The title page should also
-contain this information: see @ref{titlepage, ,
-@code{@@titlepage}}.)(a)refill
-
-@node makeinfo Pointer Creation, , node, Nodes
-@section Creating Pointers with @code{makeinfo}
-@cindex Creating pointers with @code{makeinfo}
-@cindex Pointer creation with @code{makeinfo}
-@cindex Automatic pointer creation with @code{makeinfo}
-
-The @code{makeinfo} program has a feature for automatically creating
-node pointers for a hierarchically organized file that lacks
-them.@refill
-
-When you take advantage of this feature, you do not need to write the
-`Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers after the name of a node.
-However, you must write a sectioning command, such as @code{@@chapter}
-or @code{@@section}, on the line immediately following each truncated
-@code{@@node} line. You cannot write a comment line after a node
-line; the section line must follow it immediately.@refill
-
-In addition, you must follow the `Top' @code{@@node} line with a line beginning
-with @code{@@top} to mark the `Top' node in the file. @xref{makeinfo
-top, , @code{@@top}}.
-
-Finally, you must write the name of each node (except for the `Top'
-node) in a menu that is one or more hierarchical levels above the
-node's hierarchical level.@refill
-
-This node pointer insertion feature in @code{makeinfo} is an
-alternative to the menu and pointer creation and update commands in
-Texinfo mode. (@xref{Updating Nodes and Menus}.) It is especially
-helpful to people who do not use GNU Emacs for writing Texinfo
-documents.@refill
-
-@node Menus, Cross References, Nodes, Top
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@chapter Menus
-@cindex Menus
-@findex menu
-
-@dfn{Menus} contain pointers to subordinate
-nodes.@footnote{Menus can carry you to any node, regardless
-of the hierarchical structure; even to nodes in a different
-Info file. However, the GNU Emacs Texinfo mode updating
-commands work only to create menus of subordinate nodes.
-Conventionally, cross references are used to refer to other
-nodes.} In Info, you use menus to go to such nodes. Menus
-have no effect in printed manuals and do not appear in
-them.@refill
-
-By convention, a menu is put at the end of a node since a reader who
-uses the menu may not see text that follows it.@refill
-
-@ifinfo
-A node that has a menu should @emph{not} contain much text. If you
-have a lot of text and a menu, move most of the text into a new
-subnode---all but a few lines.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-@iftex
-@emph{A node that has a menu should not contain much text.} If you
-have a lot of text and a menu, move most of the text into a new
-subnode---all but a few lines. Otherwise, a reader with a terminal
-that displays only a few lines may miss the menu and its associated
-text. As a practical matter, you should locate a menu within 20 lines
-of the beginning of the node.@refill
-@end iftex
-
-@menu
-* Menu Location:: Put a menu in a short node.
-* Writing a Menu:: What is a menu?
-* Menu Parts:: A menu entry has three parts.
-* Less Cluttered Menu Entry:: Two part menu entry.
-* Menu Example:: Two and three part menu entries.
-* Other Info Files:: How to refer to a different Info file.
-@end menu
-
-@node Menu Location, Writing a Menu, Menus, Menus
-@ifinfo
-@heading Menus Need Short Nodes
-@end ifinfo
-@cindex Menu location
-@cindex Location of menus
-@cindex Nodes for menus are short
-@cindex Short nodes for menus
-
-@ifinfo
-A reader can easily see a menu that is close to the beginning of the
-node. The node should be short. As a practical matter, you should
-locate a menu within 20 lines of the beginning of the node.
-Otherwise, a reader with a terminal that displays only a few lines may
-miss the menu and its associated text.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-
-The short text before a menu may look awkward in a printed manual. To
-avoid this, you can write a menu near the beginning of its node and
-follow the menu by an @code{@@node} line, and then an @code{@@heading}
-line located within @code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end ifinfo}. This way,
-the menu, @code{@@node} line, and title appear only in the Info file,
-not the printed document.@refill
-
-For example, the preceding two paragraphs follow an Info-only menu,
-@code{@@node} line, and heading, and look like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@menu
-* Menu Location:: Put a menu in a short node.
-* Writing a Menu:: What is a menu?
-* Menu Parts:: A menu entry has three parts.
-* Less Cluttered Menu Entry:: Two part menu entry.
-* Menu Example:: Two and three part entries.
-* Other Info Files:: How to refer to a different
- Info file.
-@@end menu
-
-@@node Menu Location, Writing a Menu, , Menus
-@@ifinfo
-@@heading Menus Need Short Nodes
-@@end ifinfo
-@end group
-@end example
-
-The Texinfo file for this document contains more than a dozen
-examples of this procedure. One is at the beginning of this chapter;
-another is at the beginning of the ``Cross References'' chapter.@refill
-
-@node Writing a Menu, Menu Parts, Menu Location, Menus
-@section Writing a Menu
-@cindex Writing a menu
-@cindex Menu writing
-
-A menu consists of an @code{@@menu} command on a line by
-itself followed by menu entry lines or menu comment lines
-and then by an @code{@@end menu} command on a line by
-itself.@refill
-
-A menu looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@menu
-Larger Units of Text
-
-* Files:: All about handling files.
-* Multiples: Buffers. Multiple buffers; editing
- several files at once.
-@@end menu
-@end group
-@end example
-
-In a menu, every line that begins with an @w{@samp{* }} is a
-@dfn{menu entry}. (Note the space after the asterisk.) A
-line that does not start with an @w{@samp{* }} may also
-appear in a menu. Such a line is not a menu entry but is a
-menu comment line that appears in the Info file. In
-the example above, the line @samp{Larger Units of Text} is a
-menu comment line; the two lines starting with @w{@samp{* }}
-are menu entries.
-
-@node Menu Parts, Less Cluttered Menu Entry, Writing a Menu, Menus
-@section The Parts of a Menu
-@cindex Parts of a menu
-@cindex Menu parts
-@cindex @code{@@menu} parts
-
-A menu entry has three parts, only the second of which is required:
-
-@enumerate
-@item
-The menu entry name (optional).
-
-@item
-The name of the node (required).
-
-@item
-A description of the item (optional).
-@end enumerate
-
-The template for a menu entry looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-* @var{menu-entry-name}: @var{node-name}. @var{description}
-@end example
-
-Follow the menu entry name with a single colon and follow the node name
-with tab, comma, period, or newline.@refill
-
-In Info, a user selects a node with the @kbd{m} (@code{Info-menu})
-command. The menu entry name is what the user types after the @kbd{m}
-command.@refill
-
-The third part of a menu entry is a descriptive phrase or sentence.
-Menu entry names and node names are often short; the description
-explains to the reader what the node is about. A useful description
-complements the node name rather than repeats it. The description,
-which is optional, can spread over two or more lines; if it does, some
-authors prefer to indent the second line while others prefer to align it
-with the first (and all others). It's up to you.
-
-
-@node Less Cluttered Menu Entry, Menu Example, Menu Parts, Menus
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Less Cluttered Menu Entry
-@cindex Two part menu entry
-@cindex Double-colon menu entries
-@cindex Menu entries with two colons
-@cindex Less cluttered menu entry
-@cindex Uncluttered menu entry
-
-When the menu entry name and node name are the same, you can write
-the name immediately after the asterisk and space at the beginning of
-the line and follow the name with two colons.@refill
-
-@need 800
-For example, write
-
-@example
-* Name:: @var{description}
-@end example
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-instead of
-
-@example
-* Name: Name. @var{description}
-@end example
-
-You should use the node name for the menu entry name whenever possible,
-since it reduces visual clutter in the menu.@refill
-
-@node Menu Example, Other Info Files, Less Cluttered Menu Entry, Menus
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section A Menu Example
-@cindex Menu example
-@cindex Example menu
-
-A menu looks like this in Texinfo:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@menu
-* menu entry name: Node name. A short description.
-* Node name:: This form is preferred.
-@@end menu
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-This produces:
-
-@example
-@group
-* menu:
-
-* menu entry name: Node name. A short description.
-* Node name:: This form is preferred.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@need 700
-Here is an example as you might see it in a Texinfo file:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@menu
-Larger Units of Text
-
-* Files:: All about handling files.
-* Multiples: Buffers. Multiple buffers; editing
- several files at once.
-@@end menu
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-This produces:
-
-@example
-@group
-* menu:
-Larger Units of Text
-
-* Files:: All about handling files.
-* Multiples: Buffers. Multiple buffers; editing
- several files at once.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-In this example, the menu has two entries. @samp{Files} is both a menu
-entry name and the name of the node referred to by that name.
-@samp{Multiples} is the menu entry name; it refers to the node named
-@samp{Buffers}. The line @samp{Larger Units of Text} is a comment; it
-appears in the menu, but is not an entry.@refill
-
-Since no file name is specified with either @samp{Files} or
-@samp{Buffers}, they must be the names of nodes in the same Info file
-(@pxref{Other Info Files, , Referring to Other Info Files}).@refill
-
-@node Other Info Files, , Menu Example, Menus
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Referring to Other Info Files
-@cindex Referring to other Info files
-@cindex Nodes in other Info files
-@cindex Other Info files' nodes
-@cindex Going to other Info files' nodes
-@cindex Info; other files' nodes
-
-You can create a menu entry that enables a reader in Info to go to a
-node in another Info file by writing the file name in parentheses just
-before the node name. In this case, you should use the three-part menu
-entry format, which saves the reader from having to type the file
-name.@refill
-
-@need 800
-The format looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@menu
-* @var{first-entry-name}:(@var{filename})@var{nodename}. @var{description}
-* @var{second-entry-name}:(@var{filename})@var{second-node}. @var{description}
-@@end menu
-@end group
-@end example
-
-For example, to refer directly to the @samp{Outlining} and
-@samp{Rebinding} nodes in the @cite{XEmacs User's Manual}, you would
-write a menu like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@menu
-* Outlining: (xemacs)Outline Mode. The major mode for
- editing outlines.
-* Rebinding: (xemacs)Rebinding. How to redefine the
- meaning of a key.
-@@end menu
-@end group
-@end example
-
-If you do not list the node name, but only name the file, then Info
-presumes that you are referring to the `Top' node.@refill
-
-The @file{dir} file that contains the main menu for Info has menu
-entries that list only file names. These take you directly to the `Top'
-nodes of each Info document. (@xref{Install an Info File}.)@refill
-
-@need 700
-For example:
-
-@example
-@group
-* Info: (info). Documentation browsing system.
-* Emacs: (emacs). The extensible, self-documenting
- text editor.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-(The @file{dir} top level directory for the Info system is an Info file,
-not a Texinfo file, but a menu entry looks the same in both types of
-file.)@refill
-
-Note that the GNU Emacs Texinfo mode menu updating commands only work
-with nodes within the current buffer, so you cannot use them to create
-menus that refer to other files. You must write such menus by hand.@refill
-
-@node Cross References, Marking Text, Menus, Top
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@chapter Cross References
-@cindex Making cross references
-@cindex Cross references
-@cindex References
-
-@dfn{Cross references} are used to refer the reader to other parts of the
-same or different Texinfo files. In Texinfo, nodes are the
-places to which cross references can refer.@refill
-
-@menu
-* References:: What cross references are for.
-* Cross Reference Commands:: A summary of the different commands.
-* Cross Reference Parts:: A cross reference has several parts.
-* xref:: Begin a reference with `See' @dots{}
-* Top Node Naming:: How to refer to the beginning of another file.
-* ref:: A reference for the last part of a sentence.
-* pxref:: How to write a parenthetical cross reference.
-* inforef:: How to refer to an Info-only file.
-* uref:: How to refer to a uniform resource locator.
-@end menu
-
-@node References, Cross Reference Commands, Cross References, Cross References
-@ifinfo
-@heading What References Are For
-@end ifinfo
-
-Often, but not always, a printed document should be designed so that
-it can be read sequentially. People tire of flipping back and forth
-to find information that should be presented to them as they need
-it.@refill
-
-However, in any document, some information will be too detailed for
-the current context, or incidental to it; use cross references to
-provide access to such information. Also, an on-line help system or a
-reference manual is not like a novel; few read such documents in
-sequence from beginning to end. Instead, people look up what they
-need. For this reason, such creations should contain many cross
-references to help readers find other information that they may not
-have read.@refill
-
-In a printed manual, a cross reference results in a page reference,
-unless it is to another manual altogether, in which case the cross
-reference names that manual.@refill
-
-In Info, a cross reference results in an entry that you can follow using
-the Info @samp{f} command. (@inforef{Help-Adv, Some advanced Info
-commands, info}.)@refill
-
-The various cross reference commands use nodes to define cross
-reference locations. This is evident in Info, in which a cross
-reference takes you to the specified node. @TeX{} also uses nodes to
-define cross reference locations, but the action is less obvious. When
-@TeX{} generates a DVI file, it records nodes' page numbers and
-uses the page numbers in making references. Thus, if you are writing
-a manual that will only be printed, and will not be used on-line, you
-must nonetheless write @code{@@node} lines to name the places to which
-you make cross references.@refill
-
-@need 800
-@node Cross Reference Commands, Cross Reference Parts, References, Cross References
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Different Cross Reference Commands
-@cindex Different cross reference commands
-
-There are four different cross reference commands:@refill
-
-@table @code
-@item @@xref
-Used to start a sentence in the printed manual saying @w{`See @dots{}'}
-or an Info cross-reference saying @samp{*Note @var{name}: @var{node}.}.
-
-@item @@ref
-Used within or, more often, at the end of a sentence; same as
-@code{@@xref} for Info; produces just the reference in the printed
-manual without a preceding `See'.@refill
-
-@item @@pxref
-Used within parentheses to make a reference that suits both an Info
-file and a printed book. Starts with a lower case `see' within the
-printed manual. (@samp{p} is for `parenthesis'.)@refill
-
-@item @@inforef
-Used to make a reference to an Info file for which there is no printed
-manual.@refill
-@end table
-
-@noindent
-(The @code{@@cite} command is used to make references to books and
-manuals for which there is no corresponding Info file and, therefore,
-no node to which to point. @xref{cite, , @code{@@cite}}.)(a)refill
-
-@node Cross Reference Parts, xref, Cross Reference Commands, Cross References
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Parts of a Cross Reference
-@cindex Cross reference parts
-@cindex Parts of a cross reference
-
-A cross reference command requires only one argument, which is the
-name of the node to which it refers. But a cross reference command
-may contain up to four additional arguments. By using these
-arguments, you can provide a cross reference name for Info, a topic
-description or section title for the printed output, the name of a
-different Info file, and the name of a different printed
-manual.@refill
-
-Here is a simple cross reference example:@refill
-
-@example
-@@xref@{Node name@}.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-which produces
-
-@example
-*Note Node name::.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and
-
-@quotation
-See Section @var{nnn} [Node name], page @var{ppp}.
-@end quotation
-
-@need 700
-Here is an example of a full five-part cross reference:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@xref@{Node name, Cross Reference Name, Particular Topic,
-info-file-name, A Printed Manual@}, for details.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-which produces
-
-@example
-*Note Cross Reference Name: (info-file-name)Node name,
-for details.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-in Info and
-
-@quotation
-See section ``Particular Topic'' in @i{A Printed Manual}, for details.
-@end quotation
-
-@noindent
-in a printed book.
-
-The five possible arguments for a cross reference are:@refill
-
-@enumerate
-@item
-The node name (required). This is the node to which the
-cross reference takes you. In a printed document, the location of the
-node provides the page reference only for references within the same
-document.@refill
-
-@item
-The cross reference name for the Info reference, if it is to be different
-from the node name. If you include this argument, it becomes
-the first part of the cross reference. It is usually omitted.@refill
-
-@item
-A topic description or section name. Often, this is the title of the
-section. This is used as the name of the reference in the printed
-manual. If omitted, the node name is used.@refill
-
-@item
-The name of the Info file in which the reference is located, if it is
-different from the current file. You need not include any @samp{.info}
-suffix on the file name, since Info readers try appending it
-automatically.
-
-@item
-The name of a printed manual from a different Texinfo file.@refill
-@end enumerate
-
-The template for a full five argument cross reference looks like
-this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@xref@{@var{node-name}, @var{cross-reference-name}, @var{title-or-topic},
-@var{info-file-name}, @var{printed-manual-title}@}.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-Cross references with one, two, three, four, and five arguments are
-described separately following the description of @code{@@xref}.(a)refill
-
-Write a node name in a cross reference in exactly the same way as in
-the @code{@@node} line, including the same capitalization; otherwise, the
-formatters may not find the reference.@refill
-
-You can write cross reference commands within a paragraph, but note
-how Info and @TeX{} format the output of each of the various commands:
-write @code{@@xref} at the beginning of a sentence; write
-@code{@@pxref} only within parentheses, and so on.@refill
-
-@node xref, Top Node Naming, Cross Reference Parts, Cross References
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@xref}
-@findex xref
-@cindex Cross references using @code{@@xref}
-@cindex References using @code{@@xref}
-
-The @code{@@xref} command generates a cross reference for the
-beginning of a sentence. The Info formatting commands convert it into
-an Info cross reference, which the Info @samp{f} command can use to
-bring you directly to another node. The @TeX{} typesetting commands
-convert it into a page reference, or a reference to another book or
-manual.@refill
-
-@menu
-* Reference Syntax:: What a reference looks like and requires.
-* One Argument:: @code{@@xref} with one argument.
-* Two Arguments:: @code{@@xref} with two arguments.
-* Three Arguments:: @code{@@xref} with three arguments.
-* Four and Five Arguments:: @code{@@xref} with four and five arguments.
-@end menu
-
-@node Reference Syntax, One Argument, xref, xref
-@ifinfo
-@subheading What a Reference Looks Like and Requires
-@end ifinfo
-
-Most often, an Info cross reference looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-*Note @var{node-name}::.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-or like this
-
-@example
-*Note @var{cross-reference-name}: @var{node-name}.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-In @TeX{}, a cross reference looks like this:
-
-@example
-See Section @var{section-number} [@var{node-name}], page @var{page}.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-or like this
-
-@example
-See Section @var{section-number} [@var{title-or-topic}], page @var{page}.
-@end example
-
-The @code{@@xref} command does not generate a period or comma to end
-the cross reference in either the Info file or the printed output.
-You must write that period or comma yourself; otherwise, Info will not
-recognize the end of the reference. (The @code{@@pxref} command works
-differently. @xref{pxref, , @code{@@pxref}}.)(a)refill
-
-@quotation
-@strong{Please note:} A period or comma @strong{must} follow the closing
-brace of an @code{@@xref}. It is required to terminate the cross
-reference. This period or comma will appear in the output, both in
-the Info file and in the printed manual.@refill
-@end quotation
-
-@code{@@xref} must refer to an Info node by name. Use @code{@@node}
-to define the node (@pxref{Writing a Node}).@refill
-
-@code{@@xref} is followed by several arguments inside braces, separated by
-commas. Whitespace before and after these commas is ignored.@refill
-
-A cross reference requires only the name of a node; but it may contain
-up to four additional arguments. Each of these variations produces a
-cross reference that looks somewhat different.@refill
-
-@quotation
-@strong{Please note:} Commas separate arguments in a cross reference;
-avoid including them in the title or other part lest the formatters
-mistake them for separators.@refill
-@end quotation
-
-@node One Argument, Two Arguments, Reference Syntax, xref
-@subsection @code{@@xref} with One Argument
-
-The simplest form of @code{@@xref} takes one argument, the name of
-another node in the same Info file. The Info formatters produce
-output that the Info readers can use to jump to the reference; @TeX{}
-produces output that specifies the page and section number for you.@refill
-
-@need 700
-@noindent
-For example,
-
-@example
-@@xref@{Tropical Storms@}.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-*Note Tropical Storms::.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and
-
-@quotation
-See Section 3.1 [Tropical Storms], page 24.
-@end quotation
-
-@noindent
-(Note that in the preceding example the closing brace is followed by a
-period.)@refill
-
-You can write a clause after the cross reference, like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@xref@{Tropical Storms@}, for more info.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-which produces
-
-@example
-*Note Tropical Storms::, for more info.
-@end example
-
-@quotation
-See Section 3.1 [Tropical Storms], page 24, for more info.
-@end quotation
-
-@noindent
-(Note that in the preceding example the closing brace is followed by a
-comma, and then by the clause, which is followed by a period.)@refill
-
-@node Two Arguments, Three Arguments, One Argument, xref
-@subsection @code{@@xref} with Two Arguments
-
-With two arguments, the second is used as the name of the Info cross
-reference, while the first is still the name of the node to which the
-cross reference points.@refill
-
-@need 750
-@noindent
-The template is like this:
-
-@example
-@@xref@{@var{node-name}, @var{cross-reference-name}@}.
-@end example
-
-@need 700
-@noindent
-For example,
-
-@example
-@@xref@{Electrical Effects, Lightning@}.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces:
-
-@example
-*Note Lightning: Electrical Effects.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and
-
-@quotation
-See Section 5.2 [Electrical Effects], page 57.
-@end quotation
-
-@noindent
-(Note that in the preceding example the closing brace is followed by a
-period; and that the node name is printed, not the cross reference name.)@refill
-
-You can write a clause after the cross reference, like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@xref@{Electrical Effects, Lightning@}, for more info.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-which produces
-@example
-*Note Lightning: Electrical Effects, for more info.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and
-
-@quotation
-See Section 5.2 [Electrical Effects], page 57, for more info.
-@end quotation
-
-@noindent
-(Note that in the preceding example the closing brace is followed by a
-comma, and then by the clause, which is followed by a period.)@refill
-
-@node Three Arguments, Four and Five Arguments, Two Arguments, xref
-@subsection @code{@@xref} with Three Arguments
-
-A third argument replaces the node name in the @TeX{} output. The third
-argument should be the name of the section in the printed output, or
-else state the topic discussed by that section. Often, you will want to
-use initial upper case letters so it will be easier to read when the
-reference is printed. Use a third argument when the node name is
-unsuitable because of syntax or meaning.@refill
-
-Remember to avoid placing a comma within the title or topic section of
-a cross reference, or within any other section. The formatters divide
-cross references into arguments according to the commas; a comma
-within a title or other section will divide it into two arguments. In
-a reference, you need to write a title such as ``Clouds, Mist, and
-Fog'' without the commas.@refill
-
-Also, remember to write a comma or period after the closing brace of a
-@code{@@xref} to terminate the cross reference. In the following
-examples, a clause follows a terminating comma.@refill
-
-
-@need 750
-@noindent
-The template is like this:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@xref@{@var{node-name}, @var{cross-reference-name}, @var{title-or-topic}@}.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@need 700
-@noindent
-For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@xref@{Electrical Effects, Lightning, Thunder and Lightning@},
-for details.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-*Note Lightning: Electrical Effects, for details.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and
-
-@quotation
-See Section 5.2 [Thunder and Lightning], page 57, for details.
-@end quotation
-
-If a third argument is given and the second one is empty, then the
-third argument serves both. (Note how two commas, side by side, mark
-the empty second argument.)@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@xref@{Electrical Effects, , Thunder and Lightning@},
-for details.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-*Note Thunder and Lightning: Electrical Effects, for details.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and
-
-@quotation
-See Section 5.2 [Thunder and Lightning], page 57, for details.
-@end quotation
-
-As a practical matter, it is often best to write cross references with
-just the first argument if the node name and the section title are the
-same, and with the first and third arguments if the node name and title
-are different.@refill
-
-Here are several examples from @cite{The GNU Awk User's Guide}:@refill
-
-@smallexample
-@@xref@{Sample Program@}.
-@@xref@{Glossary@}.
-@@xref@{Case-sensitivity, ,Case-sensitivity in Matching@}.
-@@xref@{Close Output, , Closing Output Files and Pipes@},
- for more information.
-@@xref@{Regexp, , Regular Expressions as Patterns@}.
-@end smallexample
-
-@node Four and Five Arguments, , Three Arguments, xref
-@subsection @code{@@xref} with Four and Five Arguments
-
-In a cross reference, a fourth argument specifies the name of another
-Info file, different from the file in which the reference appears, and
-a fifth argument specifies its title as a printed manual.@refill
-
-Remember that a comma or period must follow the closing brace of an
-@code{@@xref} command to terminate the cross reference. In the
-following examples, a clause follows a terminating comma.@refill
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-The template is:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@xref@{@var{node-name}, @var{cross-reference-name}, @var{title-or-topic},
-@var{info-file-name}, @var{printed-manual-title}@}.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@need 700
-@noindent
-For example,
-
-@example
-@@xref@{Electrical Effects, Lightning, Thunder and Lightning,
-weather, An Introduction to Meteorology@}, for details.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-*Note Lightning: (weather)Electrical Effects, for details.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-The name of the Info file is enclosed in parentheses and precedes
-the name of the node.
-
-@noindent
-In a printed manual, the reference looks like this:@refill
-
-@quotation
-See section ``Thunder and Lightning'' in @i{An Introduction to
-Meteorology}, for details.
-@end quotation
-
-@noindent
-The title of the printed manual is typeset in italics; and the
-reference lacks a page number since @TeX{} cannot know to which page a
-reference refers when that reference is to another manual.@refill
-
-Often, you will leave out the second argument when you use the long
-version of @code{@@xref}. In this case, the third argument, the topic
-description, will be used as the cross reference name in Info.@refill
-
-@noindent
-The template looks like this:
-
-@example
-@@xref@{@var{node-name}, , @var{title-or-topic}, @var{info-file-name},
-@var{printed-manual-title}@}, for details.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-which produces
-
-@example
-*Note @var{title-or-topic}: (@var{info-file-name})@var{node-name}, for details.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and
-
-@quotation
-See section @var{title-or-topic} in @var{printed-manual-title}, for details.
-@end quotation
-
-@need 700
-@noindent
-For example,
-
-@example
-@@xref@{Electrical Effects, , Thunder and Lightning,
-weather, An Introduction to Meteorology@}, for details.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-@group
-*Note Thunder and Lightning: (weather)Electrical Effects,
-for details.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and
-
-@quotation
-See section ``Thunder and Lightning'' in @i{An Introduction to
-Meteorology}, for details.
-@end quotation
-
-On rare occasions, you may want to refer to another Info file that
-is within a single printed manual---when multiple Texinfo files are
-incorporated into the same @TeX{} run but make separate Info files.
-In this case, you need to specify only the fourth argument, and not
-the fifth.@refill
-
-@node Top Node Naming, ref, xref, Cross References
-@section Naming a `Top' Node
-@cindex Naming a `Top' Node in references
-@cindex @samp{@r{Top}} node naming for references
-
-In a cross reference, you must always name a node. This means that in
-order to refer to a whole manual, you must identify the `Top' node by
-writing it as the first argument to the @code{@@xref} command. (This
-is different from the way you write a menu entry; see @ref{Other Info
-Files, , Referring to Other Info Files}.) At the same time, to
-provide a meaningful section topic or title in the printed cross
-reference (instead of the word `Top'), you must write an appropriate
-entry for the third argument to the @code{@@xref} command.
-@refill
-
-@noindent
-Thus, to make a cross reference to @cite{The GNU Make Manual},
-write:@refill
-
-@example
-@@xref@{Top, , Overview, make, The GNU Make Manual@}.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-which produces
-
-@example
-*Note Overview: (make)Top.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and
-
-@quotation
-See section ``Overview'' in @i{The GNU Make Manual}.
-@end quotation
-
-@noindent
-In this example, @samp{Top} is the name of the first node, and
-@samp{Overview} is the name of the first section of the manual.@refill
-@node ref, pxref, Top Node Naming, Cross References
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@ref}
-@cindex Cross references using @code{@@ref}
-@cindex References using @code{@@ref}
-@findex ref
-
-@code{@@ref} is nearly the same as @code{@@xref} except that it does
-not generate a `See' in the printed output, just the reference itself.
-This makes it useful as the last part of a sentence.@refill
-
-@need 700
-@noindent
-For example,
-
-@example
-For more information, see @@ref@{Hurricanes@}.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-For more information, see *Note Hurricanes::.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and
-
-@quotation
-For more information, see Section 8.2 [Hurricanes], page 123.
-@end quotation
-
-The @code{@@ref} command sometimes leads writers to express themselves
-in a manner that is suitable for a printed manual but looks awkward
-in the Info format. Bear in mind that your audience will be using
-both the printed and the Info format.@refill
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-Sea surges are described in @@ref@{Hurricanes@}.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@quotation
-Sea surges are described in Section 6.7 [Hurricanes], page 72.
-@end quotation
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-in a printed document, and the following in Info:
-
-@example
-Sea surges are described in *Note Hurricanes::.
-@end example
-
-@quotation
-@strong{Caution:} You @emph{must} write a period or comma immediately
-after an @code{@@ref} command with two or more arguments. Otherwise,
-Info will not find the end of the cross reference entry and its
-attempt to follow the cross reference will fail. As a general rule,
-you should write a period or comma after every @code{@@ref} command.
-This looks best in both the printed and the Info output.@refill
-@end quotation
-
-@node pxref, inforef, ref, Cross References
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@pxref}
-@cindex Cross references using @code{@@pxref}
-@cindex References using @code{@@pxref}
-@findex pxref
-
-The parenthetical reference command, @code{@@pxref}, is nearly the
-same as @code{@@xref}, but you use it @emph{only} inside parentheses
-and you do @emph{not} type a comma or period after the command's
-closing brace. The command differs from @code{@@xref} in two
-ways:@refill
-
-@enumerate
-@item
-@TeX{} typesets the reference for the printed manual with a lower case
-`see' rather than an upper case `See'.@refill
-
-@item
-The Info formatting commands automatically end the reference with a
-closing colon or period.@refill
-@end enumerate
-
-Because one type of formatting automatically inserts closing
-punctuation and the other does not, you should use @code{@@pxref}
-@emph{only} inside parentheses as part of another sentence. Also, you
-yourself should not insert punctuation after the reference, as you do
-with @code{@@xref}.(a)refill
-
-@code{@@pxref} is designed so that the output looks right and works
-right between parentheses both in printed output and in an Info file.
-In a printed manual, a closing comma or period should not follow a
-cross reference within parentheses; such punctuation is wrong. But in
-an Info file, suitable closing punctuation must follow the cross
-reference so Info can recognize its end. @code{@@pxref} spares you
-the need to use complicated methods to put a terminator into one form
-of the output and not the other.@refill
-
-@noindent
-With one argument, a parenthetical cross reference looks like
-this:@refill
-
-@example
-@dots{} storms cause flooding (@@pxref@{Hurricanes@}) @dots{}
-@end example
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-which produces
-
-@example
-@group
-@dots{} storms cause flooding (*Note Hurricanes::) @dots{}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and
-
-@quotation
-@dots{} storms cause flooding (see Section 6.7 [Hurricanes], page 72) @dots{}
-@end quotation
-
-With two arguments, a parenthetical cross reference has this
-template:@refill
-
-@example
-@dots{} (@@pxref@{@var{node-name}, @var{cross-reference-name}@}) @dots{}
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-which produces
-
-@example
-@dots{} (*Note @var{cross-reference-name}: @var{node-name}.) @dots{}
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and
-
-@need 1500
-@quotation
-@dots{} (see Section @var{nnn} [@var{node-name}], page @var{ppp}) @dots{}
-@end quotation
-
-@code{@@pxref} can be used with up to five arguments just like
-@code{@@xref} (@pxref{xref, , @code{@@xref}}).(a)refill
-
-@quotation
-@strong{Please note:} Use @code{@@pxref} only as a parenthetical
-reference. Do not try to use @code{@@pxref} as a clause in a sentence.
-It will look bad in either the Info file, the printed output, or
-both.@refill
-
-Also, parenthetical cross references look best at the ends of sentences.
-Although you may write them in the middle of a sentence, that location
-breaks up the flow of text.@refill
-@end quotation
-
-@node inforef, uref, pxref, Cross References
-@section @code{@@inforef}
-@cindex Cross references using @code{@@inforef}
-@cindex References using @code{@@inforef}
-@findex inforef
-
-@code{@@inforef} is used for cross references to Info files for which
-there are no printed manuals. Even in a printed manual,
-@code{@@inforef} generates a reference directing the user to look in
-an Info file.@refill
-
-The command takes either two or three arguments, in the following
-order:@refill
-
-@enumerate
-@item
-The node name.
-
-@item
-The cross reference name (optional).
-
-@item
-The Info file name.
-@end enumerate
-
-@noindent
-Separate the arguments with commas, as with @code{@@xref}. Also, you
-must terminate the reference with a comma or period after the
-@samp{@}}, as you do with @code{@@xref}.(a)refill
-
-@noindent
-The template is:
-
-@example
-@@inforef@{@var{node-name}, @var{cross-reference-name}, @var{info-file-name}@},
-@end example
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-Thus,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@inforef@{Expert, Advanced Info commands, info@},
-for more information.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-@group
-*Note Advanced Info commands: (info)Expert,
-for more information.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-and
-
-@quotation
-See Info file @file{info}, node @samp{Expert}, for more information.
-@end quotation
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-Similarly,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@inforef@{Expert, , info@}, for more information.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-*Note (info)Expert::, for more information.
-@end example
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-and
-
-@quotation
-See Info file @file{info}, node @samp{Expert}, for more information.
-@end quotation
-
-The converse of @code{@@inforef} is @code{@@cite}, which is used to
-refer to printed works for which no Info form exists. @xref{cite, ,
-@code{@@cite}}.(a)refill
-
-
-@node uref, , inforef, Cross References
-@section @code{@@uref@{@var{url}[, @var{displayed-text}]@}}
-@findex uref
-@cindex Uniform resource locator, referring to
-@cindex URL, referring to
-
-@code{@@uref} produces a reference to a uniform resource locator (URL).
-It takes one mandatory argument, the URL, and one optional argument, the
-text to display (the default is the URL itself). In HTML output,
-@code{@@uref} produces a link you can follow. For example:
-
-@example
-The official GNU ftp site is
-@@uref@{ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu@}
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces (in text):
-@display
-The official GNU ftp site is
-@uref{ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu}
-@end display
-
-@noindent
-whereas
-@example
-The official
-@@uref@{ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu,
- GNU ftp site@} holds programs and texts.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces (in text):
-@display
-The official @uref{ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu, GNU ftp site} holds
-programs and texts.
-@end display
-
-@noindent
-and (in HTML):
-@example
-The official <A
HREF="ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu">GNU ftp
-site</A> holds programs and texts.
-@end example
-
-To merely indicate a URL, use @code{@@url} (@pxref{url, @code{@@url}}).
-
-
-@node Marking Text, Quotations and Examples, Cross References, Top
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@chapter Marking Words and Phrases
-@cindex Paragraph, marking text within
-@cindex Marking words and phrases
-@cindex Words and phrases, marking them
-@cindex Marking text within a paragraph
-
-In Texinfo, you can mark words and phrases in a variety of ways.
-The Texinfo formatters use this information to determine how to
-highlight the text.
-You can specify, for example, whether a word or phrase is a
-defining occurrence, a metasyntactic variable, or a symbol used in a
-program. Also, you can emphasize text.@refill
-
-@menu
-* Indicating:: How to indicate definitions, files, etc.
-* Emphasis:: How to emphasize text.
-@end menu
-
-@node Indicating, Emphasis, Marking Text, Marking Text
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Indicating Definitions, Commands, etc.
-@cindex Highlighting text
-@cindex Indicating commands, definitions, etc.
-
-Texinfo has commands for indicating just what kind of object a piece of
-text refers to. For example, metasyntactic variables are marked by
-@code{@@var}, and code by @code{@@code}. Since the pieces of text are
-labelled by commands that tell what kind of object they are, it is easy
-to change the way the Texinfo formatters prepare such text. (Texinfo is
-an @emph{intentional} formatting language rather than a @emph{typesetting}
-formatting language.)@refill
-
-For example, in a printed manual,
-code is usually illustrated in a typewriter font;
-@code{@@code} tells @TeX{} to typeset this text in this font. But it
-would be easy to change the way @TeX{} highlights code to use another
-font, and this change would not effect how keystroke examples are
-highlighted. If straight typesetting commands were used in the body
-of the file and you wanted to make a change, you would need to check
-every single occurrence to make sure that you were changing code and
-not something else that should not be changed.@refill
-
-@menu
-* Useful Highlighting:: Highlighting provides useful information.
-* code:: How to indicate code.
-* kbd:: How to show keyboard input.
-* key:: How to specify keys.
-* samp:: How to show a literal sequence of characters.
-* var:: How to indicate a metasyntactic variable.
-* file:: How to indicate the name of a file.
-* dfn:: How to specify a definition.
-* cite:: How to refer to a book that is not in Info.
-* url:: How to indicate a world wide web reference.
-* email:: How to indicate an electronic mail address.
-@end menu
-
-@node Useful Highlighting, code, Indicating, Indicating
-@ifinfo
-@subheading Highlighting Commands are Useful
-@end ifinfo
-
-The highlighting commands can be used to generate useful information
-from the file, such as lists of functions or file names. It is
-possible, for example, to write a program in Emacs Lisp (or a keyboard
-macro) to insert an index entry after every paragraph that contains
-words or phrases marked by a specified command. You could do this to
-construct an index of functions if you had not already made the
-entries.@refill
-
-The commands serve a variety of purposes:@refill
-
-@table @code
-@item @@code@{@var{sample-code}@}
-Indicate text that is a literal example of a piece of a program.@refill
-
-@item @@kbd@{@var{keyboard-characters}@}
-Indicate keyboard input.@refill
-
-@item @@key@{@var{key-name}@}
-Indicate the conventional name for a key on a keyboard.@refill
-
-@item @@samp@{@var{text}@}
-Indicate text that is a literal example of a sequence of characters.@refill
-
-@item @@var@{@var{metasyntactic-variable}@}
-Indicate a metasyntactic variable.@refill
-
-@item @@url@{@var{uniform-resource-locator}@}
-Indicate a uniform resource locator for the World Wide Web.
-
-@item @@file@{@var{file-name}@}
-Indicate the name of a file.@refill
-
-@item @@email@{@var{email-address}[, @var{displayed-text}]@}
-Indicate an electronic mail address.
-
-@item @@dfn@{@var{term}@}
-Indicate the introductory or defining use of a term.@refill
-
-@item @@cite@{@var{reference}@}
-Indicate the name of a book.@refill
-
-@ignore
-@item @@ctrl@{@var{ctrl-char}@}
-Use for an @sc{ascii} control character.@refill
-@end ignore
-@end table
-
-@node code, kbd, Useful Highlighting, Indicating
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@code}@{@var{sample-code}@}
-@findex code
-
-Use the @code{@@code} command to indicate text that is a piece of a
-program and which consists of entire syntactic tokens. Enclose the
-text in braces.@refill
-
-Thus, you should use @code{@@code} for an expression in a program, for
-the name of a variable or function used in a program, or for a
-keyword. Also, you should use @code{@@code} for the name of a
-program, such as @code{diff}, that is a name used in the machine. (You
-should write the name of a program in the ordinary text font if you
-regard it as a new English word, such as `Emacs' or `Bison'.)@refill
-
-Use @code{@@code} for environment variables such as @code{TEXINPUTS},
-and other variables.@refill
-
-Use @code{@@code} for command names in command languages that
-resemble programming languages, such as Texinfo or the shell.
-For example, @code{@@code} and @code{@@samp} are produced by writing
-@samp{@@code@{@@@@code@}} and @samp{@@code@{@@@@samp@}} in the Texinfo
-source, respectively.@refill
-
-Note, however, that you should not use @code{@@code} for shell options
-such as @samp{-c} when such options stand alone. (Use @code{@@samp}.)
-Also, an entire shell command often looks better if written using
-@code{@@samp} rather than @code{@@code}. In this case, the rule is to
-choose the more pleasing format.@refill
-
-It is incorrect to alter the case of a word inside an @code{@@code}
-command when it appears at the beginning of a sentence. Most computer
-languages are case sensitive. In C, for example, @code{Printf} is
-different from the identifier @code{printf}, and most likely is a
-misspelling of it. Even in languages which are not case sensitive, it
-is confusing to a human reader to see identifiers spelled in different
-ways. Pick one spelling and always use that. If you do not want to
-start a sentence with a command written all in lower case, you should
-rearrange the sentence.@refill
-
-Do not use the @code{@@code} command for a string of characters shorter
-than a syntactic token. If you are writing about @samp{TEXINPU}, which
-is just a part of the name for the @code{TEXINPUTS} environment
-variable, you should use @code{@@samp}.(a)refill
-
-In particular, you should not use the @code{@@code} command when writing
-about the characters used in a token; do not, for example, use
-@code{@@code} when you are explaining what letters or printable symbols
-can be used in the names of functions. (Use @code{@@samp}.) Also, you
-should not use @code{@@code} to mark text that is considered input to
-programs unless the input is written in a language that is like a
-programming language. For example, you should not use @code{@@code} for
-the keystroke commands of GNU Emacs (use @code{@@kbd} instead) although
-you may use @code{@@code} for the names of the Emacs Lisp functions that
-the keystroke commands invoke.@refill
-
-In the printed manual, @code{@@code} causes @TeX{} to typeset the
-argument in a typewriter face. In the Info file, it causes the Info
-formatting commands to use single quotation marks around the text.
-
-@need 700
-For example,
-
-@example
-Use @@code@{diff@} to compare two files.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces this in the printed manual:@refill
-
-@quotation
-Use @code{diff} to compare two files.
-@end quotation
-@iftex
-
-@noindent
-and this in the Info file:@refill
-
-@example
-Use `diff' to compare two files.
-@end example
-@end iftex
-
-
-@node kbd, key, code, Indicating
-@subsection @code{@@kbd}@{@var{keyboard-characters}@}
-@findex kbd
-@cindex keyboard input
-
-Use the @code{@@kbd} command for characters of input to be typed by
-users. For example, to refer to the characters @kbd{M-a},
-write@refill
-
-@example
-@@kbd@{M-a@}
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-and to refer to the characters @kbd{M-x shell}, write@refill
-
-@example
-@@kbd@{M-x shell@}
-@end example
-
-@cindex user input
-@cindex slanted typewriter font, for @code{@@kbd}
-The @code{@@kbd} command has the same effect as @code{@@code} in Info,
-but by default produces a different font (slanted typewriter instead of
-normal typewriter) in the printed manual, so users can distinguish the
-characters they are supposed to type from those the computer outputs.
-
-@findex kbdinputstyle
-Since the usage of @code{@@kbd} varies from manual to manual, you can
-control the font switching with the @code{@@kbdinputstyle} command.
-This command has no effect on Info output. Write this command at the
-beginning of a line with a single word as an argument, one of the
-following:
-@vindex distinct@r{, arg to @@kbdinputstyle}
-@vindex example@r{, arg to @@kbdinputstyle}
-@vindex code@r{, arg to @@kbdinputstyle}
-@table @samp
-@item code
-Always use the same font for @code{@@kbd} as @code{@@code}.
-@item example
-Use the distinguishing font for @code{@@kbd} only in @code{@@example}
-and similar environments.
-@item example
-(the default) Always use the distinguishing font for @code{@@kbd}.
-@end table
-
-You can embed another @@-command inside the braces of an @code{@@kbd}
-command. Here, for example, is the way to describe a command that
-would be described more verbosely as ``press an @samp{r} and then
-press the @key{RET} key'':@refill
-
-@example
-@@kbd@{r @@key@{RET@}@}
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This produces: @kbd{r @key{RET}}
-
-You also use the @code{@@kbd} command if you are spelling out the letters
-you type; for example:@refill
-
-@example
-To give the @@code@{logout@} command,
-type the characters @@kbd@{l o g o u t @@key@{RET@}@}.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This produces:
-
-@quotation
-To give the @code{logout} command,
-type the characters @kbd{l o g o u t @key{RET}}.
-@end quotation
-
-(Also, this example shows that you can add spaces for clarity. If you
-really want to mention a space character as one of the characters of
-input, write @kbd{@@key@{SPC@}} for it.)@refill
-
-
-@node key, samp, kbd, Indicating
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@key}@{@var{key-name}@}
-@findex key
-
-Use the @code{@@key} command for the conventional name for a key on a
-keyboard, as in:@refill
-
-@example
-@@key@{RET@}
-@end example
-
-You can use the @code{@@key} command within the argument of an
-@code{@@kbd} command when the sequence of characters to be typed
-includes one or more keys that are described by name.@refill
-
-@need 700
-For example, to produce @kbd{C-x @key{ESC}} you would type:@refill
-
-@example
-@@kbd@{C-x @@key@{ESC@}@}
-@end example
-
-Here is a list of the recommended names for keys:
-@cindex Recommended names for keys
-@cindex Keys, recommended names
-@cindex Names recommended for keys
-@cindex Abbreviations for keys
-
-@quotation
-@table @t
-@item SPC
-Space
-@item RET
-Return
-@item LFD
-Linefeed (however, since most keyboards nowadays do not have a Linefeed key,
-it might be better to call this character @kbd{C-j}.
-@item TAB
-Tab
-@item BS
-Backspace
-@item ESC
-Escape
-@item DEL
-Delete
-@item SHIFT
-Shift
-@item CTRL
-Control
-@item META
-Meta
-@end table
-@end quotation
-
-@cindex META key
-There are subtleties to handling words like `meta' or `ctrl' that are
-names of modifier keys. When mentioning a character in which the
-modifier key is used, such as @kbd{Meta-a}, use the @code{@@kbd} command
-alone; do not use the @code{@@key} command; but when you are referring
-to the modifier key in isolation, use the @code{@@key} command. For
-example, write @samp{@@kbd@{Meta-a@}} to produce @kbd{Meta-a} and
-@samp{@@key@{META@}} to produce @key{META}.
-
-@c I don't think this is a good explanation.
-@c I think it will puzzle readers more than it clarifies matters. -- rms.
-@c In other words, use @code{@@kbd} for what you do, and use @code{@@key}
-@c for what you talk about: ``Press @code{@@kbd@{M-a@}} to move point to
-@c the beginning of the sentence. The @code{@@key@{META@}} key is often in
-@c the lower left of the keyboard.''@refill
-
-@node samp, var, key, Indicating
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@samp}@{@var{text}@}
-@findex samp
-
-Use the @code{@@samp} command to indicate text that is a literal example
-or `sample' of a sequence of characters in a file, string, pattern, etc.
-Enclose the text in braces. The argument appears within single
-quotation marks in both the Info file and the printed manual; in
-addition, it is printed in a fixed-width font.@refill
-
-@example
-To match @@samp@{foo@} at the end of the line,
-use the regexp @@samp@{foo$@}.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@quotation
-To match @samp{foo} at the end of the line, use the regexp
-@samp{foo$}.(a)refill
-@end quotation
-
-Any time you are referring to single characters, you should use
-@code{@@samp} unless @code{@@kbd} or @code{@@key} is more appropriate.
-Use @code{@@samp} for the names of command-line options (except in an
-@code{@@table}, where @code{@@code} seems to read more easily). Also,
-you may use @code{@@samp} for entire statements in C and for entire
-shell commands---in this case, @code{@@samp} often looks better than
-@code{@@code}. Basically, @code{@@samp} is a catchall for whatever is
-not covered by @code{@@code}, @code{@@kbd}, or @code{@@key}.(a)refill
-
-Only include punctuation marks within braces if they are part of the
-string you are specifying. Write punctuation marks outside the braces
-if those punctuation marks are part of the English text that surrounds
-the string. In the following sentence, for example, the commas and
-period are outside of the braces:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-In English, the vowels are @@samp@{a@}, @@samp@{e@},
-@@samp@{i@}, @@samp@{o@}, @@samp@{u@}, and sometimes
-@@samp@{y@}.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This produces:
-
-@quotation
-In English, the vowels are @samp{a}, @samp{e},
-@samp{i}, @samp{o}, @samp{u}, and sometimes
-@samp{y}.
-@end quotation
-
-@node var, file, samp, Indicating
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@var}@{@var{metasyntactic-variable}@}
-@findex var
-
-Use the @code{@@var} command to indicate metasyntactic variables. A
-@dfn{metasyntactic variable} is something that stands for another piece of
-text. For example, you should use a metasyntactic variable in the
-documentation of a function to describe the arguments that are passed
-to that function.@refill
-
-Do not use @code{@@var} for the names of particular variables in
-programming languages. These are specific names from a program, so
-@code{@@code} is correct for them. For example, the Emacs Lisp variable
-@code{texinfo-tex-command} is not a metasyntactic variable; it is
-properly formatted using @code{@@code}.(a)refill
-
-The effect of @code{@@var} in the Info file is to change the case of
-the argument to all upper case; in the printed manual, to italicize it.
-
-@need 700
-For example,
-
-@example
-To delete file @@var@{filename@},
-type @@code@{rm @@var@{filename@}@}.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@quotation
-To delete file @var{filename}, type @code{rm @var{filename}}.
-@end quotation
-
-@noindent
-(Note that @code{@@var} may appear inside @code{@@code},
-@code{@@samp}, @code{@@file}, etc.)@refill
-
-Write a metasyntactic variable all in lower case without spaces, and
-use hyphens to make it more readable. Thus, the Texinfo source for
-the illustration of how to begin a Texinfo manual looks like
-this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-\input texinfo
-@@@@setfilename @@var@{info-file-name@}
-@@@@settitle @@var@{name-of-manual@}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This produces:
-
-@example
-@group
-\input texinfo
-@@setfilename @var{info-file-name}
-@@settitle @var{name-of-manual}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-In some documentation styles, metasyntactic variables are shown with
-angle brackets, for example:@refill
-
-@example
-@dots{}, type rm <filename>
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-However, that is not the style that Texinfo uses. (You can, of
-course, modify the sources to @TeX{} and the Info formatting commands
-to output the @code{<@dots{}>} format if you wish.)@refill
-
-@node file, dfn, var, Indicating
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@file}@{@var{file-name}@}
-@findex file
-
-Use the @code{@@file} command to indicate text that is the name of a
-file, buffer, or directory, or is the name of a node in Info. You can
-also use the command for file name suffixes. Do not use @code{@@file}
-for symbols in a programming language; use @code{@@code}.
-
-Currently, @code{@@file} is equivalent to @code{@@samp} in its effects.
-For example,@refill
-
-@example
-The @@file@{.el(a)} files are in
-the @@file@{/usr/local/emacs/lisp@} directory.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@quotation
-The @file{.el} files are in
-the @file{/usr/local/emacs/lisp} directory.
-@end quotation
-
-@node dfn, cite, file, Indicating
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@dfn}@{@var{term}@}
-@findex dfn
-
-Use the @code{@@dfn} command to identify the introductory or defining
-use of a technical term. Use the command only in passages whose
-purpose is to introduce a term which will be used again or which the
-reader ought to know. Mere passing mention of a term for the first
-time does not deserve @code{@@dfn}. The command generates italics in
-the printed manual, and double quotation marks in the Info file. For
-example:@refill
-
-@example
-Getting rid of a file is called @@dfn@{deleting@} it.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@quotation
-Getting rid of a file is called @dfn{deleting} it.
-@end quotation
-
-As a general rule, a sentence containing the defining occurrence of a
-term should be a definition of the term. The sentence does not need
-to say explicitly that it is a definition, but it should contain the
-information of a definition---it should make the meaning clear.
-
-@node cite, url, dfn, Indicating
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@cite}@{@var{reference}@}
-@findex cite
-
-Use the @code{@@cite} command for the name of a book that lacks a
-companion Info file. The command produces italics in the printed
-manual, and quotation marks in the Info file.@refill
-
-(If a book is written in Texinfo, it is better to use a cross reference
-command since a reader can easily follow such a reference in Info.
-@xref{xref, , @code{@@xref}}.)(a)refill
-
-@ignore
-@c node ctrl, , cite, Indicating
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@c subsection @code{@@ctrl}@{@var{ctrl-char}@}
-@findex ctrl
-
-The @code{@@ctrl} command is seldom used. It describes an @sc{ascii}
-control character by inserting the actual character into the Info
-file.
-
-Usually, in Texinfo, you talk what you type as keyboard entry by
-describing it with @code{@@kbd}: thus, @samp{@@kbd@{C-a@}} for
-@kbd{C-a}. Use @code{@@kbd} in this way when talking about a control
-character that is typed on the keyboard by the user. When talking
-about a control character appearing in a file or a string, do not use
-@code{@@kbd} since the control character is not typed. Also, do not
-use @samp{C-} but spell out @code{control-}, as in @samp{control-a},
-to make it easier for a reader to understand.@refill
-
-@code{@@ctrl} is an idea from the beginnings of Texinfo which may not
-really fit in to the scheme of things. But there may be times when
-you want to use the command. The pattern is
-@code{@@ctrl@{@var{ch}@}}, where @var{ch} is an @sc{ascii} character
-whose control-equivalent is wanted. For example, to specify
-@samp{control-f}, you would enter@refill
-
-@example
-@@ctrl@{f@}
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@quotation
-@ctrl{f}
-@end quotation
-
-In the Info file, this generates the specified control character, output
-literally into the file. This is done so a user can copy the specified
-control character (along with whatever else he or she wants) into another
-Emacs buffer and use it. Since the `control-h',`control-i', and
-`control-j' characters are formatting characters, they should not be
-indicated with @code{@@ctrl}.(a)refill
-
-In a printed manual, @code{@@ctrl} generates text to describe or
-identify that control character: an uparrow followed by the character
-@var{ch}.(a)refill
-@end ignore
-
-
-@node url, email, cite, Indicating
-@subsection @code{@@url}@{@var{uniform-resource-locator}@}
-@findex url
-@cindex Uniform resource locator, indicating
-@cindex URL, indicating
-
-Use the @code{@@url} to indicate a uniform resource locator on the World
-Wide Web. This is analogous to @code{@@file}, @code{@@var}, etc., and
-is purely for markup purposes. It does not produce a link you can
-follow in HTML output (the @code{@@uref} command does, @pxref{uref,,
-@code{@@uref}}). It is useful for example URL's which do not actually
-exist. For example:
-
-@c Two lines because one is too long for smallbook format.
-@example
-For example, the url might be
-@@url@{http://host.domain.org/path@}.
-@end example
-
-
-@node email, , url, Indicating
-@subsection @code{@@email}@{@var{email-address}[, @var{displayed-text}]@}
-@findex email
-
-Use the @code{@@email} command to indicate an electronic mail address.
-It takes one mandatory argument, the address, and one optional argument, the
-text to display (the default is the address itself).
-
-@cindex mailto link
-In Info and @TeX{}, the address is shown in angle brackets, preceded by
-the text to display if any. In HTML output, @code{@@email} produces a
-@samp{mailto} link that usually brings up a mail composition window.
-For example:
-
-@example
-Send bug reports to @@email@{bug-texinfo@@@@gnu.org(a)}.
-Send suggestions to the @@email@{bug-texinfo@@@(a)gnu.org, same place@}.
-@end example
-@noindent
-produces
-@example
-Send bug reports to @email{bug-texinfo@(a)gnu.org}.
-Send suggestions to the @email{bug-texinfo@(a)gnu.org, same place}.
-@end example
-
-
-@node Emphasis, , Indicating, Marking Text
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Emphasizing Text
-@cindex Emphasizing text
-
-Usually, Texinfo changes the font to mark words in the text according to
-what category the words belong to; an example is the @code{@@code} command.
-Most often, this is the best way to mark words.
-However, sometimes you will want to emphasize text without indicating a
-category. Texinfo has two commands to do this. Also, Texinfo has
-several commands that specify the font in which @TeX{} will typeset
-text. These commands have no affect on Info and only one of them,
-the @code{@@r} command, has any regular use.@refill
-
-@menu
-* emph & strong:: How to emphasize text in Texinfo.
-* Smallcaps:: How to use the small caps font.
-* Fonts:: Various font commands for printed output.
-* Customized Highlighting:: How to define highlighting commands.
-@end menu
-
-@node emph & strong, Smallcaps, Emphasis, Emphasis
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@emph}@{@var{text}@} and @code{@@strong}@{@var{text}@}
-@cindex Emphasizing text, font for
-@findex emph
-@findex strong
-
-The @code{@@emph} and @code{@@strong} commands are for emphasis;
-@code{@@strong} is stronger. In printed output, @code{@@emph}
-produces @emph{italics} and @code{@@strong} produces
-@strong{bold}.(a)refill
-
-@need 800
-For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@quotation
-@@strong@{Caution:@} @@samp@{rm * .[^.]*@} removes @@emph@{all@}
-files in the directory.
-@@end quotation
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@iftex
-@noindent
-produces the following in printed output:
-
-@quotation
-@strong{Caution}: @code{rm * .[^.]*} removes @emph{all}
-files in the directory.
-@end quotation
-
-@noindent
-and the following in Info:
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-@noindent
-produces:
-@end ifinfo
-
-@example
- *Caution*: `rm * .[^.]*' removes *all*
- files in the directory.
-@end example
-
-The @code{@@strong} command is seldom used except to mark what is, in
-effect, a typographical element, such as the word `Caution' in the
-preceding example.
-
-In the Info file, both @code{@@emph} and @code{@@strong} put asterisks
-around the text.@refill
-
-@quotation
-@strong{Caution:} Do not use @code{@@emph} or @code{@@strong} with the
-word @samp{Note}; Info will mistake the combination for a cross
-reference. Use a phrase such as @strong{Please note} or
-@strong{Caution} instead.@refill
-@end quotation
-
-@node Smallcaps, Fonts, emph & strong, Emphasis
-@subsection @code{@@sc}@{@var{text}@}: The Small Caps Font
-@cindex Small caps font
-@findex sc @r{(small caps font)}
-
-@iftex
-Use the @samp{@@sc} command to set text in the printed output in @sc{a
-small caps font} and set text in the Info file in upper case letters.@refill
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-Use the @samp{@@sc} command to set text in the printed output in a
-small caps font and set text in the Info file in upper case letters.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-
-Write the text between braces in lower case, like this:@refill
-
-@example
-The @@sc@{acm@} and @@sc@{ieee@} are technical societies.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This produces:
-
-@display
-The @sc{acm} and @sc{ieee} are technical societies.
-@end display
-
-@TeX{} typesets the small caps font in a manner that prevents the
-letters from `jumping out at you on the page'. This makes small caps
-text easier to read than text in all upper case. The Info formatting
-commands set all small caps text in upper case.@refill
-
-@ifinfo
-If the text between the braces of an @code{@@sc} command is upper case,
-@TeX{} typesets in full-size capitals. Use full-size capitals
-sparingly.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-@iftex
-If the text between the braces of an @code{@@sc} command is upper case,
-@TeX{} typesets in @sc{FULL-SIZE CAPITALS}. Use full-size capitals
-sparingly.@refill
-@end iftex
-
-You may also use the small caps font for a jargon word such as
-@sc{ato} (a @sc{nasa} word meaning `abort to orbit').@refill
-
-There are subtleties to using the small caps font with a jargon word
-such as @sc{cdr}, a word used in Lisp programming. In this case, you
-should use the small caps font when the word refers to the second and
-subsequent elements of a list (the @sc{cdr} of the list), but you
-should use @samp{@@code} when the word refers to the Lisp function of
-the same spelling.@refill
-
-@node Fonts, Customized Highlighting, Smallcaps, Emphasis
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection Fonts for Printing, Not Info
-@cindex Fonts for printing, not for Info
-@findex i @r{(italic font)}
-@findex b @r{(bold font)}
-@findex t @r{(typewriter font)}
-@findex r @r{(Roman font)}
-
-Texinfo provides four font commands that specify font changes in the
-printed manual but have no effect in the Info file. @code{@@i}
-requests @i{italic} font (in some versions of @TeX{}, a slanted font
-is used), @code{@@b} requests @b{bold} face, @code{@@t} requests the
-@t{fixed-width}, typewriter-style font used by @code{@@code}, and @code{@@r} requests a
-@r{roman} font, which is the usual font in which text is printed. All
-four commands apply to an argument that follows, surrounded by
-braces.@refill
-
-Only the @code{@@r} command has much use: in example programs, you
-can use the @code{@@r} command to convert code comments from the
-fixed-width font to a roman font. This looks better in printed
-output.@refill
-
-@need 700
-For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@lisp
-(+ 2 2) ; @@r@{Add two plus two.@}
-@@end lisp
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@lisp
-(+ 2 2) ; @r{Add two plus two.}
-@end lisp
-
-If possible, you should avoid using the other three font commands. If
-you need to use one, it probably indicates a gap in the Texinfo
-language.@refill
-
-@node Customized Highlighting, , Fonts, Emphasis
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection Customized Highlighting
-@cindex Highlighting, customized
-@cindex Customized highlighting
-
-@c I think this whole section is obsolete with the advent of macros
-@c --karl, 15sep96.
-You can use regular @TeX{} commands inside of @code{@@iftex} @dots{}
-@code{@@end iftex} to create your own customized highlighting commands
-for Texinfo. The easiest way to do this is to equate your customized
-commands with pre-existing commands, such as those for italics. Such
-new commands work only with @TeX{}.@refill
-
-@findex definfoenclose
-@cindex Enclosure command for Info
-You can use the @code{@@definfoenclose} command inside of
-@code{@@ifinfo} @dots{} @code{@@end ifinfo} to define commands for Info
-with the same names as new commands for @TeX{}.
-@code{@@definfoenclose} creates new commands for Info that mark text by
-enclosing it in strings that precede and follow the text.
-@footnote{Currently, @code{@@definfoenclose} works only with
-@code{texinfo-format-buffer} and @code{texinfo-format-region}, not with
-@code{makeinfo}.}(a)refill
-
-Here is how to create a new @@-command called @code{@@phoo} that causes
-@TeX{} to typeset its argument in italics and causes Info to display the
-argument between @samp{//} and @samp{\\}.@refill
-
-@need 1300
-For @TeX{}, write the following to equate the @code{@@phoo} command with
-the existing @code{@@i} italics command:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@iftex
-@@global@@let@@phoo=@@i
-@@end iftex
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This defines @code{@@phoo} as a command that causes @TeX{} to typeset
-the argument to @code{@@phoo} in italics. @code{@@global@@let} tells
-@TeX{} to equate the next argument with the argument that follows the
-equals sign.
-
-@need 1300
-For Info, write the following to tell the Info formatters to enclose the
-argument between @samp{//} and @samp{\\}:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@ifinfo
-@@definfoenclose phoo, //, \\
-@@end ifinfo
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-Write the @code{@@definfoenclose} command on a line and follow it with
-three arguments separated by commas (commas are used as separators in an
-@code{@@node} line in the same way).@refill
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-The first argument to @code{@@definfoenclose} is the @@-command name
-@strong{without} the @samp{@@};
-
-@item
-the second argument is the Info start delimiter string; and,
-
-@item
-the third argument is the Info end delimiter string.
-@end itemize
-
-@noindent
-The latter two arguments enclose the highlighted text in the Info file.
-A delimiter string may contain spaces. Neither the start nor end
-delimiter is required. However, if you do not provide a start
-delimiter, you must follow the command name with two commas in a row;
-otherwise, the Info formatting commands will misinterpret the end
-delimiter string as a start delimiter string.@refill
-
-After you have defined @code{@@phoo} both for @TeX{} and for Info, you
-can then write @code{@@phoo@{bar@}} to see @samp{//bar\\}
-in Info and see
-@ifinfo
-@samp{bar} in italics in printed output.
-@end ifinfo
-@iftex
-@i{bar} in italics in printed output.
-@end iftex
-
-Note that each definition applies to its own formatter: one for @TeX{},
-the other for Info.
-
-@need 1200
-Here is another example:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@ifinfo
-@@definfoenclose headword, , :
-@@end ifinfo
-@@iftex
-@@global@@let@@headword=@@b
-@@end iftex
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This defines @code{@@headword} as an Info formatting command that
-inserts nothing before and a colon after the argument and as a @TeX{}
-formatting command to typeset its argument in bold.
-
-@node Quotations and Examples, Lists and Tables, Marking Text, Top
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@chapter Quotations and Examples
-
-Quotations and examples are blocks of text consisting of one or more
-whole paragraphs that are set off from the bulk of the text and
-treated differently. They are usually indented.@refill
-
-In Texinfo, you always begin a quotation or example by writing an
-@@-command at the beginning of a line by itself, and end it by writing
-an @code{@@end} command that is also at the beginning of a line by
-itself. For instance, you begin an example by writing @code{@@example}
-by itself at the beginning of a line and end the example by writing
-@code{@@end example} on a line by itself, at the beginning of that
-line.@refill
-@findex end
-
-@menu
-* Block Enclosing Commands:: Use different constructs for
- different purposes.
-* quotation:: How to write a quotation.
-* example:: How to write an example in a fixed-width font.
-* noindent:: How to prevent paragraph indentation.
-* Lisp Example:: How to illustrate Lisp code.
-* smallexample & smalllisp:: Forms for the @code{@@smallbook} option.
-* display:: How to write an example in the current font.
-* format:: How to write an example that does not narrow
- the margins.
-* exdent:: How to undo the indentation of a line.
-* flushleft & flushright:: How to push text flushleft or flushright.
-* cartouche:: How to draw cartouches around examples.
-@end menu
-
-@node Block Enclosing Commands, quotation, Quotations and Examples, Quotations and
Examples
-@section The Block Enclosing Commands
-
-Here are commands for quotations and examples:@refill
-
-@table @code
-@item @@quotation
-Indicate text that is quoted. The text is filled, indented, and
-printed in a roman font by default.@refill
-
-@item @@example
-Illustrate code, commands, and the like. The text is printed
-in a fixed-width font, and indented but not filled.@refill
-
-@item @@lisp
-Illustrate Lisp code. The text is printed in a fixed-width font,
-and indented but not filled.@refill
-
-@item @@smallexample
-Illustrate code, commands, and the like. Similar to
-@code{@@example}, except that in @TeX{} this command typesets text in
-a smaller font for the smaller @code{@@smallbook} format than for the
-8.5 by 11 inch format.@refill
-
-@item @@smalllisp
-Illustrate Lisp code. Similar to @code{@@lisp}, except that
-in @TeX{} this command typesets text in a smaller font for the smaller
-@code{@@smallbook} format than for the 8.5 by 11 inch format.@refill
-
-@item @@display
-Display illustrative text. The text is indented but not filled, and
-no font is specified (so, by default, the font is roman).@refill
-
-@item @@format
-Print illustrative text. The text is not indented and not filled
-and no font is specified (so, by default, the font is roman).@refill
-@end table
-
-The @code{@@exdent} command is used within the above constructs to
-undo the indentation of a line.
-
-The @code{@@flushleft} and @code{@@flushright} commands are used to line
-up the left or right margins of unfilled text.@refill
-
-The @code{@@noindent} command may be used after one of the above
-constructs to prevent the following text from being indented as a new
-paragraph.@refill
-
-You can use the @code{@@cartouche} command within one of the above
-constructs to highlight the example or quotation by drawing a box with
-rounded corners around it. (The @code{@@cartouche} command affects
-only the printed manual; it has no effect in the Info file; see
-@ref{cartouche, , Drawing Cartouches Around Examples}.)@refill
-
-@node quotation, example, Block Enclosing Commands, Quotations and Examples
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@quotation}
-@cindex Quotations
-@findex quotation
-
-The text of a quotation is
-processed normally except that:@refill
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-the margins are closer to the center of the page, so the whole of the
-quotation is indented;@refill
-
-@item
-the first lines of paragraphs are indented no more than other
-lines;@refill
-
-@item
-in the printed output, interparagraph spacing is reduced.@refill
-@end itemize
-
-@quotation
-This is an example of text written between an @code{@@quotation}
-command and an @code{@@end quotation} command. An @code{@@quotation}
-command is most often used to indicate text that is excerpted from
-another (real or hypothetical) printed work.@refill
-@end quotation
-
-Write an @code{@@quotation} command as text on a line by itself. This
-line will disappear from the output. Mark the end of the quotation
-with a line beginning with and containing only @code{@@end quotation}.
-The @code{@@end quotation} line will likewise disappear from the
-output. Thus, the following,@refill
-
-@example
-@@quotation
-This is
-a foo.
-@@end quotation
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@quotation
-This is a foo.
-@end quotation
-
-@node example, noindent, quotation, Quotations and Examples
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@example}
-@cindex Examples, formatting them
-@cindex Formatting examples
-@findex example
-
-The @code{@@example} command is used to indicate an example that is
-not part of the running text, such as computer input or output.@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-This is an example of text written between an
-@code{@@example} command
-and an @code{@@end example} command.
-The text is indented but not filled.
-@end group
-
-@group
-In the printed manual, the text is typeset in a
-fixed-width font, and extra spaces and blank lines are
-significant. In the Info file, an analogous result is
-obtained by indenting each line with five spaces.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-Write an @code{@@example} command at the beginning of a line by itself.
-This line will disappear from the output. Mark the end of the example
-with an @code{@@end example} command, also written at the beginning of a
-line by itself. The @code{@@end example} will disappear from the
-output.@refill
-
-@need 700
-For example,
-
-@example
-@@example
-mv foo bar
-@@end example
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-mv foo bar
-@end example
-
-Since the lines containing @code{@@example} and @code{@@end example}
-will disappear, you should put a blank line before the
-@code{@@example} and another blank line after the @code{@@end
-example}. (Remember that blank lines between the beginning
-@code{@@example} and the ending @code{@@end example} will appear in
-the output.)@refill
-
-@quotation
-@strong{Caution:} Do not use tabs in the lines of an example (or anywhere
-else in Texinfo, for that matter)! @TeX{} treats tabs as single
-spaces, and that is not what they look like. This is a problem with
-@TeX{}. (If necessary, in Emacs, you can use @kbd{M-x untabify} to
-convert tabs in a region to multiple spaces.)@refill
-@end quotation
-
-Examples are often, logically speaking, ``in the middle'' of a
-paragraph, and the text continues after an example should not be
-indented. The @code{@@noindent} command prevents a piece of text from
-being indented as if it were a new paragraph.
-@ifinfo
-(@xref{noindent}.)
-@end ifinfo
-
-(The @code{@@code} command is used for examples of code that are
-embedded within sentences, not set off from preceding and following
-text. @xref{code, , @code{@@code}}.)
-
-@node noindent, Lisp Example, example, Quotations and Examples
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@noindent}
-@findex noindent
-
-An example or other inclusion can break a paragraph into segments.
-Ordinarily, the formatters indent text that follows an example as a new
-paragraph. However, you can prevent this by writing @code{@@noindent}
-at the beginning of a line by itself preceding the continuation
-text.@refill
-
-@need 1500
-For example:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@example
-This is an example
-@@end example
-
-@@noindent
-This line is not indented. As you can see, the
-beginning of the line is fully flush left with the line
-that follows after it. (This whole example is between
-@@code@{@@@@display@} and @@code@{@@@@end display@}.)
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@display
-@example
-This is an example
-@end example
-@tex
-% Remove extra vskip; this is a kludge to counter the effect of display
-\vskip-3.5\baselineskip
-@end tex
-
-@noindent
-This line is not indented. As you can see, the
-beginning of the line is fully flush left with the line
-that follows after it. (This whole example is between
-@code{@@display} and @code{@@end display}.)
-@end display
-
-To adjust the number of blank lines properly in the Info file output,
-remember that the line containing @code{@@noindent} does not generate a
-blank line, and neither does the @code{@@end example} line.@refill
-
-In the Texinfo source file for this manual, each line that says
-`produces' is preceded by a line containing @code{@@noindent}.(a)refill
-
-Do not put braces after an @code{@@noindent} command; they are not
-necessary, since @code{@@noindent} is a command used outside of
-paragraphs (@pxref{Command Syntax}).@refill
-
-@node Lisp Example, smallexample & smalllisp, noindent, Quotations and Examples
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@lisp}
-@cindex Lisp example
-@findex lisp
-
-The @code{@@lisp} command is used for Lisp code. It is synonymous
-with the @code{@@example} command.
-
-@lisp
-This is an example of text written between an
-@code{@@lisp} command and an @code{@@end lisp} command.
-@end lisp
-
-Use @code{@@lisp} instead of @code{@@example} to preserve information
-regarding the nature of the example. This is useful, for example, if
-you write a function that evaluates only and all the Lisp code in a
-Texinfo file. Then you can use the Texinfo file as a Lisp
-library.@footnote{It would be straightforward to extend Texinfo to work
-in a similar fashion for C, Fortran, or other languages.}@refill
-
-Mark the end of @code{@@lisp} with @code{@@end lisp} on a line by
-itself.@refill
-
-@node smallexample & smalllisp, display, Lisp Example, Quotations and Examples
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp}
-@cindex Small book example
-@cindex Example for a small book
-@cindex Lisp example for a small book
-@findex smallexample
-@findex smalllisp
-
-In addition to the regular @code{@@example} and @code{@@lisp} commands,
-Texinfo has two other ``example-style'' commands. These are the
-@code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands. Both these
-commands are designed for use with the @code{@@smallbook} command that
-causes @TeX{} to produce a printed manual in a 7 by 9.25 inch format
-rather than the regular 8.5 by 11 inch format.@refill
-
-In @TeX{}, the @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands
-typeset text in a smaller font for the smaller @code{@@smallbook}
-format than for the 8.5 by 11 inch format. Consequently, many examples
-containing long lines fit in a narrower, @code{@@smallbook} page
-without needing to be shortened. Both commands typeset in the normal
-font size when you format for the 8.5 by 11 inch size; indeed,
-in this situation, the @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp}
-commands are defined to be the @code{@@example} and @code{@@lisp}
-commands.@refill
-
-In Info, the @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands are
-equivalent to the @code{@@example} and @code{@@lisp} commands, and work
-exactly the same.@refill
-
-Mark the end of @code{@@smallexample} or @code{@@smalllisp} with
-@code{@@end smallexample} or @code{@@end smalllisp},
-respectively.@refill
-
-@iftex
-Here is an example written in the small font used by the
-@code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands:
-
-@ifclear smallbook
-@display
-@tex
-% Remove extra vskip; this is a kludge to counter the effect of display
-\vskip-3\baselineskip
-@end tex
-@end display
-@end ifclear
-@end iftex
-@ifset smallbook
-@iftex
-@smallexample
-This is an example of text written between @code{@@smallexample} and
-@code{@@end smallexample}. In Info and in an 8.5 by 11 inch manual,
-this text appears in its normal size; but in a 7 by 9.25 inch manual,
-this text appears in a smaller font.
-@end smallexample
-@end iftex
-@end ifset
-@ifinfo
-@smallexample
-This is an example of text written between @code{@@smallexample} and
-@code{@@end smallexample}. In Info and in an 8.5 by 11 inch manual,
-this text appears in its normal size; but in a 7 by 9.25 inch manual,
-this text appears in a smaller font.
-@end smallexample
-@end ifinfo
-
-The @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands make it
-easier to prepare smaller format manuals without forcing you to edit
-examples by hand to fit them onto narrower pages.@refill
-
-As a general rule, a printed document looks better if you write all the
-examples in a chapter consistently in @code{@@example} or in
-@code{@@smallexample}. Only occasionally should you mix the two
-formats.@refill
-
-@xref{smallbook, , Printing ``Small'' Books}, for more information
-about the @code{@@smallbook} command.@refill
-
-@node display, format, smallexample & smalllisp, Quotations and Examples
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@display}
-@cindex Display formatting
-@findex display
-
-The @code{@@display} command begins a kind of example. It is like the
-@code{@@example} command
-except that, in
-a printed manual, @code{@@display} does not select the fixed-width
-font. In fact, it does not specify the font at all, so that the text
-appears in the same font it would have appeared in without the
-@code{@@display} command.@refill
-
-@display
-This is an example of text written between an @code{@@display} command
-and an @code{@@end display} command. The @code{@@display} command
-indents the text, but does not fill it.
-@end display
-
-@node format, exdent, display, Quotations and Examples
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@format}
-@findex format
-
-The @code{@@format} command is similar to @code{@@example} except
-that, in the printed manual, @code{@@format} does not select the
-fixed-width font and does not narrow the margins.@refill
-
-@format
-This is an example of text written between an @code{@@format} command
-and an @code{@@end format} command. As you can see
-from this example,
-the @code{@@format} command does not fill the text.
-@end format
-
-@node exdent, flushleft & flushright, format, Quotations and Examples
-@section @code{@@exdent}: Undoing a Line's Indentation
-@cindex Indentation undoing
-@findex exdent
-
-The @code{@@exdent} command removes any indentation a line might have.
-The command is written at the beginning of a line and applies only to
-the text that follows the command that is on the same line. Do not use
-braces around the text. In a printed manual, the text on an
-@code{@@exdent} line is printed in the roman font.@refill
-
-@code{@@exdent} is usually used within examples. Thus,@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@example
-This line follows an @@@@example command.
-@@exdent This line is exdented.
-This line follows the exdented line.
-The @@@@end example comes on the next line.
-@@end group
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-@group
-This line follows an @@example command.
-@exdent This line is exdented.
-This line follows the exdented line.
-The @@end example comes on the next line.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-In practice, the @code{@@exdent} command is rarely used.
-Usually, you un-indent text by ending the example and
-returning the page to its normal width.@refill
-
-@node flushleft & flushright, cartouche, exdent, Quotations and Examples
-@section @code{@@flushleft} and @code{@@flushright}
-@findex flushleft
-@findex flushright
-
-The @code{@@flushleft} and @code{@@flushright} commands line up the
-ends of lines on the left and right margins of a page,
-but do not fill the text. The commands are written on lines of their
-own, without braces. The @code{@@flushleft} and @code{@@flushright}
-commands are ended by @code{@@end flushleft} and @code{@@end
-flushright} commands on lines of their own.@refill
-
-@need 1500
-For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@flushleft
-This text is
-written flushleft.
-@@end flushleft
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@quotation
-@flushleft
-This text is
-written flushleft.
-@end flushleft
-@end quotation
-
-
-@code{@@flushright} produces the type of indentation often used in the
-return address of letters. For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@flushright
-Here is an example of text written
-flushright. The @@code@{@@flushright@} command
-right justifies every line but leaves the
-left end ragged.
-@@end flushright
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@flushright
-Here is an example of text written
-flushright. The @code{@@flushright} command
-right justifies every line but leaves the
-left end ragged.
-@end flushright
-
-@node cartouche, , flushleft & flushright, Quotations and Examples
-@section Drawing Cartouches Around Examples
-@findex cartouche
-@cindex Box with rounded corners
-
-In a printed manual, the @code{@@cartouche} command draws a box with
-rounded corners around its contents. You can use this command to
-further highlight an example or quotation. For instance, you could
-write a manual in which one type of example is surrounded by a cartouche
-for emphasis.@refill
-
-The @code{@@cartouche} command affects only the printed manual; it has
-no effect in the Info file.@refill
-
-@need 1500
-For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@example
-@@cartouche
-% pwd
-/usr/local/share/emacs
-@@end cartouche
-@@end example
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-surrounds the two-line example with a box with rounded corners, in the
-printed manual.
-
-@iftex
-In a printed manual, the example looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@cartouche
-% pwd
-/usr/local/lib/emacs/info
-@end cartouche
-@end group
-@end example
-@end iftex
-
-
-@node Lists and Tables, Indices, Quotations and Examples, Top
-@chapter Lists and Tables
-@cindex Making lists and tables
-@cindex Lists and tables, making
-@cindex Tables and lists, making
-
-Texinfo has several ways of making lists and tables. Lists can be
-bulleted or numbered; two-column tables can highlight the items in
-the first column; multi-column tables are also supported.
-
-@menu
-* Introducing Lists:: Texinfo formats lists for you.
-* itemize:: How to construct a simple list.
-* enumerate:: How to construct a numbered list.
-* Two-column Tables:: How to construct a two-column table.
-* Multi-column Tables:: How to construct generalized tables.
-@end menu
-
-@ifinfo
-@node Introducing Lists, itemize, Lists and Tables, Lists and Tables
-@heading Introducing Lists
-@end ifinfo
-
-Texinfo automatically indents the text in lists or tables, and numbers
-an enumerated list. This last feature is useful if you modify the
-list, since you do not need to renumber it yourself.@refill
-
-Numbered lists and tables begin with the appropriate @@-command at the
-beginning of a line, and end with the corresponding @code{@@end}
-command on a line by itself. The table and itemized-list commands
-also require that you write formatting information on the same line as
-the beginning @@-command.(a)refill
-
-Begin an enumerated list, for example, with an @code{@@enumerate}
-command and end the list with an @code{@@end enumerate} command.
-Begin an itemized list with an @code{@@itemize} command, followed on
-the same line by a formatting command such as @code{@@bullet}, and end
-the list with an @code{@@end itemize} command.@refill
-@findex end
-
-Precede each element of a list with an @code{@@item} or @code{@@itemx}
-command.@refill
-
-@sp 1
-@noindent
-Here is an itemized list of the different kinds of table and lists:@refill
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-Itemized lists with and without bullets.
-
-@item
-Enumerated lists, using numbers or letters.
-
-@item
-Two-column tables with highlighting.
-@end itemize
-
-@sp 1
-@noindent
-Here is an enumerated list with the same items:@refill
-
-@enumerate
-@item
-Itemized lists with and without bullets.
-
-@item
-Enumerated lists, using numbers or letters.
-
-@item
-Two-column tables with highlighting.
-@end enumerate
-
-@sp 1
-@noindent
-And here is a two-column table with the same items and their
-@w{@@-commands}:@refill
-
-@table @code
-@item @@itemize
-Itemized lists with and without bullets.
-
-@item @@enumerate
-Enumerated lists, using numbers or letters.
-
-@item @@table
-@itemx @@ftable
-@itemx @@vtable
-Two-column tables with indexing.
-@end table
-
-@node itemize, enumerate, Introducing Lists, Lists and Tables
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Making an Itemized List
-@cindex Itemization
-@findex itemize
-
-The @code{@@itemize} command produces sequences of indented
-paragraphs, with a bullet or other mark inside the left margin
-at the beginning of each paragraph for which such a mark is desired.@refill
-
-Begin an itemized list by writing @code{@@itemize} at the beginning of
-a line. Follow the command, on the same line, with a character or a
-Texinfo command that generates a mark. Usually, you will write
-@code{@@bullet} after @code{@@itemize}, but you can use
-@code{@@minus}, or any character or any special symbol that results in
-a single character in the Info file. (When you write @code{@@bullet}
-or @code{@@minus} after an @code{@@itemize} command, you may omit the
-@samp{@{@}}.)(a)refill
-
-Write the text of the indented paragraphs themselves after the
-@code{@@itemize}, up to another line that says @code{@@end
-itemize}.@refill
-
-Before each paragraph for which a mark in the margin is desired, write
-a line that says just @code{@@item}. Do not write any other text on this
-line.@refill
-@findex item
-
-Usually, you should put a blank line before an @code{@@item}. This
-puts a blank line in the Info file. (@TeX{} inserts the proper
-interline whitespace in either case.) Except when the entries are
-very brief, these blank lines make the list look better.@refill
-
-Here is an example of the use of @code{@@itemize}, followed by the
-output it produces. Note that @code{@@bullet} produces a @samp{*} in
-Info and a round dot in @TeX{}.@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@itemize @@bullet
-@@item
-Some text for foo.
-
-@@item
-Some text
-for bar.
-@@end itemize
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This produces:
-
-@quotation
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-Some text for foo.
-
-@item
-Some text
-for bar.
-@end itemize
-@end quotation
-
-Itemized lists may be embedded within other itemized lists. Here is a
-list marked with dashes embedded in a list marked with bullets:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@itemize @@bullet
-@@item
-First item.
-
-@@itemize @@minus
-@@item
-Inner item.
-
-@@item
-Second inner item.
-@@end itemize
-
-@@item
-Second outer item.
-@@end itemize
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This produces:
-
-@quotation
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-First item.
-
-@itemize @minus
-@item
-Inner item.
-
-@item
-Second inner item.
-@end itemize
-
-@item
-Second outer item.
-@end itemize
-@end quotation
-
-@node enumerate, Two-column Tables, itemize, Lists and Tables
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Making a Numbered or Lettered List
-@cindex Enumeration
-@findex enumerate
-
-@code{@@enumerate} is like @code{@@itemize} (@pxref{itemize,,
-@code{@@itemize}}), except that the labels on the items are
-successive integers or letters instead of bullets.
-
-Write the @code{@@enumerate} command at the beginning of a line. The
-command does not require an argument, but accepts either a number or a
-letter as an option. Without an argument, @code{@@enumerate} starts the
-list with the number @samp{1}. With a numeric argument, such as
-@samp{3}, the command starts the list with that number. With an upper
-or lower case letter, such as @samp{a} or @samp{A}, the command starts
-the list with that letter.@refill
-
-Write the text of the enumerated list in the same way you write an
-itemized list: put @code{@@item} on a line of its own before the start
-of each paragraph that you want enumerated. Do not write any other text
-on the line beginning with @code{@@item}.(a)refill
-
-You should put a blank line between entries in the list.
-This generally makes it easier to read the Info file.@refill
-
-@need 1500
-Here is an example of @code{@@enumerate} without an argument:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@enumerate
-@@item
-Underlying causes.
-
-@@item
-Proximate causes.
-@@end enumerate
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This produces:
-
-@enumerate
-@item
-Underlying causes.
-
-@item
-Proximate causes.
-@end enumerate
-@sp 1
-Here is an example with an argument of @kbd{3}:@refill
-@sp 1
-@example
-@group
-@@enumerate 3
-@@item
-Predisposing causes.
-
-@@item
-Precipitating causes.
-
-@@item
-Perpetuating causes.
-@@end enumerate
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This produces:
-
-@enumerate 3
-@item
-Predisposing causes.
-
-@item
-Precipitating causes.
-
-@item
-Perpetuating causes.
-@end enumerate
-@sp 1
-Here is a brief summary of the alternatives. The summary is constructed
-using @code{@@enumerate} with an argument of @kbd{a}.@refill
-@sp 1
-@enumerate a
-@item
-@code{@@enumerate}
-
-Without an argument, produce a numbered list, starting with the number
-1.@refill
-
-@item
-@code{@@enumerate @var{positive-integer}}
-
-With a (positive) numeric argument, start a numbered list with that
-number. You can use this to continue a list that you interrupted with
-other text.@refill
-
-@item
-@code{@@enumerate @var{upper-case-letter}}
-
-With an upper case letter as argument, start a list
-in which each item is marked
-by a letter, beginning with that upper case letter.@refill
-
-@item
-@code{@@enumerate @var{lower-case-letter}}
-
-With a lower case letter as argument, start a list
-in which each item is marked by
-a letter, beginning with that lower case letter.@refill
-@end enumerate
-
-You can also nest enumerated lists, as in an outline.@refill
-
-@node Two-column Tables, Multi-column Tables, enumerate, Lists and Tables
-@section Making a Two-column Table
-@cindex Tables, making two-column
-@findex table
-
-@code{@@table} is similar to @code{@@itemize} (@pxref{itemize,,
-@code{@@itemize}}), but allows you to specify a name or heading line for
-each item. The @code{@@table} command is used to produce two-column
-tables, and is especially useful for glossaries, explanatory
-exhibits, and command-line option summaries.
-
-@menu
-* table:: How to construct a two-column table.
-* ftable vtable:: Automatic indexing for two-column tables.
-* itemx:: How to put more entries in the first column.
-@end menu
-
-@ifinfo
-@node table, ftable vtable, Two-column Tables, Two-column Tables
-@subheading Using the @code{@@table} Command
-
-Use the @code{@@table} command to produce two-column tables.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-
-Write the @code{@@table} command at the beginning of a line and follow
-it on the same line with an argument that is a Texinfo ``indicating''
-command such as @code{@@code}, @code{@@samp}, @code{@@var}, or
-@code{@@kbd} (@pxref{Indicating}). Although these commands are usually
-followed by arguments in braces, in this case you use the command name
-without an argument because @code{@@item} will supply the argument.
-This command will be applied to the text that goes into the first column
-of each item and determines how it will be highlighted. For example,
-@code{@@code} will cause the text in the first column to be highlighted
-with an @code{@@code} command. (We recommend @code{@@code} for
-@code{@@table}'s of command-line options.)
-
-@findex asis
-You may also choose to use the @code{@@asis} command as an argument to
-@code{@@table}. @code{@@asis} is a command that does nothing; if you
-use this command after @code{@@table}, @TeX{} and the Info formatting
-commands output the first column entries without added highlighting
-(``as is'').@refill
-
-(The @code{@@table} command may work with other commands besides those
-listed here. However, you can only use commands that normally take
-arguments in braces.)@refill
-
-Begin each table entry with an @code{@@item} command at the beginning
-of a line. Write the first column text on the same line as the
-@code{@@item} command. Write the second column text on the line
-following the @code{@@item} line and on subsequent lines. (You do not
-need to type anything for an empty second column entry.) You may
-write as many lines of supporting text as you wish, even several
-paragraphs. But only text on the same line as the @code{@@item} will
-be placed in the first column.@refill
-@findex item
-
-Normally, you should put a blank line before an @code{@@item} line.
-This puts a blank like in the Info file. Except when the entries are
-very brief, a blank line looks better.@refill
-
-@need 1500
-The following table, for example, highlights the text in the first
-column with an @code{@@samp} command:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@table @@samp
-@@item foo
-This is the text for
-@@samp@{foo@}.
-
-@@item bar
-Text for @@samp@{bar@}.
-@@end table
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This produces:
-
-@table @samp
-@item foo
-This is the text for
-@samp{foo}.
-@item bar
-Text for @samp{bar}.
-@end table
-
-If you want to list two or more named items with a single block of
-text, use the @code{@@itemx} command. (@xref{itemx, ,
-@code{@@itemx}}.)(a)refill
-
-@node ftable vtable, itemx, table, Two-column Tables
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@ftable} and @code{@@vtable}
-@cindex Tables with indexes
-@cindex Indexing table entries automatically
-@findex ftable
-@findex vtable
-
-The @code{@@ftable} and @code{@@vtable} commands are the same as the
-@code{@@table} command except that @code{@@ftable} automatically enters
-each of the items in the first column of the table into the index of
-functions and @code{@@vtable} automatically enters each of the items in
-the first column of the table into the index of variables. This
-simplifies the task of creating indices. Only the items on the same
-line as the @code{@@item} commands are indexed, and they are indexed in
-exactly the form that they appear on that line. @xref{Indices, ,
-Creating Indices}, for more information about indices.@refill
-
-Begin a two-column table using @code{@@ftable} or @code{@@vtable} by
-writing the @@-command at the beginning of a line, followed on the same
-line by an argument that is a Texinfo command such as @code{@@code},
-exactly as you would for an @code{@@table} command; and end the table
-with an @code{@@end ftable} or @code{@@end vtable} command on a line by
-itself.
-
-See the example for @code{@@table} in the previous section.
-
-@node itemx, , ftable vtable, Two-column Tables
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@subsection @code{@@itemx}
-@cindex Two named items for @code{@@table}
-@findex itemx
-
-Use the @code{@@itemx} command inside a table when you have two or more
-first column entries for the same item, each of which should appear on a
-line of its own. Use @code{@@itemx} for all but the first entry;
-@code{@@itemx} should always follow an @code{@@item} command. The
-@code{@@itemx} command works exactly like @code{@@item} except that it
-does not generate extra vertical space above the first column text.
-
-@need 1000
-For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@table @@code
-@@item upcase
-@@itemx downcase
-These two functions accept a character or a string as
-argument, and return the corresponding upper case (lower
-case) character or string.
-@@end table
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This produces:
-
-@table @code
-@item upcase
-@itemx downcase
-These two functions accept a character or a string as
-argument, and return the corresponding upper case (lower
-case) character or string.@refill
-@end table
-
-@noindent
-(Note also that this example illustrates multi-line supporting text in
-a two-column table.)@refill
-
-
-@node Multi-column Tables, , Two-column Tables, Lists and Tables
-@section Multi-column Tables
-@cindex Tables, making multi-column
-@findex multitable
-
-@code{@@multitable} allows you to construct tables with any number of
-columns, with each column having any width you like.
-
-You define the column widths on the @code{@@multitable} line itself, and
-write each row of the actual table following an @code{@@item} command,
-with columns separated by an @code{@@tab} command. Finally, @code{@@end
-multitable} completes the table. Details in the sections below.
-
-@menu
-* Multitable Column Widths:: Defining multitable column widths.
-* Multitable Rows:: Defining multitable rows, with examples.
-@end menu
-
-@node Multitable Column Widths, Multitable Rows, Multi-column Tables, Multi-column
Tables
-@subsection Multitable Column Widths
-@cindex Multitable column widths
-@cindex Column widths, defining for multitables
-@cindex Widths, defining multitable column
-
-You can define the column widths for a multitable in two ways: as
-fractions of the line length; or with a prototype row. Mixing the two
-methods is not supported. In either case, the widths are defined
-entirely on the same line as the @code{@@multitable} command.
-
-@enumerate
-@item
-@findex columnfractions
-@cindex Line length, column widths as fraction of
-To specify column widths as fractions of the line length, write
-@code{@@columnfractions} and the decimal numbers (presumably less than
-1) after the @code{@@multitable} command, as in:
-
-@example
-@@multitable @@columnfractions .33 .33 .33
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-The fractions need not add up exactly to 1.0, as these do
-not. This allows you to produce tables that do not need the full line
-length.
-
-@item
-@cindex Prototype row, column widths defined by
-To specify a prototype row, write the longest entry for each column
-enclosed in braces after the @code{@@multitable} command. For example:
-
-@example
-@@multitable @{some text for column one@} @{for column two@}
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-The first column will then have the width of the typeset `some text for
-column one', and the second column the width of `for column two'.
-
-The prototype entries need not appear in the table itself.
-
-Although we used simple text in this example, the prototype entries can
-contain Texinfo commands; markup commands such as @code{@@code} are
-particularly likely to be useful.
-
-@end enumerate
-
-
-@node Multitable Rows, , Multitable Column Widths, Multi-column Tables
-@subsection Multitable Rows
-@cindex Multitable rows
-@cindex Rows, of a multitable
-
-@findex item
-@cindex tab
-After the @code{@@multitable} command defining the column widths (see
-the previous section), you begin each row in the body of a multitable
-with @code{@@item}, and separate the column entries with @code{@@tab}.
-Line breaks are not special within the table body, and you may break
-input lines in your source file as necessary.
-
-Here is a complete example of a multi-column table (the text is from
-@cite{The XEmacs Users' Manual}, @pxref{Split Window,, Splitting Windows,
-xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}):
-
-@example
-@@multitable @@columnfractions .15 .45 .4
-@@item Key @@tab Command @@tab Description
-@@item C-x 2
-@@tab @@code@{split-window-vertically@}
-@@tab Split the selected window into two windows,
-with one above the other.
-@@item C-x 3
-@@tab @@code@{split-window-horizontally@}
-@@tab Split the selected window into two windows
-positioned side by side.
-@@item C-Mouse-2
-@@tab
-@@tab In the mode line or scroll bar of a window,
-split that window.
-@@end multitable
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces:
-
-@multitable @columnfractions .15 .45 .4
-@item Key @tab Command @tab Description
-@item C-x 2
-@tab @code{split-window-vertically}
-@tab Split the selected window into two windows,
-with one above the other.
-@item C-x 3
-@tab @code{split-window-horizontally}
-@tab Split the selected window into two windows
-positioned side by side.
-@item C-Mouse-2
-@tab
-@tab In the mode line or scroll bar of a window,
-split that window.
-@end multitable
-
-
-@node Indices, Insertions, Lists and Tables, Top
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@chapter Creating Indices
-@cindex Indices
-@cindex Creating indices
-
-Using Texinfo, you can generate indices without having to sort and
-collate entries manually. In an index, the entries are listed in
-alphabetical order, together with information on how to find the
-discussion of each entry. In a printed manual, this information
-consists of page numbers. In an Info file, this information is a menu
-entry leading to the first node referenced.@refill
-
-Texinfo provides several predefined kinds of index: an index
-for functions, an index for variables, an index for concepts, and so
-on. You can combine indices or use them for other than their
-canonical purpose. If you wish, you can define your own indices.@refill
-
-@menu
-* Index Entries:: Choose different words for index entries.
-* Predefined Indices:: Use different indices for different kinds
- of entry.
-* Indexing Commands:: How to make an index entry.
-* Combining Indices:: How to combine indices.
-* New Indices:: How to define your own indices.
-@end menu
-
-@node Index Entries, Predefined Indices, Indices, Indices
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Making Index Entries
-@cindex Index entries, making
-@cindex Entries, making index
-
-When you are making index entries, it is good practice to think of the
-different ways people may look for something. Different people
-@emph{do not} think of the same words when they look something up. A
-helpful index will have items indexed under all the different words
-that people may use. For example, one reader may think it obvious that
-the two-letter names for indices should be listed under ``Indices,
-two-letter names'', since the word ``Index'' is the general concept.
-But another reader may remember the specific concept of two-letter
-names and search for the entry listed as ``Two letter names for
-indices''. A good index will have both entries and will help both
-readers.@refill
-
-Like typesetting, the construction of an index is a highly skilled,
-professional art, the subtleties of which are not appreciated until you
-need to do it yourself.@refill
-
-@xref{Printing Indices & Menus}, for information about printing an index
-at the end of a book or creating an index menu in an Info file.@refill
-
-@node Predefined Indices, Indexing Commands, Index Entries, Indices
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Predefined Indices
-
-Texinfo provides six predefined indices:@refill
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-A @dfn{concept index} listing concepts that are discussed.@refill
-
-@item
-A @dfn{function index} listing functions (such as entry points of
-libraries).@refill
-
-@item
-A @dfn{variables index} listing variables (such as global variables
-of libraries).@refill
-
-@item
-A @dfn{keystroke index} listing keyboard commands.@refill
-
-@item
-A @dfn{program index} listing names of programs.@refill
-
-@item
-A @dfn{data type index} listing data types (such as structures defined in
-header files).@refill
-@end itemize
-
-@noindent
-Not every manual needs all of these, and most manuals use two or three
-of them. This manual has two indices: a
-concept index and an @@-command index (that is actually the function
-index but is called a command index in the chapter heading). Two or
-more indices can be combined into one using the @code{@@synindex} or
-@code{@@syncodeindex} commands. @xref{Combining Indices}.@refill
-
-@node Indexing Commands, Combining Indices, Predefined Indices, Indices
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Defining the Entries of an Index
-@cindex Defining indexing entries
-@cindex Index entries
-@cindex Entries for an index
-@cindex Specifying index entries
-@cindex Creating index entries
-
-The data to make an index come from many individual indexing commands
-scattered throughout the Texinfo source file. Each command says to add
-one entry to a particular index; after formatting, the index will give
-the current page number or node name as the reference.@refill
-
-An index entry consists of an indexing command at the beginning of a
-line followed, on the rest of the line, by the entry.@refill
-
-For example, this section begins with the following five entries for
-the concept index:@refill
-
-@example
-@@cindex Defining indexing entries
-@@cindex Index entries
-@@cindex Entries for an index
-@@cindex Specifying index entries
-@@cindex Creating index entries
-@end example
-
-Each predefined index has its own indexing command---@code{@@cindex}
-for the concept index, @code{@@findex} for the function index, and so
-on.@refill
-
-@cindex Writing index entries
-@cindex Index entry writing
-Concept index entries consist of text. The best way to write an index
-is to choose entries that are terse yet clear. If you can do this,
-the index often looks better if the entries are not capitalized, but
-written just as they would appear in the middle of a sentence.
-(Capitalize proper names and acronyms that always call for upper case
-letters.) This is the case convention we use in most GNU manuals'
-indices.
-
-If you don't see how to make an entry terse yet clear, make it longer
-and clear---not terse and confusing. If many of the entries are several
-words long, the index may look better if you use a different convention:
-to capitalize the first word of each entry. But do not capitalize a
-case-sensitive name such as a C or Lisp function name or a shell
-command; that would be a spelling error.
-
-Whichever case convention you use, please use it consistently!
-
-@ignore
-Concept index entries consist of English text. The usual convention
-is to capitalize the first word of each such index entry, unless that
-word is the name of a function, variable, or other such entity that
-should not be capitalized. However, if your concept index entries are
-consistently short (one or two words each) it may look better for each
-regular entry to start with a lower case letter, aside from proper
-names and acronyms that always call for upper case letters. Whichever
-convention you adapt, please be consistent!
-@end ignore
-
-Entries in indices other than the concept index are symbol names in
-programming languages, or program names; these names are usually
-case-sensitive, so use upper and lower case as required for them.
-
-By default, entries for a concept index are printed in a small roman
-font and entries for the other indices are printed in a small
-@code{@@code} font. You may change the way part of an entry is
-printed with the usual Texinfo commands, such as @code{@@file} for
-file names and @code{@@emph} for emphasis (@pxref{Marking
-Text}).@refill
-@cindex Index font types
-
-@cindex Predefined indexing commands
-@cindex Indexing commands, predefined
-The six indexing commands for predefined indices are:
-
-@table @code
-@item @@cindex @var{concept}
-@findex cindex
-Make an entry in the concept index for @var{concept}.@refill
-
-@item @@findex @var{function}
-@findex findex
-Make an entry in the function index for @var{function}.@refill
-
-@item @@vindex @var{variable}
-@findex vindex
-Make an entry in the variable index for @var{variable}.@refill
-
-@item @@kindex @var{keystroke}
-@findex kindex
-Make an entry in the key index for @var{keystroke}.@refill
-
-@item @@pindex @var{program}
-@findex pindex
-Make an entry in the program index for @var{program}.@refill
-
-@item @@tindex @var{data type}
-@findex tindex
-Make an entry in the data type index for @var{data type}.@refill
-@end table
-
-@quotation
-@strong{Caution:} Do not use a colon in an index entry. In Info, a
-colon separates the menu entry name from the node name. An extra
-colon confuses Info.
-@xref{Menu Parts, , The Parts of a Menu},
-for more information about the structure of a menu entry.@refill
-@end quotation
-
-If you write several identical index entries in different places in a
-Texinfo file, the index in the printed manual will list all the pages to
-which those entries refer. However, the index in the Info file will
-list @strong{only} the node that references the @strong{first} of those
-index entries. Therefore, it is best to write indices in which each
-entry refers to only one place in the Texinfo file. Fortunately, this
-constraint is a feature rather than a loss since it means that the index
-will be easy to use. Otherwise, you could create an index that lists
-several pages for one entry and your reader would not know to which page
-to turn. If you have two identical entries for one topic, change the
-topics slightly, or qualify them to indicate the difference.@refill
-
-You are not actually required to use the predefined indices for their
-canonical purposes. For example, suppose you wish to index some C
-preprocessor macros. You could put them in the function index along
-with actual functions, just by writing @code{@@findex} commands for
-them; then, when you print the ``Function Index'' as an unnumbered
-chapter, you could give it the title `Function and Macro Index' and
-all will be consistent for the reader. Or you could put the macros in
-with the data types by writing @code{@@tindex} commands for them, and
-give that index a suitable title so the reader will understand.
-(@xref{Printing Indices & Menus}.)@refill
-
-@node Combining Indices, New Indices, Indexing Commands, Indices
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section Combining Indices
-@cindex Combining indices
-@cindex Indices, combining them
-
-Sometimes you will want to combine two disparate indices such as functions
-and concepts, perhaps because you have few enough of one of them that
-a separate index for them would look silly.@refill
-
-You could put functions into the concept index by writing
-@code{@@cindex} commands for them instead of @code{@@findex} commands,
-and produce a consistent manual by printing the concept index with the
-title `Function and Concept Index' and not printing the `Function
-Index' at all; but this is not a robust procedure. It works only if
-your document is never included as part of another
-document that is designed to have a separate function index; if your
-document were to be included with such a document, the functions from
-your document and those from the other would not end up together.
-Also, to make your function names appear in the right font in the
-concept index, you would need to enclose every one of them between
-the braces of @code{@@code}.(a)refill
-
-@menu
-* syncodeindex:: How to merge two indices, using @code{@@code}
- font for the merged-from index.
-* synindex:: How to merge two indices, using the
- default font of the merged-to index.
-@end menu
-
-@node syncodeindex, synindex, Combining Indices, Combining Indices
-@subsection @code{@@syncodeindex}
-@findex syncodeindex
-
-When you want to combine functions and concepts into one index, you
-should index the functions with @code{@@findex} and index the concepts
-with @code{@@cindex}, and use the @code{@@syncodeindex} command to
-redirect the function index entries into the concept index.@refill
-@findex syncodeindex
-
-The @code{@@syncodeindex} command takes two arguments; they are the name
-of the index to redirect, and the name of the index to redirect it to.
-The template looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@syncodeindex @var{from} @var{to}
-@end example
-
-@cindex Predefined names for indices
-@cindex Two letter names for indices
-@cindex Indices, two letter names
-@cindex Names for indices
-For this purpose, the indices are given two-letter names:@refill
-
-@table @samp
-@item cp
-concept index
-@item fn
-function index
-@item vr
-variable index
-@item ky
-key index
-@item pg
-program index
-@item tp
-data type index
-@end table
-
-Write an @code{@@syncodeindex} command before or shortly after the
-end-of-header line at the beginning of a Texinfo file. For example,
-to merge a function index with a concept index, write the
-following:@refill
-
-@example
-@@syncodeindex fn cp
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This will cause all entries designated for the function index to merge
-in with the concept index instead.@refill
-
-To merge both a variables index and a function index into a concept
-index, write the following:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@syncodeindex vr cp
-@@syncodeindex fn cp
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@cindex Fonts for indices
-The @code{@@syncodeindex} command puts all the entries from the `from'
-index (the redirected index) into the @code{@@code} font, overriding
-whatever default font is used by the index to which the entries are
-now directed. This way, if you direct function names from a function
-index into a concept index, all the function names are printed in the
-@code{@@code} font as you would expect.@refill
-
-@node synindex, , syncodeindex, Combining Indices
-@subsection @code{@@synindex}
-@findex synindex
-
-The @code{@@synindex} command is nearly the same as the
-@code{@@syncodeindex} command, except that it does not put the
-`from' index entries into the @code{@@code} font; rather it puts
-them in the roman font. Thus, you use @code{@@synindex} when you
-merge a concept index into a function index.@refill
-
-@xref{Printing Indices & Menus}, for information about printing an index
-at the end of a book or creating an index menu in an Info file.@refill
-
-@node New Indices, , Combining Indices, Indices
-@section Defining New Indices
-@cindex Defining new indices
-@cindex Indices, defining new
-@cindex New index defining
-@findex defindex
-@findex defcodeindex
-
-In addition to the predefined indices, you may use the
-@code{@@defindex} and @code{@@defcodeindex} commands to define new
-indices. These commands create new indexing @@-commands with which
-you mark index entries. The @code{@@defindex }command is used like
-this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@defindex @var{name}
-@end example
-
-The name of an index should be a two letter word, such as @samp{au}.
-For example:@refill
-
-@example
-@@defindex au
-@end example
-
-This defines a new index, called the @samp{au} index. At the same
-time, it creates a new indexing command, @code{@@auindex}, that you
-can use to make index entries. Use the new indexing command just as
-you would use a predefined indexing command.@refill
-
-For example, here is a section heading followed by a concept index
-entry and two @samp{au} index entries.@refill
-
-@example
-@@section Cognitive Semantics
-@@cindex kinesthetic image schemas
-@@auindex Johnson, Mark
-@@auindex Lakoff, George
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-(Evidently, @samp{au} serves here as an abbreviation for ``author''.)
-Texinfo constructs the new indexing command by concatenating the name
-of the index with @samp{index}; thus, defining an @samp{au} index
-leads to the automatic creation of an @code{@@auindex} command.@refill
-
-Use the @code{@@printindex} command to print the index, as you do with
-the predefined indices. For example:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@node Author Index, Subject Index, , Top
-@@unnumbered Author Index
-
-@@printindex au
-@end group
-@end example
-
-The @code{@@defcodeindex} is like the @code{@@defindex} command, except
-that, in the printed output, it prints entries in an @code{@@code} font
-instead of a roman font. Thus, it parallels the @code{@@findex} command
-rather than the @code{@@cindex} command.@refill
-
-You should define new indices within or right after the end-of-header
-line of a Texinfo file, before any @code{@@synindex} or
-@code{@@syncodeindex} commands (@pxref{Header}).@refill
-
-@node Insertions, Breaks, Indices, Top
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@chapter Special Insertions
-@cindex Inserting special characters and symbols
-@cindex Special insertions
-
-Texinfo provides several commands for inserting characters that have
-special meaning in Texinfo, such as braces, and for other graphic
-elements that do not correspond to simple characters you can type.
-
-@iftex
-These are:
-
-@itemize @bullet
-@item Braces, @samp{@@} and periods.
-@item Whitespace within and around a sentence.
-@item Accents.
-@item Dots and bullets.
-@item The @TeX{} logo and the copyright symbol.
-@item Mathematical expressions.
-@end itemize
-@end iftex
-
-@menu
-* Braces Atsigns:: How to insert braces, @samp{@@}.
-* Inserting Space:: How to insert the right amount of space
- within a sentence.
-* Inserting Accents:: How to insert accents and special characters.
-* Dots Bullets:: How to insert dots and bullets.
-* TeX and copyright:: How to insert the @TeX{} logo
- and the copyright symbol.
-* pounds:: How to insert the pounds currency symbol.
-* minus:: How to insert a minus sign.
-* math:: How to format a mathematical expression.
-* Glyphs:: How to indicate results of evaluation,
- expansion of macros, errors, etc.
-* Images:: How to include graphics.
-@end menu
-
-
-@node Braces Atsigns, Inserting Space, Insertions, Insertions
-@section Inserting @@ and Braces
-@cindex Inserting @@, braces
-@cindex Braces, inserting
-@cindex Special characters, commands to insert
-@cindex Commands to insert special characters
-
-@samp{@@} and curly braces are special characters in Texinfo. To insert
-these characters so they appear in text, you must put an @samp{@@} in
-front of these characters to prevent Texinfo from misinterpreting
-them.
-
-Do not put braces after any of these commands; they are not
-necessary.
-
-@menu
-* Inserting An Atsign:: How to insert @samp{@@}.
-* Inserting Braces:: How to insert @samp{@{} and @samp{@}}.
-@end menu
-
-@node Inserting An Atsign, Inserting Braces, Braces Atsigns, Braces Atsigns
-@subsection Inserting @samp{@@} with @@@@
-@findex @@ @r{(single @samp{@@})}
-
-@code{@@@@} stands for a single @samp{@@} in either printed or Info
-output.
-
-Do not put braces after an @code{@@@@} command.
-
-@node Inserting Braces, , Inserting An Atsign, Braces Atsigns
-@subsection Inserting @samp{@{} and @samp{@}}with @@@{ and @@@}
-@findex @{ @r{(single @samp{@{})}
-@findex @} @r{(single @samp{@}})}
-
-@code{@@@{} stands for a single @samp{@{} in either printed or Info
-output.
-
-@code{@@@}} stands for a single @samp{@}} in either printed or Info
-output.
-
-Do not put braces after either an @code{@@@{} or an @code{@@@}}
-command.
-
-
-@node Inserting Space, Inserting Accents, Braces Atsigns, Insertions
-@section Inserting Space
-
-@cindex Inserting space
-@cindex Spacing, inserting
-@cindex Whitespace, inserting
-The following sections describe commands that control spacing of various
-kinds within and after sentences.
-
-@menu
-* Not Ending a Sentence:: Sometimes a . doesn't end a sentence.
-* Ending a Sentence:: Sometimes it does.
-* Multiple Spaces:: Inserting multiple spaces.
-* dmn:: How to format a dimension.
-@end menu
-
-@node Not Ending a Sentence, Ending a Sentence, Inserting Space, Inserting Space
-@subsection Not Ending a Sentence
-
-@cindex Not ending a sentence
-@cindex Sentence non-ending punctuation
-@cindex Periods, inserting
-Depending on whether a period or exclamation point or question mark is
-inside or at the end of a sentence, less or more space is inserted after
-a period in a typeset manual. Since it is not always possible for
-Texinfo to determine when a period ends a sentence and when it is used
-in an abbreviation, special commands are needed in some circumstances.
-(Usually, Texinfo can guess how to handle periods, so you do not need to
-use the special commands; you just enter a period as you would if you
-were using a typewriter, which means you put two spaces after the
-period, question mark, or exclamation mark that ends a sentence.)
-
-@findex: @r{(suppress widening)}
-Use the @code{@@:}@: command after a period, question mark,
-exclamation mark, or colon that should not be followed by extra space.
-For example, use @code{@@:}@: after periods that end abbreviations
-which are not at the ends of sentences.
-
-@need 700
-For example,
-
-@example
-The s.o.p.@@: has three parts @dots{}
-The s.o.p. has three parts @dots{}
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-@ifinfo
-produces
-@end ifinfo
-@iftex
-produces the following. If you look carefully at this printed output,
-you will see a little more whitespace after @samp{s.o.p.} in the second
-line.@refill
-@end iftex
-
-@quotation
-The s.o.p.@: has three parts @dots{}@*
-The s.o.p. has three parts @dots{}
-@end quotation
-
-@noindent
-(Incidentally, @samp{s.o.p.} is an abbreviation for ``Standard Operating
-Procedure''.)
-
-@code{@@:} has no effect on the Info output. Do not put braces after
-@code{@@:}.
-
-
-@node Ending a Sentence, Multiple Spaces, Not Ending a Sentence, Inserting Space
-@subsection Ending a Sentence
-
-@cindex Ending a Sentence
-@cindex Sentence ending punctuation
-
-@findex . @r{(end of sentence)}
-@findex ! @r{(end of sentence)}
-@findex ? @r{(end of sentence)}
-Use @code{@(a).}@: instead of a period, @code{@@!}@: instead of an
-exclamation point, and @code{@@?}@: instead of a question mark at the end
-of a sentence that ends with a single capital letter. Otherwise, @TeX{}
-will think the letter is an abbreviation and will not insert the correct
-end-of-sentence spacing. Here is an example:
-
-@example
-Give it to M.I.B. and to M.E.W@@. Also, give it to R.J.C@@.
-Give it to M.I.B. and to M.E.W. Also, give it to R.J.C.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-@ifinfo
-produces
-@end ifinfo
-@iftex
-produces the following. If you look carefully at this printed output,
-you will see a little more whitespace after the @samp{W} in the first
-line.
-@end iftex
-
-@quotation
-Give it to M.I.B. and to M.E.W@. Also, give it to R.J.C@.@*
-Give it to M.I.B. and to M.E.W. Also, give it to R.J.C.
-@end quotation
-
-In the Info file output, @code{@(a).}@: is equivalent to a simple
-(a)samp{.}; likewise for @code{@@!}@: and @code{@@?}@:.
-
-The meanings of @code{@@:} and @code{@(a).}@: in Texinfo are designed to
-work well with the Emacs sentence motion commands (@pxref{Sentences,,,
-xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}). This made it necessary for them to be
-incompatible with some other formatting systems that use @@-commands.
-
-Do not put braces after any of these commands.
-
-
-@node Multiple Spaces, dmn, Ending a Sentence, Inserting Space
-@subsection Multiple Spaces
-
-@cindex Multiple spaces
-@cindex Whitespace, inserting
-@findex (space)
-@findex (tab)
-@findex (newline)
-
-Ordinarily, @TeX{} collapses multiple whitespace characters (space, tab,
-and newline) into a single space. Info output, on the other hand,
-preserves whitespace as you type it, except for changing a newline into
-a space; this is why it is important to put two spaces at the end of
-sentences in Texinfo documents.
-
-Occasionally, you may want to actually insert several consecutive
-spaces, either for purposes of example (what your program does with
-multiple spaces as input), or merely for purposes of appearance in
-headings or lists. Texinfo supports three commands:
-@code{@@@kbd{SPACE}}, @code{@@@kbd{TAB}}, and @code{@@@kbd{NL}}, all of
-which insert a single space into the output. (Here,
-@code{@@@kbd{SPACE}} represents an @samp{@@} character followed by a
-space, i.e., @samp{@@ }, and @kbd{TAB} and @kbd{NL} represent the tab
-character and end-of-line, i.e., when @samp{@@} is the last character on
-a line.)
-
-For example,
-@example
-Spacey@@ @@ @@ @@
-example.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-Spacey@ @ @ @
-example.
-@end example
-
-Other possible uses of @code{@@@kbd{SPACE}} have been subsumed by
-@code{@@multitable} (@pxref{Multi-column Tables}).
-
-Do not follow any of these commands with braces.
-
-
-@node dmn, , Multiple Spaces, Inserting Space
-@subsection @code{@@dmn}@{@var{dimension}@}: Format a Dimension
-@cindex Thin space between number, dimension
-@cindex Dimension formatting
-@cindex Format a dimension
-@findex dmn
-
-At times, you may want to write @samp{12@dmn{pt}} or
-@samp{8.5(a)dmn{in}} with little or no space between the number and the
-abbreviation for the dimension. You can use the @code{@@dmn} command
-to do this. On seeing the command, @TeX{} inserts just enough space
-for proper typesetting; the Info formatting commands insert no space
-at all, since the Info file does not require it.@refill
-
-To use the @code{@@dmn} command, write the number and then follow it
-immediately, with no intervening space, by @code{@@dmn}, and then by
-the dimension within braces. For example,
-
-@example
-A4 paper is 8.27@@dmn@{in@} wide.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@quotation
-A4 paper is 8.27@dmn{in} wide.
-@end quotation
-
-Not everyone uses this style. Some people prefer @w{(a)samp{8.27 in.@@:}}
-or @w{(a)samp{8.27 inches}} to @samp{8.27@@dmn@{in@}} in the Texinfo file.
-In these cases, however, the formatters may insert a line break between
-the number and the dimension, so use @code{@@w} (@pxref{w}). Also, if
-you write a period after an abbreviation within a sentence, you should
-write @samp{@@:} after the period to prevent @TeX{} from inserting extra
-whitespace, as shown here. @xref{Inserting Space}.
-
-
-@node Inserting Accents, Dots Bullets, Inserting Space, Insertions
-@section Inserting Accents
-
-@cindex Inserting accents
-@cindex Accents, inserting
-@cindex Floating accents, inserting
-
-Here is a table with the commands Texinfo provides for inserting
-floating accents. The commands with non-alphabetic names do not take
-braces around their argument (which is taken to be the next character).
-(Exception: @code{@@,} @emph{does} take braces around its argument.)
-This is so as to make the source as convenient to type and read as
-possible, since accented characters are very common in some languages.
-
-@findex "
-@cindex Umlaut accent
-@findex '
-@cindex Acute accent
-@findex =
-@cindex Macron accent
-@findex ^
-@cindex Circumflex accent
-@findex `
-@cindex Grave accent
-@findex ~
-@cindex Tilde accent
-@findex ,
-@cindex Cedilla accent
-@findex dotaccent
-@cindex Dot accent
-@findex H
-@cindex Hungariam umlaut accent
-@findex ringaccent
-@cindex Ring accent
-@findex tieaccent
-@cindex Tie-after accent
-@findex u
-@cindex Breve accent
-@findex ubaraccent
-@cindex Underbar accent
-@findex udotaccent
-@cindex Underdot accent
-@findex v
-@cindex Check accent
-@multitable {@@questiondown@{@}} {Output} {macron/overbar accent}
-@item Command @tab Output @tab What
-@item @t{@@"o} @tab @"o @tab umlaut accent
-@item @t{@@'o} @tab @'o @tab acute accent
-@item @t{@@,@{c@}} @tab @,{c} @tab cedilla accent
-@item @t{@@=o} @tab @=o @tab macron/overbar accent
-@item @t{@@^o} @tab @^o @tab circumflex accent
-@item @t{@@`o} @tab @`o @tab grave accent
-@item @t{@@~o} @tab @~o @tab tilde accent
-@item @t{@@dotaccent@{o@}} @tab @dotaccent{o} @tab overdot accent
-@item @t{@@H@{o@}} @tab @H{o} @tab long Hungarian umlaut
-@item @t{@@ringaccent@{o@}} @tab @ringaccent{o} @tab ring accent
-@item @t{@@tieaccent@{oo@}} @tab @tieaccent{oo} @tab tie-after accent
-@item @t{@@u@{o@}} @tab @u{o} @tab breve accent
-@item @t{@@ubaraccent@{o@}} @tab @ubaraccent{o} @tab underbar accent
-@item @t{@@udotaccent@{o@}} @tab @udotaccent{o} @tab underdot accent
-@item @t{@@v@{o@}} @tab @v{o} @tab hacek or check accent
-@end multitable
-
-This table lists the Texinfo commands for inserting other characters
-commonly used in languages other than English.
-
-@findex questiondown
-@cindex @questiondown{}
-@findex exclamdown
-@cindex @exclamdown{}
-@findex aa
-@cindex @aa{}
-@findex AA
-@cindex @AA{}
-@findex ae
-@cindex @ae{}
-@findex AE
-@cindex @AE{}
-@findex dotless
-@cindex @dotless{i}
-@cindex @dotless{j}
-@cindex Dotless i, j
-@findex l
-@cindex @l{}
-@findex L
-@cindex @L{}
-@findex o
-@cindex @o{}
-@findex O
-@cindex @O{}
-@findex oe
-@cindex @oe{}
-@findex OE
-@cindex @OE{}
-@findex ss
-@cindex @ss{}
-@cindex Es-zet
-@cindex Sharp S
-@cindex German S
-@multitable {@@questiondown@{@}} {oe,OE} {es-zet or sharp S}
-@item @t{@@exclamdown@{@}} @tab @exclamdown{} @tab upside-down !
-@item @t{@@questiondown@{@}} @tab @questiondown{} @tab upside-down ?
-@item @t{@@aa@{@},@@AA@{@}} @tab @aa{},@AA{} @tab A,a with circle
-@item @t{@@ae@{@},@@AE@{@}} @tab @ae{},@AE{} @tab ae,AE ligatures
-@item @t{@@dotless@{i@}} @tab @dotless{i} @tab dotless i
-@item @t{@@dotless@{j@}} @tab @dotless{j} @tab dotless j
-@item @t{@@l@{@},@@L@{@}} @tab @l{},@L{} @tab suppressed-L,l
-@item @t{@@o@{@},@@O@{@}} @tab @o{},@O{} @tab O,o with slash
-@item @t{@@oe@{@},@@OE@{@}} @tab @oe{},@OE{} @tab OE,oe ligatures
-@item @t{@@ss@{@}} @tab @ss{} @tab es-zet or sharp S
-@end multitable
-
-
-@node Dots Bullets, TeX and copyright, Inserting Accents, Insertions
-@section Inserting Ellipsis, Dots, and Bullets
-@cindex Dots, inserting
-@cindex Bullets, inserting
-@cindex Ellipsis, inserting
-@cindex Inserting ellipsis
-@cindex Inserting dots
-@cindex Special typesetting commands
-@cindex Typesetting commands for dots, etc.
-
-An @dfn{ellipsis} (a line of dots) is not typeset as a string of
-periods, so a special command is used for ellipsis in Texinfo. The
-@code{@@bullet} command is special, too. Each of these commands is
-followed by a pair of braces, @samp{@{@}}, without any whitespace
-between the name of the command and the braces. (You need to use braces
-with these commands because you can use them next to other text; without
-the braces, the formatters would be confused. @xref{Command Syntax, ,
-@@-Command Syntax}, for further information.)@refill
-
-@menu
-* dots:: How to insert dots @dots{}
-* bullet:: How to insert a bullet.
-@end menu
-
-
-@node dots, bullet, Dots Bullets, Dots Bullets
-@subsection @code{@@dots}@{@} (@dots{})
-@findex dots
-@cindex Inserting dots
-@cindex Dots, inserting
-
-Use the @code{@@dots@{@}} command to generate an ellipsis, which is
-three dots in a row, appropriately spaced, like this: `@dots{}'. Do
-not simply write three periods in the input file; that would work for
-the Info file output, but would produce the wrong amount of space
-between the periods in the printed manual.
-
-Similarly, the @code{@@enddots@{@}} command generates an
-end-of-sentence ellipsis (four dots) @enddots{}
-
-@iftex
-Here is an ellipsis: @dots{}
-Here are three periods in a row: ...
-
-In printed output, the three periods in a row are closer together than
-the dots in the ellipsis.
-@end iftex
-
-
-@node bullet, , dots, Dots Bullets
-@subsection @code{@@bullet}@{@} (@bullet{})
-@findex bullet
-
-Use the @code{@@bullet@{@}} command to generate a large round dot, or
-the closest possible thing to one. In Info, an asterisk is used.@refill
-
-Here is a bullet: @bullet{}
-
-When you use @code{@@bullet} in @code{@@itemize}, you do not need to
-type the braces, because @code{@@itemize} supplies them.
-(@xref{itemize, , @code{@@itemize}}.)(a)refill
-
-
-@node TeX and copyright, pounds, Dots Bullets, Insertions
-@section Inserting @TeX{} and the Copyright Symbol
-
-The logo `@TeX{}' is typeset in a special fashion and it needs an
-@@-command. The copyright symbol, `@copyright{}', is also special.
-Each of these commands is followed by a pair of braces, @samp{@{@}},
-without any whitespace between the name of the command and the
-braces.@refill
-
-@menu
-* tex:: How to insert the @TeX{} logo.
-* copyright symbol:: How to use @code{@@copyright}@{@}.
-@end menu
-
-
-@node tex, copyright symbol, TeX and copyright, TeX and copyright
-@subsection @code{@@TeX}@{@} (@TeX{})
-@findex tex (command)
-
-Use the @code{@@TeX@{@}} command to generate `@TeX{}'. In a printed
-manual, this is a special logo that is different from three ordinary
-letters. In Info, it just looks like @samp{TeX}. The
-@code{@@TeX@{@}} command is unique among Texinfo commands in that the
-@kbd{T} and the @kbd{X} are in upper case.@refill
-
-
-@node copyright symbol, , tex, TeX and copyright
-@subsection @code{@@copyright}@{@} (@copyright{})
-@findex copyright
-
-Use the @code{@@copyright@{@}} command to generate `@copyright{}'. In
-a printed manual, this is a @samp{c} inside a circle, and in Info,
-this is @samp{(C)}.@refill
-
-
-@node pounds, minus, TeX and copyright, Insertions
-@section @code{@@pounds@{@}} (@pounds{}): Pounds Sterling
-@findex pounds
-
-Use the @code{@@pounds@{@}} command to generate `@pounds{}'. In a
-printed manual, this is the symbol for the currency pounds sterling.
-In Info, it is a @samp{#}. Other currency symbols are unfortunately not
-available.
-
-
-@node minus, math, pounds, Insertions
-@section @code{@@minus}@{@} (@minus{}): Inserting a Minus Sign
-@findex minus
-
-Use the @code{@@minus@{@}} command to generate a minus sign. In a
-fixed-width font, this is a single hyphen, but in a proportional font,
-the symbol is the customary length for a minus sign---a little longer
-than a hyphen, shorter than an em-dash:
-
-@display
-@samp{@minus{}} is a minus sign generated with @samp{@@minus@{@}},
-
-`-' is a hyphen generated with the character @samp{-},
-
-`---' is an em-dash for text.
-@end display
-
-@noindent
-In the fixed-width font used by Info, @code{@@minus@{@}} is the same
-as a hyphen.
-
-You should not use @code{@@minus@{@}} inside @code{@@code} or
-@code{@@example} because the width distinction is not made in the
-fixed-width font they use.
-
-When you use @code{@@minus} to specify the mark beginning each entry in
-an itemized list, you do not need to type the braces
-(@pxref{itemize, , @code{@@itemize}}.)
-
-
-@node math, Glyphs, minus, Insertions
-@section @code{@@math} - Inserting Mathematical Expressions
-@findex math
-@cindex Mathematical expressions
-
-You can write a short mathematical expression with the @code{@@math}
-command. Write the mathematical expression between braces, like this:
-
-@example
-@@math@{(a + b)(a + b) = a^2 + 2ab + b^2@}
-@end example
-
-@iftex
-@need 1000
-@noindent
-This produces the following in @TeX{}:
-
-@display
-@math{(a + b)(a + b) = a^2 + 2ab + b^2}
-@end display
-
-@noindent
-and the following in Info:
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-@noindent
-This produces the following in Info:
-@end ifinfo
-
-@example
-(a + b)(a + b) = a^2 + 2ab + b^2
-@end example
-
-Thus, the @code{@@math} command has no effect on the Info output.
-
-For complex mathematical expressions, you can also use @TeX{} directly
-(@pxref{Raw Formatter Commands}). When you use @TeX{} directly,
-remember to write the mathematical expression between one or two
-@samp{$} (dollar-signs) as appropriate.
-
-
-@node Glyphs, Images, math, Insertions
-@section Glyphs for Examples
-@cindex Glyphs
-
-In Texinfo, code is often illustrated in examples that are delimited
-by @code{@@example} and @code{@@end example}, or by @code{@@lisp} and
-@code{@@end lisp}. In such examples, you can indicate the results of
-evaluation or an expansion using @samp{@result{}} or
-@samp{@expansion{}}. Likewise, there are commands to insert glyphs
-to indicate
-printed output, error messages, equivalence of expressions, and the
-location of point.@refill
-
-The glyph-insertion commands do not need to be used within an example, but
-most often they are. Every glyph-insertion command is followed by a pair of
-left- and right-hand braces.@refill
-
-@menu
-* Glyphs Summary::
-* result:: How to show the result of expression.
-* expansion:: How to indicate an expansion.
-* Print Glyph:: How to indicate printed output.
-* Error Glyph:: How to indicate an error message.
-* Equivalence:: How to indicate equivalence.
-* Point Glyph:: How to indicate the location of point.
-@end menu
-
-@node Glyphs Summary, result, Glyphs, Glyphs
-@ifinfo
-@subheading Glyphs Summary
-
-Here are the different glyph commands:@refill
-@end ifinfo
-
-@table @asis
-@item @result{}
-@code{@@result@{@}} points to the result of an expression.@refill
-
-@item @expansion{}
-@code{@@expansion@{@}} shows the results of a macro expansion.@refill
-
-@item @print{}
-@code{@@print@{@}} indicates printed output.@refill
-
-@item @error{}
-@code{@@error@{@}} indicates that the following text is an error
-message.@refill
-
-@item @equiv{}
-@code{@@equiv@{@}} indicates the exact equivalence of two forms.@refill
-
-@item @point{}
-@code{@@point@{@}} shows the location of point.@refill
-@end table
-
-
-@menu
-* result::
-* expansion::
-* Print Glyph::
-* Error Glyph::
-* Equivalence::
-* Point Glyph::
-@end menu
-
-@node result, expansion, Glyphs Summary, Glyphs
-@subsection @code{@@result@{@}} (@result{}): Indicating Evaluation
-@cindex Result of an expression
-@cindex Indicating evaluation
-@cindex Evaluation glyph
-@cindex Value of an expression, indicating
-
-Use the @code{@@result@{@}} command to indicate the result of
-evaluating an expression.@refill
-
-@iftex
-The @code{@@result@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{=>} in Info and
-as @samp{@result{}} in the printed output.
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-The @code{@@result@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{@result{}} in Info
-and as a double stemmed arrow in the printed output.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-
-Thus, the following,
-
-@lisp
-(cdr '(1 2 3))
- @result{} (2 3)
-@end lisp
-
-@noindent
-may be read as ``@code{(cdr '(1 2 3))} evaluates to @code{(2 3)}''.
-
-
-@node expansion, Print Glyph, result, Glyphs
-@subsection @code{@@expansion@{@}} (@expansion{}): Indicating an Expansion
-@cindex Expansion, indicating it
-
-When an expression is a macro call, it expands into a new expression.
-You can indicate the result of the expansion with the
-@code{@@expansion@{@}} command.@refill
-
-@iftex
-The @code{@@expansion@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{==>} in Info and
-as @samp{@expansion{}} in the printed output.
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-The @code{@@expansion@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{@expansion{}}
-in Info and as a long arrow with a flat base in the printed output.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-
-@need 700
-For example, the following
-
-@example
-@group
-@@lisp
-(third '(a b c))
- @@expansion@{@} (car (cdr (cdr '(a b c))))
- @@result@{@} c
-@@end lisp
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@lisp
-@group
-(third '(a b c))
- @expansion{} (car (cdr (cdr '(a b c))))
- @result{} c
-@end group
-@end lisp
-
-@noindent
-which may be read as:
-
-@quotation
-@code{(third '(a b c))} expands to @code{(car (cdr (cdr '(a b c))))};
-the result of evaluating the expression is @code{c}.
-@end quotation
-
-@noindent
-Often, as in this case, an example looks better if the
-@code{@@expansion@{@}} and @code{@@result@{@}} commands are indented
-five spaces.@refill
-
-
-@node Print Glyph, Error Glyph, expansion, Glyphs
-@subsection @code{@@print@{@}} (@print{}): Indicating Printed Output
-@cindex Printed output, indicating it
-
-Sometimes an expression will print output during its execution. You
-can indicate the printed output with the @code{@@print@{@}} command.@refill
-
-@iftex
-The @code{@@print@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{-|} in Info and
-as @samp{@print{}} in the printed output.
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-The @code{@@print@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{@print{}} in Info
-and similarly, as a horizontal dash butting against a vertical bar, in
-the printed output.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-
-In the following example, the printed text is indicated with
-@samp{@print{}}, and the value of the expression follows on the
-last line.@refill
-
-@lisp
-@group
-(progn (print 'foo) (print 'bar))
- @print{} foo
- @print{} bar
- @result{} bar
-@end group
-@end lisp
-
-@noindent
-In a Texinfo source file, this example is written as follows:
-
-@lisp
-@group
-@@lisp
-(progn (print 'foo) (print 'bar))
- @@print@{@} foo
- @@print@{@} bar
- @@result@{@} bar
-@@end lisp
-@end group
-@end lisp
-
-
-@node Error Glyph, Equivalence, Print Glyph, Glyphs
-@subsection @code{@@error@{@}} (@error{}): Indicating an Error Message
-@cindex Error message, indicating it
-
-A piece of code may cause an error when you evaluate it. You can
-designate the error message with the @code{@@error@{@}} command.@refill
-
-@iftex
-The @code{@@error@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{error-->} in Info
-and as @samp{@error{}} in the printed output.
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-The @code{@@error@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{@error{}} in Info
-and as the word `error' in a box in the printed output.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-
-@need 700
-Thus,
-
-@example
-@@lisp
-(+ 23 'x)
-@@error@{@} Wrong type argument: integer-or-marker-p, x
-@@end lisp
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@lisp
-(+ 23 'x)
-@error{} Wrong type argument: integer-or-marker-p, x
-@end lisp
-
-@noindent
-This indicates that the following error message is printed
-when you evaluate the expression:
-
-@lisp
-Wrong type argument: integer-or-marker-p, x
-@end lisp
-
-@samp{@error{}} itself is not part of the error message.
-
-
-@node Equivalence, Point Glyph, Error Glyph, Glyphs
-@subsection @code{@@equiv@{@}} (@equiv{}): Indicating Equivalence
-@cindex Equivalence, indicating it
-
-Sometimes two expressions produce identical results. You can indicate the
-exact equivalence of two forms with the @code{@@equiv@{@}} command.@refill
-
-@iftex
-The @code{@@equiv@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{==} in Info and
-as @samp{@equiv{}} in the printed output.
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-The @code{@@equiv@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{@equiv{}} in Info
-and as a three parallel horizontal lines in the printed output.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-
-Thus,
-
-@example
-@@lisp
-(make-sparse-keymap) @@equiv@{@} (list 'keymap)
-@@end lisp
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@lisp
-(make-sparse-keymap) @equiv{} (list 'keymap)
-@end lisp
-
-@noindent
-This indicates that evaluating @code{(make-sparse-keymap)} produces
-identical results to evaluating @code{(list 'keymap)}.
-
-
-@node Point Glyph, , Equivalence, Glyphs
-@subsection @code{@@point@{@}} (@point{}): Indicating Point in a Buffer
-@cindex Point, indicating it in a buffer
-
-Sometimes you need to show an example of text in an Emacs buffer. In
-such examples, the convention is to include the entire contents of the
-buffer in question between two lines of dashes containing the buffer
-name.@refill
-
-You can use the @samp{@@point@{@}} command to show the location of point
-in the text in the buffer. (The symbol for point, of course, is not
-part of the text in the buffer; it indicates the place @emph{between}
-two characters where point is located.)@refill
-
-@iftex
-The @code{@@point@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{-!-} in Info and
-as @samp{@point{}} in the printed output.
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-The @code{@@point@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{@point{}} in Info
-and as a small five pointed star in the printed output.@refill
-@end ifinfo
-
-The following example shows the contents of buffer @file{foo} before
-and after evaluating a Lisp command to insert the word @code{changed}.@refill
-
-@example
-@group
----------- Buffer: foo ----------
-This is the @point{}contents of foo.
----------- Buffer: foo ----------
-
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@example
-@group
-(insert "changed ")
- @result{} nil
----------- Buffer: foo ----------
-This is the changed @point{}contents of foo.
----------- Buffer: foo ----------
-
-@end group
-@end example
-
-In a Texinfo source file, the example is written like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@@example
----------- Buffer: foo ----------
-This is the @@point@{@}contents of foo.
----------- Buffer: foo ----------
-
-(insert "changed ")
- @@result@{@} nil
----------- Buffer: foo ----------
-This is the changed @@point@{@}contents of foo.
----------- Buffer: foo ----------
-@@end example
-@end example
-
-
-@c this should be described with figures when we have them
-@c perhaps in the quotation/example chapter.
-@node Images, , Glyphs, Insertions
-@section Inserting Images
-
-@cindex Images, inserting
-@cindex Pictures, inserting
-@findex image
-
-You can insert an image in an external file with the @code{@@image}
-command:
-
-@example
-@@image@{@var{filename}, @r{[}@var{width}@r{]}, @r{[}@var{height}@r{]}@}
-@end example
-
-@cindex Formats for images
-@cindex Image formats
-The @var{filename} argument is mandatory, and must not have an
-extension, because the different processors support different formats:
-@TeX{} reads the file @file{(a)var{filename}.eps} (Encapsulated PostScript
-format); @code{makeinfo} uses @file{(a)var{filename}.txt} verbatim for
-Info output (more or less as if it was an @code{@@example}). HTML
-output requires @file{(a)var{filename}.jpg}.
-
-@cindex Width of images
-@cindex Height of images
-@cindex Aspect ratio of images
-@cindex Distorting images
-The optional @var{width} and @var{height} arguments specify the size to
-scale the image to (they are ignored for Info output). If they are both
-specified, the image is presented in its natural size (given in the
-file); if only one is specified, the other is scaled proportionately;
-and if both are specified, both are respected, thus possibly distorting
-the original image by changing its aspect ratio.
-
-@cindex Dimensions and image sizes
-The @var{width} and @var{height} may be specified using any valid @TeX{}
-dimension, namely:
-
-@table @asis
-@item pt
-@cindex Points (dimension)
-point (72.27pt = 1in)
-@item pc
-@cindex Picas
-pica (1pc = 12pt)
-@item bp
-@cindex Big points
-big point (72bp = 1in)
-@item in
-@cindex Inches
-inch
-@item cm
-@cindex Centimeters
-centimeter (2.54cm = 1in)
-@item mm
-@cindex Millimeters
-millimeter (10mm = 1cm)
-@item dd
-@cindex Did@^ot points
-did@^ot point (1157dd = 1238pt)
-@item cc
-@cindex Ciceros
-cicero (1cc = 12dd)
-@item sp
-@cindex Scaled points
-scaled point (65536sp = 1pt)
-@end table
-
-@pindex ridt.eps
-For example, the following will scale a file @file{ridt.eps} to one
-inch vertically, with the width scaled proportionately:
-
-@example
-@@image@{ridt,,1in@}
-@end example
-
-@pindex epsf.tex
-For @code{@@image} to work with @TeX{}, the file @file{epsf.tex} must be
-installed somewhere that @TeX{} can find it. This file is included in
-the Texinfo distribution and is available from
-@uref{ftp://ftp.tug.org/tex/epsf.tex}.
-
-
-@node Breaks, Definition Commands, Insertions, Top
-@chapter Making and Preventing Breaks
-@cindex Making line and page breaks
-@cindex Preventing line and page breaks
-
-Usually, a Texinfo file is processed both by @TeX{} and by one of the
-Info formatting commands. Line, paragraph, or page breaks sometimes
-occur in the `wrong' place in one or other form of output. You must
-ensure that text looks right both in the printed manual and in the
-Info file.@refill
-
-For example, in a printed manual, page breaks may occur awkwardly in
-the middle of an example; to prevent this, you can hold text together
-using a grouping command that keeps the text from being split across
-two pages. Conversely, you may want to force a page break where none
-would occur normally. Fortunately, problems like these do not often
-arise. When they do, use the break, break prevention, or pagination
-commands.@refill
-
-@menu
-* Break Commands:: Cause and prevent splits.
-* Line Breaks:: How to force a single line to use two lines.
-* - and hyphenation:: How to tell TeX about hyphenation points.
-* w:: How to prevent unwanted line breaks.
-* sp:: How to insert blank lines.
-* page:: How to force the start of a new page.
-* group:: How to prevent unwanted page breaks.
-* need:: Another way to prevent unwanted page breaks.
-@end menu
-
-@ifinfo
-@node Break Commands, Line Breaks, Breaks, Breaks
-@heading The Break Commands
-@end ifinfo
-@iftex
-@sp 1
-@end iftex
-
-The break commands create or allow line and paragraph breaks:@refill
-
-@table @code
-@item @@*
-Force a line break.
-
-@item @@sp @var{n}
-Skip @var{n} blank lines.@refill
-
-@item @@-
-Insert a discretionary hyphen.
-
-@item @@hyphenation@{@var{hy-phen-a-ted words}@}
-Define hyphen points in @var{hy-phen-a-ted words}.
-@end table
-
-The line-break-prevention command holds text together all on one
-line:@refill
-
-@table @code
-@item @@w@{@var{text}@}
-Prevent @var{text} from being split and hyphenated across two lines.@refill
-@end table
-@iftex
-@sp 1
-@end iftex
-
-The pagination commands apply only to printed output, since Info
-files do not have pages.@refill
-
-@table @code
-@item @@page
-Start a new page in the printed manual.@refill
-
-@item @@group
-Hold text together that must appear on one printed page.@refill
-
-@item @@need @var{mils}
-Start a new printed page if not enough space on this one.@refill
-@end table
-
-@node Line Breaks, - and hyphenation, Break Commands, Breaks
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@*}: Generate Line Breaks
-@findex * @r{(force line break)}
-@cindex Line breaks
-@cindex Breaks in a line
-
-The @code{@@*} command forces a line break in both the printed manual and
-in Info.@refill
-
-@need 700
-For example,
-
-@example
-This line @@* is broken @@*in two places.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-@group
-This line
- is broken
-in two places.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-(Note that the space after the first @code{@@*} command is faithfully
-carried down to the next line.)@refill
-
-@need 800
-The @code{@@*} command is often used in a file's copyright page:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-This is edition 2.0 of the Texinfo documentation,@@*
-and is for @dots{}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-In this case, the @code{@@*} command keeps @TeX{} from stretching the
-line across the whole page in an ugly manner.@refill
-
-@quotation
-@strong{Please note:} Do not write braces after an @code{@@*} command;
-they are not needed.@refill
-
-Do not write an @code{@@refill} command at the end of a paragraph
-containing an @code{@@*} command; it will cause the paragraph to be
-refilled after the line break occurs, negating the effect of the line
-break.@refill
-@end quotation
-
-@node - and hyphenation, w, Line Breaks, Breaks
-@section @code{@@-} and @code{@@hyphenation}: Helping @TeX{} hyphenate
-
-@findex -
-@findex hyphenation
-@cindex Hyphenation, helping @TeX{} do
-@cindex Fine-tuning, and hyphenation
-
-Although @TeX{}'s hyphenation algorithm is generally pretty good, it
-does miss useful hyphenation points from time to time. (Or, far more
-rarely, insert an incorrect hyphenation.) So, for documents with an
-unusual vocabulary or when fine-tuning for a printed edition, you may
-wish to help @TeX{} out. Texinfo supports two commands for this:
-
-@table @code
-@item @@-
-Insert a discretionary hyphen, i.e., a place where @TeX{} can (but does
-not have to) hyphenate. This is especially useful when you notice
-an overfull hbox is due to @TeX{} missing a hyphenation (@pxref{Overfull
-hboxes}). @TeX{} will not insert any hyphenation points in a word
-containing @code{@@-}.
-
-@item @@hyphenation@{@var{hy-phen-a-ted words}@}
-Tell @TeX{} how to hyphenate @var{hy-phen-a-ted words}. As shown, you
-put a @samp{-} at each hyphenation point. For example:
-@example
-@@hyphenation@{man-u-script man-u-scripts@}
-@end example
-@noindent
-@TeX{} only uses the specified hyphenation points when the
-words match exactly, so give all necessary variants.
-@end table
-
-Info output is not hyphenated, so these commands have no effect there.
-
-@node w, sp, - and hyphenation, Breaks
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@w}@{@var{text}@}: Prevent Line Breaks
-@findex w @r{(prevent line break)}
-@cindex Line breaks, preventing
-@cindex Hyphenation, preventing
-
-@code{@@w@{@var{text}@}} outputs @var{text} and prohibits line breaks
-within @var{text}.@refill
-
-You can use the @code{@@w} command to prevent @TeX{} from automatically
-hyphenating a long name or phrase that happens to fall near the end of a
-line.@refill
-
-@example
-You can copy GNU software from @@w@{@@samp@{ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu@}(a)}.
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@quotation
-You can copy GNU software from @w{(a)samp{ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu}}.
-@end quotation
-
-@quotation
-@strong{Caution:} Do not write an @code{@@refill} command at the end
-of a paragraph containing an @code{@@w} command; it will cause the
-paragraph to be refilled and may thereby negate the effect of the
-@code{@@w} command.@refill
-@end quotation
-
-@node sp, page, w, Breaks
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@sp} @var{n}: Insert Blank Lines
-@findex sp @r{(line spacing)}
-@cindex Spaces (blank lines)
-@cindex Blank lines
-@cindex Line spacing
-
-A line beginning with and containing only @code{@@sp @var{n}}
-generates @var{n} blank lines of space in both the printed manual and
-the Info file. @code{@@sp} also forces a paragraph break. For
-example,@refill
-
-@example
-@@sp 2
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-generates two blank lines.
-
-The @code{@@sp} command is most often used in the title page.@refill
-
-@ignore
-@c node br, page, sp, Breaks
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@c section @code{@@br}: Generate Paragraph Breaks
-@findex br @r{(paragraph breaks)}
-@cindex Paragraph breaks
-@cindex Breaks in a paragraph
-
-The @code{@@br} command forces a paragraph break. It inserts a blank
-line. You can use the command within or at the end of a line. If
-used within a line, the @code{@@br@{@}} command must be followed by
-left and right braces (as shown here) to mark the end of the
-command.@refill
-
-@need 700
-For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-This line @@br@{@}contains and is ended by paragraph breaks@@br
-and is followed by another line.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@example
-@group
-This line
-
-contains and is ended by paragraph breaks
-
-and is followed by another line.
-@end group
-@end example
-
-The @code{@@br} command is seldom used.
-@end ignore
-
-@node page, group, sp, Breaks
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@page}: Start a New Page
-@cindex Page breaks
-@findex page
-
-A line containing only @code{@@page} starts a new page in a printed
-manual. The command has no effect on Info files since they are not
-paginated. An @code{@@page} command is often used in the @code{@@titlepage}
-section of a Texinfo file to start the copyright page.@refill
-
-@node group, need, page, Breaks
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@group}: Prevent Page Breaks
-@cindex Group (hold text together vertically)
-@cindex Holding text together vertically
-@cindex Vertically holding text together
-@findex group
-
-The @code{@@group} command (on a line by itself) is used inside an
-@code{@@example} or similar construct to begin an unsplittable vertical
-group, which will appear entirely on one page in the printed output.
-The group is terminated by a line containing only @code{@@end group}.
-These two lines produce no output of their own, and in the Info file
-output they have no effect at all.@refill
-
-@c Once said that these environments
-@c turn off vertical spacing between ``paragraphs''.
-@c Also, quotation used to work, but doesn't in texinfo-2.72
-Although @code{@@group} would make sense conceptually in a wide
-variety of contexts, its current implementation works reliably only
-within @code{@@example} and variants, and within @code{@@display},
-@code{@@format}, @code{@@flushleft} and @code{@@flushright}.
-@xref{Quotations and Examples}. (What all these commands have in
-common is that each line of input produces a line of output.) In
-other contexts, @code{@@group} can cause anomalous vertical
-spacing.@refill
-
-@need 750
-This formatting requirement means that you should write:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@example
-@@group
-@dots{}
-@@end group
-@@end example
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-with the @code{@@group} and @code{@@end group} commands inside the
-@code{@@example} and @code{@@end example} commands.
-
-The @code{@@group} command is most often used to hold an example
-together on one page. In this Texinfo manual, more than 100 examples
-contain text that is enclosed between @code{@@group} and @code{@@end
-group}.
-
-If you forget to end a group, you may get strange and unfathomable
-error messages when you run @TeX{}. This is because @TeX{} keeps
-trying to put the rest of the Texinfo file onto the one page and does
-not start to generate error messages until it has processed
-considerable text. It is a good rule of thumb to look for a missing
-@code{@@end group} if you get incomprehensible error messages in
-@TeX{}.(a)refill
-
-@node need, , group, Breaks
-@comment node-name, next, previous, up
-@section @code{@@need @var{mils}}: Prevent Page Breaks
-@cindex Need space at page bottom
-@findex need
-
-A line containing only @code{@@need @var{n}} starts
-a new page in a printed manual if fewer than @var{n} mils (thousandths
-of an inch) remain on the current page. Do not use
-braces around the argument @var{n}. The @code{@@need} command has no
-effect on Info files since they are not paginated.@refill
-
-@need 800
-This paragraph is preceded by an @code{@@need} command that tells
-@TeX{} to start a new page if fewer than 800 mils (eight-tenths
-inch) remain on the page. It looks like this:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@need 800
-This paragraph is preceded by @dots{}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-The @code{@@need} command is useful for preventing orphans (single
-lines at the bottoms of printed pages).@refill
-
-@node Definition Commands, Footnotes, Breaks, Top
-@chapter Definition Commands
-@cindex Definition commands
-
-The @code{@@deffn} command and the other @dfn{definition commands}
-enable you to describe functions, variables, macros, commands, user
-options, special forms and other such artifacts in a uniform
-format.@refill
-
-In the Info file, a definition causes the entity
-category---`Function', `Variable', or whatever---to appear at the
-beginning of the first line of the definition, followed by the
-entity's name and arguments. In the printed manual, the command
-causes @TeX{} to print the entity's name and its arguments on the left
-margin and print the category next to the right margin. In both
-output formats, the body of the definition is indented. Also, the
-name of the entity is entered into the appropriate index:
-@code{@@deffn} enters the name into the index of functions,
-@code{@@defvr} enters it into the index of variables, and so
-on.@refill
-
-A manual need not and should not contain more than one definition for
-a given name. An appendix containing a summary should use
-@code{@@table} rather than the definition commands.@refill
-
-@menu
-* Def Cmd Template:: How to structure a description using a
- definition command.
-* Optional Arguments:: How to handle optional and repeated arguments.
-* deffnx:: How to group two or more `first' lines.
-* Def Cmds in Detail:: All the definition commands.
-* Def Cmd Conventions:: Conventions for writing definitions.
-* Sample Function Definition::
-@end menu
-
-@node Def Cmd Template, Optional Arguments, Definition Commands, Definition Commands
-@section The Template for a Definition
-@cindex Definition template
-@cindex Template for a definition
-
-The @code{@@deffn} command is used for definitions of entities that
-resemble functions. To write a definition using the @code{@@deffn}
-command, write the @code{@@deffn} command at the beginning of a line
-and follow it on the same line by the category of the entity, the name
-of the entity itself, and its arguments (if any). Then write the body
-of the definition on succeeding lines. (You may embed examples in the
-body.) Finally, end the definition with an @code{@@end deffn} command
-written on a line of its own. (The other definition commands follow
-the same format.)@refill
-
-The template for a definition looks like this:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@deffn @var{category} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-@var{body-of-definition}
-@@end deffn
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@need 700
-@noindent
-For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@deffn Command forward-word count
-This command moves point forward @@var@{count@} words
-(or backward if @@var@{count@} is negative). @dots{}
-@@end deffn
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@quotation
-@deffn Command forward-word count
-This function moves point forward @var{count} words
-(or backward if @var{count} is negative). @dots{}
-@end deffn
-@end quotation
-
-Capitalize the category name like a title. If the name of the
-category contains spaces, as in the phrase `Interactive Command',
-write braces around it. For example:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@deffn @{Interactive Command@} isearch-forward
-@dots{}
-@@end deffn
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-Otherwise, the second word will be mistaken for the name of the
-entity.@refill
-
-Some of the definition commands are more general than others. The
-@code{@@deffn} command, for example, is the general definition command
-for functions and the like---for entities that may take arguments. When
-you use this command, you specify the category to which the entity
-belongs. The @code{@@deffn} command possesses three predefined,
-specialized variations, @code{@@defun}, @code{@@defmac}, and
-@code{@@defspec}, that specify the category for you: ``Function'',
-``Macro'', and ``Special Form'' respectively. (In Lisp, a special form
-is an entity much like a function.) The @code{@@defvr} command also is
-accompanied by several predefined, specialized variations for describing
-particular kinds of variables.@refill
-
-The template for a specialized definition, such as @code{@@defun}, is
-similar to the template for a generalized definition, except that you
-do not need to specify the category:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@defun @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-@var{body-of-definition}
-@@end defun
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-Thus,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@defun buffer-end flag
-This function returns @@code@{(point-min)@} if @@var@{flag@}
-is less than 1, @@code@{(point-max)@} otherwise.
-@dots{}
-@@end defun
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@quotation
-@defun buffer-end flag
-This function returns @code{(point-min)} if @var{flag} is less than 1,
-@code{(point-max)} otherwise. @dots{}
-@end defun
-@end quotation
-
-@noindent
-@xref{Sample Function Definition, Sample Function Definition, A Sample
-Function Definition}, for a more detailed example of a function
-definition, including the use of @code{@@example} inside the
-definition.@refill
-
-The other specialized commands work like @code{@@defun}.(a)refill
-
-@node Optional Arguments, deffnx, Def Cmd Template, Definition Commands
-@section Optional and Repeated Arguments
-@cindex Optional and repeated arguments
-@cindex Repeated and optional arguments
-@cindex Arguments, repeated and optional
-@cindex Syntax, optional & repeated arguments
-@cindex Meta-syntactic chars for arguments
-
-Some entities take optional or repeated arguments, which may be
-specified by a distinctive glyph that uses square brackets and
-ellipses. For @w{example}, a special form often breaks its argument list
-into separate arguments in more complicated ways than a
-straightforward function.@refill
-
-@iftex
-An argument enclosed within square brackets is optional.
-Thus, the phrase
-@samp{@code{@r{[}@var{optional-arg}@r{]}}} means that
-@var{optional-arg} is optional.
-An argument followed by an ellipsis is optional
-and may be repeated more than once.
-@c This is consistent with Emacs Lisp Reference manual
-Thus, @samp{@var{repeated-args}@dots{}} stands for zero or more arguments.
-Parentheses are used when several arguments are grouped
-into additional levels of list structure in Lisp.
-@end iftex
-@c The following looks better in Info (no `r', `samp' and `code'):
-@ifinfo
-An argument enclosed within square brackets is optional.
-Thus, [@var{optional-arg}] means that @var{optional-arg} is optional.
-An argument followed by an ellipsis is optional
-and may be repeated more than once.
-@c This is consistent with Emacs Lisp Reference manual
-Thus, @var{repeated-args}@dots{} stands for zero or more arguments.
-Parentheses are used when several arguments are grouped
-into additional levels of list structure in Lisp.
-@end ifinfo
-
-Here is the @code{@@defspec} line of an example of an imaginary
-special form:@refill
-
-@quotation
-@defspec foobar (@var{var} [@var{from} @var{to} [@var{inc}]]) @var{body}@dots{}
-@end defspec
-@tex
-\vskip \parskip
-@end tex
-@end quotation
-
-@noindent
-In this example, the arguments @var{from} and @var{to} are optional,
-but must both be present or both absent. If they are present,
-@var{inc} may optionally be specified as well. These arguments are
-grouped with the argument @var{var} into a list, to distinguish them
-from @var{body}, which includes all remaining elements of the
-form.@refill
-
-In a Texinfo source file, this @code{@@defspec} line is written like
-this (except it would not be split over two lines, as it is in this
-example).@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@defspec foobar (@@var@{var@} [@@var@{from@} @@var@{to@}
- [@@var@{inc@}]]) @@var@{body@}@@dots@{@}
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-The function is listed in the Command and Variable Index under
-@samp{foobar}.(a)refill
-
-@node deffnx, Def Cmds in Detail, Optional Arguments, Definition Commands
-@section Two or More `First' Lines
-@cindex Two `First' Lines for @code{@@deffn}
-@cindex Grouping two definitions together
-@cindex Definitions grouped together
-@findex deffnx
-
-To create two or more `first' or header lines for a definition, follow
-the first @code{@@deffn} line by a line beginning with @code{@@deffnx}.
-The @code{@@deffnx} command works exactly like @code{@@deffn}
-except that it does not generate extra vertical white space between it
-and the preceding line.@refill
-
-@need 1000
-For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@deffn @{Interactive Command@} isearch-forward
-@@deffnx @{Interactive Command@} isearch-backward
-These two search commands are similar except @dots{}
-@@end deffn
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces
-
-@deffn {Interactive Command} isearch-forward
-@deffnx {Interactive Command} isearch-backward
-These two search commands are similar except @dots{}
-@end deffn
-
-Each of the other definition commands has an `x' form: @code{@@defunx},
-@code{@@defvrx}, @code{@@deftypefunx}, etc.
-
-The `x' forms work just like @code{@@itemx}; see @ref{itemx, , @code{@@itemx}}.
-
-@node Def Cmds in Detail, Def Cmd Conventions, deffnx, Definition Commands
-@section The Definition Commands
-
-Texinfo provides more than a dozen definition commands, all of which
-are described in this section.@refill
-
-The definition commands automatically enter the name of the entity in
-the appropriate index: for example, @code{@@deffn}, @code{@@defun},
-and @code{@@defmac} enter function names in the index of functions;
-@code{@@defvr} and @code{@@defvar} enter variable names in the index
-of variables.@refill
-
-Although the examples that follow mostly illustrate Lisp, the commands
-can be used for other programming languages.@refill
-
-@menu
-* Functions Commands:: Commands for functions and similar entities.
-* Variables Commands:: Commands for variables and similar entities.
-* Typed Functions:: Commands for functions in typed languages.
-* Typed Variables:: Commands for variables in typed languages.
-* Abstract Objects:: Commands for object-oriented programming.
-* Data Types:: The definition command for data types.
-@end menu
-
-@node Functions Commands, Variables Commands, Def Cmds in Detail, Def Cmds in Detail
-@subsection Functions and Similar Entities
-
-This section describes the commands for describing functions and similar
-entities:@refill
-
-@table @code
-@findex deffn
-@item @@deffn @var{category} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-The @code{@@deffn} command is the general definition command for
-functions, interactive commands, and similar entities that may take
-arguments. You must choose a term to describe the category of entity
-being defined; for example, ``Function'' could be used if the entity is
-a function. The @code{@@deffn} command is written at the beginning of a
-line and is followed on the same line by the category of entity being
-described, the name of this particular entity, and its arguments, if
-any. Terminate the definition with @code{@@end deffn} on a line of its
-own.@refill
-
-@need 750
-For example, here is a definition:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@deffn Command forward-char nchars
-Move point forward @@var@{nchars@} characters.
-@@end deffn
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-This shows a rather terse definition for a ``command'' named
-@code{forward-char} with one argument, @var{nchars}.
-
-@code{@@deffn} prints argument names such as @var{nchars} in italics or
-upper case, as if @code{@@var} had been used, because we think of these
-names as metasyntactic variables---they stand for the actual argument
-values. Within the text of the description, write an argument name
-explicitly with @code{@@var} to refer to the value of the argument. In
-the example above, we used @samp{@@var@{nchars@}} in this way.
-
-The template for @code{@@deffn} is:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@deffn @var{category} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-@var{body-of-definition}
-@@end deffn
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@findex defun
-@item @@defun @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-The @code{@@defun} command is the definition command for functions.
-@code{@@defun} is equivalent to @samp{@@deffn Function
-@dots{}}.(a)refill
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@defun set symbol new-value
-Change the value of the symbol @@var@{symbol@}
-to @@var@{new-value@}.
-@@end defun
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-shows a rather terse definition for a function @code{set} whose
-arguments are @var{symbol} and @var{new-value}. The argument names on
-the @code{@@defun} line automatically appear in italics or upper case as
-if they were enclosed in @code{@@var}. Terminate the definition with
-@code{@@end defun} on a line of its own.@refill
-
-The template is:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@defun @var{function-name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-@var{body-of-definition}
-@@end defun
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@code{@@defun} creates an entry in the index of functions.
-
-@findex defmac
-@item @@defmac @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-The @code{@@defmac} command is the definition command for macros.
-@code{@@defmac} is equivalent to @samp{@@deffn Macro @dots{}} and
-works like @code{@@defun}.(a)refill
-
-@findex defspec
-@item @@defspec @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-The @code{@@defspec} command is the definition command for special
-forms. (In Lisp, a special form is an entity much like a function,
-@pxref{Special Forms,,, lispref, XEmacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
-@code{@@defspec} is equivalent to @samp{@@deffn @{Special Form@}
-@dots{}} and works like @code{@@defun}.(a)refill
-@end table
-
-@node Variables Commands, Typed Functions, Functions Commands, Def Cmds in Detail
-@subsection Variables and Similar Entities
-
-Here are the commands for defining variables and similar
-entities:@refill
-
-@table @code
-@findex defvr
-@item @@defvr @var{category} @var{name}
-The @code{@@defvr} command is a general definition command for
-something like a variable---an entity that records a value. You must
-choose a term to describe the category of entity being defined; for
-example, ``Variable'' could be used if the entity is a variable.
-Write the @code{@@defvr} command at the beginning of a line and
-followed it on the same line by the category of the entity and the
-name of the entity.@refill
-
-Capitalize the category name like a title. If the name of the category
-contains spaces, as in the name ``User Option'', enclose it in braces.
-Otherwise, the second word will be mistaken for the name of the entity.
-For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@defvr @{User Option@} fill-column
-This buffer-local variable specifies
-the maximum width of filled lines.
-@dots{}
-@@end defvr
-@end group
-@end example
-
-Terminate the definition with @code{@@end defvr} on a line of its
-own.@refill
-
-The template is:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@defvr @var{category} @var{name}
-@var{body-of-definition}
-@@end defvr
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@code{@@defvr} creates an entry in the index of variables for @var{name}.
-
-@findex defvar
-@item @@defvar @var{name}
-The @code{@@defvar} command is the definition command for variables.
-@code{@@defvar} is equivalent to @samp{@@defvr Variable
-@dots{}}.(a)refill
-
-@need 750
-For example:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@defvar kill-ring
-@dots{}
-@@end defvar
-@end group
-@end example
-
-The template is:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@defvar @var{name}
-@var{body-of-definition}
-@@end defvar
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@code{@@defvar} creates an entry in the index of variables for
-@var{name}.(a)refill
-
-@findex defopt
-@item @@defopt @var{name}
-@cindex User options, marking
-The @code{@@defopt} command is the definition command for @dfn{user
-options}, i.e., variables intended for users to change according to
-taste; Emacs has many such (@pxref{Variables,,, xemacs, XEmacs User's
-Manual}). @code{@@defopt} is equivalent to @samp{@@defvr @{User
-Option@} @dots{}} and works like @code{@@defvar}.(a)refill
-@end table
-
-
-@node Typed Functions, Typed Variables, Variables Commands, Def Cmds in Detail
-@subsection Functions in Typed Languages
-
-The @code{@@deftypefn} command and its variations are for describing
-functions in languages in which you must declare types of variables and
-functions, such as C and C++.
-
-@table @code
-@findex deftypefn
-@item @@deftypefn @var{category} @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-The @code{@@deftypefn} command is the general definition command for
-functions and similar entities that may take arguments and that are
-typed. The @code{@@deftypefn} command is written at the beginning of
-a line and is followed on the same line by the category of entity
-being described, the type of the returned value, the name of this
-particular entity, and its arguments, if any.@refill
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-For example,
-
-@example
-@group
-@@deftypefn @{Library Function@} int foobar
- (int @@var@{foo@}, float @@var@{bar@})
-@dots{}
-@@end deftypefn
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@need 1000
-@noindent
-(where the text before the ``@dots{}'', shown above as two lines, would
-actually be a single line in a real Texinfo file) produces the following
-in Info:
-
-@smallexample
-@group
--- Library Function: int foobar (int FOO, float BAR)
-@dots{}
-@end group
-@end smallexample
-@iftex
-
-In a printed manual, it produces:
-
-@quotation
-@deftypefn {Library Function} int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar})
-@dots{}
-@end deftypefn
-@end quotation
-@end iftex
-
-This means that @code{foobar} is a ``library function'' that returns an
-@code{int}, and its arguments are @var{foo} (an @code{int}) and
-@var{bar} (a @code{float}).@refill
-
-The argument names that you write in @code{@@deftypefn} are not subject
-to an implicit @code{@@var}---since the actual names of the arguments in
-@code{@@deftypefn} are typically scattered among data type names and
-keywords, Texinfo cannot find them without help. Instead, you must write
-@code{@@var} explicitly around the argument names. In the example
-above, the argument names are @samp{foo} and @samp{bar}.@refill
-
-The template for @code{@@deftypefn} is:@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@deftypefn @var{category} @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments} @dots{}
-@var{body-of-description}
-@@end deftypefn
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-Note that if the @var{category} or @var{data type} is more than one
-word then it must be enclosed in braces to make it a single argument.@refill
-
-If you are describing a procedure in a language that has packages,
-such as Ada, you might consider using @code{@@deftypefn} in a manner
-somewhat contrary to the convention described in the preceding
-paragraphs.@refill
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-For example:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@deftypefn stacks private push
- (@@var@{s@}:in out stack;
- @@var@{n@}:in integer)
-@dots{}
-@@end deftypefn
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-(The @code{@@deftypefn} arguments are shown split into three lines, but
-would be a single line in a real Texinfo file.)
-
-In this instance, the procedure is classified as belonging to the
-package @code{stacks} rather than classified as a `procedure' and its
-data type is described as @code{private}. (The name of the procedure
-is @code{push}, and its arguments are @var{s} and @var{n}.)@refill
-
-@code{@@deftypefn} creates an entry in the index of functions for
-@var{name}.(a)refill
-
-@item @@deftypefun @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-@findex deftypefun
-The @code{@@deftypefun} command is the specialized definition command
-for functions in typed languages. The command is equivalent to
-@samp{@@deftypefn Function @dots{}}.@refill
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-Thus,
-
-@smallexample
-@group
-@@deftypefun int foobar (int @@var@{foo@}, float @@var@{bar@})
-@dots{}
-@@end deftypefun
-@end group
-@end smallexample
-
-@noindent
-produces the following in Info:
-
-@example
-@group
--- Function: int foobar (int FOO, float BAR)
-@dots{}
-@end group
-@end example
-@iftex
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-and the following in a printed manual:
-
-@quotation
-@deftypefun int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar})
-@dots{}
-@end deftypefun
-@end quotation
-@end iftex
-
-@need 800
-The template is:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@deftypefun @var{type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-@var{body-of-description}
-@@end deftypefun
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@code{@@deftypefun} creates an entry in the index of functions for
-@var{name}.(a)refill
-
-@end table
-
-
-@node Typed Variables, Abstract Objects, Typed Functions, Def Cmds in Detail
-@subsection Variables in Typed Languages
-
-Variables in typed languages are handled in a manner similar to
-functions in typed languages. @xref{Typed Functions}. The general
-definition command @code{@@deftypevr} corresponds to
-@code{@@deftypefn} and the specialized definition command
-@code{@@deftypevar} corresponds to @code{@@deftypefun}.(a)refill
-
-@table @code
-@findex deftypevr
-@item @@deftypevr @var{category} @var{data-type} @var{name}
-The @code{@@deftypevr} command is the general definition command for
-something like a variable in a typed language---an entity that records
-a value. You must choose a term to describe the category of the
-entity being defined; for example, ``Variable'' could be used if the
-entity is a variable.@refill
-
-The @code{@@deftypevr} command is written at the beginning of a line
-and is followed on the same line by the category of the entity
-being described, the data type, and the name of this particular
-entity.@refill
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-For example:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@deftypevr @{Global Flag@} int enable
-@dots{}
-@@end deftypevr
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces the following in Info:
-
-@example
-@group
--- Global Flag: int enable
-@dots{}
-@end group
-@end example
-@iftex
-
-@noindent
-and the following in a printed manual:
-
-@quotation
-@deftypevr {Global Flag} int enable
-@dots{}
-@end deftypevr
-@end quotation
-@end iftex
-
-@need 800
-The template is:
-
-@example
-@@deftypevr @var{category} @var{data-type} @var{name}
-@var{body-of-description}
-@@end deftypevr
-@end example
-
-@code{@@deftypevr} creates an entry in the index of variables for
-@var{name}.(a)refill
-
-@findex deftypevar
-@item @@deftypevar @var{data-type} @var{name}
-The @code{@@deftypevar} command is the specialized definition command
-for variables in typed languages. @code{@@deftypevar} is equivalent
-to @samp{@@deftypevr Variable @dots{}}.@refill
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-For example:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@deftypevar int fubar
-@dots{}
-@@end deftypevar
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-produces the following in Info:
-
-@example
-@group
--- Variable: int fubar
-@dots{}
-@end group
-@end example
-@iftex
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-and the following in a printed manual:
-
-@quotation
-@deftypevar int fubar
-@dots{}
-@end deftypevar
-@end quotation
-@end iftex
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-The template is:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@deftypevar @var{data-type} @var{name}
-@var{body-of-description}
-@@end deftypevar
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@code{@@deftypevar} creates an entry in the index of variables for
-@var{name}.(a)refill
-@end table
-
-@node Abstract Objects, Data Types, Typed Variables, Def Cmds in Detail
-@subsection Object-Oriented Programming
-
-Here are the commands for formatting descriptions about abstract
-objects, such as are used in object-oriented programming. A class is
-a defined type of abstract object. An instance of a class is a
-particular object that has the type of the class. An instance
-variable is a variable that belongs to the class but for which each
-instance has its own value.@refill
-
-In a definition, if the name of a class is truly a name defined in the
-programming system for a class, then you should write an @code{@@code}
-around it. Otherwise, it is printed in the usual text font.@refill
-
-@table @code
-@findex defcv
-@item @@defcv @var{category} @var{class} @var{name}
-The @code{@@defcv} command is the general definition command for
-variables associated with classes in object-oriented programming. The
-@code{@@defcv} command is followed by three arguments: the category of
-thing being defined, the class to which it belongs, and its
-name. Thus,@refill
-
-@example
-@group
-@@defcv @{Class Option@} Window border-pattern
-@dots{}
-@@end defcv
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-illustrates how you would write the first line of a definition of the
-@code{border-pattern} class option of the class @code{Window}.@refill
-
-The template is
-
-@example
-@group
-@@defcv @var{category} @var{class} @var{name}
-@dots{}
-@@end defcv
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@code{@@defcv} creates an entry in the index of variables.
-
-@findex defivar
-@item @@defivar @var{class} @var{name}
-The @code{@@defivar} command is the definition command for instance
-variables in object-oriented programming. @code{@@defivar} is
-equivalent to @samp{@@defcv @{Instance Variable@} @dots{}}@refill
-
-The template is:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@defivar @var{class} @var{instance-variable-name}
-@var{body-of-definition}
-@@end defivar
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@code{@@defivar} creates an entry in the index of variables.
-
-@findex defop
-@item @@defop @var{category} @var{class} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-The @code{@@defop} command is the general definition command for
-entities that may resemble methods in object-oriented programming.
-These entities take arguments, as functions do, but are associated
-with particular classes of objects.@refill
-
-For example, some systems have constructs called @dfn{wrappers} that
-are associated with classes as methods are, but that act more like
-macros than like functions. You could use @code{@@defop Wrapper} to
-describe one of these.@refill
-
-Sometimes it is useful to distinguish methods and @dfn{operations}.
-You can think of an operation as the specification for a method.
-Thus, a window system might specify that all window classes have a
-method named @code{expose}; we would say that this window system
-defines an @code{expose} operation on windows in general. Typically,
-the operation has a name and also specifies the pattern of arguments;
-all methods that implement the operation must accept the same
-arguments, since applications that use the operation do so without
-knowing which method will implement it.@refill
-
-Often it makes more sense to document operations than methods. For
-example, window application developers need to know about the
-@code{expose} operation, but need not be concerned with whether a
-given class of windows has its own method to implement this operation.
-To describe this operation, you would write:@refill
-
-@example
-@@defop Operation windows expose
-@end example
-
-The @code{@@defop} command is written at the beginning of a line and
-is followed on the same line by the overall name of the category of
-operation, the name of the class of the operation, the name of the
-operation, and its arguments, if any.@refill
-
-@need 800
-@noindent
-The template is:
-
-@example
-@group
-@@defop @var{category} @var{class} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-@var{body-of-definition}
-@@end defop
-@end group
-@end example
-
-@code{@@defop} creates an entry, such as `@code{expose} on
-@code{windows}', in the index of functions.@refill
-
-@item @@defmethod @var{class} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{}
-@findex defmethod
-The @code{@@defmethod} command is the definition command for methods
-in object-oriented programming. A method is a kind of function that
-implements an o